Home
Acronis Backup & Recovery 10 Advanced Workstation
Contents
1. Any user that has permission to read write files in an unmanaged vault can e back up data to the unmanaged vault e recover data from any backup located in the unmanaged vault e view and manage all the archives located in the unmanaged vault 4 1 1 Working with the Centralized vault view This section briefly describes the main elements of the Centralized vault view and suggests ways to work with them Vault toolbar The toolbar contains operational buttons that let you perform operations with the selected centralized vault See the Actions on centralized vaults p 125 section for details Pie chart with legend The pie chart lets you estimate the vault s load it shows the proportion of the vault s free space and occupied space The pie chart is not available if the vault is located on a tape library i free space space on the storage device where the vault is located For example if the vault is located on a hard disk the vault free space is free space of the appropriate volume f occupied space total size of backup archives and their metadata if it is located in the vault The legend displays the following information about the vault e for managed vaults only the name of the storage node that manages the vault e full path to the vault e total number of archives and backups stored in the vault e the ratio of the occupied space to the original data size 124 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e for ma
2. Time based alerts Last backup This option is effective when the console is connected to a managed machine p 348 or to the management server p 348 The option defines whether to alert if no backup was performed on a given machine for a period of time You can configure the time period that is considered critical for your business The preset is alert if the last successful backup on a machine was completed more than 5 days ago The alert is displayed in the Alerts section of the Dashboard When the console is connected to the management server this setting will also control the color scheme of the Last backup column s value for each machine Last connection This option is effective when the console is connected to the management server or to a registered machine p 349 The option defines whether to alert if no connection was established between a registered machine and the management server for a period of time so indicating that the machine might not be centrally managed for instance in the case of network connection failure to that machine You can configure the length of time that is considered critical The preset is alert if the machine s last connection to the management server was more than 5 days ago The alert is displayed in the Alerts section of the Dashboard When the console is connected to the management server this setting will also control the color scheme of the Last connect column s value for each
3. Dest removable media Dest removable media Dest HDD Dest network share Dest Tape Dest removable media Dest removable media Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Dest HDD Dest network share Dest Tape Dest removable media Dest removable media Reset archive bit Reboot after the backup Create full backups as synthetic backups Notifications E mail p 100 z Win Pop up p 101 z Event tracing Windows events log p 102 SNMP p 102 n 3 4 1 1 Archive protection This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media This option is effective for both disk level and file level backup The preset is Disabled To protect the archive from unauthorized access Fe 5 Select the Set password for the archive check box In the Enter the password field type a password In the Confirm the password field re type the password Select one of the following o Do not encrypt the archive will be protected with the password only o AES 128 the archive will be encrypted using the Advanced Standard Encryption AES algorithm with a 128 bit key o AES 192 the archive will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 192 bit key o AES 256 the archive will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 256 bit key Click OK The AES cryptographic algorithm operates in the Cipher b
4. Parameter Full backup Incremental Differential Retention rules Apply the rules only if the retention rules are set Cleanup schedule only if On schedule is selected Examples Weekly full backup Meaning Specifies on what schedule and under which conditions to perform a full backup For example the full backup can be set up to run every Sunday at 1 00 AM as soon as all users are logged off Specifies on what schedule and under which conditions to perform an incremental backup If the archive contains no backups at the time of the task run a full backup is created instead of the incremental backup Specifies on what schedule and under which conditions to perform a differential backup If the archive contains no full backups at the time of the task run a full backup is created instead of the differential backup Specifies what retention rules will be applied to the archive For example the cleanup procedure can be set up to delete all backups older than six months Specifies when to apply the retention rules p 38 For example the cleanup procedure can be set up to run after each backup and also on schedule This option is available only if you have set at least one retention rule in Retention rules Specifies a schedule for archive cleanup For example the cleanup can be scheduled to start on the last day of each month This option is available only if you selected On schedule i
5. The scheme allows for efficient data storage more backups accumulate toward the current time Having four backups we could recover data as of today yesterday half a week or a week ago Roll back period The number of days we can go back in the archive is different on different days The minimum number of days we are guaranteed to have is called the roll back period The following table shows full backup and roll back periods for schemes of various levels Number of Full backup On different Roll back levels every days can go period back 2 2 days 1 to 2 days 1 day Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 333 3 4 days 2 to 5 days 2 days 4 8 days 4 to 11 days 4 days 5 16 days 8 to 23 days 8 days 6 32 days 16to 47 days 16 days Adding a level doubles the full backup and roll back periods To see why the number of recovery days varies let us return to the previous example Here are the backups we have on day 12 numbers in gray denote deleted backups A new level 3 differential backup has not yet been created so the backup of day five is still stored Since it depends on the full backup of day one that backup is available as well This enables us to go as far back as 11 days which is the best case scenario The following day however a new third level differential backup is created and the old full backup is deleted This gives us only a four day recovery interval which turns out to be the worst case scenario
6. To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them 6 9 6 3 Set active volume If you have several primary volumes you must specify one to be the boot volume For this you can set a volume to become active A disk can have only one active volume so if you set a volume as active the volume which was active before will be automatically unset If you need to set a volume active 1 Select a primary volume on a basic MBR disk to set as active 2 Right click on the selected volume and then click Mark as active in the context menu If there is no other active volume in the system the pending operation of setting active volume will be added ee ee es etsy 3 If another active volume is present in the system you will receive the warning that the previous active volume will have to be set passive first By clicking OK in the Warning window you ll add the pending operation of setting active volume Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 269 To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view immediately 6 9 6 4 Change volume letter Windows operating systems assign letters C D etc to hard disk volumes at startup
7. Use the mount command specifying the volume s index in the i parameter For example Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 trueimagemnt mount mnt filename smb server backups linux_machine tib i 4 This command mounts the logical volume DYN1 whose index in the backup is 4 on the mount point mnt To unmount a backup volume e Use the unmount command specifying the volume s mount point as a parameter For example trueimagemnt unmount mnt 6 8 6 Acronis PXE Server Acronis PXE Server allows for booting machines to Acronis bootable components through the network Network booting e eliminates the need to have a technician onsite to install the bootable media into the system that must be booted e during group operations reduces the time required for booting multiple machines as compared to using physical bootable media Booting multiple machines from the Acronis PXE Server makes sense if there is a Dynamic Host Control Protocol DHCP server on your network Then the network interfaces of the booted machines will automatically obtain IP addresses Without the DHCP you will have to pre configure and upload on the PXE server the bootable agent for each machine separately 6 8 6 1 Acronis PXE Server Installation To install Acronis PXE Server 1 Run the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 setup file 2 Select Acronis PXE Server from the list of Centralized management components 3 Follow the onscreen ins
8. 2000 2009 3 The management server deploys the policy to the machines 4 Oneach machine the agent p 339 installed on the machine finds data items using the selection rules For example if the selection rule is All volumes the entire machine will be backed up 5 On each machine the agent installed on the machine creates a backup plan p 340 using other rules specified by the policy Such backup plan is called a centralized plan p 342 6 On each machine the agent installed on the machine creates a set of centralized tasks p 342 that will carry out the plan Backup scheme A part of the backup plan p 340 that includes the backup schedule and optionally the retention rules and the cleanup p 343 schedule For example perform full backup p 347 monthly on the last day of the month at 10 00AM and incremental backup p 347 on Sundays at 10 00PM Delete backups that are older than 3 months Check for such backups every time the backup operation is completed Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the ability to use well known optimized backup schemes such as GFS p 347 and Tower of Hanoi p 351 to create a custom backup scheme or back up data once Bootable agent A bootable rescue utility that includes most of the functionality of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent p 339 Bootable agent is based on Linux kernel A machine p 347 can be booted into a bootable agent using either bootable medi
9. Acronis Active Restore The Acronis proprietary technology that brings a system online immediately after the system recovery is started The system boots from the backup p 344 and the machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services The data required to serve incoming requests is recovered with the highest priority everything else is recovered in the background Limitations e the backup must be located on the local drive any device available through the BIOS except for network boot e does not work with Linux images Acronis Plug in for WinPE A modification of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows that can run in the preinstallation environment The plug in can be added to a WinPE p 352 image using Acronis WinPE ISO Builder The resulting bootable media p 341 can be used to boot any PC compatible machine and perform with certain limitations most of the direct management p 344 operations without help of an operating system Operations can be configured and controlled either locally through the GUI or remotely using the console p 343 Acronis Secure Zone A secure volume for storing backup archives p 339 within a managed machine p 348 Advantages e enables recovery of a disk to the same disk where the disk s backup resides e offers a cost effective and handy method for protecting data from software malfunction virus attack operator error e eliminates the need for a separate me
10. Backing up files and folders Backing up an entire virtual machine or its volumes Disk backup recovery File and folder recovery Recovery of volumes from a disk backup Master boot record recovery Recovery of a disk volume backup to an existing virtual machine Recovery of a disk volume backup to a new virtual machine Recovery of a virtual machine backup to an existing virtual machine Recovery of a virtual machine backup to a new virtual machine Validation of a single archive Validation of backups Validation of all archives stored in a vault Deleting backups from a backup archive in accordance with retention rules Creating Acronis Secure Zone Resizing changing password deleting Acronis Secure Zone Disk management operations Service task performed on a storage node Depending on the type of task and whether it is running or not a combination of the following tabs will appear Task The Task tab is common for all types of tasks It provides general information on the selected task Archive The Archive tab is available for backup archive validation and cleanup tasks Provides information on the archive its name type size where it is stored etc Backup The Backup tab is available for recovery backup validation and export tasks 188 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Provides details on the selected backup when it was created its type full incremental differential information on the arc
11. The name looks like ArchiveN where N is a sequence number If the program finds that the archive Archive is already stored in the location it will automatically suggest the name Archive2 7 2 6 Access credentials for location Specify credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive will be stored The user name of these credentials will be considered as the archive owner To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the policy credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the backup policy specified in the General section o Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify Use this option if the policy credentials do not have access permissions to the location You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK ee me ee em wn we cm we cme cme ee em we ee ee ee me oe ee me ee oe eee oe ee oe ee oe eee ee eee oe eee ee eee oe eee oe ee oe eee oe ee oe ee oe ee eee ee ee eee eee eee eee eee eee eee eee Warning As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred through a network as plaintext This means
12. o When backup completes successfully to send a notification when the backup task has completed successfully o When backup fails to send a notification when the backup task has failed The When user interaction is required check box is always selected 4 For the e mail message to include the log entries related to the backup select the Add full log to the notification check box 5 Click Additional e mail parameters to configure additional e mail parameters as follows then click OK o From type the e mail address of the user from whom the message will be sent If you leave this field empty messages will be constructed as if they are from the destination address o Use encryption you can opt for encrypted connection to the mail server SSL and TLS encryption types are available for selection o Some Internet service providers require authentication on the incoming mail server before being allowed to send something If this is your case select the Log on to incoming mail server check box to enable a POP server and to set up its settings e Incoming mail server POP enter the name of the POP server e Port set the port of the POP server By default the port is set to 110 e User name enter the user name e Password enter the password o Select the Use the specified outgoing mail server check box to enable an SMTP server and to set up its settings e Outgoing mail server SMTP enter the name of t
13. 273 342 343 344 Centralized task 341 342 344 Centralized vault 19 20 52 342 348 Centralized vaults 123 300 Change volume label 265 270 Change volume letter 265 270 Choosing a backup scheme 139 Choosing the operating system for disk management 258 Cleanup 24 130 339 341 343 350 352 Client and server applications 74 Cloning method and advanced options 260 Common operations 157 Communication between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components 73 Components for centralized management 18 Compression level 89 98 Conditions 107 173 Configuring Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components 306 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Configuring communication settings 74 Connecting to a machine booted from media 250 Console Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console 24 338 341 343 344 Console options 82 Consolidation 132 339 343 Content selection 212 214 Create volume wizard 266 Creating a backup plan 185 193 230 283 289 Creating a backup policy 278 297 318 Creating a custom static or dynamic group e 283 292 293 295 Creating a managed centralized vault 125 127 134 297 298 Creating a personal vault e 156 157 Creating a volume 265 Creating Acronis Secure Zone 47 156 238 326 Creating an unmanaged centralized vault 125 129 Criteria of the choice 140 Cumulat
14. 342 349 Physical machines 280 Plan 349 Policies on machines and groups 56 281 Policy 349 Policy credentials 318 319 Policy deployment state on a group 63 Policy deployment state on a machine 61 Policy details 276 278 279 287 295 Policy selection 282 286 292 357 Policy status on a group 64 Policy status on a machine 62 Pop up messages 82 Post backup command 94 Post data capture command 96 Post recovery command 115 Pre Post commands 89 93 95 113 114 Pre Post data capture commands 89 94 98 Pre backup command 93 Pre data capture command 95 Pre recovery command 114 Prerequisites 133 Privileges for centralized management 69 Privileges for local connection 69 Privileges for remote connection in Windows 69 Proprietary Acronis technologies 46 Protecting the servers 54 Protecting the virtual machines 56 Protecting the workstations 55 PXE and DHCP on the same server 256 PXE Server 20 R Recovering a vast number of files from a file backup 229 Recovering data 158 211 225 283 Recovering from tape library 135 Recovering MD devices and logical volumes 252 Recovery point 347 349 351 Recovery priority e 113 115 Registered machine 83 342 349 Registration 20 51 56 86 280 349 Rescan 126 134 135 136 137 154 Result confirmation 238 240 Retention rules 38 202 208 209
15. 343 can be performed quite fast without 130 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 accessing the media It is possible to view the content of a backup archive located on a tape through the console even if a tape library is turned off due to content information stored in the database To create an incremental or differential backup of data the program uses the database instead of loading mounting rewinding and reading a tape with the full data backup However a tape should be read for example to validate p 351 a backup or to recover data from a backup A tape library can be locally attached to a machine the agent is installed on but only in the case the library is considered as a single tape drive The agent can use such device to write and read data backups but the backup s format differs from the format of the backups on the tapes written through the storage node To get information about the readability of the archives on tapes written by different components of other versions of the product by means of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 see the Tape compatibility table p 44 section Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 enables you to set up distribution of backups by media For example a separate tape set can be used to back up some specific data and the backups of all other data will be written onto any currently mounted tape which does not belong to the tape set See the Tape options p 109 section for more information Th
16. Disk 1 LDM database Disk2 Protec GPT Microsoft LDM tive MBR Reserved database Partition MSR LDM Metadata partition 1 MB Dynamic disks organized on MBR Disk 1 and GPT Disk 2 disks For more information about dynamic disks please refer to the following Microsoft knowledge base articles Disk Management Windows XP Professional Resource Kit http technet microsoft com en us library bb457110 aspx Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 345 816307 Best practices for using dynamic disks on Windows Server 2003 based computers http support microsoft com kb 816307 Dynamic group A group of machines p 347 which is populated automatically by the management server p 348 according to membership criteria specified by the administrator Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 offers the following membership criteria e Operating system e Active Directory organization unit IP address range A machine remains in a dynamic group as long as the machine meets the group s criteria The machine is removed from the group automatically as soon as e the machine s properties change so that the machine does not meet the criteria anymore OR e the administrator changes the criteria so that the machine does not meet them anymore There is no way to remove a machine from a dynamic group manually except for deleting the machine from the management server Dynamic volume Any volume located on dynamic disks p 345 or more preci
17. In the first line select the rule from the list or type it manually To add another rule click the next empty line and select the rule from the list or type it manually The program remembers the rules typed manually and the next time you open the window these rules will be available for selection in the list The following table explains the pre defined rules that can be selected from the list To include In the Volumes column Comments Windows and Linux volumes All volumes Type or select All Volumes Refers to all volumes on machines running Windows and all mounted volumes on machines running Linux Windows volumes Volume C Type C or select it from the list 320 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 System volume Type or select System Volume The system volume contains the hardware specific files that are needed to start Windows such as Ntldr Boot ini and Ntdetect com There is only one system volume even if multiple Windows operating systems are installed on the computer Boot volume Type or select Boot Volume Refers to the registered machine s boot volume The boot volume contains the Windows folder and the supporting files for the Windows operating system typically located in the Windows System32 folder It may or may not be the same as the system volume If multiple operating systems are installed on the computer this is the boot volume of the operating system in which the agent is working
18. Inc 2000 2009 To perform the planned operation click Commit in the toolbar and then click Proceed in the Pending Operations window If you set a 64K cluster size for FAT16 FAT32 or on 8KB 64KB cluster size for NTFS Windows can mount the _ volume but some programs e g Setup programs might calculate its disk space incorrectly 6 9 6 2 Delete volume This version of Acronis Disk Director Lite has reduced functionality because it is mainly a tool for preparing bare metal systems for recovering previously saved volume images The features of resizing the existing volumes and creating the new volumes using free space from the existing ones exist on the full version of the software so with this version deleting an existing volume sometimes might be the only way to free the necessary disk space without changing the existing disk configuration After a volume is deleted its space is added to unallocated disk space It can be used for creation of a new volume or to change another volume s type If you need to delete a volume 1 Select a hard disk and a volume to be deleted 2 Select Delete volume or a similar item in the Operations sidebar list or click the Delete the selected volume icon on the toolbar If the volume contains any data you will receive the warning that all the information on this volume will be lost irrevocably By clicking OK in the Delete volume window you ll add the pending operation of volume deletion
19. Pre recovery command To specify a command batch file to be executed before the recovery process starts 1 In the Command field type a command or browse to a batch file The program does not support interactive commands i e commands that require user input for example pause 2 Inthe Working directory field specify a path to a directory where the command batch file will be executed 3 Inthe Arguments field specify the command s execution arguments if required 4 Depending on the result you want to obtain select the appropriate options as described in the table below 5 Click Test command to check if the command is correct Check box Selection Fail the task if the command Selected Cleared Selected Cleared execution fails Do not recover until the Selected Selected Cleared Cleared command execution is complete 114 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Result Preset Perform the N A Perform the recovery after recover Perform the recovery f 7 the command is concurrently with only after the l executed despite the command command is execution failure execution and successfully or SUCCESS irrespective of the executed Fail the command task if the command execution result execution failed Post recovery command To specify a command executable file to be executed after the recovery is completed 1 Inthe Command field type a command or browse to a batch file 2 Inthe Working directory
20. T keme to back wp 13 59 G8 Al 2 volumes NTFS GC Pew Volume E gt Exclusens tne bak Archive Access credentials Administrator plan s cece Gets L Archie coments d Heb Action page Create backup plan Using controls and specifying settings The action pages offer two ways of representation basic and advanced The basic representation hides such fields as credentials comments etc When the advanced representation is enabled all the available fields are displayed You can switch between the views by selecting the Advanced view check box at the top of the action page Most settings are configured by clicking the respective Change links to the right Others are selected from the drop down list or typed manually in the page s fields advanced view GE General Plan name Backup 2 25 2009 7 41 21 AM Plan s credentials Run as Administrator current user Change Comments a i n taun w EN l Action page Controls 1 3 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components This section contains a list of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components with a brief description of their functionality 16 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 includes three types of components Components for a managed machine agents These are applications that perform data backup recovery and other operations on the machines managed with Acronis B
21. The connection will be established only if the use of SSL certificates is enabled on the client application Disabled The same as Not configured 2 11 8 4 Network port configuration Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components use the 9876 TCP network communication port by default The server listens to this port for incoming connection This port is also used as default by the Acronis client During component installation you might be asked to confirm the port opening or to open the port manually in case you are using a firewall other than Windows Firewall After installation you can change the ports at any time to match your preferable values or for the purpose of security This operation requires the restart of Acronis Remote Agent in Windows or the Acronis_agent in Linux service After the port is changed on the server side connect to the server using the lt Server IP gt lt port gt or the lt Server hostname gt lt port gt URL notation Note If you use network address translation NAT you can also configure the port by setting up port mapping Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Tl Configuring the port in the operating system Windows To be able to change the ports numbers load and configure the Administrative Template provided by Acronis as described in Configuring communication settings p 74 under Remote Agent ports Linux Specify the port in the etc Acronis Policies Agent config file Restart
22. To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the plan s credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials of the backup plan account specified in the General section o Use the following credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials you specify Use this option if the plan account does not have access permissions to the location You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK Warning As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are _ transferred through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer ee nts sts sss sts ss ists sts si ssi tis ssh sts iiss ssh ss os sceesesesesenasesesesness 6 2 9 Backup schemes Choose one of the available backup schemes e Back up now to create a backup task for manual start and run the task immediately after its creation e Back up later to create a backup task for manual start OR schedule one time task execution in the future 200 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e Simple to schedule when and how often to backup
23. and suggests the ways to work with them Vault toolbar The toolbar contains operational buttons that let you perform operations with the selected personal vault See the Actions on personal vaults p 156 section for details Pie chart with legend The pie chart lets you estimate the vault s load it shows the proportion of the vault s free space and occupied space i free space space on the storage device where the vault is located For example if the vault is located on a hard disk the vault free space is free space of the appropriate volume f occupied space total size of backup archives and their metadata if it is located in the vault Other files that may be put to this folder by a user are not counted The legend displays the following information about the vault e full path to the vault e total number of archives and backups stored in the vault e the ratio of the occupied space to the original data size Vault content The Vault content section contains the archives table and toolbar The archives table displays archives and backups that are stored in the vault Use the archives toolbar to perform actions on the selected archives and backups The list of backups is expanded by clicking the plus sign to the left of the archive s name All the archives are grouped by type on the following tabs e The Disk archives tab lists all the archives that contain disk or volume backups images e The File archives tab l
24. appropriate place with the zero size A volume backup stores all other files and folders of the selected volume independent of their Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 321 attributes including hidden and system files the boot record the file allocation table FAT if it exists the root and the zero track of the hard disk with the master boot record MBR The boot code of GPT volumes is not backed up A disk backup stores all volumes of the selected disk including hidden volumes such as the vendor s maintenance partitions and the zero track with the master boot record Linux A volume backup stores all files and folders of the selected volume independent of their attributes a boot record and the file system super block A disk backup stores all disk volumes as well as the zero track with the master boot record Volumes with unsupported file systems will be backed up sector by sector Note on Linux machines You can include both Windows and Linux volumes partitions in one centralized backup policy For instance it is possible to set up a policy to back up volume C on Windows machines and partition dev hda1 on Linux machines Unlike Windows there is no clear distinction between a volume partition and a folder directory in Linux Linux has the root partition denoted as to which elements of various types including hard disks directories and system devices are attached mounted forming a tree similar to the f
25. before data is recovered from it Check file system after recovery This option is effective only when recovering disks or volumes When operating under bootable media this option is not effective for the NTFS file system The preset is Disabled This option defines whether to check the integrity of the file system after a disk or volume recovery Restart machine automatically if it is required for recovery This option is effective when recovery takes place on a machine running an operating system The preset is Disabled The option defines whether to reboot the machine automatically if it is required for recovery Such might be the case when a volume locked by the operating system has to be recovered Reboot machine after recovery This option is effective when operating under bootable media The preset is Disabled This option enables booting the machine into the recovered operating system without user interaction Change SID after the recovery is finished The preset is Disabled Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 can generate an unique security identifier SID for the recovered system You do not need a new SID when recovering a system over itself or when creating a system replica that will replace the original system Generate a new SID if the original and the recovered systems will work concurrently in the same workgroup or domain 120 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 3 4 2 8 VM power management These options a
26. but plan to keep safe only certain data the current project for example choose file backup This will reduce the archive size thus saving storage space Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 195 Disks volumes Available if the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or for Linux is installed Select this option to back up disks and or volumes To be able to back up disks or volumes you must have Administrator or Backup operator privileges Backing up disks and volumes enables you to recover the entire system in case of severe data damage or hardware failure The backup procedure is faster than copying files and may significantly speed up the backup process when it comes to backing up large volumes of data _ Note for Linux users We recommend that you unmount any volumes that contain non journaling file systems such as the ext2 file system before backing them up Otherwise these volumes might contain corrupted files upon recovery recovery of these volumes with resize might fail 6 2 4 Items to back up The items to backup depend on the source type p 195 selected previously 6 2 4 1 Selecting disks and volumes To specify disks volumes to back up 1 Select the check boxes for the disks and or volumes to back up You can select a random set of disks and volumes _ If your operating system and its loader reside on different volumes always include both volumes in the backup The volumes must also
27. lt gt Set up a date when this schedule will be disabled If this check box is cleared the task will be run for an indefinite number of days Advanced scheduling settings p 169 are available only for machines registered on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server To specify these settings click Change in the Advanced settings area All the settings you made are displayed in the Result field at the bottom of the window 162 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Examples Simple daily schedule Run the task every day at 6PM The schedule s parameters are thus set up as follows 1 2 Every 1 day s Once at 06 00 00 PM Effective From not set The task will be started on the current day if it has been created before 6PM If you have created the task after 6 PM the task will be started for the first time on the next day at 6 PM To not set The task will be performed for an indefinite number of days Three hour time interval lasting for three months schedule Run the task every three hours The task starts on a certain date say September 15 2009 and ends after three months The schedule s parameters are thus set up as follows 1 2 Every 1 day s Every 3 hours From 12 00 00 AM midnight Until 09 00 00 PM thus the task will be performed 8 times a day with a 3 hour time interval After the last daily recurrence at 9 PM the next day comes and the task starts over agai
28. p 47 lets you recover and boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware or a virtual machine A Windows system can be brought online in seconds while it is still being recovered Using the proprietary Acronis Active Restore p 49 technology Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will boot the machine into the operating system found in the backup as if the system were on the physical disk The system becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services Thus the system downtime will be minimal A dynamic volume can be recovered over an existing volume to unallocated space of a disk group or to unallocated space of a basic disk To learn more about recovering dynamic volumes please turn to the Microsoft LDM Dynamic volumes p 41 section Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows has the ability to recover a disk volume backup to a new virtual machine of any of the following types VMware Workstation Microsoft Virtual PC Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance The virtual appliance can then be imported to XenServer The VMware Workstation machine can be converted to the open virtualization format OVF using the VMware OVF tool With Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi you can create a new virtual machine on the respective virtualization server You might need to prepare target disks before recovery Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 includes a handy disk management utility
29. protocol Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 73 e Encrypted communication provides secure transfer of information between any two components for example between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node by encrypting the data being transferred For instructions on how to set up secure authentication and data encryption settings see Configuring communication options p 74 For instructions on how to manage SSL certificates used for secure authentication see SSL certificates p 79 Note The components of earlier Acronis products including those of the Acronis True Image Echo family cannot connect to the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components regardless of the secure authentication and data encryption settings 2 11 8 2 Client and server applications There are two stakeholders of the secure communication process e Client application or client is an application that tries to establish connection e Server application or server is an application to which the client tries to connect For example if Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console is connecting to Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent on a remote machine the former is the client and the latter is the server An Acronis component can act as a client application a server application or both as shown in the following table Component name Can be Can be client server Acronis Back
30. such as revoke policies or explore policy inheritance The panel is collapsed by default To expand the panel click the l chevron The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Group details p 295 window 7 1 3 1 Actions on machines Registering machines on the management server Once the machine is added or imported to the All physical machines group it becomes registered on the management server Registered machines are available for deploying backup policies and for performing other centralized management operations Registration provides a trusted relationship between the agent residing on the machine and the management server Adding and importing actions are available when you select the iE Physical machines view or the am All physical machines group in the navigation tree To Do Add a new machine to the Click 4 Add a machine to AMS management server In the Add machine p 284 window select the machine that needs to be added to the management server Import machines from Click W Import machines from Active Directory Active Directory In the Import machines from Active Directory p 285 window specify the machines or organizational units whose machines you need to import to the management server Import machines from a Click Import machines from file text file In the Import machines from file p 285 window browse for a txt or csv file containing the names or IP addresses of machines to
31. vault Deduplication and NTFS data streams In the NTFS file system a file may have one or more additional sets of data associated with it often called alternate data streams When such file is backed up so are all its alternate data streams However these streams are never deduplicated even when the file itself is 68 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 2 11 7 Privileges for centralized management This section describes the users privileges that are required to manage a machine locally and remotely to manage a machine registered on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server and to access and manage Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node 2 11 7 1 Types of connection to a managed machine There are two types of connection to a managed machine local connection and remote connection Local connection The local connection is established between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console on a machine and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent on the same machine To establish a local connection e On the toolbar click Connect then point to New connection and then click This machine Remote connection A remote connection is established between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console on one machine and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent on another machine You might need to specify logon credentials to establish a remote connection To establish a remote connection 1 O
32. 2000 2009 To select whether to send the recovery operations events to the SNMP managers Choose one of the following e Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine For more information refer to Machine options p 86 e Send SNMP notifications individually for recovery operation events to send the events of the recovery operations to the specified SNMP managers o Types of events to send choose the types of events to be sent All events Errors and warnings or Errors only o Server name IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management application the messages will be sent to o Community type the name of SNMP community to which both the host running SNMP management application and the sending machine belong The typical community is public Click Send test message to check if the settings are correct Do not send SNMP notifications to disable sending the log events of the recovery operations to SNMP managers 3 4 2 6 Error handling These options are effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media These options enable you to specify how to handle errors that might occur during recovery Do not show messages and dialogs while processing silent mode The preset is Disabled With the silent mode enabled the program will automatically handle situations requiring user interaction where possible If an operation ca
33. 2009 disk space say 1 GB the files that are specific to each machine occupy the other 50 another 1 GB In a deduplicating vault the size of the first machine s backup in this case will be 2 GB and that of the second machine will be 1 GB In a non deduplicating vault the backups would occupy 4 GB in total As a result the deduplication ratio is 4 3 or about 1 33 1 Similarly in case of three machines the ratio becomes 1 5 1 for four machines it is 1 6 1 It approaches 2 1 as more such machines are backed up to the same vault This means that you can buy say a 10 TB storage device instead of a 20 TB one The actual amount of capacity reduction is influenced by numerous factors such as the type of data that is being backed up the frequency of the backup and the backups retention period 2 11 6 4 How deduplication works Deduplication at source When performing a backup to a deduplicating vault Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent reads items being backed up disk blocks for disk backup or files for file backup and calculates a fingerprint of each block Such a fingerprint often called a hash value uniquely represents the item s content within the vault Before sending the item to the vault the agent queries the deduplication database to determine whether the item s hash value is the same as that of an already stored item If so the agent sends only the item s hash value otherwise it sends the item itself
34. 210 328 335 336 343 358 Rights for Acronis services 72 320 RSM Media Pools 130 132 Run backup plan 184 187 289 Running Acronis Disk Director Lite 257 S Scheduling 107 161 202 210 234 328 337 Secure communication 73 Select destination disks 267 268 Select the type of volume being created 266 267 Selecting disks and volumes 196 Selecting files and folders 197 Selecting source and target disks 260 Selection rule 62 340 349 Set active volume 265 269 Set the volume options 268 Set the volume size 267 268 Setting up a machine to boot from PXE 255 Setting up centralized data protection ina heterogeneous network 10 52 Setting up SNMP services on the receiving machine 88 Simple scheme 201 328 SNMP notifications 85 87 91 102 113 118 Source files exclusion 89 92 Source type 189 193 195 196 SSL certificates 74 76 79 Startup page 82 Static group 342 350 Storage Node 9 19 43 52 297 Storage node Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node 19 52 342 343 347 348 350 Storage node details 297 298 299 Storage nodes 296 Storage node side cleanup 20 123 297 348 350 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Storage node side validation 20 123 297 348 350 Supported file systems 22 Supported operating systems 21 y Tape compatibility table 44 131 132 154 Tape libr
35. 327 Specify when and how often to back up your data define for how long to keep the created backup archives in the selected location set up a schedule for the archive cleanup procedure Use well known optimized backup schemes such as Grandfather Father Son and Tower of Hanoi create a custom backup scheme or back up data once Archive validation When to validate Optional Define when and how often to perform validation and whether to validate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive Backup options Settings Optional Configure parameters of the backup operation such as pre post backup commands maximum network bandwidth allocated for the backup stream or the backup archive compression level If you do nothing in this section the default values p 89 as set in the management server will be used After any of the settings is changed against the default value a new line that displays the newly set value appears The setting status changes from Default to Custom Should you modify the setting again the line will display the new value unless the new value is the default one When the default value is set the line disappears and so you always see only the settings that differ from the default values in this section of the Create Backup Policy page To reset all the settings to the default values click Reset to default During the backup operation the registered machines default backup options are ignored Aft
36. All fixed volumes Type or select Fixed Volumes Refers to all volumes other than removable media Fixed volumes include volumes on SCSI ATAPI ATA SSA SAS and SATA devices and on RAID arrays Linux volumes First partition on Type or select dev hda1 hda1 is the standard device name for the the first IDE hard first partition of the first IDE hard disk disk of a Linux drive For more details see Note on Linux machine machines First partition on Type or select dev sda1 sda1 is the standard device name for the the first SCSI hard first partition of the first SCSI hard disk disk of a Linux drive For more details see Note on Linux machine machines First partition on Type or select dev md1 md1 is the standard device name for the the first software first partition of the first software RAID RAID hard disk of a drive For more details see Note on Linux Linux machine machines The names of templates such as All Volumes or System Volume are case insensitive you can type All volumes all volumes etc What does a disk or volume backup store For supported file systems a disk or volume backup stores only those sectors that contain data This reduces the resulting backup size and speeds up the backup and recovery operations Windows The swap file pagefile sys and the file that keeps the RAM content when the machine goes into hibernation hiberfil sys are not backed up After recovery the files will be re created in the
37. Basic MBR volume Basic GPT volume Backed up source Basic MBR volume Dynamic volume Type as of the target Dynamic volume Simple Basic MBR volume Basic GPT volume Basic MBR Basic GPT volume Dynamic volume Type as of the target N A Basic MBR volume Basic GPT volume Basic MBR volume Basic MBR volume volume Unallocated space basic GPT disk Basic GPT volume Basic GPT volume Basic GPT volume Moving and resizing volumes during recovery You can resize the resulting basic volume both MBR and GPT during recovery or change the volume s location on the disk A resulting dynamic volume cannot be moved or resized Preparing disk groups and volumes Before recovering dynamic volumes to bare metal you should create a disk group on the target hardware You also might need to create or increase unallocated space on an existing disk group This can be done by deleting volumes or converting basic disks to dynamic You might want to change the target volume type basic simple spanned striped mirrored RAID 0 1 RAID 5 This can be done by deleting the target volume and creating a new volume on the resulting unallocated space Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 includes a handy disk management utility which enables you to perform the above operations both under the operating system and on bare metal To find out more about Acronis Disk Director Lite see the Disk management p 256 section 2 9
38. Controlling user rights to perform operations and access backups Running services with minimal user rights Restricted remote access to a backup agent Secure communication between the product components Using third party certificates for authentication of the components Data encryption options for both data transmission and storage Backup of remote machines to a centralized storage node behind firewalls 1 2 Getting started Direct management 1 3 Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent Start the console Windows Start the console by selecting it from the start menu Connect the console to the machine where the agent is installed Where to go from here For what to do next see Basic concepts p 24 For understanding of the GUI elements see Using the management console p 10 Centralized management We recommend that you first try to manage the single machine using direct management as described above To start with centralized management 1 2 Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server p 19 Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agents on the machines that need data protection When installing the agents register each of the machines on the management server To do so enter the server s IP or name and the centralized administrator s credentials in one of the installation wizard s windows Install Acronis Backup a
39. DWORD Value e Base Decimal e Value 40 3 Add the PagedPoolSize entry to the subkey e Entry type DWORD Value e Base Hexadecimal e Value FFFFFFFF 4 Quit Registry Editor and then restart the machine If this does not resolve the problem or for more details on adding these registry settings see the corresponding Microsoft Help and Support article Tip In general if a volume contains many files consider using a disk level backup instead of a file level one In _ this case you will be able to recover the entire volume as well as particular files stored on it 6 4 Validating vaults archives and backups Validation is an operation that checks the possibility of data recovery from a backup Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination Validation of a disk or volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup Both procedures are resource intensive Validation of an archive will validate all the archive s backups A vault or a location validation will validate all archives stored in this vault location While successful validation means high probability of successful recovery it does not check all factors that influence the recovery process If you back up the operating system only a test recovery in bootable environment to a spare hard drive can guarantee success of the recovery At least ensure that the backup can be successfully validated
40. In the management console click Recover In Archive click Change and then specify the name of the archive In Backup click Change and then select the backup from which you want to recover data In Data type select Volumes In Items to recover select the check box next to my_volgroup my_logvol Under Where to recover click Change and then select the logical volume that you created in Step 1 Click the chevron buttons to expand the list of disks Click OK to start the recovery For a complete list of commands and utilities that you can use in the bootable media environment see List of commands and utilities available in Linux based bootable media p 250 For detailed descriptions of the trueimagecmd and trueimagemnt utilities see the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 command line reference Mounting backup volumes You may want to mount a volume stored in a disk backup for example to view some files in it before Starting the recovery To mount a backup volume 1 2 254 Use the list command to list the volumes which are stored in the backup For example trueimagecmd list filename smb server backups linux_machine tib The output will contain lines similar to the following Num Idx Partition Flags Start Size Type Disk 1 Table O Table Disk 2 Table O Table Dynamic amp GPT Volumes DYN1 4 my_volgroup my_logvol 12533760 Ext2 You will need the volume s index given in the Idx column in the next step
41. On day 14 the interval is five days It increases on subsequent days before decreasing again and so on The roll back period shows how many days we are guaranteed to have even in the worst case For a four level scheme it is four days 1 2 1 6 Custom backup scheme At a glance e Custom schedule and conditions for backups of each type e Custom schedule and retention rules 334 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Parameters Parameter Full backup Incremental Differential Retention rules Apply the rules only if the retention rules are set Cleanup schedule only if On schedule is selected Examples Weekly full backup Meaning Specifies on what schedule and under which conditions to perform a full backup For example the full backup can be set up to run every Sunday at 1 00 AM as soon as all users are logged off Specifies on what schedule and under which conditions to perform an incremental backup If the archive contains no backups at the time of the task run a full backup is created instead of the incremental backup Specifies on what schedule and under which conditions to perform a differential backup If the archive contains no full backups at the time of the task run a full backup is created instead of the differential backup Specifies what retention rules will be applied to the archive For example the cleanup procedure can be set up to delete all backups older than six
42. PM during one day From lt gt Until lt gt In the Effective area set the following settings From lt gt Set up a date when this schedule will be enabled an effective date If this check box is cleared the task will be started on the nearest day and time you have specified above To lt gt Set up a date when this schedule will be disabled If this check box is cleared the task will be run for an indefinite number of months Advanced scheduling settings p 169 are available only for machines registered on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server To specify these settings click Change in the Advanced settings area All the settings you made are displayed in the Result field at the bottom of the window Examples Last day of every month schedule Run the task once at 10 PM on the last day of every month The schedule s parameters are set up as follows Months lt All months gt Days Last The task will run on the last day of every month despite its actual date Once at 10 00 00 PM eS E Effective From empty To empty Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 167 This schedule is widely used when creating a custom backup scheme The Last day of every month schedule is added to the full backups while the differential backups are scheduled to be performed once a week and incremental on workdays For more details see the Monthly full weekly differential and daily increm
43. PXE Support netsh dhcp gt set optionvalue 60 STRING PXEClient 6 8 6 4 Work across subnets To enable the Acronis PXE Server to work in another subnet across the switch configure the switch to relay the PXE traffic The PXE server IP addresses are configured on a per interface basis using IP helper functionality in the same way as DHCP server addresses For more information please refer to http support microsoft com default aspx kb 257579 6 9 Disk management Acronis Disk Director Lite is a tool for preparing a machine disk volume configuration for recovering the volume images saved by the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 software 256 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Sometimes after the volume has been backed up and its image placed into a safe storage the machine disk configuration might change due to a HDD replacement or hardware loss In such case with the help of Acronis Disk Director Lite the user has the possibility to recreate the necessary disk configuration so that the volume image can be recovered exactly as it was or with any alteration of the disk or volume structure the user might consider necessary All operations on disks and volumes involve a certain risk of data damage Operations on system bootable or data volumes must be carried out very carefully to avoid potential problems with the booting process or hard _ disk data storage Operations with hard disks and volumes take a certain amount
44. Revoke machine group l l l The management server will revoke the policy from the selected machine or group of machines The policy itself remains on the management server 7 1 3 Physical machines Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 lets the administrator protect data and perform management operations on multiple machines The administrator adds a machine to the management server using the machine s name or IP address imports machines from Active Directory or from text files Once a machine is registered p 349 on the management server it becomes available for grouping applying backup policies and monitoring the activities related to data protection To estimate whether the data is successfully protected on a managed machine the management server administrator checks its status A machine s status is defined as the most severe status of all backup plans p 180 both local and centralized existing on the machine and all backup policies p 276 applied to the machine It can be OK Warnings or Errors 280 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Groups The management server administrator has the ability to group machines A machine can be a member of more than one group One or more nested groups can be created inside any group created by the administrator Grouping helps organize data protection by the company departments by the Active Directory domains or organizational units within a domain by various populations of use
45. SERVE cccivcs seassey sone ussacuseuins Sucessconascnse a a a coyote evel a 255 DISK Waid COI OI sists esata wise derecgies Gach E EE E i Ea Ean EA EEN 256 Basie preca OMS a cuctecccc cde tarsus tsacusee seacwentase N studs tas aeee tur a te aude ne icun nad 257 Running Acronis Disk Director Lite vuiss4 ccs cutipacecs ee hse tie tae ees ha 257 Choosing the operating system for disk MANABEMENL c sccccessssececsssseceeessseeecessseeceesseeeeeessnaeees 258 DikmandeemMent VEW ceranae a cus enuses eauon aoe saueersocetueapentenewed van seeeaye 258 DiskoperatiONS eae erate epee a eR Pe OR A ae ees 259 NOME OD CTALION S sucdeatusirs trace E EEEE AA EAAS 265 PETTING CSCO sirien a E soa Cassone a ON 271 Centralized management sesessssesesesessesesscssoecesesssoeoecssssoscesesesseosoesssosoessossosseseee 273 Administering Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Serve cccccsseceeeeeeees 273 aS OG ANG iechecsack casas tacts Sucaseewstbetads custo R ie esaescah cassava usec sascc sa paaeeemeaneaeseennaas aaa S 273 BAC POLICIE Sica seu tcatonetcacsge tiene A T eo Meee 275 PIN SICA iia CINE S 2cecs lt ccesusesocansguus cases toncusveareuckasie hateveaes our teu tcenuceut asauue ney andanonabasdscaseuneisenatepumaeine meet eeck 280 7 1 4 Storage node mnsa a a a Sot sabe soot etia Ant ners ee eee urea 296 TAS MSK aa E a a N A 300 7 1 6 LOE aA a T apa Se eieteneusteaes tease 302 FE Configuring Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 co
46. SP4 Professional XP SP2 e Windows XP Professional x64 Edition Home Edition e Windows Vista all Editions Remote connection to the agent installed on Windows Home editions is not possible 1 5 Supported file systems Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 can back up and recover the following file systems with the following limitations e FAT16 32 e NTFS e Ext2 Ext3 e ReiserFS3 particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node e ReiserFS4 volume recovery without the volume resize capability particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node e XFS volume recovery without the volume resize capability particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node e JFS particular files cannot be recovered from disk backups located on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node e Linux SWAP Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 can back up and recover corrupted or non supported file systems using the sector by sector approach 1 6 Technical support As part of a purchased annual Support charge you are entitled to Technical Support as follows to the extent that electronic services are available you may electronically access at no additional charge Support services for the Software which Acronis shall endeavor to make available twenty four 24 hours a day
47. Some items such as encrypted files or disk blocks of a non standard size cannot be deduplicated and the agent always transfers such items to the vault without calculating their hash values For more information about restrictions of file level and disk level deduplication see Deduplication restrictions p 68 Deduplication at target After a backup to a deduplicating vault is completed the storage node deduplicates data in the vault as follows 1 It moves the items disk blocks or files from the archives to a special folder within the vault storing duplicate items there only once This folder is called the deduplication data store Items that cannot be deduplicated remain in the archives 2 Inthe archives it replaces the moved items with the correspondent references to them As a result the vault contains a number of unique deduplicated items with each item having one or more references to it from the vault s archives Compacting task After one or more backups or archives have been deleted from the vault either manually or during cleanup the vault may contain items which are no longer referred to from any archive Such items are deleted by the compacting task which is a scheduled task performed by the storage node Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 67 By default the compacting task runs every Sunday night at 03 00 You can re schedule the task as described in Operations with storage nodes p 297 under Change the
48. Some machines are being used as storage facilities where the operating system claims a small space segment and all other disk space is committed to storage such as movies sounds or other multimedia files Some of these storage volumes can be extremely large as compared to the system and so practically all the recovery time will be dedicated to recovering the files which might be used much later on if in any near future at all If you opt for Acronis Active Restore the system will be operational in a short time Users will be able to open the necessary files from the storage and use them while the rest of the files which are not immediately necessary are being recovered in the background Examples movie collection storage music collection storage multimedia storage How to use 1 Back up the system disk or volume to a location accessible through the system s BIOS This may be Acronis Secure Zone a USB hard drive a flash drive or any internal hard drive rm rerererm mm rererermemmteresermmenrerererm men tereresmeensesese mma teresa Steet TOTO Fete S LOLS mS TOTO FRIST StS t NIST FRETS LOLS FEI OI 1S TOTO TOF erer omamme reram ammore reamme oreraa ISSO tO O FRETS LS FSFE O11 tN S LOLS t REN r emama eres orams orema erer ormare SS IL RNS LS Le Sele mamase reroror oreraa esere _ If your operating system and its loader reside on different volumes always include both volumes in the backup The volumes must also be recovered together ot
49. Specify Windows XP and Windows Vista as the criteria This way any workstation that will be registered on the management server later will be added to this group and protected by the same policy Apply the policy to the W_1 group Make sure that the policy has been successfully deployed to each of the workstations The policy deployment state has to change from Deploying to Deployed and its status has to be OK To see the resulting backup plans on each of the workstations a navigate to the All machines group or the W_1 group b select the workstation c select the Backup plans and tasks tab on the Information pane You can also see the resulting tasks created on the workstations in the Tasks view Use the Dashboard or the Tasks view to track the daily activities related to the policy Once you ascertain that all tasks run as specified you can only check the policy status in the Backup policies view To protect data on a daily basis you can also use the GFS or Tower of Hanoi backup schemes Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 55 2 11 2 3 Protecting the virtual machines Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for ESX provides the flexibility to protect virtual machines in multiple ways e Connect the console to the virtual appliance Agent for ESX and create a backup plan that will back up all or some of the virtual machines e Connect the console to the virtual appliance Agent for ESX and create an individual backu
50. Sunday at 03 00 00 AM Repeat once Click View details In the Storage node details p 299 window the content of which is duplicated on the Information panel examine information about the storage node and the vaults managed by this node You can also manage the compacting task manually start and stop the task i Click su Refresh The management console will update the list of storage nodes from the management server with the most recent information Though the list of storage nodes is refreshed automatically based on events the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Adding a storage node To add a storage node 1 In the IP Name field enter the name or the IP address of the machine the storage node resides on or click Browse and browse the network for the machine Use the fully qualified domain name FQDN of the storage node that is a completely specified domain name ending in a top level domain Do not enter 127 0 0 1 or localhost as the storage node IP name These settings are no good even if the management server and the storage node are on the same machine because after the policy using the storage node is deployed each agent will try to access the storage node as if it were installed on the agent s host 2 To provide a valid user account for the
51. System disk conversion Acronis Disk Director Lite does not require an operating system reboot after dynamic to basic conversion of the disk if 1 There is a single Windows 2008 Vista operating system installed on the disk 2 The machine runs this operating system 2 Dynamic to basic conversion of the disk comprising of system volumes takes a certain amount of time and any _ power loss unintentional turning off of the machine or accidental pressing of the Reset button during the _ procedure could result in bootability loss In contrast to Windows Disk Manager the program ensures e safe conversion of a dynamic disk to basic when it contains volumes with data except striped spanned and RAID volumes e bootability of an offline operating system on the disk after the operation 264 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 9 6 Volume operations Acronis Disk Director Lite includes the following operations that can be performed on volumes e Create Volume p 265 Creates a new volume with the help of the Create Volume Wizard e Delete Volume p 269 Deletes the selected volume Set Active p 269 Sets the selected volume Active so that the machine will be able to boot with the OS installed there e Change Letter p 270 Changes the selected volume letter e Change Label p 270 Changes the selected volume label e Format Volume p 271 Formats a volume giving it the necessary file system The full ver
52. This is probably due unavailable or the license to the license server being unavailable You may also key data was corrupted want to ensure that the licenses are present on the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 177 Check connectivity to the server and run Acronis License Server to manage licenses Trial period is over Insert a full license key Low free space on X vaults Show list Bootable rescue media was Create now not created No backups performed Back up within last X days now Trial version of product expires in X days Not connected to the Show log management server for 3 days Activities license server 15 day trial period has expired Enter a full license key Show list will take you to the Vaults view where you can examine the vault size free space content and take the necessary steps to increase the free space To be able to recover an operating system when the machine fails to boot you must 1 Back up the system volume and the boot volume if it is different 2 Create at least one bootable media p 341 Create now will launch the Bootable Media Builder p 348 The Dashboard warns you that no data was backed up on the machine for a relatively long period of time Back up now will take you to Create a Backup Plan page where you can instantly configure and run the backup operation To configure the time interval that is considered as critical select Options gt Console options g
53. a basic MBR disk you can resize and relocate the volume by dragging it or its borders with a mouse or by entering corresponding values in the appropriate fields Using this feature you can redistribute the disk space between the volumes being recovered In this case you will have to recover the volume to be reduced first Properties Type A basic MBR disk can contain up to four primary volumes or up to three primary volumes and multiple logical drives By default the program selects the original volume s type You can change this setting if required e Primary Information about primary volumes is contained in the MBR partition table Most operating systems can boot only from the primary volume of the first hard disk but the number of primary volumes is limited If you are going to recover a system volume to a basic MBR disk select the Active check box Active volume is used for loading an operating system Choosing active for a volume without an Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 219 installed operating system could prevent the machine from booting You cannot set a logical drive or dynamic volume active e Logical Information about logical volumes is located not in the MBR but in the extended partition table The number of logical volumes on a disk is unlimited A logical volume cannot be set as active If you recover a system volume to another hard disk with its own volumes and operating system you will most likely need only
54. a better driver Use this option only if the automatic drivers search does not help to boot the system Drivers for a virtual machine When recovering a system to a new virtual machine the Universal Restore technology is applied in the background because the program knows what drivers are required for the supported virtual machines When recovering the system to an existing virtual machine that uses SCSI hard drive controller be sure to specify SCSI drivers for the virtual environment in the Mass storage drivers to install anyway step Use drivers bundled with your virtual machine software or download the latest drivers versions from the software manufacturer Web site 6 3 10 How to convert a disk backup to a virtual machine Rather than converting a TIB file to a virtual disk file which requires additional operations to bring the virtual disk into use Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 performs the conversion by recovery of a disk backup to a fully configured and operational new virtual machine You have the ability to adapt the virtual machine configuration to your needs when configuring the recovery operation With Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows you can recover a disk volume backup to a new virtual machine of any of the following types VMware Workstation Microsoft Virtual PC Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance Files of the new virtual machine will be placed in the folder you select Yo
55. a command batch file to be executed before the backup process starts 1 In the Command field type a command or browse to a batch file The program does not support interactive commands i e commands that require user input for example pause 2 Inthe Working directory field specify a path to a directory where the command batch file will be executed 3 Inthe Arguments field specify the command s execution arguments if required 4 Depending on the result you want to obtain select the appropriate options as described in the table below 5 Click Test command to check if the command is correct Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 93 Check box Selection Fail the task if the command Selected Cleared Selected Cleared execution fails Do not back up until the Selected Selected Cleared Cleared command execution is complete Result Preset Perform the N A Perform the backup after the backu Perform the p p command is concurrently with backup only after i executed despite the command the command is execution failure execution and successfully i or success irrespective of the executed Fail the EnA task if the execution result command execution fails Post backup command To specify a command executable file to be executed after the backup is completed 1 2 In the Command field type a command or browse to a batch file In the Working directory field specify a path to a directory where the
56. a member of Operations To Do View details of a group Click View details You will be taken to the Group details window where you can examine all information related to this group View tasks related to a Click E View tasks group You will be taken to the Tasks view with pre filtered tasks related to the selected backup group View log related to a group Click View log This opens Log view with pre filtered log entries of the selected group Remove machine from a Click Fs Remove group The centralized plans which were deployed to the parent group will no longer affect this machine Inheritance order The Inheritance order window lets you examine where the policy applied to the machine came from The policy that was directly applied to the machine is displayed as follows Machine name The policy that is applied on the machine through inheritance is displayed as in the following example Group1 gt kd Group2 gt Group3 gt Machine1 Group1 in the root contains Group2 to which the policy is applied directly Group2 in turn contains child Group3 that inherits the policy from the parent and applies the policy to Machinel respectively The machine or group to which the policy was applied directly is boldfaced and marked with an icon All items are interactive i e when you click on a machine or a group its parent group view will be opened Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 291 Filtering and sorting
57. a storage node p 350 according to the backup plans p 340 that produce the archives p 339 stored in a managed location p 348 Being an alternative to the agent side validation p 339 the validation on the storage node side relieves the production servers of unnecessary CPU load 350 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 T Task In Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 a task is a set of sequential actions to be performed on a managed machine p 348 when a certain time comes or a certain event occurs The actions are described in an xml script file The start condition schedule exists in the protected registry keys Tower of Hanoi A popular backup scheme p 341 aimed to maintain the optimal balance between a backup archive p 339 size and the number of recovery points p 349 available from the archive Unlike the GFS p 347 scheme that has only three levels of recovery resolution daily weekly monthly resolution the Tower of Hanoi scheme continuously reduces the time interval between recovery points as the backup age increases This allows for very efficient usage of the backup storage For more information please refer to Tower of Hanoi backup scheme p 36 U Universal Restore Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore The Acronis proprietary technology that helps boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware or a virtual machine The Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for t
58. address in the Path field as follows ftp ftp_server port number or sftp sftp_server port number If the port number is not specified port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP After entering access credentials the folders on the server become available Click the appropriate folder on the server You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access To do so click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer o Ifthe archive is stored on a locally attached tape device expand the Tape drives group then click the required device 2 In the table to the right of the tree select the archive The table displays the names of the archives contained in each vault folder you select While you are reviewing the location content archives can be added deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives You can switch between displaying archives by names and displaying the physical representation of the archives as TIB files using the Show archives and Show TIB files buttons 3 Click OK 6 3 3 Datatype Choose what type of data to recover from the selected disk backup e Disks to recover disks e Volumes to recover volumes e Files to
59. all groups that use this dynamic criterion To learn more about grouping machines see the Grouping the registered machines p 56 section To learn more about how policies are applied to machines and groups see the Policies on machines and groups p 56 section Way of working with machines e First add machines to the management server Adding machines is available when selecting the EE Physical machines view or the amp All physical machines group in the Navigation tree e Select the group the required machine is in then select the machine e Use the toolbar s operational buttons to take actions on the machine p 282 e Use the Information panel s tabs to view detailed information about the selected machine and perform additional operations such as start stop tasks revoke policies explore the policy inheritance etc The panel is collapsed by default To expand the panel click the chevron The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Machine details p 286 window e Use filtering and sorting p 292 capabilities for easy browsing and examination of the machines in question Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 281 Way of working with groups e Inthe Physical machines view select the group e Use the toolbar s operational buttons to perform actions on the selected group p 292 e Use the Information panel s tabs to view detailed information about the selected group and perform additional operations
60. an OS on your machine that does not support dynamic disks If you need to convert a dynamic disk to basic 1 Select the dynamic disk to convert to basic 2 Right click on the selected volume and then click Convert to basic in the context menu You will receive a final warning about the dynamic disk being converted to basic You will be advised about the changes that will happen to the system if the chosen disk is converted from dynamic into basic E g if such a conversion will stop the disk from being accessed by the system the operating system will stop loading after such conversion or if the disk you want to convert to basic contains any volumes of the types that are only supported by dynamic disks all volume types except Simple volumes then you will be warned here about the possible damage to the data involved in the conversion Please note the operation is unavailable for a dynamic disk containing Spanned Striped or RAID 5 volumes ee 3 If you click OK in this warning window the conversion will be performed immediately After the conversion the last 8Mb of disk space is reserved for the future conversion of the disk from basic to dynamic In some cases the possible unallocated space and the proposed maximum volume size might differ e g when the size of one mirror establishes the size of the other mirror or the last 8Mb of disk space are reserved for the future conversion of the disk from basic to dynamic
61. and Task details p 187 windows respectively 6 1 2 1 Understanding states and statuses Backup plan execution states A backup plan can be in one of the following execution states Idle Waiting Running Stopping Need Interaction Plan states names are the same as task state names because a plan state is a cumulative state of the plan s tasks qe How it is determined How to handle Need interaction At least one task needs Identify the tasks that need interaction the program will user interaction display what action is needed gt Stop the tasks or enable the tasks to run change media provide additional space on the vault ignore the read error create the missing Acronis Secure Zone 2 At least one task is No action is required running Otherwise see 3 Otherwise see 2 3 At least one task is Waiting for condition This situation is quite normal but waiting delaying a backup for too long is risky The solution may be to set the maximum delay or force the condition tell the user to Otherwise see 4 log off enable the required network connection Waiting while another task locks the necessary resources A one time waiting case may occur when a task start is delayed or a task run lasts much longer than usual for some particular reason and this way prevents another task from starting This situation is resolved automatically when the obstructing task comes to an end Consider stopping a task if it hangs fo
62. archives list only the archives and backups corresponding to these filters are displayed here To see all content clean all the filter fields What happens if delete a backup that is a base of an incremental or differential backup To preserve archive consistency the program will consolidate the two backups For example you delete a full backup but retain the next incremental one The backups will be combined into a single full backup which will be dated the incremental backup date When you delete an incremental or differential backup from the middle of the chain the resulting backup type will be incremental Please be aware that consolidation is just a method of deletion but not an alternative to deletion The resulting backup will not contain data that was present in the deleted backup and was absent from the retained incremental or differential backup There should be enough space in the vault for temporary files created during consolidation Backups resulting from consolidation always have maximum compression 4 3 4 Filtering and sorting archives The following is a guideline for you to filter and sort archives in the archives table Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 159 To Sort backup archives by any column Filter archives by name owner or machine Do Click the column s header to sort the archives in ascending order Click it once again to sort the archives in descending order In the field below the corre
63. backup For example assume that you selected the folder MyFolder and the file MyFile tmp outside that folder and selected to skip all 92 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 tmp files In this case all tmp files in the folder MyFolder will be skipped during the backup process but the file MyFile tmp will not be skipped 3 4 1 3 Pre Post commands This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and PE based bootable media The option enables you to define the commands to be automatically executed before and after the backup procedure The following scheme illustrates when pre post commands are executed Pre backup Backup Post backup command command Examples of how you can use the pre post commands e delete some temporary files from the disk before starting backup e configure a third party antivirus product to be started each time before the backup starts copy an archive to another location after the backup ends The program does not support interactive commands i e commands that require user input for example pause To specify pre post commands 1 Enable pre post commands execution by checking the following options o Execute before the backup o Execute after the backup 2 Do any of the following o Click Edit to specify a new command or a batch file o Select the existing command or the batch file from the drop down list 3 Click OK Pre backup command To specify
64. be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK 6 3 8 When to recover Select when to start the recovery task e Recover now the recovery task will be started immediately after you click the final OK e Recover later the recovery task will be started at the date and time you specify If you do not need to schedule the task and wish to start it manually afterwards select the Task will be started manually do no schedule the task check box 6 3 9 Universal Restore Use Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore when you need to recover and boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for the operating system startup such as storage controllers motherboard or chipset Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 223 To learn more about the Universal Restore technology see the Universal Restore p 47 section Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore is not available when e amachine is booted with Acronis Startup Recovery Manager using F11 e the backup image is located in Acronis Secure Zone e you have chosen to use Acronis Active Restore p 338 because these features are primarily meant for instant data recovery on the same machine Preparation Before recovering Windows to dissimilar hardware make sure that you have the drivers for the new HDD controll
65. between the storage device capacity the restrictive parameters you set and the cleanup frequency The retention rules logic assumes that the storage device capacity is much more than the average backup size and the maximum archive size does not come close to the physical storage Capacity but leaves a reasonable reserve Due to this exceeding the archive size that may occur between the cleanup task runs will not be critical for the business process The rarer the cleanup runs the more space you need to store backups that outlive their lifetime The Vaults p 122 page provides you with information about free space available in each vault Check this page from time to time If the free space which in fact is the storage device free space approaches zero you might need to toughen the restrictions for some or all archives residing in this vault 2 8 Backing up dynamic volumes Windows This section explains in brief how to back up and recover dynamic volumes p 346 using Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Basic disks that use the GUID Partition Table GPT are also discussed Dynamic volume is a volume located on dynamic disks p 345 or more exactly on a disk group p 344 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 supports the following dynamic volume types RAID levels e simple spanned e striped RAID 0 e mirrored RAID 1 e amirror of stripes RAID 0 1 e RAIDS Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 can back up and recover dynamic volumes
66. capacity the network bandwidth or the managed machines CPU load required for the enterprise data protection This goal is achieved through organizing and managing the locations that serve as dedicated storages of the enterprise backup archives managed vaults The storage nodes enable creating highly scalable and flexible in terms of the hardware support storage infrastructure Up to 20 storage nodes can be set up each being able to manage up to 20 vaults The administrator controls the storage nodes centrally from the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server p 348 Direct console connection to a storage node is not possible Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 19 Setting up the storage infrastructure Install the storage nodes add them to the management server the procedure is similar to the managed machine registration p 349 and create centralized vaults p 342 When creating a centralized vault specify the path to the vault the storage node that will manage the vault and the management operations to be performed on the vault A managed vault can be organized e onthe hard drives local to the storage node e onanetwork share e ona Storage Area Network SAN e ona Network Attached Storage NAS e ona tape library locally attached to the storage node The management operations are as follows Storage node side cleanup and validation Archives stored in unmanaged vaults are maintained by the agen
67. clone a disk create volume convert volume A kind of direct management is performed when using bootable media p 341 Some of the direct management operations can also be performed via the management server GUI This presumes however either an explicit or an implicit direct connection to the selected machine Disk backup Image A backup p 339 that contains a sector based copy of a disk or a volume in a packaged form Normally only sectors that contain data are copied Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides an option to take a raw image that is copy all the disk sectors which enables imaging of unsupported file systems Disk group A number of dynamic disks p 345 that store the common configuration data in their LDM databases and therefore can be managed as a whole Normally all dynamic disks created within the same machine p 347 are members of the same disk group As soon as the first dynamic disk is created by the LDM or another disk management tool the disk group name can be found in the registry key HKEY_ LOCAL _MACHINE SYSTEM CurrentControlSet Services dmio Boot Info Primary Disk Group Name The next created or imported disks are added to the same disk group The group exists until at least one of its members exists Once the last dynamic disk is disconnected or converted to basic the group is discontinued though its name is kept in the above registry key In case a dynamic disk is created or connected again
68. command batch file will be executed In the Arguments field specify the command execution arguments if required If successful execution of the command is critical for your backup strategy select the Fail the task if the command execution fails check box In case the command execution fails the program will remove the resulting TIB file and temporary files if possible and the task will fail When the check box is not selected the command execution result does not affect the task execution failure or success You can track the command execution result by exploring the log or the errors and warnings displayed on the Dashboard Click Test Command to check if the command is correct 3 4 1 4 Pre Post data capture commands This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems The option enables you to define the commands to be automatically executed before and after data capture that is taking the data snapshot performed by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 at the beginning of the backup procedure The following scheme illustrates when the pre post data capture commands are executed 94 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Pre backup Pre data Jata Post data Post backup command capture capture capture command command command If the Volume Shadow Copy Service p 97 option is enabled the commands execution and the Microsoft VSS actions will be sequenced as follows Before data capture commands
69. context menu You will receive a warning window stating that you are about to convert GPT into MBR You will be explained the changes that will happen to the system after the chosen disk is converted from GPT to MBR E g if such conversion will stop a disk from being accessed by the system the operating system will stop loading after such conversion or some volumes on the selected GPT disk will not be accessible with MBR e g volumes located more than 2 TB from the beginning of the disk you will be warned here about such damage 3 By clicking OK you ll add a pending operation of GPT to MBR disk conversion To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them 6 9 5 5 Disk conversion basic to dynamic You would want to convert a basic disk to dynamic in the following cases e If you plan to use the disk as part of a dynamic disk group e f you want to achieve additional disk reliability for data storage If you need to convert a basic disk to dynamic 1 Select the basic disk to convert to dynamic 2 Right click on the selected volume and then click Convert to dynamic in the context menu You will receive a final warning about the basic disk being converted to dynamic 3 If you click OK in this warning window the conversion will be performed immediately and if necessary your machine will be restarted _ P
70. data and specify retention rules e Grandfather Father Son to use the Grandfather Father Son backup scheme The scheme does not allow data to be backed up more than once a day You set the days of week when the daily backup will be performed and select from these days the day of weekly monthly backup Then you set the retention periods for the daily referred to as sons weekly referred to as fathers and monthly referred to as grandfathers backups The expired backups will be deleted automatically e Tower of Hanoi to use the Tower of Hanoi backup scheme where you schedule when and how often to back up sessions and select the number of backup levels up to 16 In this scheme the data can be backed up more than once a day By setting up the backup schedule and selecting backup levels you automatically obtain the rollback period the guaranteed number of sessions that you can go back at any time The automatic cleanup mechanism maintains the required rollback period by deleting the expired backups and keeping the most recent backups of each level e Custom to create a custom scheme where you are free to set up a backup strategy in the way your enterprise needs it most specify multiple schedules for different backup types add conditions and specify the retention rules 6 2 9 1 Back up now scheme With the Back up now scheme the backup will be performed immediately right after you click the OK button at the botto
71. data recovery directly from an FTP server requires the backup to be split into files no more than 2GB in size 3 4 1 14 File level security These options are effective only for file level backup in Windows operating systems In archives store encrypted files in a decrypted state This option defines whether to decrypt files before saving them to a backup archive The preset is Disabled Simply ignore this option if you do not use the encryption Enable the option if encrypted files are included in the backup and you want them to be accessed by any user after recovery Otherwise only the user who encrypted the files folders will be able to read them Decryption may also be useful if you are going to recover encrypted files on a different machine File encryption is available in Windows using the NTFS file system with the Encrypting File System EFS To access a file or folder encryption setting select Properties gt General gt Advanced Attributes gt Encrypt contents _ to secure data 104 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Preserve file security settings in archives This option defines whether to back up NTFS permissions for files along with the files The preset is Enabled When the option is enabled files and folders are saved in the archive with the original permissions to read write or execute the files for each user or user group If you recover a secured file folder on a machine without the user account spec
72. day at 09 30 03 AM Second machine Every day at 09 00 00 AM Third machine Every day at 09 59 59 AM Example 2 Suppose that you are deploying a backup policy with the following schedule to three machines Run the task Daily Every 2 Hour s From 09 00 00 AM Until 11 00 00 AM Distribute start time within the time window Maximum delay 1 Hour s Distribution method Random Then the time of the task s first run on each machine may be any time between 09 00 00 AM and 09 59 59 AM the interval between the first and the second run is exactly two hours for instance First machine Every day at 09 30 03 AM and 11 30 03 AM Second machine Every day at 09 00 00 AM and 11 00 00 AM Third machine Every day at 09 59 59 AM and 11 59 59 AM To specify advanced settings T 170 Connect to the management server or to a machine registered on it and then start creating a backup policy or a backup plan In How to back up select the Simple Tower of Hanoi or Custom scheme and then click Change to specify a schedule for the scheme Under Run the task select Daily Weekly or Monthly In the Advanced settings area click Change Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 5 To enable the use of the Wake on LAN functionality select the Use Wake on LAN check box 6 To distribute the centralized backup tasks start times select the Distribute start time within the time window check box and then specify the maximum delay value and the
73. default value is 12 00 PM Back up on Specifies the days on which to perform a backup The default value is Workdays Weekly Monthly Specifies which of the days selected in the Back up on field you want to reserve for weekly and monthly backups A monthly backup will be performed every fourth such day The default value is Friday Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 329 Keep backups Specifies how long you want the backups to be stored in the archive A term can be set in hours days weeks months or years For monthly backups you can also select Keep indefinitely if you want them to be saved forever The default values for each backup type are as follows Daily 1 week recommended minimum Weekly 1 month 1 month for keeping backups is equal to four weeks Monthly indefinitely The retention period for weekly backups must exceed that for daily backups the monthly backups retention period must be greater than the weekly backups retention period We recommend setting a retention period of at least one week for daily backups At all times a backup is not deleted until all backups that directly depend on it become subject to deletion as well This is why you might see a weekly or a monthly backup remain in the archive for a few days past its expected expiration date If the schedule starts with a daily or a weekly backup a full backup is created instead Examples Each day of the past week each week of the
74. defragmentation might be considerably larger than usual because defragmentation changes file locations on the disk and the backup reflects these changes It is recommended that you re create a full backup after disk defragmentation The following table summarizes the advantages and shortcomings of each backup type as they appear based on common knowledge In real life these parameters depend on numerous factors such as the amount speed and pattern of data changes the nature of the data the physical Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 29 specifications of the devices the backup recovery options you set to name a few Practice is the best guide to selecting the optimal backup scheme Parameter Full backup Differential backup Incremental backup Storage space Maximal Medium Minimal Creation time Maximal Medium Minimal Recovery time Minimal Medium Maximal 2 3 User privileges on a managed machine When managing a machine running Windows the scope of a user s management rights depends on the user s privileges on the machine Regular users A regular user such as a member of the Users group has the following management rights e Perform file level backup and recovery of the files that the user has permissions to access but without using a file level backup snapshot e Create backup plans and tasks and manage them e View but not manage backup plans and tasks created by other users e View the local event log Adminis
75. each vault folder you select While you are reviewing the location content archives can be added deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives You can switch between displaying archives by names and displaying the physical representation of the archives as TIB files using the Show archives and Show TIB files buttons 3 Click OK 6 5 2 Backup selection To select a backup 1 Select one of the backups by its creation date time 2 To assist you with choosing the right backup the bottom table displays the volumes contained in the selected backup To obtain information on a volume right click it and then click Information 3 Click OK 6 5 3 Access credentials To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the current user credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the current user o Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify Use this option if the current user account does not have access permissions to the location You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account
76. effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media The option defines whether the agent s operating on the managed machine have to send the log events to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP managers You can choose the types of events to be sent You can override the settings set here exclusively for the events that occur during backup or during recovery in the Default backup and recovery options p 89 In this case the settings set here will be effective for operations other than backup and recovery such as archive validation or cleanup You can further override the settings set in the default backup and recovery options when creating a backup plan or a recovery task The settings you obtain in this case will be plan specific or task specific Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP objects to SNMP management applications 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 1 0 string identifying the type of event Information Warning Error Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 87 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 2 0 string containing the text description of the event it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 in its log The preset is Disabled To set up sending SNMP messages 1 Select the Send messages to SNMP server check box 2 Specify the appropriate opti
77. event isean E a EEEN S T 171 OC EONS eea a a a a a a O 173 Useri Ole ranen a N E A E 173 locationis avalapl Enen A A A case vuesb su aamereiscnbeeees 174 UES Ume Me NVa kann a AAN A 174 Si VO SOCOM naana a a A E eaaassausee nastececrsealy 175 WIIG SIC last WACO rorotu T eeaause een oenae ence 176 Direct management arrene eco sslacissacesciten asec T A 177 Administering a managed machine ccccessecccssecccsccceesceceeececeececenecesuenceseecessuecenenees 177 EAS FDO ANY sea a aa a satan a 177 Backup plans andadak anian man aaa a a a a eon herenngeee 179 LOT hrn E E N T E AT E N ERAN 190 Creatine a DACKUD D laien a a N 193 Why is the program asking for the password ccccssssccecssssseceessseeecssssssecesssaseecessaseeeesssaeeeeessaaeeees 195 Backup plian s credentials sernir eiui eeann rearen a NAANA RAAE EA IE Anaa EEEa EAEN Tan 195 SOUTO VPE eae E E A ta Sas tated eee iota 195 kems to Dack UDancrinini n E E I A vs OE EN 196 Access ChEGENITIalS Tor SOUC Eusa EAE E a AEE E 197 EXCISION S aa kotana a T TO 197 6 2 7 6 2 8 6 2 9 6 2 10 6 3 6 3 1 6 3 2 6 3 3 6 3 4 6 3 5 6 3 6 6 3 7 6 3 8 6 3 9 6 3 10 6 3 11 6 3 12 6 4 6 4 1 6 4 2 6 4 3 6 4 4 6 4 5 6 4 6 6 5 6 5 1 6 5 2 6 5 3 6 5 4 6 6 6 7 6 7 1 6 7 2 6 8 6 8 1 6 8 2 6 8 3 6 8 4 6 8 5 6 8 6 6 9 6 9 1 6 9 2 6 9 3 6 9 4 6 9 5 6 9 6 6 9 7 7 1 7 1 1 Tdd TAS
78. field specify a path to a directory where the command batch file will be executed 3 Inthe Arguments field specify the command execution arguments if required 4 If successful execution of the command is critical for you select the Fail the task if the command execution fails check box In case the command execution fails the task run result will be set to Failed When the check box is not selected the command execution result does not affect the task execution failure or success You can track the command execution result by exploring the log or the errors and warnings displayed on the Dashboard 5 Click Test command to check if the command is correct l Keep in mind that the path to the batch file and the working directory you specify must exist and be accessible from the managed machine after the recovery is completed 3 4 2 2 Recovery priority This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media The priority of a process running in a system determines the amount of CPU and system resources allocated to that process Decreasing the recovery priority will free more resources for other applications Increasing the recovery priority might speed up the recovery process by requesting the operating system to allocate more resources to the application that will perform the recovery However the resulting effect will depend on the overall CPU usa
79. file Unpack all files of your WinPE 1 x ISO to a separate folder on the hard disk Select Acronis Win PE ISO Builder from the start menu Specify path to the folder with the WinPE files ee ee E Specify path to the folder with the Acronis Plug in files check the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE SOFTWARE Acronis WinPE Settings WinPE for the plug in location 6 Specify the full path to the resulting ISO file including the file name 7 Check your settings in the summary screen and click Proceed 8 Burn the ISO to CD or DVD using a third party tool or copy to a flash drive Once a machine boots into the WinPE Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 starts automatically 6 8 1 3 Adding the Acronis Plug in to WinPE 2 x Acronis WinPE ISO Builder provides three methods of integrating Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 with WinPE 2 x e Adding the Acronis Plug in to the existing PE 2 ISO This comes in handy when you have to add the plug in to the previously configured PE 2 ISO that is already in use Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 247 e Creating the PE 2 ISO with the plug in from scratch e Adding the Acronis Plug in to a WIM file for any future purpose manual ISO building adding other tools to the image and so on To be able to perform any of the above operations install Acronis WinPE ISO Builder on a machine where Windows Automated Installation Kit WAIK is installed If you do not have such machine prepare as described in
80. file system Note the program suggests the cluster size best suited to the volume with the chosen file system If you are creating a basic volume which can be made into a system volume this page will be different giving you the opportunity to select the volume Type Primary Active Primary or Logical Typically Primary is selected to install an operating system to a volume Select the Active default value if you want to install an operating system on this volume to boot at machine startup If the Primary button is not selected the Active option will be inactive If the volume is intended for data storage select Logical A Basic disk can contain up to four primary volumes If they already exist the disk will have to be converted into dynamic otherwise or Active and Primary options will be disabled and you will only be able to select the Logical volume type The warning message will advise you that an OS installed on this volume will not be bootable 2 If you use characters when setting a new volume label that are unsupported by the currently installed operation system you will get the appropriate warning and the Next button will be disabled You will have to change the label to proceed with the creation of the new volume If you click the Back button you will be returned to the previous page Set the volume size p 268 If you click the Finish button you will complete the operation planning 268 Copyright Acronis
81. for weekly and monthly backups e Custom retention periods for backups of each type Description Let us suppose that we want to set up a backup plan that will regularly produce a series of daily D weekly W and monthly M backups Here is a natural way to do this the following table shows a sample two month period for such a plan ee we Pm ee pf fe fo fo i Jan 8 Jan 14 pol ofo o poms ole oo prom Tole foo more ele ee eon To fe fo fo waren To fe fo e Feb 19 Feb 25 esms ojojoj o mm Daily backups run every workday except Friday which is left for weekly and monthly backups Monthly backups run every fourth Friday and weekly backups run on all other Fridays e Monthly Grandfather backups are full e Weekly Father backups are differential e Daily Son backups are incremental Parameters You can set up the following parameters of a Grandfather Father Son GFS scheme 202 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Start backup at Specifies when to start a backup The default value is 12 00 PM Back up on Specifies the days on which to perform a backup The default value is Workdays Weekly Monthly Specifies which of the days selected in the Back up on field you want to reserve for weekly and monthly backups A monthly backup will be performed every fourth such day The default value is Friday Keep backups Specifies how long you want the backups to be stored in the archive A term can
82. has six settings Maximum Connections Description Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous synchronization connections to keep Possible values Any integer number between 1 and 500 Default value 200 If the total number of online registered machines does not exceed the value in Maximum Connections connections to those machines are always kept and the management server periodically performs synchronization with each machine Otherwise it connects to a number of registered machines depending on the allotted number of simultaneous connections After synchronization for a machine is complete the management server may disconnect from that machine and use the free connection for synchronization with another machine and so on Note Connections to machines with high synchronization priority see Period High Priority later in this topic are likely to be always kept Synchronization connections are unrelated to connections such as those between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console Maximum Workers Description Specifies the maximum number of threads to use for synchronization Possible values Any integer number between 1 and 100 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 311 312 Default value 30 The management server s process uses special threads called worker threads or workers to perform synchronization for a registered machine which is connect
83. have a choice between the two The console that installs on Linux has limited functionality e remote installation of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components is not available e the Active Directory related features such as browsing the AD are not available 1 4 Supported operating systems Acronis License Server e Windows Professional 2000 SP4 XP Professional SP2 e Windows Server 2000 Advanced Server 2000 Server 2003 SBS 2003 SBS 2008 Server 2008 e Windows XP Professional x64 Edition Windows Server 2003 2008 x64 Editions e Windows Vista all Editions except for Vista Home Basic and Vista Home Premium Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console e Windows Professional 2000 SP4 XP Professional SP2 e Windows Server 2000 Advanced Server 2000 Server 2003 SBS 2003 SBS 2008 Server 2008 e Windows XP Professional x64 Edition Home Edition Windows Server 2003 2008 x64 Editions e Windows Vista all Editions Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node e Windows Professional 2000 SP4 XP Professional SP2 e Windows Server 2000 Advanced Server 2000 Server 2003 SBS 2003 SBS 2008 Server 2008 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 21 e Windows XP Professional x64 Edition Windows Server 2003 2008 x64 Editions e Windows Vista all Editions except for Vista Home Basic and Vista Home Premium Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows e Windows Professional 2000
84. implied that the Use a separate tape set option is enabled To calculate the number of tapes you should take into account the following considerations e full backup size Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 151 e average size of incremental backups e average size of differential backups e compression level specified for backing up the data e tape rotation scheme frequency of backups retention rules e tape append options e requirements to support off site tape cartridge archives There is no common formula to calculate a number of tapes required in all possible combinations of above listed considerations But the general way to get a number of tapes for a case includes the following steps 1 Draw or write a chain of backups until the first backup can be deleted 2 Take into account the tape append options the chain might be sectioned onto tape sets 3 Calculate the number of tapes in each tape set 4 Thesum of the calculated values gives the total number of tapes required for the case Tape planning Example 1 Imagine the case with the following features e full backup size is F_GB e average size of incremental backups is _GB e average size of differential backups is D_GB compression level provides CL average reduction coefficient e selected tape rotation scheme is Tower of Hanoi with four levels e tape options are the following o the Usea separate tape set option is selected o the Always use a free tape For ea
85. in four tasks three backup tasks and one cleanup task 7 2 8 Archive validation Set up the validation task to check if the backed up data is recoverable If the backup could not pass the validation successfully the validation task fails and the backup plan gets the Error status To set up validation specify the following parameters 1 When to validate select when to perform the validation As the validation is a resource intensive operation it makes sense to schedule the validation to the managed machine s off peak period On the other hand if the validation is a major part of your data protection strategy and you prefer to be immediately informed whether the backed up data is not corrupted and can be successfully recovered think of starting the validation right after backup creation 2 What to validate select either to validate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination Validation of a volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup Validation of the archive will validate all the archive s backups and may take a long time and a lot of system resources 3 Validation schedule appears only if you have selected the on schedule in step 1 set the schedule of validation For more information see the Scheduling p 161 section Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 337 Glossary A
86. incremental backup Task 4 validate archive Task 5 Cleanup archive Maintain archive Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 25 Backup using bootable media You can boot the machine using the bootable media configure the backup operation in the same way as a simple backup plan and execute the operation This will help you extract files and logical volumes from a system that failed to boot take an image of the offline system or back up sector by sector an unsupported file system Managed Machine Vault i h A RS gt Bootable Agent 6 RAM Boot Archive 1 F Backup 0 F Backup 1 F Backup 2 Backup 0 Backup 2 Backup Operation Full backup of Data 2 h aey 5 Backup 5 F l l E Recovery under operating system When it comes to data recovery you create a recovery task on the managed machine You specify the vault then select the archive and then select the backup referring to the date and time of the backup creation or more precisely to the time when the creation has started In most cases the data will be reverted to that moment Examples of exceptions to this rule Recovering a database from a backup that contains the transaction log a single backup provides multiple recovery points and so you can make additional selections Recovering multiple files from a file backup taken without snapshot each file will be reverted to the moment when i
87. is 0 no license check will be performed without a license Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 s functionality will be disabled after the number of days given by Maximum Time Without License Server see the next parameter See also License Server Connection Retry Interval later in this topic Maximum Time Without License Server Description Specifies how long in days Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will work as normal until its functionality is disabled Possible values any integer number between 0 and 60 Default value 30 If Acronis License Server is unavailable Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will continue working with Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 313 full functionality for the number of days specified in Maximum Time Without License Server as counted from the moment of installation or from the last successful check License Server Connection Retry Interval Description Specifies the interval between connection attempts when Acronis License Server is unavailable Possible values any integer number between 0 and 24 Default value 1 If during a check for the license key see License Check Interval earlier in this topic Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent could not connect to the license server it will try to reconnect once in the number of hours given by License Server Connection Retry Interval If the value is 0 no reconnection attempts will be performed the agent will only check for the license as determ
88. is stolen or accessed by an unauthorized person the malefactor will not be able to decrypt the vault contents without access to the storage node Encrypted archives p 346 will be encrypted over the encryption performed by the agent p 339 F Full backup A self sufficient backup p 339 containing all data chosen for backup You do not need access to any other backup to recover the data from a full backup G GFS Grandfather Father Son A popular backup scheme p 341 aimed to maintain the optimal balance between a backup archive p 339 size and the number of recovery points p 349 available from the archive GFS enables recovering with daily resolution for the last several days weekly resolution for the last several weeks and monthly resolution for any time in the past For more information please refer to GFS backup scheme p 32 Image The same as Disk backup p 344 Incremental backup A backup p 339 that stores changes to the data against the latest backup You need access to other backups from the same archive p 339 to restore data from an incremental backup L Local backup plan A backup plan p 340 created on a managed machine p 348 using direct management p 344 Local task A task p 350 belonging to a local backup plan p 347 or a task that does not belong to any plan such as a recovery task A local task belonging to a backup plan can be modified by editing the plan only other local t
89. learn more about using credentials in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 see the Owners and credentials p 30 section To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges see the User privileges on a managed machine p 30 section 6 3 2 Archive selection Selecting the archive 1 Enter the full path to the location in the Path field or select the desired folder in the folders tree o Ifthe archive is stored in a centralized vault expand the Centralized group and click the vault o Ifthe archive is stored in a personal vault expand the Personal group and click the vault Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 213 o Ifthe archive is stored in a local folder on the machine expand the Local folders group and click the required folder If the archive is located on removable media e g DVDs first insert the last DVD and then insert discs in order starting from the first one when the program prompts o If the archive is stored on a network share expand the Network folders group then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder If the network share requires access credentials the program will ask for them Note for Linux users To specify a Common Internet File System CIFS network share which is mounted on a mount point such as mnt share select this mount point instead of the network share itself o If the archive is stored on an FTP or SFTP server type the server name or
90. logon any user current user specify the user s account User logoff any user current user specify the user s account System startup Free space change specify the amount of free space change on any volume selected for backup or containing data selected for backup An event in Windows event log specify the parameters of the event Condition For backup operations only you can specify a condition or multiple conditions in addition to the events Once any of the events occurs the scheduler checks the condition and runs the task if the condition is met With multiple conditions all of them must be met simultaneously to enable task execution The table below lists the conditions available under Windows operating systems Condition run the task only if User is idle a screen saver is running or the machine is locked Archive location is available The task run time is within the specified time interval All users are logged off Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 161 The specified period of time has passed since the last successful backup completed The scheduler behavior in case the event occurs but the condition or any of multiple conditions is not met is defined by the Task start conditions p 107 backup option What ifs e What if an event occurs and a condition if any is met while the previous task run has not completed The event will be ignored e What if an event occurs while the scheduler is wait
91. machine 3 1 4 Number of tasks This option is effective only when the console is connected to the management server The option defines how many tasks will be displayed at a time in the Tasks view You can also use filters available in the Tasks view to limit the number of displayed tasks The preset is 400 The adjustment range is 20 to 500 To make a selection choose the desired value from the Number of tasks drop down menu Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 83 3 1 5 Fonts This option is effective when the console is connected to a managed machine or to the management server The option defines the fonts to be used in the Graphical User Interface of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 The Menu setting affects the drop down and context menus The Application setting affects the other GUI elements The preset is System Default font for both the menus and the application interface items To make a selection choose the font from the respective combo box and set the font s properties You can preview the font s appearance by clicking the button to the right 3 2 Management server options The management server options enable you to adjust the behavior of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server To access the management server options connect the console to the management server and then select Options gt Management server options from the top menu 3 2 1 Logging level This option defines whethe
92. machine click Options gt gt and specify o User name When entering a name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain The user account has to be a member of the Administrators group on the machine o Password The password for the account Select the Save password check box to store the password for the account 3 Click OK Because registration requires the storage node s participation it cannot take place when the machine is offline 7 1 4 2 Storage node details The Storage node details window accumulates in four tabs all information on the selected Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node This information is also duplicated on the Information pane Storage node properties The tab displays the following information about the selected storage node e Name the name of the machine where the storage node is installed e IP the IP address of the machine where the storage node is installed e Availability o Unknown this status is displayed until the first connection between the management server and the storage node is established after adding the storage node or starting the management server s service o Online the storage node is available for the management server This means that the last management server s connection to the node was successful Connection is established every 2 minutes o Offline the storage node is unavailable o With
93. machine for a specific period of time the administrator can delete the machine from the server or register the machine once again The preset is Stand alone management To set up centralized management on the machine 1 Select Centralized management 2 Specify the Management Server IP Name 3 Specify the user name and password of the management server administrator on prompt If the entered data is correct you will be able to click OK and the machine will be registered on the management server Otherwise re enter the data or select Stand alone management To disable centralized management select Stand alone management 3 3 2 Event tracing It is possible to duplicate log events generated by the agent s operating on the managed machine in the Application Event Log of Windows or send the events to the specified SNMP managers If you do not modify the event tracing options anywhere except for here your settings will be effective for each local backup plan and each task created on the machine You can override the settings set here exclusively for the events occurred during backup or during recovery see Default backup and recovery options p 89 In this case the settings set here will be effective for operations other than backup and recovery such as archive validation or cleanup You can further override the settings set in the default backup and recovery options when creating a backup plan or a recovery task The setting
94. machines To Sort machines by any column Filter machines by name Filter machines by status last connect last backup availability Do Click the column s header to sort the machines in ascending order Click it once again to sort the machines in descending order Type a machine s name in the field below the corresponding column s header As a result you will see the list of machines whose names fully or just partly coincide with the entered value In a field below the corresponding column s header select the required value from the list Configuring the machines table By default the table has five columns that are displayed others are hidden If required you can hide the shown columns and show the hidden ones To show or hide columns 1 Right click any column header to open the context menu The menu items that are ticked off correspond to column headers presented in the table 2 Click the items you want to be displayed hidden 1 1 3 2 Actions on groups Actions are available when you select the s Physical machines view in the Navigation tree and then click on a group The following is a guideline for you to perform actions on selected groups To Create a custom static or a dynamic group Apply a backup policy to a group View detailed information on a group Rename a custom group subgroup 292 Do Click Ea Create group In the Create group p 293 window specify the required
95. met for too long and further delaying the backup is becoming risky you can set the time interval after which the task will run irrespective of the condition Select the Run the task anyway after check box and specify the time interval The task will start as soon as the conditions are met OR the maximum time delay lapses depending on which comes first Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 107 Time diagram Wait until conditions are met f Scheduled time or event Condition Idle Waiting Running Idle Task state _ Scheduled time or event condition Idle Waiting Running Idle Task stata _ Skip the task execution Delaying a backup might be unacceptable for example when you need to back up data strictly at the specified time Then it makes sense to skip the backup rather than wait for the conditions especially if the events occur relatively often 3 4 1 19 Task failure handling This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media This option determines the program behavior when any of the backup plan s tasks fails The preset is Continue executing the backup plan Stop executing the backup plan The plan s schedule will be temporarily disabled so that you have time to find out and eliminate the cause of the failure None of the plan s tasks will start on schedule until you resume the plan execution with the button i
96. monitor the health of the entire product infrastructure using a few easily understandable parameters The state and status of a backup policy are included in such parameters Issues if any arise from the very bottom of the infrastructure tasks on managed machines to the cumulative policy status The administrator checks the status at a glance If the status is not OK the administrator can navigate down to the issue details in a few clicks This section helps you understand the policies states and statuses displayed by the management server 2 11 5 1 Policy deployment state on a machine To see this parameter select any group containing the machine in the tree then select the machine and then select the Backup policies tab on the Information pane Once you apply a policy to a machine or a group of machines the server deploys the policy to the machines On each of the machines the agent creates a backup plan While the policy is transferred to the machine and the backup plan is being created the policy s deployment state on the machine is Deploying Once the backup plan is successfully created the policy state on the machine becomes Deployed You may need to modify the policy for some reason Once you confirm the changes the management server updates the policy on all machines the policy was deployed to While the changes are transferred to the machine and the agent updates the backup plan the policy state on the machine is Upd
97. much as possible The backup duration will be maximal You may want to select maximum compression when backing up to removable media to reduce the number of blank disks required 3 4 1 9 Backup performance Use this group of options to specify the amount of network and system resources to allocate to the backup process Backup performance options might have a more or less noticeable effect on the speed of the backup process This depends on the overall system configuration and the physical characteristics of devices the backup is being performed from or to Backup priority This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems The priority of a process running in a system determines the amount of CPU and system resources allocated to that process Decreasing the backup priority will free more resources for other applications Increasing the backup priority might speed up the backup process by requesting the operating system to allocate more resources like the CPU to the backup application However the resulting effect will depend on the overall CPU usage and other factors like disk in out speed or network traffic The preset is Low To specify the backup process priority Select one of the following e Low to minimize resources taken by the backup process leaving more resources to other processes running on the machine e Normal to run the backup process with normal speed allocating resources on a par with othe
98. not have a machine with WAIK prepare as follows 1 Download and install Windows Automated Installation Kit WAIK Automated Installation Kit AIK for Windows Vista PE 2 0 http www microsoft com Downloads details aspx familyid C7 D4BC6D 15F3 4284 9123 679830D629F2 amp displaylang en Automated Installation Kit AIK for Windows Vista SP1 and Windows Server 2008 PE 2 1 http www microsoft com downloads details aspx FamilyID 94bb6e34 d890 4932 81a5 5b650c657de08 amp DisplayLang en 2 optional Burn the WAIK to DVD or copy to a flash drive 3 Install the Microsoft NET Framework v 2 0 from this kit NETFXx86 or NETFXx64 depending on your hardware 4 Install Microsoft Core XML MSXML 5 0 or 6 0 Parser from this kit 5 Install Windows AIK from this kit 6 Install Acronis WinPE ISO Builder on the same machine It is recommended that you familiarize yourself with the help documentation supplied with Windows AIK To access the documentation select Microsoft Windows AIK gt Documentation from the start menu Using Bart PE You can create a Bart PE image with Acronis Plug in using the Bart PE Builder Please refer to Building Bart PE with Acronis Plug in from Windows distribution p 249 for details 6 8 1 1 Bootable Media Builder To enable creating physical media the machine must have a CD DVD recording drive or allow a flash drive to be attached To enable PXE or WDS RIS configuration the machine must have a net
99. observe Description Offer Comment x Failed tasks X View the View the tasks will open the Backup plans and Tasks tasks view with failed tasks where you can examine the reason of failure fa Tasks that need interaction Resolve When at least one task existing in the management X server s database needs human interaction the Dashboard shows an alert Click Resolve to open the Tasks Need Interaction window where you can examine every case and specify your decision fx Failed to check licensesonX View log Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent connects to Acronis machine s License Server at the start and then every 1 5 days as specified by the agent configuration parameters The alert is displayed if the license check was unsuccessful on at least one agent This might happen if the license server was unavailable or the license key data was corrupted Click View log to find out the cause of the unsuccessful check If the license check does not succeed for 1 60 days as specified by the agent configuration parameters the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 213 Vaults with low free space X View vaults Bootable media was not created No backups have been created for X day s on Y machine s Not connected to management server for X day s Y machine s Agent is not installed on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server machine It is recommended to back up the management server to protect its co
100. of time and any power loss unintentional turning off of the machine or accidental pressing of the Reset button during the procedure could result in volume damage and data loss Please take all necessary precautions p 257 to avoid possible data loss 6 9 1 Basic precautions To avoid any possible disk and volume structure damage or data loss please take all necessary precautions and follow these simple rules 1 Create a disk image of the disk on which volumes will be created or managed Having your most important data backed up to another hard disk or CD will allow you to work on disk volumes being reassured that your data is safe Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 is an extremely effective comprehensive data backup and recovery solution _ It creates a data or disk backup copy stored in a compressed archive file that can be restored in case of any eee De ee rng 2 Test your disk to make sure it is fully functional and does not contain bad sectors or file system errors 3 Do not perform any disk volume operations while running other software that has low level disk access Close these programs before running Acronis Disk Director Lite With these simple precautions you will protect yourself against accidental data loss 6 9 2 Running Acronis Disk Director Lite You can run Acronis Disk Director Lite under Windows or start it from a bootable media Running Acronis Disk Director Lite under Windows If you r
101. off shut down or hibernate the machine using the Start Menu commands the end of the current session will be automatically postponed until the recovery is completed Should you decide to switch off the machine with the Power button though all the changes made to the system since the last boot up _ would be lost the system will not be recovered not even partially and the only possible solution in this case will be to start the recovery process anew from a bootable media 6 The background recovery continues until all the selected volumes are recovered the log entry is made and the Acronis Active Restore icon disappears from the system tray 2 11 Understanding centralized management This section contains an overview of centralized data protection with Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Please be sure you have an understanding of how data is protected on a single machine p 24 before reading this section 2 11 1 Basic concepts Applying backup policies and tracking their execution To protect data on a single machine you install on the machine an agent p 339 or multiple agents for various data types you want to protect You connect the console to the machine and create a backup plan p 340 or multiple backup plans What if you have to manage hundreds of machines It takes time to create a backup plan on each machine while the plans may be quite similar you need to back up say the system drive and the users docume
102. parameters of the group HE Custom groups can be created in the root folder Ge Physical machines or in other custom groups Click Apply backup policy In the Policy selection p 286 window specify the backup policy you need to apply to the selected group If there are child groups in the selected group the backup policy will be applied to them as well Click View details In the Group details p 295 window examine information on the selected group Click ie Rename In the Name column type a new name for the selected group Built in groups cannot be renamed Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Edit a custom group Move one custom group to another Delete a custom group Refresh a list of groups Click Edit In the Edit group p 295 window change the required parameters of the group Click is Move to In the Move to group p 295 window specify a group that will be a new parent of the selected group Click 4 Delete Deletion of a parent group will delete its child groups as well Backup policies applied to the parent group and inherited by its child groups will be revoked from all members of the deleted groups The the policies that are directly applied to the members will remain Click J Refresh The management console will update the list of groups from the management server with the most recent information Though the list of groups is refreshed automatically based on eve
103. past month Let us consider a GFS backup scheme that many may find useful e Back up files every day including weekends e Be able to recover files as of any date over the past seven days e Have access to weekly backups of the past month e Keep monthly backups indefinitely Backup scheme parameters can then be set up as follows e Start backup at 11 00 PM e Back up on All days e Weekly monthly Saturday for example Keep backups o Daily 1 week o Weekly 1 month o Monthly indefinitely As a result an archive of daily weekly and monthly backups will be created Daily backups will be available for seven days since creation For instance a daily backup of Sunday January 1 will be 330 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 available through next Sunday January 8 the first weekly backup the one of Saturday January 7 will be stored on the system until February 7 Monthly backups will never be deleted Limited storage If you do not want to arrange a vast amount of space to store a huge archive you may set up a GFS scheme so as to make your backups more short lived at the same time ensuring that your information can be recovered in case of an accidental data loss Suppose that you need to e Perform backups at the end of each working day e Be able to recover an accidentally deleted or inadvertently modified file if this has been discovered relatively quickly e Have access to a weekly backup for 10 days after
104. plan Click 26 Delete What will happen if delete the backup plan The plan s deletion deletes all its tasks Why can t I delete the backup plan The backup plan is in the Running state A backup plan cannot be deleted if at least one of its tasks is running The backup plan has a centralized origin A centralized plan can be deleted by the management server administrator by revoking the backup policy that produced the plan Task Click p d Delete Why can t I delete the task Task belongs to a backup plan A task belonging to a backup plan cannot be deleted separately from the plan Edit the plan to remove the task or delete the entire plan Click 4 Refresh The management console will update the list of backup plans and tasks existing on the machine with the most recent information Though the list is refreshed automatically based on events the data may not be retrieved immediately from the managed machine due to some latency Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Filtering and sorting Filtering and sorting of the backup policies is performed in the same way as in the Backup plans and tasks view for direct management See the Filter and sort backup plans and tasks p 186 section for details Member of This tab appears only if the selected machine is added to one or more custom groups and displays a list of the groups the machine is
105. plan should use tapes from the tape library however the options presets increase usage efficiency of both whole tape library and each tape To view and change the tape options select Options gt Default backup and recovery options gt Default backup options gt Tape options from the top menu To change the settings of the backup policy plan to be created click Change in the Backup options section on the Create backup policy plan page It opens the Backup options window where the Tape options page is contained with the pre defined values When backing up to a tape and the end of the tape is reached a free tape will be mounted automatically and the operation will continue onto the new tape While a backup task is running the following tape specific information is accessible from the console e number of tapes currently used by the backup operation e labels of the tapes used by the task up to the current time in case of backup splitting e label of the tape that is currently written Recovering from tape library Data recovery from archives located on tape devices is performed in the same way as with other storage devices When recovering you start creating a recovery task select the tape device vault and select the archive and the backup to recover data from At task creation the program uses the storage node database instead of accessing tapes However selection of data to recover e g some files or specific volumes requi
106. recover specific files and folders 6 3 4 Content selection The representation of this window depends on the type of data stored in the archive 214 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 3 4 1 Disks volumes selection To select a backup and disks volumes to recover 1 Select one of the successive incremental backups by its creation date and time Thus you can revert the disk data to a certain moment in time Specify the items to recover By default all items of the selected backup will be selected If you do not want to recover certain items just uncheck them To obtain information on a disk volume right click it and then click Information OPTIONAL The Acronis Active Restore check box is available when recovering Windows starting from Windows 2000 Acronis Active Restore brings a system online immediately after the recovery is started The operating system boots from the backup image and the machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services The data required to serve incoming requests is recovered with the highest priority everything else is recovered in the background See Acronis Active Restore p 49 for details Click OK Selecting an MBR You will usually select the disk s MBR if o The operating system cannot boot o The disk is new and does not have an MBR o Recovering custom or non Windows boot loaders such as LILO and GRUB o The disk geometry is different to that stored in the back
107. resources required for protection of enterprise data This goal is achieved by organizing managed vaults p 348 Storage node enables the administrator to e relieve managed machines p 348 of unnecessary CPU load by using the storage node side cleanup p 350 and storage node side validation p 350 e drastically reduce backup traffic and storage space taken by the archives p 339 by using deduplication p 343 e prevent access to the backup archives even in case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by a malefactor by using encrypted vaults p 346 Storage node side cleanup Cleanup p 343 performed by a storage node p 350 according to the backup plans p 340 that produce the archives p 339 stored in a managed vault p 348 Being an alternative to the agent side cleanup p 339 the cleanup on the storage node side relieves the production servers of unnecessary CPU load Since the cleanup schedule exists on the machine p 347 the agent p 339 resides on and therefore uses the machine s time and events the agent has to initiate the storage node side cleanup every time the scheduled time or event comes To do so the agent must be online The following table summarizes the cleanup types used in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage node side Schedule set by Backup plan Backup plan Retention rules set by Backup plan Backup plan Storage node side validation Validation p 351 performed by
108. services For detailed information about Windows GPO Editor please see http msdn2 microsoft com en us library aa374163 aspx For detailed information about Group Policies please see 78 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 http msdn2 microsoft com en us library aa374177 aspx SS Lera Cepter Poikcy B Adminitrative Pemplates Computer Configuration Par Soe ae Seket an bento view Rs description Eeti E a endows Settings I Windows Components kan Miik E E Adminis ie Terplatec Tunari Pokey Tennplates Ce ICT EE THIT I MeH aia 1 oe SOM 23 Vee VSO 32 2 11 8 6 SSL certificates Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components use Secure Sockets Layer SSL certificates for secure authentication SSL certificates for the components can be one of the two types Self signed certificates such as certificates automatically generated during the installation of an Acronis component e Non self signed certificates such as certificates issued by a third party Certificate Authority CA for example by a public CA such as VeriSign or Thawte or by your organization s CA Certificate path All Acronis components installed on a machine when acting as a server application use an SSL certificate called the server certificate In Windows the certificate path and the server certificate s file name are specified in the registry key HKEY LOCAL MACHINE SOFTWARE Acronis Encryption Server The default path is Sy
109. space becomes unallocated After you click OK Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will start deleting the zone When removing Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent from the system you have two options to keep Acronis Secure Zone along with its contents which will enable data recovery on booting from bootable media or remove Acronis Secure Zone 6 8 Bootable media Bootable media Bootable media is physical media CD DVD USB drive or other media supported by a machine BIOS as a boot device that boots on any PC compatible machine and enables you to run Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent either in a Linux based environment or Windows Preinstallation Environment WinPE without the help of an operating system Bootable media is most often used to e recover an operating system that cannot start access and back up the data that has survived in a corrupted system e deploy an operating system on bare metal e create basic or dynamic volumes on bare metal e back up sector by sector a disk with an unsupported file system e back up offline any data that cannot be backed up online because of restricted access being permanently locked by the running applications or for any other reason A machine can be booted into the above environments either with physical media or using the network boot from Acronis PXE Server Windows Deployment Services WDS or Remote Installation Services RIS These servers with uploaded bootable components ca
110. than 6 months Apply the rules After backing up On schedule Cleanup schedule Monthly on the Last day of All months at 10 00 PM By default a backup is not deleted as long as it has dependent backups that must be kept For example if a full backup has become subject to deletion but there are incremental or differential backups that depend on it the deletion is postponed until all the dependent backups can be deleted as well For more information see Retention rules p 38 336 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Resulting tasks Any custom scheme always produces three backup tasks and in case the retention rules are specified a cleanup task Each task is listed in the list of tasks either as Scheduled if the schedule has been set up or as Manual if the schedule has not been set up You can manually run any backup task or cleanup task at any time regardless of whether it has a schedule In the first of the previous examples we set up a schedule only for full backups However the scheme will still result in three backup tasks enabling you to manually start a backup of any type e Full backup runs every Friday at 10 00 PM e Incremental backup runs manually e Differential backup runs manually You can run any of these backup tasks by selecting it from the list of tasks in the Backup plans and tasks section in the left pane If you have also specified the retention rules in your backup scheme the scheme will result
111. that the storage node will perform deduplication p 64 encryption Management operations cannot be canceled or disabled They will be performed for all archives stored in the vault unless the vault is deleted Any managed vault is self contained that is contains all metadata the storage node needs to manage the vault In case the storage node is lost or its database is corrupted the new storage node retrieves the metadata and re creates the database When the vault is attached to another storage node the same procedure takes place Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 123 Accessing managed vaults To be able to back up to a managed vault a user must have an account on the machine where the storage node is installed The scope of a user s privileges in a vault depends on the user s rights on the storage node A user who is a member of the Users group can view and manage his her own archives Members of the Administrators group can view and manage any archive stored on the storage node A user who is a member of the Administrators group on a managed machine can view and manage archives created by any user of this machine To learn more about privileges depending on the user rights see the User privileges on a storage node p 71 section Unmanaged vaults An unmanaged vault is a centralized vault that is not managed by a storage node To access an unmanaged vault a user has to have access privileges for the location from the network
112. that the user name and password can be intercepted by _an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer 7 2 7 Backup scheme selection Choose one of the available backup schemes e Back up now to create a backup task for manual start and run the task immediately after its creation e Back up later to create a backup task for manual start OR schedule one time task execution in the future e Simple to schedule when and how often to backup data and specify retention rules e Grandfather Father Son to use the Grandfather Father Son backup scheme The scheme does not allow data to be backed up more than once a day You set the days of week when the daily backup will be performed and select from these days the day of weekly monthly backup Then you set the retention periods for the daily referred to as sons weekly referred to as Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 327 fathers and monthly referred to as grandfathers backups The expired backups will be deleted automatically Tower of Hanoi to use the Tower of Hanoi backup scheme where you schedule when and how often to back up sessions and select the number of backup levels up to 16 In this scheme the data can be backed up more than once a day By setting up the backup schedule and selecting backup levels you automatically obtain the rollback period the guaranteed number of sessions that you can go back at any time The automatic cleanup mechanism maint
113. that will create a full backup p 339 of your data every time the task is manually started A complex backup plan might consist of multiple tasks which run on schedule create full incremental or differential backups p 28 perform archive maintenance operations such as backup validation p 351 or deleting outdated backups archive cleanup p 343 You can customize backup operations using various backup options such as pre post backup commands network bandwidth throttling error handling or notification options 6 Use the Backup plans and tasks page to view information about your backup plans and tasks and monitor their execution Use the Log page to browse the operations log 7 The location where you store backup archives is called a vault p 352 Navigate to the Vaults page to view information about your vaults Navigate further to the specific vault to view archives and backups and perform manual operations with them mounting validating deleting viewing contents You can also select a backup to recover data from it Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 24 The following diagram illustrates the notions discussed above For more definitions please refer to the Glossary Create gt Bootable media Backup Plan 1 Control Task 1 Full backup Managed Machine d F Backup 1 ag F Backup 2 Backup Plan 2 Task 1 Full backup Task 2 Differential backup Task 3
114. the data In this case you can recover the volume as logical to access the data only File system Change the volume file system if required By default the program selects the original volume s file system Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 can make the following file system conversions FAT 16 gt FAT 32 and Ext2 gt Ext3 For volumes with other native file systems this option is not available Assume you are going to recover a volume from an old low capacity FAT16 disk to a newer disk FAT16 would not be effective and might even be impossible to set on the high capacity hard disk That s because FAT16 supports volumes up to 4GB so you will not be able to recover a 4GB FAT16 volume to a volume that exceeds that limit without changing the file system It would make sense here to change the file system from FAT16 to FAT32 Older operating systems MS DOS Windows 95 and Windows NT 3 x 4 x do not support FAT32 and will not be operable after you recover a volume and change its file system These can be normally recovered on a FAT16 volume only Logical drive letter for Windows only Assign a letter to the recovered volume Select the desired letter from a drop down list e With the default AUTO selection the first unused letter will be assigned to the volume e If you select NO no letter will be assigned to the recovered volume hiding it from the OS You should not assign letters to volumes that are inaccessible to Windows such
115. the last backup 12 hour s e Task start conditions Wait until the conditions are met As a result 1 if the free space changes by more than 1GB before 12 hours pass since the successful completion of the last backup the scheduler will wait until 12 hours pass and then will start the task 2 if the free space changes by more than 1GB after 12 hours pass since the last backup successful completion the backup task will start immediately 3 if the free space never changes by more than 1GB the task will never start You can start the backup manually if need be in the Backup plans and tasks view 176 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 Direct management This section covers operations that can be performed directly on a managed machine by using the direct console agent connection The content of this section is applicable to both stand alone and advanced editions of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 6 1 Administering a managed machine This section describes the views that are available through the navigation tree of the console connected to a managed machine and explains how to work with each view 6 1 1 Dashboard Use the Dashboard to estimate at a glance whether the data is successfully protected on the machine The dashboard shows the summary of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent s activities and enables you to rapidly identify and resolve any issues Alerts The alerts section draws your attention to issue
116. the task To recover all the files you will have to run the task once again Edit a task Click Edit Why can t I edit the task e Task belongs to a backup plan Only tasks that do not belong to a backup plan such as a recovery task can be modified by direct editing When you need to modify a task belonging to a local backup plan edit the backup plan A task belonging to a centralized backup plan can be modified by editing the centralized policy that soawned the plan Only the management server administrator can do this e Do not have the appropriate privilege Without Administrator privileges on the machine a user cannot modify tasks owned by other users Delete a task Click gt 4 Delete Why can t I delete the task e Task belongs to a backup plan A task belonging to a backup plan cannot be deleted separately from the plan Edit the plan to remove the task or delete the entire plan e Do not have the appropriate privilege Without Administrator privileges on the machine a user cannot delete tasks owned by other users e This is a built in compacting task Each storage node has a built in service task called a compacting task This task cannot be deleted Refresh tasks table Click j Refresh The management console will update the list of tasks existing on the machines with the most recent information Though the list of tasks is refreshed automatically based on events the data may not be retrieved immediat
117. under Change the compacting task schedule Users with these additional privileges are also called storage node administrators Recommendations on user accounts To allow users to access the centralized vaults managed by a storage node you must ensure that those users have a right to access the storage node from the network If both the users machines and the machine with the storage node are in one Active Directory domain you probably do not need to perform any further steps all users are typically members of the Domain Users group and so can access the storage node Otherwise you need to create user accounts on the machine where the storage node is installed We recommend creating a separate user account for each user who will access the storage node so that the users are able to access only the archives they own Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 71 When creating the accounts follow these guidelines e For users whom you want to act as storage node administrators add their accounts to the Administrators group e For other users add their user accounts to the Users group Additional right of machine administrators A user who is a member of the Administrators group on a machine can view and manage any archives created from that machine in a managed vault regardless of the type of that user s account on the storage node Example Suppose that two users on a machine UserA and UserB perform backups from this mach
118. using the bootable media Different ways to create a validation task Using the Validation page is the most general way to create a validation task Here you can validate immediately or set up a validation schedule for any backup archive or location you have permission to access Validation of an archive or of the latest backup in the archive can be scheduled as part of the backup plan For more information see the Creating a backup plan p 193 section You can access the Validation page from the Vaults p 122 view Right click the object to validate archive backup or vault and select Validate from the context menu The Validation page will be 230 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 opened with the pre selected object as a source All you need to do is to select when to validate and optionally provide a name for the task To create a validation task perform the following steps General Task name Optional Enter a unique name for the validation task A conscious name lets you quickly identify the task among the others Credentials p 231 Optional The validation task will run on behalf of the user who is creating the task You can change the task credentials if necessary To access this option select the Advanced view check box What to validate Validate Choose an object to validate Archive p 232 in that case you need to specify the archive Backup p 233 specify the archive first and then sel
119. vaults is described in depth in the Creating a personal vault p 157 section Click Change user In the appearing dialog box provide the credentials required for accessing the vault Click EE Create Acronis Secure Zone The procedure of creating the Acronis Secure Zone is described in depth in the Creating Acronis Secure Zone p 238 section Click Explore In the appearing Explorer window examine the selected vault s content Click wa Validate You will be taken to the Validation p 230 page where this vault is already pre selected as a source The vault validation checks all the archives stored in the vault Click gt 4 Delete The deleting operation actually removes only a shortcut to the folder from the Vaults view The folder itself remains untouched You have the option to keep or delete archives contained in the folder Click J Refresh While you are reviewing the vault content archives can be added to the vault deleted or modified Click Refresh to update the vault information with the most recent changes Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 4 2 2 1 Creating a personal vault To create a personal vault 1 Inthe Name field type a name for the vault being created 2 Optional In the Comments field add a description of the vault 3 Inthe Path field click Change In the opened Personal Vault Path window specify a path to the folder that will be used as the vault 4 Click OK As a re
120. when an old backup deletion must be postponed as it still is a base for other backups The table below indicates the case when deletion of full backup E created at session 1 is postponed at session 17 until session 25 because the differential backup D created at session 9 is still actual In the table all cells with deleted backups are grayed out Session ae 4 Incremental TEn AO RAN 000 MAN RRN ANN NE somen fel i Acme tT tT tT ert tT ETT ET te Te See Differential backup D created at session 9 will be deleted at session 25 after creation of a new differential backup is completed This way a backup archive created in accordance with the Tower of Hanoi scheme by Acronis sometimes includes up to two additional backups over the classical implementation of the scheme For information about using Tower of Hanoi for tape libraries see Using the Tower of Hanoi tape rotation scheme p 147 2 7 Retention rules The backups produced by a backup plan make an archive The two retention rules described in this section enable you to limit the archive size and set the lifetime retention period of the backups 1 Delete backups older than This is a time interval counted back from the moment when the retention rules are applied Every time a retention rule is applied the program calculates the date and time in the past corresponding 38 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 to this interval and
121. working with views Generally every view contains a table of items a table toolbar with buttons and the Information panel e Use filtering and sorting capabilities to search the table for the item in question Inthe table select the desired item e Inthe Information panel collapsed by default view the item s details e Perform actions on the selected item There are several ways of performing the same action on selected items o By clicking the buttons on the table toolbar o By clicking in the items in the Item s name Actions bar on the Actions and Tools pane o By selecting the items in the Actions menu o By right clicking the item and selecting the operation in the context menu Action pages An action page appears in the main area when clicking any action item in the Actions menu or in the Actions bar on the Actions and tools pane It contains steps you need to perform in order to create and launch any task or a backup plan or backup policy Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 15 Lit Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Connected to The Machime Loca S joj gt 75 S Connect a chom 4 lo pa rpn iee g r Create backup plan Create a backup pan to protect data on ths machine General Plan name Backup 4 32009 4 31 48 AM Plan s credentios Run as Administrator fourrent user Comments Sort addibonal infiromabon on Get badug plan beng cerated What to back up Source type Bees okumes
122. you decide to initialize the disk you will be able to summon the initialization prompt by right clicking on the gray block depicting the disk and choosing the Disk Initialization action in the context menu If you want to initialize the new hardware immediately you can choose whether you want the disk to have the MBR or the GPT partition scheme You can also decide on the disk s immediate conversion to dynamic or it can be left basic depending on the tasks you plan for this new hardware _ Please note that the new disk initialization will not be postponed and added to the pending operations list to be committed later After you accept the settings and click the OK button the initialization will start immediately It _ is a quick procedure and will be finished in a short time but still please wait until it is finished do not try to _ interrupt it If you decide to change the new disk settings it can be done later using the standard Acronis Disk Director Lite disk tools Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 259 After the disk is initialized its icon is now shown in green instead of grayed and the necessary new disk information appears The disk block remains gray though because after the initialization all the disk space remains unallocated and so still impossible to be used for program installation or file storage To be able to use it proceed normally to the Create volume operation 6 9 5 2 Basic disk cloning Sometime
123. you have selected in the previous step If you have to take space from the boot or the system volume please bear the following in mind e Moving or resizing of the volume from which the system is currently booted will require a reboot e Taking all free space from a system volume may cause the operating system to work unstably and even fail to start Do not set the maximum zone size if the boot or the system volume is selected 6 7 1 3 Password for Acronis Secure Zone Setting up a password protects the Acronis Secure Zone from unauthorized access The program will ask for the password at any operation relating to the zone and the archives located there such as data backup and recovery validating archives using the Acronis Startup Recovery Manager with the F11 key resizing and deleting the zone To set up a password Choose Use password In the Enter the password field type a new password In the Confirm the password field re type the password Click OK 2 oe To disable password 1 Choose Do not use 2 Click OK 6 7 1 4 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is a modification of the bootable agent p 341 residing on the system disk and configured to start at boot time on pressing F11 It eliminates the need for a separate media or network connection to start the bootable rescue utility Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 239 Activate Enables the boot time prompt Press F11 f
124. 0 similar systems to a deduplicating vault the archives in total will occupy less space as compared to backup to a normal vault Best practice is to back up one of the similar systems first so that Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node registers all the system s files as potential deduplication items This will lead to faster backup processes and less network traffic because of effective deduplication at source regardless whether the backups are performed simultaneously or not e When performing incremental backups of similar data from different sources provided that the changes to the data are also similar Such is the case when you deploy updates to these systems and apply the incremental backup Again it is recommended that you first back up one machine and then the others all at once or one by one e When performing incremental backups of data that does not change itself but changes its location Such is the case when multiple pieces of data circulate over the network or within one system Each time a piece of data moves it is included in the incremental backup which becomes sizeable while it does not contain new data Deduplication helps to solve the problem each time an item appears in a new place a reference to the item is saved instead of the item itself Deduplication and incremental backups In case of random changes to the data de duplication at incremental backup will not produce much effect because e The deduplicat
125. 2 2 10 3 2 10 4 2 11 2 11 1 2 11 2 2 11 3 2 11 4 2 11 5 2 11 6 2 11 7 2 11 8 3 1 ZEL 3 1 2 31 3 Introducing Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 cccsscsccscsscsccsccccsscscescescesescescececees 7 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 OVErVICW ssccccssscsesssccossccessseceusveneneseneosseseusseneusvencusss 7 Gerne S Cae OC acacia ttaiecss tei eon A N 8 Usine the management c NsSOlessurminrarnirac iN A cass cusctecauws cu O Aa 10 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components sssessssessseesssresserrssressrrrssrrssrerseressrresereseee 16 ABENETOR NVINGOWS siinanrin aii ea EEN 17 Bootable components and media DuUIIder cessscccesssceeesssseceeesseeeecssssseceessaseeceesseeesessenseesessaeeas 18 WinPE ISO BUNGE sns nanena a a N A a A R tueesuncneemnee 18 Components for centralized management cssccceessssecessssececssssececssseseceesseeecesseeeeeesssaeeeeessnaeeeees ss 18 Mangeement CONS Olennon a nerativentuaed E N enu atteadoeal nueasstaeeeene 21 S pponedoperaung Syste NS enara a a eae ins 21 S ppor ed TESS yS TONS oran r N C N E TNR 22 TOCMMICAl SUP DORE uag a a a N a A eadaicabatacdaaatnoulant 22 Understanding Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 ccccccsssscsceccccsccccsceccccsseccececcnces 24 BASIC CONCEDE aN T S 24 Full incremental and differential backups essessessessseereessrnsesreresrrerssrereseresssrereserressseeee 28 User privileges ON a manag
126. 2 Once the reason of the warning is clear you might want to perform actions to prevent future warnings or failure Use the Activities section of the Dashboard to quickly access the warning log entries What to do if a policy status is OK No action is required Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 211 Fela Actions on backup policies All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding items on the tasks toolbar The operations can also be performed using the context menu right click the selected backup policy or using the Backup policy name actions bar on the Actions and tools pane The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with backup policies To Create a backup policy Apply policy to machines or groups Edit a policy Delete a policy View details of a policy or revoke a policy View tasks of a policy View log of a policy Refresh a list of policies Do Click 2 Create backup policy The procedure of creating a backup policy is described in depth in the Creating a backup policy p 318 section Click D Apply to In the Machines selection p 278 window specify the machines groups the selected backup policy will be applied to If the machine is currently offline the policy will be deployed when the machine comes online again Click Edit Editing policies is performed in the same way as creating p 318 Once the policy is edited the manage
127. 220 If Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows is installed The selected disks will be recovered to a new virtual machine of any of the following types VMware Workstation Microsoft Virtual PC Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance The virtual machine files will be saved to the destination you specify If Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi is installed These agents enable creating a new virtual machine on the virtualization server you specify 216 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The new virtual machine will be configured automatically the source machine configuration being copied where possible The configuration is displayed in the Virtual Machine Settings p 221 section Check the settings and make changes if necessary Then you proceed to the regular disk mapping procedure described below Existing virtual machine Available when the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi is installed On selecting this you specify the virtualization server and the target virtual machine Then you proceed to the regular disk mapping procedure described below weereereereereereereereernereereersersereeraersersereereeraerestacrsersersereetsersatecrsersereareerserseteatsasseeatasrnarsstesiseisetssiseiseisstsaiseisessasseiseseessereessessaseaseeseessaceaseesseseseessesseseaieeisssesianiessenieaiensessesianiesssersaresiesrssrsaresissrssresrest
128. 249 6 8 2 Connecting to a machine booted from media Once a machine boots from bootable media the machine terminal displays a startup window with the IP address es obtained from DHCP or set according to the pre configured values Remote connection To connect to the machine remotely select Connect gt Manage a remote machine in the console menu and specify one of the machine s IP addresses Provide the user name and password if these have been configured when creating the bootable media Local connection Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console is always present on the bootable media Anyone who has physical access to the machine terminal can run the console and connect Just click Run management console in the bootable agent startup window 6 8 3 Working under bootable media Operations on a machine booted with bootable media are very similar to backup and recovery under the operating system The difference is as follows 1 Disk letters seen under Windows style bootable media might differ from the way Windows identifies drives For example the D drive under the rescue utility might correspond to the E drive in Windows 2 The Linux style bootable media shows local disks and volumes as unmounted sda1 sda2 3 There is no Navigation tree in the media GUI Use the Navigation menu item to navigate between views 4 Tasks cannot be scheduled in fact tasks are not created at all If you need to repeat the o
129. 3 2 Understanding Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 This section attempts to give its readers a clear understanding of the product so that they can use the product in various circumstances without step by step instructions 2 1 Basic concepts Please familiarize yourself with the basic notions used in the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 graphical user interface and documentation Advanced users are welcome to use this section as a step by step quick start guide The details can be found in the context help Backup under operating system 1 To protect data on a machine install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent p 339 on the machine which becomes a managed machine p 348 from this point on 2 To be able to manage the machine using Graphical User Interface install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console p 343 on the same machine or any machine from which you prefer to operate If you have the standalone product edition skip this step since in your case the console installs with the agent 3 Runthe console To be able to recover the machine s operating system if the system fails to start create bootable media p 341 4 Connect the console to the managed machine 5 Create a backup plan p 340 To do so you have to specify at the very least the data to be protected and the location where the backup archive p 339 will be stored This will create a minimal backup plan consisting of one task p 350
130. 339 340 342 343 346 347 348 350 351 352 Backup operation 339 340 Backup options 340 346 Backup performance 99 Backup plan Plan 9 20 24 51 193 339 340 341 342 343 347 349 350 352 Backup plan details e 180 183 189 288 Backup plan execution states 179 180 189 280 287 Backup plan statuses 179 180 189 Backup plans and tasks 179 195 Backup plan s credentials 193 195 Backup policies 275 Backup policy Policy 19 51 340 342 343 348 349 Backup policy deployment states 275 276 Backup policy statuses 275 276 280 287 Backup policy s state and statuses 61 276 Backup priority 90 99 Backup scheme 340 341 347 351 Backup scheme selection 319 327 Backup schemes 194 200 Backup selection 231 233 235 236 Backup splitting 90 103 Basic concepts 8 24 51 193 Basic disk cloning 259 260 Basic precautions 257 354 Bootability troubleshooting 226 Bootable agent 47 239 338 341 Bootable components and media builder 18 Bootable media 9 18 21 24 105 178 211 240 242 257 274 338 341 344 348 Bootable Media Builder 243 244 Building Bart PE with Acronis Plug in from Windows distribution 244 249 Built in group 56 341 C Case to analyze 140 142 Centralized backup plan 46 51 340 341 342 Centralized log entry details 303 305 Centralized management 52
131. 4 123 124 125 Actions on groups 282 292 Actions on log entries 190 191 303 304 Actions on machines 281 282 Actions on personal vaults 123 155 156 Actions on storage nodes 68 71 297 Actions on tasks 300 Actions with archives on tapes in a library 135 Adding a machine to another group 283 286 Adding a machine to the management server 282 284 Adding a storage node 297 298 299 Adding machines to a group 283 286 Adding the Acronis Plug in to WinPE 1 x 243 247 Adding the Acronis Plug in to WinPE 2 x 244 247 Additional settings 45 90 110 113 119 Administering a managed machine 177 Administering Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server 273 Advanced scheduling settings 162 165 167 169 Agent Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent 20 24 51 339 341 343 344 346 347 348 349 350 352 Agent for Windows 17 Agent side cleanup 339 350 Agent side validation 339 350 Archive 194 198 318 326 338 339 Archive protection 89 91 Archive selection 211 213 231 232 235 Archive validation 194 210 337 At Windows Event Log event 171 Attaching a managed vault 126 129 Back up later scheme 201 328 Back up now scheme 201 328 Backing up dynamic volumes Windows 41 211 Backing up to tape library 135 Backup 24 28 339 343 344 347 351 Backup archive Archive 19 24
132. 46 348 349 350 Management server administrator rights 72 Management server options 84 Managing a tape library 126 136 Managing Acronis Secure Zone 238 241 Managing mounted images 237 Media builder 178 274 348 Media components 90 105 Merging and moving personal vaults 157 Messenger service WinPopup 91 101 113 117 Monthly schedule 167 206 298 332 Mounting an image 234 Move one group to another 293 295 Moving a machine to another group 283 286 Multi volume snapshot 89 97 N Network connection speed 90 100 Network port 245 246 Network port configuration 75 77 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Network settings 245 Notifications 100 116 NT signature 217 Number of tasks 83 302 O Operations with a machine 58 Operations with archives stored in a vault 123 125 155 157 Operations with backups 123 125 155 158 Operations with panes 14 Options 82 Organizational unit criterion 293 294 Overview 64 112 123 127 130 297 Overwriting 223 Owners and credentials 30 154 213 232 306 P Parameters set through Group Policy 306 Parameters set through GUI 317 Parameters set through Windows registry 317 Password for Acronis Secure Zone 238 239 Pending operations 258 261 262 263 269 270 271 Personal vault 338 344 349 Personal vaults 47 154 Physical machine
133. 48 How to reactivate GRUB or LILO and change its configuration 228 I Image 347 Importing machines from a text file 282 285 Importing machines from Active Directory 282 285 Increasing Acronis Secure Zone 241 Incremental backup 339 341 343 347 Inheritance of policies 59 Inheritance order 288 291 296 Introducing Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 7 Inventory 133 136 154 Items to back up 193 196 318 320 L Labeling 136 137 License Server 21 Limitations 132 List of commands and utilities available in Linux based bootable media 250 254 Local backup plan 46 344 347 Local task 344 347 Location is available 174 Location selection 231 233 Log 183 190 278 280 284 287 288 296 300 302 Log entry details e 190 192 Logging level 84 303 304 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 MI Machine 19 339 340 341 342 344 346 348 349 350 352 Machine details 280 281 284 286 Machine management 86 287 Machine options 86 102 103 118 119 Machines selection 278 Main area views and action pages 11 14 Managed machine 10 24 83 338 340 342 344 347 348 349 350 351 Managed vault 52 296 343 347 348 350 351 Management Console 8 21 Management Server 8 19 Management server Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server 10 19 51 83 340 341 342 343 344 3
134. 7 Acronis WWW LACRONIS COM Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Advanced Workstation User s Guide Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 All rights reserved Acronis and Acronis Secure Zone are registered trademarks of Acronis Inc l al al Acronis Compute with Confidence Acronis Startup Recovery Manager Acronis Active Restore and the Acronis logo are trademarks of Acronis Inc Linux is a registered trademark of Linus Torvalds Windows and MS DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation All other trademarks and copyrights referred to are the property of their respective owners Distribution of substantively modified versions of this document is prohibited without the explicit permission of the copyright holder Distribution of this work or derivative work in any standard paper book form for commercial purposes is prohibited unless prior permission is obtained from the copyright holder DOCUMENTATION IS PROVIDED AS IS AND ALL EXPRESS OR IMPLIED CONDITIONS REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES INCLUDING ANY IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON INFRINGEMENT ARE DISCLAIMED EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT THAT SUCH DISCLAIMERS ARE HELD TO BE LEGALLY INVALID Table of Contents 1 1 1 2 T 1 3 1 34 13 2 133 1 3 4 1 3 5 1 4 1 5 1 6 2 1 Zid 2 3 2 4 2 5 2 6 2T 2 8 2 9 2 9 1 2 9 2 2 10 2 10 1 2 10
135. As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred _ through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an 236 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 5 4 Volume selection Select the volumes to mount and configure the mounting parameters for each of the selected volumes as follows 1 Select the check box for each volume you need to mount 2 Click on the selected volume to set its mounting parameters o Access mode choose the mode you want the volume to be mounted in e Read only enables exploring and opening files within the backup without committing any changes e Read write with this mode the program assumes that the backup content will be modified and creates an incremental backup to capture the changes o Assign letter in Windows Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will assign an unused letter to the mounted volume If required select another letter to assign from the drop down list o Mount point in Linux specify the directory where you want the volume to be mounted 3 If several volumes are selected for mounting click on every volume to set its mounting parameters described in the previous step 4 Click OK 6 6 Managing mounted images Once a volume is mounted you can browse files and folders contained in the backup using a file manager and copy the desired files to any destination Thus if you
136. Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 2 9 2 Using a single tape drive A tape drive that is locally attached to a managed machine can be used by local backup plans as a storage device The functionality of a locally attached autoloader or tape library is limited to the ordinary tape drive This means that the program can only work with the currently mounted tape and you have to mount tapes manually Backup to a locally attached tape device When creating a backup plan you are able to select the locally attached tape device as the backup destination An archive name is not needed when backing up to a tape An archive can span multiple tapes but can contain only one full backup and an unlimited number of incremental backups Every time you create a full backup you start with a new tape and create a new archive As soon as the tape is full a dialog window with a request to insert a new tape will appear The content of a non empty tape will be overwritten on prompt You have an option to disable prompts see Additional settings p 110 Workaround In case you want to keep more than one archive on the tape for example back up volume C and volume D separately choose incremental backup mode instead of a full backup when you create an initial backup of the second volume In other situations incremental backup is used for appending changes to the previously created archive You might experience short pauses that are required to rewind the ta
137. D DO D Fri W D D D DN Sat W D D DOD DN An ideal archive created according to the GFS scheme Schedule Workdays at 8 00 PM Weekly Monthly Friday Keep daily backups 7 days Keep weekly backups 2 weeks Keep monthly backups 6 months Starting from the third week weekly backups will be regularly deleted After 6 months monthly backups will start to be deleted The diagram for weekly and monthly backups will look similar to the week based timescale The resulting archive real In reality the archive content will somewhat differ from the ideal scheme When using the incremental and differential backup methods you cannot delete a backup as soon as the scheme requires if later backups are based on this backup Regular consolidation is unacceptable because it takes too much system resources The program has to wait until the scheme requires the deletion of all the dependent backups and then deletes the entire chain Here is how the first month of your backup plan will appear in real life F stands for full backup Dif stands for differential backup I stands for incremental backup The backups that outlive their nominal lifetime because of dependencies are marked pink The initial full backup will be deleted as soon as all differential and incremental backups based on this backup are deleted Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 35 So i nr a YF Fe SY i Pe ro JSR Je ve rw Total ehd D OD D 0O Ww 0 Db bob Ww
138. Event tracing 84 86 102 118 Event tracing parameters 316 Exclusions 194 197 222 223 318 325 355 E Fast incremental differential backup 90 103 File destination 212 221 File level backup snapshot 89 97 File level security e 90 104 105 113 116 Files selection 215 Files to back up selection rules 320 323 Filtering and sorting archives 125 155 159 Filtering and sorting backup plans and tasks 179 186 291 Filtering and sorting backup policies 276 279 288 296 Filtering and sorting log entries 190 191 303 305 Filtering and sorting machines 281 292 Filtering and sorting tasks 300 302 Fits time interval e 174 Fonts 84 Format volume 265 271 Full backup 339 341 343 344 347 Full incremental and differential backups 24 28 201 328 G Getting started 8 Getting started with a tape library 133 GFS Grandfather Father Son 341 347 351 GFS backup scheme 32 131 139 347 GFS Example 1 141 GFS Example 2 141 145 GFS Example 3 141 146 Grandfather Father Son scheme 202 329 Group details 280 282 292 295 Grouping the registered machines 10 54 56 281 356 H Hardware 131 HDD writing speed 90 99 How deduplication works 67 How to apply Acronis Administrative Template 74 78 307 How to convert a disk backup to a virtual machine 225 How to create bootable media 243 2
139. Father Son and the Tower of Hanoi schemes usage is not enough For example if the full size of protected data is considerably less than the size of a tape the best choice is to use the Custom backup scheme with regular daily weekly monthly full backups some simple retention rules and tape options by default Criteria of the choice Every time you are about to design a tape rotation scheme for a backup policy plan to be created you ought to come from the following arguments e full size of the data to protect approximate size of the daily changes of data approximate size of the weekly changes of data e requirements for the backup scheme frequency performance and duration of backup operations e requirements for keeping backups minimal maximal period of backup keeping need to store tape cartridges off site e capability of the tape library number of drives loaders slots and available tapes capacity of tapes requirements for performing data recovery maximal duration You need to analyze every argument that is relevant for your case and select the main criteria for the choice Then choose a backup scheme and specify the tape options Note that any backup scheme in combination with different tape options will have quite different results for efficient use of both tapes and devices Case to analyze Suppose you need to automate a tape rotation for the case if e the full size of the data to protect is approx
140. Fibre Channel adapter for the hard disk you can install the appropriate driver manually bypassing the automatic driver search and install procedure 3 Installing drivers for Plug and Play devices Universal Restore relies on the built in Plug and Play discovery and configuration process to handle hardware differences in devices that are not critical for the system start such as video audio and USB Windows takes control over this process during the logon phase and if some of the new hardware is not detected you will have a chance to install drivers for it later manually 48 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Universal Restore and Microsoft Sysprep Universal Restore is not a system preparation tool You can apply it to any Windows image created by Acronis products including images of systems prepared with Microsoft System Preparation Tool Sysprep The following is an example of using both tools on the same system Universal Restore does not strip the security identifier SID and user profile settings in order to run the system immediately after recovery without re joining the domain or re mapping network user profiles If you are going to change the above settings on a recovered system you can prepare the system with Sysprep image it and recover if need be using the Universal Restore Limitations Universal Restore is not available e when a computer is booted with Acronis Startup Recovery Manager using F11 or e the bac
141. GPT partitioning style e Requires manual configuration of boot loaders such as LILO and GRUB after activation e Requires re activation of third party loaders after activation 2 10 3 Universal Restore Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore is the Acronis proprietary technology that helps recover and boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware or a virtual machine The Universal Restore Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 47 handles differences in devices that are critical for the operating system start up such as storage controllers motherboard or chipset Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore purpose A system can be easily recovered from a disk backup image onto the same system or to identical hardware However if you change a motherboard or use another processor version a likely possibility in case of hardware failure the recovered system could be unbootable An attempt to transfer the system to a new much more powerful computer will usually produce the same unbootable result because the new hardware is incompatible with the most critical drivers included in the image Using Microsoft System Preparation Tool Sysprep does not solve this problem because Sysprep permits installing drivers only for Plug and Play devices sound cards network adapters video cards etc As for system Hardware Abstraction Layer HAL and mass storage device drivers t
142. How to create bootable media p 243 Acronis WinPE ISO Builder supports only x86 WinPE 2 x This WnPE distribution can also work on x64 hardware _A PE image based on Win PE 2 0 requires at least 256MB RAM to work The recommended memory size for PE 2 0 is 512MB Adding Acronis Plug in to WinPE 2 x ISO To add Acronis Plug in to WinPE 2 x ISO 1 Do one ofthe following When adding the plug in to the existing Win PE 2 ISO unpack all files of your Win PE 2 ISO to a separate folder on the hard disk When creating a new PE 2 ISO select from the start menu Microsoft Windows AIK gt Windows PE Tools Command Prompt run the copype cmd script to create a folder with Windows PE files For example from a command prompt type cd Program Files Windows AIK Tools PETools copype lt arch gt lt destination gt Where lt arch gt is the hardware architecture can be x86 amd64 or ia64 but Acronis supports x86 only and lt destination gt is a path to the local folder For example copype x86 c winpe_x86 2 Select Acronis WinPE ISO Builder from the start menu 3 Specify path to the folder with the WinPE files e Specify path to the folder with the Acronis Plug in files check the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE SOFTWARE Acronis WinPE Settings WinPE for the plug in location 5 Choose whether you want to create ISO or WIM image 6 Specify the full path to the resulting image file including the file name 7 Check
143. IM this is done by simultaneously pressing lt esc gt w q lt enter gt 3 Execute the command for activating GRUB grub 4 Eject the CD and reboot LILO 1 Perform step 1 described above 2 Edit the LILO configuration file if the number of the partition where the operating system resides 228 has changed Otherwise skip this step a Open the LILO configuration file etc lilo conf vim etc lilo conf Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 b Edit the record root dev hdXY or root dev sdXY for a SCSI disk in the section corresponding to the current kernel In this record X disk number a for the first disk b for the second disk etc Y number of the partition on this disk Change X and Y according to the new location of the root For example root dev hda1 c Save the configuration file 3 Execute the command for activating LILO lilo 4 Eject the CD and reboot 6 3 11 2 About Windows loaders Windows NT 2000 XP 2003 A part of the loader resides in the partition boot sector the rest is in the files ntldr boot ini ntdetect com ntbootdd sys boot ini is a text file that contains the loader configuration Example boot loader timeout 30 default multi disk rdisk partition 1 WINDOWS operating systems multi disk rdisk partition 1 WINDOWS Microsoft Windows XP Professional noexecute optin fastdetect Windows Vista 2008 A part of the loader resides in the partit
144. M Until 07 00 00 PM 3 Effective From 09 20 2009 To not set 5 2 Weekly schedule Weekly schedule is effective in Windows and Linux operating systems To specify a weekly schedule In the Schedule area select the appropriate parameter as follows Every lt gt week s on lt gt Specify a certain number of weeks and the days of the week you want the task to be run For example with the Every 2 week s on Mon setting the task will be performed on Monday of every other week In the During the day execute the task area select one of the following Once at lt gt Set up the time at which the task will be run once Every lt gt Set up how many times the task will be run during the specified time interval For example setting the task frequency to Every 1 hour From 10 00 00 AM until 10 00 00 PM allows the task to be run 12 times from 10 AM to 10 PM during one day From lt gt Until lt gt In the Effective area set the following settings From lt gt Set up a date when this schedule will be enabled an effective date If this check box is cleared the task will be started on the nearest day and time you have specified above 164 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 To lt gt Set up a date when this schedule will be disabled If this check box is cleared the task will be run for an indefinite number of weeks Advanced scheduling settings p 169 are available only f
145. Manager A modification of the bootable agent p 341 can be placed on a system disk and configured to start at boot time when F11 is pressed This eliminates the need for rescue media or network connection to start the bootable rescue utility This feature has the trade name Acronis Startup Recovery Manager Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is especially useful for mobile users If a failure occurs the user reboots the machine hits F11 on prompt Press F11 for Acronis Startup Recovery Manager and performs data recovery in the same way as with ordinary bootable media The user can also back up using Acronis Startup Recovery Manager while on the move Acronis Secure Zone p 46 is at hand for backup and recovery operations Activation and deactivation of the Acronis Startup Recovery Manager The operation that enables using Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is called activation You are suggested to activate the Acronis Startup Recovery Manager when creating Acronis Secure Zone p 238 Once the Acronis Secure Zone is created you can activate or deactivate the Acronis Startup Recovery Manager at any time using the Manage Acronis Secure Zone action The deactivation will disable the boot time prompt Press F11 for Acronis Startup Recovery Manager This means you will need bootable media in case the system fails to boot Limitations Acronis Startup Recovery Manager e Cannot be organized on a dynamic disk or a disk using the
146. OM USB flash drive or hard disk The Acronis Plug in for WinPE p 338 enables running the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent p 339 in the preinstallation environment 352 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Index A A policy on a machine or a group 57 About Windows loaders 229 Access credentials 235 236 Access credentials for archive location 194 200 Access credentials for destination 212 223 Access credentials for location 212 216 319 327 Access credentials for source 193 197 231 233 318 324 Acronis Active Restore 45 49 211 215 224 338 351 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows 313 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components 16 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server 309 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 overview 7 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node 307 Acronis Plug in for WinPE e 338 341 352 Acronis PXE Server 255 Acronis PXE Server Installation 255 Acronis Secure Zone 46 47 237 238 338 351 Acronis Secure Zone Disk 238 Acronis Secure Zone Size 238 239 Acronis security groups 70 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager 47 211 238 239 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager ASRM 238 260 338 351 Action pages 13 15 Actions on a tape library vault 134 Actions on backup plans and tasks 180 183 Actions on backup policies 276 278 Actions on centralized vaults 5
147. P SNMP agent e etc snmp snmptrapd conf configuration file for the Net SNMP trap daemon 88 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 3 4 Default backup and recovery options 3 4 1 Default backup options Each Acronis agent has its own default backup options Once an agent is installed the default options have pre defined values which are referred to as presets in the documentation When creating a backup plan you can either use a default option or override the default option with the custom value that will be specific for this plan only You can also customize a default option itself by changing its value against the pre defined one The new value will be used by default in all backup plans you will create later on this machine To view and change the default backup options connect the console to the managed machine and then select Options gt Default backup and recovery options gt Default backup options from the top menu Availability of the backup options The set of available backup options depends on e The environment the agent operates in Windows bootable media e The type of the data being backed up disk file e The backup destination networked location or local disk e The backup scheme Back up now or using the scheduler The following table summarizes the availability of the backup options Agent for Windows Bootable media Linux based or PE based Disk File Disk File backup backup backup backup Archiv
148. PTS MINI EAE etn tae icant ic stems ctl FOE ANE cee EA ten ee ne coeds te etalon eect teeter 198 ACCESS credentials TOMA CMIVE JOCATION sr ci zeaccastincateea toes seataasacdnctnaveedacauiaceanadscueecs 200 Back p scheme S nean A see cuas eacuscsause cnceusueuncuan sauusorsvineceeses Suede eneaienteeaitadatnetses 200 PAC CII NCL atO een raed cea ace esau adrnc ht ca ts an na sedate aac deem eal gds aaa TA A a eee 210 RECOVERING data reirse iene n E aynisndeanavererorss aceon eae 211 Taske dene oaa A EN 213 Archive selectio Missin nn T E a da laasliee 213 Data VDE eyii EE E ATOA 214 Content Selecon aea AE ON E T E ia da ead ON 214 ACCESS credentials Tor IOCATION nannini a a E A O 216 D stinanonseleciOnunmn ana a a A A A NS 216 Access credentials for destinati M ssnssis riranna r e N A 223 When TO FOCOV EN sina a a E A E 223 Universal REStOlG anrora A a a 223 How to convert a disk backup to a virtual machine seseessoseessssseessseeeesssresssseeesssreessoseessssreessoreeesee 225 Bo taDIItY rOUDIESHOOUIN enana E AA 226 Recovering a vast number of files from a file backUp esssosseesseseesssseeesssreessseeessseeesseseeessereesssreeesse 229 Validating vaults archives and backupS essesssessseessrrsssrrsserssrerssrresrrreseressrreseerseeresees 230 TaskecredentidiS orena S TA 231 Arehiveselectiom snnm A A O a NA 232 Backup selecho Nini enira S a E E E ean ied bau td Shee aPcneaa 233 KOGALIOMSCIGCUON ranna N a E A S 233 Access
149. Path field This path will be created on each machine the policy will be applied to e Store each machine s archive in the machine s Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone has to be created on each machine the policy will be applied to For information on how to create Acronis Secure Zone see the Creating Acronis Secure Zone p 238 section 2 Naming the archives Data from each machine will be backed up to a separate archive Specify names for the archives The program generates a common name for the new archives and displays it in the Name field The name looks like PolicyName _ MachineName Archive1 If you are not satisfied with the automatically generated name construct another name If you selected Store all machines archives in a single location you have to use variables in order to provide the unique archive names within the location 1 Click Add variables then select o Machine name substitution for the machine s name o Policy name substitution for the backup policy s name As a result in the Name field the following rule will appear Machine name _ Policy name _Archivel1 326 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 So if the backup policy named say SYSTEM_BACKUP will be applied to three machines say FINDEPT1 FINDEPT2 FINDEPT3 the following three archives will be created in the location FINDEPT1_SYSTEM_BACKUP_Archive1 FINDEPT2_SYSTEM_BACKUP_Archive1 FINDEPT3_SYSTEM_BACKUP_Archive1 2 Click OK
150. Re attempt if an error n occurs Additional settings p 119 Set current date and time g for recovered files Validate backup archive 1 before recovery Check file system after 4 recovery Reboot machine automatically if it is required for recovery Change SID after recovery Windows F Windows recovery recovery Notifications E mail p 116 gt Win Pop up p 117 3 Event tracing Windows events log p 118 SNMP p 118 g E Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 113 3 4 2 1 Pre Post commands This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and PE based bootable media The option enables you to define the commands to be automatically executed before and after the data recovery Example of how you can use the pre post commands e launch the Checkdisk command in order to find and fix logical file system errors physical errors or bad sectors to be started before the recovery starts or after the recovery ends The program does not support interactive commands i e commands that require user input for example pause To specify pre post commands 1 Enable pre post commands execution by checking the following options o Execute before the recovery o Execute after the recovery 2 Do any of the following o Click Edit to specify a new command or a batch file o Select the existing command or the batch file from the drop down list 3 Click OK
151. Tape support Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 supports tape libraries autoloaders SCSI and USB tape drives as storage devices A tape device can be locally attached to a managed machine in this case the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent writes and reads the tapes or accessed through the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node p 19 Storage nodes ensure fully automatic operation of tape libraries and autoloaders p 130 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 43 Backup archives created using different ways of access to tape have different formats A tape written by a storage node cannot be read by an agent Linux based and PE based bootable media allow for backup and recovery using both local access and access through the storage node Backups created using the bootable media can be recovered with the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent running in the operating system 2 9 1 Tape compatibility table The following table summarizes the readability of tapes written by Acronis True Image Echo and Acronis True Image 9 1 product families in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 The table also illustrates the compatibility of tapes written by various components of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 IS readable on a tape device attached to a machine with ABR10 ABR10 ABR10 ABR10 Bootable Agentfor Agent for Storage Media Windows Linux Node on a locally device tape library by Windows on a tape through 44
152. These letters are used by applications and operating systems to locate files and folders in the volumes Connecting an additional disk as well as creating or deleting a volume on existing disks might change your system configuration As a result some applications might stop working normally or user files might not be automatically found and opened To prevent this you can manually change the letters that are automatically assigned to the volumes by the operating system If you need to change a letter assigned to a volume by the operating system Select a volume to change a letter Right click on the selected volume and then click Change letter in the context menu Select a new letter in the Change Letter window a a By clicking OK in the Change Letter window you ll add a pending operation to volume letter assignment To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view immediately 6 9 6 5 Change volume label The volume label is an optional attribute It is a name assigned to a volume for easier recognition For example one volume could be called SYSTEM a volume with an operating system or PROGRAM an application volume DATA a data volume etc but it does not imply that only the type of data stated with the label could b
153. W D0DD0DDDW __ DDDODM_ Mon F Tue F I We F l Tu F I l Fmi F b l D St F Off Sn F Oi Mon FO I ot O La Te Fil ofS EI We F Fo ft ofS rl til Thu F bf mt a E til Fi F W S i i li D Sa F wS I IIl l D an F E Tit tot oe Mon F Dif 1 i ot l Of Tue F Dif 1 toi i D We F Dif i i or 1 to Thu F Dif _ Dif bot do Fi F Dif I ot tot Dit Sat F Dif I l l Oi amn F Dif 1 ot l Bit Mon F Dif L l 0 Of Tue F Dif T Df I We F Dif Li I Ii D row Tu F Dif Dif 1 roti hi Dif S a sal F Dif 1 totter An archive created according to the GFS scheme by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Schedule Workdays at 8 00 PM Weekly Monthly Friday Keep daily backups 7 days Keep weekly backups 2 weeks Keep monthly backups 6 months 2 6 Tower of Hanoi backup scheme The need to have frequent backups always conflicts with the cost of keeping such backups for a long time The Tower of Hanoi TOH backup scheme is a useful compromise Tower of Hanoi overview The Tower of Hanoi scheme is based on a mathematical puzzle of the same name In the puzzle a series of rings are stacked in size order the largest on the bottom on one of three pegs The goal is to move the ring series to the third peg You are only allowed to move one ring at a time and are prohibited from placing a larger ring above a smaller ring The solution is to shift the first ring every other move moves 1 3 5 7 9 11 t
154. a p 341 or Acronis PXE Server Operations can be configured and controlled either locally through the GUI or remotely using the console p 343 Bootable media A physical media CD DVD USB flash drive or other media supported by a machine p 347 BIOS as a boot device that contains the bootable agent p 341 or Windows Preinstallation Environment WinPE p 352 with the Acronis Plug in for WinPE p 338 A machine can also be booted into the above environments using the network boot from Acronis PXE Server or Microsoft Remote Installation Service RIS These servers with uploaded bootable components can also be thought of as a kind of bootable media Bootable media is most often used to e recover an operating system that cannot start e access and back up the data that has survived in a corrupted system e deploy an operating system on bare metal e create basic or dynamic volumes p 346 on bare metal e back up sector by sector a disk that has an unsupported file system e back up offline any data that cannot be backed up online because of restricted access being permanently locked by the running applications or for any other reason Built in group A group of machines that always exists on a management server p 348 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 341 A management server has two built in groups that contain all machines of each type All physical machines p 349 All virtual machines p 352 Built in gro
155. a disk backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup Delete a single or Select one of the backups you want to delete then click J Delete multiple backups The program duplicates your selection in the Backups deletion p 159 window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup Review the selection and correct if need be select the check boxes for the desired backups then confirm the deletion Delete all archives and Please be aware that if filters have been applied to the vaults list you see only a part of backups in the vault the vault content Be sure that the vault does not contain archives you need to retain before starting the operation Click H Delete all The program duplicates your selection in the Backups deletion p 159 window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup Review the selection and correct if need be then confirm the deletion 4 3 3 Deleting archives and backups The Backups deletion window displays the same tab as for the vaults view but with check boxes for each archive and backup The archive or backup you have chosen to delete has the check mark Review the archive or backup that you have selected to delete If you need to delete other archives and backups select the respective check boxes then click Delete selected and confirm the deletion The filters in this window are from the archives list of the vault view Thus if some filters have been applied to the
156. a disk group with an incremental name is created When moved to another machine a disk group is considered as foreign and cannot be used until imported into the existing disk group The import updates the configuration data on both the local 344 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 and the foreign disks so that they form a single entity A foreign group is imported as is will have the original name if no disk group exists on the machine For more information about disk groups please refer to the following Microsoft knowledge base article 222189 Description of Disk Groups in Windows Disk Management http support microsoft com kb 222189 EN US Dynamic disk A hard disk managed by Logical Disk Manager LDM that is available in Windows starting with Windows 2000 LDM helps flexibly allocate volumes on a storage device for better fault tolerance better performance or larger volume size A dynamic disk can use either the master boot record MBR or GUID partition table GPT partition style In addition to MBR or GPT each dynamic disk has a hidden database where the LDM stores the dynamic volumes configuration Each dynamic disk holds the complete information about all dynamic volumes existing in the disk group which makes for better storage reliability The database occupies the last 1MB of an MBR disk On a GPT disk Windows creates the dedicated LDM Metadata partition taking space from the Microsoft Reserved Partition MSR
157. a free tape The tape will be loaded to a drive especially for this operation If the Use a separate tape set option is enabled only incremental and differential backups of the same data will be appended to the tape e For each differential backup The preset is Disabled When this option is enabled each differential backup will be written onto a free tape This option is available only when using free tape for each full backup is selected e For each incremental backup The preset is Disabled When this option is enabled each incremental backup will be written onto a free tape This option is available only when using free tape for each full and differential backup is selected 4 1 3 8 Tape rotation If all backups are deleted from a tape i e if information about the last backup on the tape is deleted from the storage node database the tape is considered as empty and can be reused during a backup cycle The same tape rotation enables you to get by with the minimum number of cartridges and not to be buried in used tapes Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 enables you to achieve full automation of tape rotation while backing up onto tape libraries This section provides you with useful information to choose a backup scheme and tape options for tape rotation To calculate the number of tapes required for tape rotation schemes you can use the method described in the Tape planning p 151 section Choosing a backup scheme When cre
158. a single tape drive 45 Using the Grandfather Father Son tape rotation scheme 32 141 Using the management console 8 10 Using the Tower of Hanoi tape rotation scheme 38 147 V Validating vaults archives and backups 126 156 158 159 230 Validation 24 131 339 350 351 352 Validation rules 340 352 Vault 24 46 241 349 351 352 Vault database path 127 128 Vault encryption 127 128 Vault path 127 129 Vaults 41 122 230 241 298 Views 14 Virtual machine 342 352 Virtual machine settings 217 218 221 226 Virtual machine type virtualization server selection 216 218 220 359 VM power management 121 Volume destination 217 219 Volume operations 265 Volume properties 219 Volume selection 235 237 Volume Shadow Copy Service 89 95 97 Volumes 212 218 Volumes to back up selection rules 320 W Weekly schedule 164 206 298 332 What if 153 When deduplication is most effective 65 When to recover 212 223 When to validate 231 234 Why is the program asking for the password 195 Windows event log 85 87 91 102 113 118 WinPE Windows Preinstallation Environment 338 341 352 WinPE ISO Builder 18 Work across subnets 256 Working under bootable media 250 Working with backup plans and tasks 183 Working with the 123 124 155 274 360 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009
159. ack up on Friday e Weekly monthly Friday Keep backups o Daily 1 week o Weekly 1 month o Monthly indefinitely Backup is thus performed only on Fridays This makes Friday the only choice for weekly and monthly backups leaving no other date for daily backups The resulting Grandfather Father archive will hence consist only of weekly differential and monthly full backups Even though it is possible to use GFS to create such an archive the Custom scheme is more flexible in this situation 6 2 9 5 Tower of Hanoi scheme At a glance Up to 16 levels of full differential and incremental backups Next level backups are twice as rare as previous level backups e One backup of each level is stored at a time Higher density of more recent backups Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 205 Parameters You can set up the following parameters of a Tower of Hanoi scheme Schedule Set up a daily p 162 weekly p 164 or monthly p 167 schedule Setting up schedule parameters allows creating simple schedules example of a simple daily schedule a backup task will be run every 1 day at 10 AM as well as more complex schedules example of a complex daily schedule a task will be run every 3 days starting from January 15 During the specified days the task will be repeated every 2 hours from 10 AM to 10 PM Thus complex schedules specify the sessions on which the scheme should run In the discussion below days can be r
160. ackup amp Recovery 10 Agents require a license to perform operations on each managed machine Agents have multiple features or add ons that enable additional functionality and so might require additional licenses Components for centralized management These components delivered with the Advanced SBS and Virtual Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 editions provide the centralized management capability Usage of these components is not licensed Console and tools The console provides Graphical User Interface and remote connection to the agents and other Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components With bootable media builders you can create bootable media in order to use the agents and other rescue utilities in a rescue environment Availability of the agent add ons in a rescue environment depends on whether an add on is installed on the machine where the media builder is working 1 3 1 Agent for Windows This agent enables disk level and file level data protection under Windows Disk backup Disk level data protection is based on backing up either a disk or a volume file system as a whole along with all the information necessary for the operating system to boot or all the disk sectors using the sector by sector approach raw mode A backup that contains a copy of a disk or a volume ina packaged form is called a disk volume backup or a disk volume image It is possible to recover disks or volumes as a whole from such backup as wel
161. aged machine the zone is always present in the list of Personal vaults Centralized backup plans p 342 can use Acronis Secure Zone as well as local plans p 347 If you have used Acronis Secure Zone before please note a radical change in the zone functionality The zone does not perform automatic cleanup that is deleting old archives anymore Use backup schemes with automatic cleanup to back up to the zone or delete outdated backups manually using the archive management functionality With the new Acronis Secure Zone behavior you obtain the ability to e list archives located in the zone and backups contained in each archive e examine a backup s content e mount a disk backup to copy files from the backup to a physical disk e safely delete archives and backups from the archives 46 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 For more information about operations available in Acronis Secure Zone see the Personal vaults p 154 section Upgrade from Acronis True Image Echo When upgrading from Acronis True Image Echo to Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Acronis Secure Zone will keep the archives created with Echo The zone will appear in the list of personal vaults and the old archives will be available for recovery To upgrade the activated Acronis Startup Recovery Manager deactivate it and activate again No action is needed to upgrade the Acronis Startup Recovery Manager if it is not activated 2 10 2 Acronis Startup Recovery
162. ains the required rollback period by deleting the expired backups and keeping the most recent backups of each level Custom to create a custom scheme where you are free to set up a backup strategy in the way your enterprise needs it most specify multiple schedules for different backup types add conditions and specify the retention rules 1 2 1 1 Back up now scheme With the Back up now scheme the backup will be performed immediately right after you click the OK button at the bottom of the page In the Backup type field select whether you want to create a full incremental or differential backup p 28 1 2 1 2 Back up later scheme With the Back up later scheme the backup will be performed only once at the date and time you specify Specify the appropriate settings as follows Backup type Select the type of backup full incremental or differential If there is no full backup in the archive a full backup will be created regardless of your selection Date and time Specify when to start the backup The task will be Select this check box if you do not need to put the backup task on a schedule and started manually wish to start it manually afterwards Tilida Simple scheme With the simple backup scheme you just schedule when and how often to back up data and set the retention rule At the first time a full backup will be created The next backups will be incremental To set up the simple backup scheme specify the ap
163. all the network bandwidth it can get when transferring the backup data Use this option to reserve a part of the network bandwidth to other network activities The preset is Maximum To set the network connection speed for backup Do any of the following e Click Transferring speed stated as a percentage of the estimated maximum speed of the network connection and then drag the slider or type a percentage in the box e Click Transferring speed stated in kilobytes per second and then enter the bandwidth limit for transferring backup data in kilobytes per second 3 4 1 10 Notifications Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the ability of notifying users about backup completion through e mail or the messaging service E mail This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media The option enables you to receive e mail notifications about the backup task s successful completion failure or need for interaction along with the full log of the task The preset is Disabled To configure e mail notification 1 Select the Send e mail notifications check box to activate notifications 2 In the E mail addresses field type the e mail address to which notifications will be sent You can enter several addresses separated by semicolons 3 Under Send notifications select the appropriate check boxes as follows 100 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009
164. allocated space size has to be enough to accommodate the backup content The way unallocated space is distributed among the disks is also important Example Striped volumes consume equal portions of space on each disk Assume you are going to recover a 30GB striped volume to a disk group consisting of two disks Each disk has volumes and a certain amount of unallocated space The total size of unallocated space is 40GB The recovery will always result in a striped volume if the unallocated space is distributed evenly among the disks 20GB and 20GB If one of the disks has 10GB and the other has 30GB of unallocated space then the recovery result depends on the size of the data being recovered If the data size is less than 20GB then one disk can hold say 10GB the other will hold the remaining 10GB This way a striped volume will be created on both disks and 20GB on the second disk will remain unallocated If the data size is more than 20GB the data cannot be distributed evenly between the two disks but can fit into a single simple volume A simple volume accommodating all the data will be created on the second disk The first disk will remain untouched Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Recovered to Dynamic volume Unallocated space disk group Basic MBR volume Basic GPT volume Unallocated space basic MBR disk Dynamic volume Dynamic volume Type as of the target Dynamic volume Type as of the source
165. alue Run the task on schedule only if all users are logged off e Condition Time since last backup Value Time since the last backup 12 hour s e Task start conditions Wait until the conditions are met If the free space changes by more than 1 GB the scheduler will wait until both conditions are met at the same time and then run the backup task 5 6 1 User Is idle Applies to Windows User is idle means that a screen saver is running on the managed machine or the machine is locked Example Run the backup task on the managed machine every day at 9PM preferably when the user is idle If the user is still active by 11PM run the task anyway e Event Daily every 1 day s Once at 09 00 00 PM e Condition User is idle Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 173 e Task start conditions Wait until the conditions are met Run the task anyway after 2 hour s As a result 1 If the user becomes idle before 9PM the backup task will start at 9PM 2 If the user becomes idle between 9PM and 11PM the backup task will start immediately after the user becomes idle 3 If the user is still active at 11PM the backup task starts anyway 5 6 2 Location Is available Applies to Windows Linux Location is available means that the destination specified for storing archives on a networked drive is accessible for creating a backup Example Backing up data to the networked location is performed on workdays a
166. alues into the special windows between the minimum and the maximum values or click on the special handle and hold and drag the borders of the disk s picture with the cursor The maximum value normally includes the most possible unallocated space But in some cases the possible unallocated space and the proposed maximum volume size might differ e g when the size of one mirror establishes the size of the other mirror or the last 8Mb of the disk space is reserved for the future conversion of the disk from basic to dynamic For basic volumes if some unallocated space is left on the disk you also will be able to choose the position of the new volume on the disk If you click the Back button you will be returned to the previous page Select destination disks p 267 If you click the Next button you will proceed to the next page Set the volume options p 268 Set the volume options On the next wizard page you can assign the volume Letter by default the first free letter of the alphabet and optionally a Label by default none Here you will also specify the File system and the Cluster size The wizard will prompt you to choose one of the Windows file systems FAT16 disabled if the volume size has been set at more than 2 Gb FAT32 disabled if the volume size has been set at more than 32 Gb NTFS or to leave the volume Unformatted In setting the cluster size you can choose between any number in the preset amount for each
167. an p 340 Policy See Backup policy p 340 R Recovery point Date and time to which the backed up data can be reverted to Registered machine A machine p 347 managed by a management server p 348 A machine can be registered on only one management server at a time A machine becomes registered as a result of the registration p 349 procedure Registration A procedure that adds a managed machine p 348 to a management server p 348 Registration sets up a trust relationship between the agent p 339 residing on the machine and the server During registration the console retrieves the management server s client certificate and passes it to the agent which uses it later to authenticate clients attempting to connect This helps prevent any attempts by network attackers from establishing a fake connection on behalf of a trusted principal the management server S Selection rule A part of the backup policy p 340 Enables the management server p 348 administrator to select the data to back up within a machine Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 349 Static group A group of machines which a management server p 348 administrator populates by manually adding machines to the group A machine remains in a static group until the administrator removes it from the group or from the management server Storage node Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node A server aimed to optimize usage of various
168. and with minor limitations basic GPT volumes Backing up dynamic volumes Dynamic and basic GPT volumes are backed up in the same way as basic MBR volumes When creating a backup plan through the GUI all types of volumes are available for selection as Items to back up When using the command line specify the dynamic and GPT volumes with the DYN prefix Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 41 Command line examples trueimagecmd create partition DYN1 DYN2 asz This will back up DYN1 and DYN2 volumes to the Acronis Secure Zone trueimagecmd create harddisk DYN asz This will back up all dynamic volumes in the system to the Acronis Secure Zone The boot code on basic GPT volumes is not backed up or recovered Recovering dynamic volumes A dynamic volume can be recovered over any type of existing volume to unallocated space of a disk group to unallocated space of a basic disk Recovery over an existing volume When a dynamic volume is recovered over an existing volume either basic or dynamic the target volume s data is overwritten with the backup content The type of target volume basic simple spanned striped mirrored RAID 0 1 RAID 5 will not change The target volume size has to be enough to accommodate the backup content Recovery to disk group unallocated space 42 When a dynamic volume is recovered to disk group unallocated space both the type and the content of the resulting volume are recovered The un
169. anel gt Administrative tools gt Event Viewer You can filter the events to be recorded The preset is Disabled To enable this option select the Log events check box Use the Types of events to log check box to filter the events to be logged in the Application Event Log of Windows o All events all events information warnings and errors o Errors and warnings o Errors only To disable this option clear the Log events check box 3 2 2 2 SNMP notifications This option defines whether the management server has to send its own log events to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP managers You can choose the types of events to be sent Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP objects to SNMP management applications 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 1 0 string identifying the type of event Information Warning Error 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 2 0 string containing the text description of the event it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 in its log The preset is Disabled To set up sending SNMP messages 1 Select the Send messages to SNMP server check box 2 Specify the appropriate options as follows o Types of events to send choose the types of events All events Errors and warnings or Errors only o Server name IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management appl
170. another group static group In the Move to group p 286 window select the group to move the machine to All the backup policies applied to the group the machine was in will be revoked The backup policies applied to the group the machine is now a member of will be deployed to the machine Remove a machine from the Click Es Remove from group current static group The backup policies applied to the group will be revoked from the machine automatically Deleting the selected machine from the management server To Do Delete a machine from the Click 2 Delete machine from AMS management server o l As a result backup policies are revoked and shortcuts to centralized vaults are deleted from the machine If the machine is not available at the moment these actions will be performed on the machine as soon as the machine becomes available to the management server Other actions Direct management operations Create a backup plan on a Click T Backup machine This operation is described in depth in the Creating a backup plan p 193 section Recover data Click Recover This operation is described in depth in the Recovering data p 211 section Connect to a machine Click E Connect directly directly Establishes a direct connection to the managed machine Enables to administer Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 283 a managed machine and perform all the direct management operations Other operations View de
171. apon sysinfo tar tune2fs udev udevinfo udevstart 251 grub ping umount gunzip pktsetup uuidgen halt powerofft vconfig hexdump ps vi hotplug raidautorun zcat 6 8 5 Recovering MD devices and logical volumes To recover Linux Software RAID devices known as MD devices and or devices created by Logical Volume Manager LVM known as logical volumes you need to manually create the correspondent volume structure before starting the recovery The following are a general procedure for recovering MD devices and logical volumes by using a Linux based bootable media and an example of such recovery You can use a similar procedure in Linux To recover MD devices and logical volumes 1 Boot the machine from a Linux based bootable media _ Tip To create a Linux based bootable media run Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console in _Windows or Linux on the toolbar click Tools and then click Create bootable media 2 Click Acronis Bootable Agent Then click Run management console 3 On the toolbar click Actions and then click Start shell Alternatively you can press CTRL ALT F2 4 If necessary examine the structure of volumes which are stored in the archive by using the trueimagecmd utility Also you can use the trueimagemnt utility to mount one or more of these volumes as if they were regular volumes see Mounting backup volumes later in this topic 5 Create the volume structure according to that
172. appropriate folder on the server You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access To do so click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials _ As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer o Ifthe archive is stored on a locally attached tape device expand the Tape drives group then click the required device 232 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 2 In the table to the right of the tree select the archive The table displays the names of the archives contained in each vault folder you select While you are reviewing the location content archives can be added deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives You can switch between displaying archives by names and displaying the physical representation of the archives as TIB files using the Show archives and Show TIB files buttons 3 Click OK 6 4 3 Backup selection To specify a backup to validate 1 Inthe upper pane select a backup by its creation date time The bottom part of the window displays the selected backup content assisting you to find the right backup 2 Click OK 6 4 4 Location selection To sel
173. aries 43 130 Tape library as a managed vault 134 Tape options 109 131 135 138 Tape planning 139 151 Example 1 152 Example 2 153 Tape rotation 131 139 Tape support 43 Task 24 340 342 347 351 Task credentials 213 231 Task details 179 180 183 187 288 300 Task failure handling 90 108 Task start conditions 90 107 162 173 181 Task states 179 181 300 Task statuses 179 182 300 Tasks 278 280 284 287 296 300 Tasks need interaction 179 Technical support 22 Temporarily disabling a backup plan 157 187 Time since last backup 176 Time based alerts 83 TOH Example 1 148 152 TOH Example 2 148 149 TOH Example 3 148 150 Tower of Hanoi 341 351 Tower of Hanoi backup scheme 36 131 139 351 Tower of Hanoi scheme 205 332 Types of connection to a managed machine 69 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Types of dynamic volumes 265 U Understanding Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 24 Understanding centralized management 51 Understanding states and statuses 180 Universal Restore 18 212 223 246 Universal Restore Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore 45 47 211 224 351 Unmanaged vault 339 351 User is idle 173 User logged off 175 User privileges on a managed machine 30 69 70 195 213 232 320 User privileges on a storage node 71 124 297 Using
174. ars from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer 2 Click OK 4 1 2 3 Attaching a managed vault A vault managed by a storage node can be attached to another storage node You might need to do so when retiring storage node hardware when the storage node is lost or when balancing loads between storage nodes As a result the first node stops managing the vault The second node scans Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 129 archives in the vault creates and fills up the database corresponding to the vault and starts managing the vault When deleting a managed vault you have the option to retain archives contained in the vault The location resulting from such deletion can also be attached to the same or another storage node Personal or centralized unmanaged vaults cannot be attached To attach a managed vault to a storage node perform the following steps Vault Storage node Select the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node that will manage the vault Path Specify the path to the location where the archives are stored Database path Specify a local folder on the storage server to create a vault specific database This database will store the metadata required for cataloguing the archives and performing deduplication Pas
175. art PE with Acronis Plug in from Windows distribution 1 Get the Bart PE builder 2 Install the Acronis WinPE ISO Builder from the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 setup file 3 Change the current folder to the folder where the Acronis Plug in for WinPE is installed by default C Program Files Acronis WinPE WinPE If the plug in is installed in a folder other than the default folder change the path accordingly check the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE SOFTWARE Acronis WinPE Settings WinPE for the plug in location 4 Run the following command export_license bat 5 Copy the contents of the current folder by default C Program Files Acronis WinPE WinPE to the BartPE folder plugins Acronis 6 Insert your Windows distribution CD if you do not have a copy of Windows installation files on the HDD 7 Start the Bart PE builder 8 Specify the path to the Windows installation files or Windows distribution CD 9 Click Plugins and check whether the Acronis plug in is enabled Enable if disabled 10 Specify the output folder and the full path to the resulting ISO file including the file name or the media to create 11 Build the Bart PE 12 Burn the ISO to CD or DVD if this has not been done yet or copy to a flash drive Once the machine boots into the Bart PE and you configure the network connection select Go gt System gt Storage gt Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 to start Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009
176. ary device attached to a machine with Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node installed all you need to do to back up onto the tape library is to create an archive vault on the device under storage node management Prerequisites A tape library device has to be installed on a machine running Windows in accordance with the device manufacturer s installation instructions If Removable Storage Manager RSM is present in your version of Windows it must be activated In Microsoft Windows XP and Microsoft Windows Server 2003 e Removable Storage Manager is part of the operating system and is activated initially To activate Removable Storage Manager in Microsoft Windows Server 2008 1 Click Administrative Tools gt Server Manager gt Features gt Add Feature 2 Select the Removable Storage Manager check box To activate Removable Storage Manager in Microsoft Windows Vista 1 Click Control Panel gt Programs gt Programs and Features gt Turn Windows features on or off 2 Select the Removable Storage Management check box Fill the library slots with tape cartridges If a tape does not get a barcode or its barcode is corrupted you can define the tape label for identification purposes later You should have Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console installed on local or remote machines as well as Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node installed on t
177. as described in the table below 5 Click Test command to check if the command is correct Check box Selection Fail the backup task if the Selected Cleared Selected Cleared command execution fails Do not perform the data Selected Selected Cleared Cleared capture until the command Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 95 execution is complete Result Preset Perform the data N A Perform the data EopUne after the command is capture only after the command is successfully executed Fail the task if the command execution fails executed despite execution failure or success Post data capture command To specify a command batch file to be executed after data capture Perform the data capture concurrently with the command and irrespective of the command execution result 1 In the Command field type a command or browse to a batch file The program does not support interactive commands i e commands that require user input for example pause 2 Inthe Working directory field specify a path to a directory where the command batch file will be executed 3 Inthe Arguments field specify the command s execution arguments if required 4 Depending on the result you want to obtain select the appropriate options as described in the table below 5 Click Test command to check if the command is correct Check box Selection Fail the task if the command Selected Cleared Selected Cleared execution fails Do not back up unt
178. as to those other than FAT and NTFS 6 3 6 3 Virtual machine type virtualization server selection The new virtual machine can be created either on a virtualization server this requires Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi to be installed or in any accessible local or networked folder To select the virtualization server the new virtual machine will be created on 1 Choose the Place on the virtualization server that select option 2 Inthe left part of the window select the virtualization server Use the right part of the window to review details on the selected server 3 Click OK to return to the Data recovery page To select the type of virtual machine 1 Choose the Save as files of the VM type that I select to the folder that specify option 2 Inthe left part of the window select the virtual machine type Use the right part of the window to review details on the selected virtual machine type 3 Click OK to return to the Data recovery page 220 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 3 6 4 Virtual machine settings The following virtual machine settings can be configured Storage Initial setting the default storage of the virtualization server if the new machine is created on the virtualization server Otherwise the current user s documents folder This is the place where the new virtual machine will be created Whether you can change the storage on the virtualization se
179. asks can be modified directly Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 347 M Machine A physical or virtual computer uniquely identified by an operating system installation Machines with multiple operating systems multi boot systems are considered as multiple machines Managed machine A machine p 347 either physical or virtual where at least one Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent p 339 is installed Managed vault A centralized vault p 342 managed by a storage node p 350 Archives p 339 in a managed vault can be accessed as follows bsp node_address vault_name archive_name Physically managed vaults can reside on a network share SAN NAS on a hard drive local to the storage node or on a tape library locally attached to the storage node The storage node performs storage node side cleanup p 350 and storage node side validation p 350 for each archive stored in the managed vault An administrator can specify additional operations that the storage node will perform deduplication p 343 encryption Any managed vault is self contained that is contains all metadata the storage node needs to manage the vault In case the storage node is lost or its database is corrupted the new storage node retrieves the metadata and re creates the database When the vault is attached to another storage node the same procedure takes place Management server Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server A ce
180. asks you to label a tape Actions on a tape library vault If a tape library vault is selected on the Navigation pane of the console the Centralized vaults page toolbar will contain the following two actions that are used for tape libraries only e Manage tapes displays the Tape Management window allowing you to refresh information on the library slots inventory tapes in the slots and define labels for the tapes If you have a new label assigned to the tape the action enables you to eject the tape temporarily to make the same label outside the cartridge e Rescan tapes displays the Tape Rescanning window which is useful for selecting slots and launching the Rescan p 137 procedure to read some special information on the content of the specified tapes Also the Edit Delete Validate and Refresh functions are allowed on a tape library vault It should be noted these functions have some specific features for a tape library So the Edit operation enables you to substitute a tape library device without the Rescan operation The Delete operation clears all the information on the selected tape library vault from the storage node database i e the operation deletes the content data of all the tapes when ever the data is used by the storage node on the tape library device At the Delete operation the vault content will be deleted from the storage node database without accessing the _ tapes The plans and tasks that use this vault will fai
181. ate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive Backup options Settings Optional Configure parameters of the backup operation such as pre post backup commands maximum network bandwidth allocated for the backup stream or the backup archive compression level If you do nothing in this section the default values p 89 will be used After any of the settings is changed against the default value a new line that displays the newly set value appears The setting status changes from Default to Custom Should you modify the setting again the line will display the new value unless the new value is the default one When the default value is set the line disappears and so you always see only the settings that differ from the default values in this section of the Create backup plan page To reset all the settings to the default values click Reset to default After you have performed all the required steps click OK to create the backup plan 194 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 After that you might be prompted for the password p 195 The plan you have created will be accessible for examination and managing in the Backup plans and tasks p 179 view 6 2 1 Why is the program asking for the password A scheduled or postponed task has to run regardless of users being logged on In case you have not explicitly specified the credentials under which the task s will run the program proposes using your account Enter y
182. ating Once the policy is updated its state becomes Deployed again This state means that the policy is functioning and no changes are currently being made to it A policy that was modified while being deployed remains in the Deploying state The management server just starts to deploy the modified policy from the beginning You may need to revoke the policy from the machine or from the group the machine is included in Once you confirm the changes the management server revokes the policy from the machine While Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 61 the changes are transferred to the machine and the agent deletes the backup plan from it the policy state on the machine is Revoking You may change grouping conditions or the machine may change its properties so that the machine leaves one group and is included into another This may result in revoking one policy and deploying another policy In this case the first policy s state on the machine will be Revoking and the second policy s state will be Deploying The policies can appear in the GUI simultaneously or one after another Backup policy state diagram Successful revoke Revoke Successtul deployment completed 2 11 5 2 Policy status on a machine To see this parameter select any group of machines in the tree then select the machine and then select the Backup policies tab on the Information pane In each of the states the backup policy can have one of th
183. ating a backup policy plan with a tape library destination the following backup schemes are available Back up now Back up later Grandfather Father Son Tower of Hanoi or Custom The Simple backup scheme is disabled because backup consolidation is impossible for archives located on tapes Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides automation of tape rotation for Grandfather Father Son Tower of Hanoi and Custom backup schemes Grandfather Father Son p 32 GFS and Tower of Hanoi p 36 ToH are the most popular backup schemes to use on tape library devices These schemes are optimized to maintain the best balance between a backup archive size the number of recovery points available from the archive and the quantity of required tapes for archiving Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 139 If your backup archive must provide recovery with daily resolution for the last several days weekly resolution for the last several weeks and monthly resolution for any time in the past the most preferred scheme for you is the Grandfather Father Son scheme If the main goal is to provide data protection for the longest period with the minimal number of used tapes permanently loaded into a small tape library e g autoloader the best solution is to probably choose the Tower of Hanoi scheme The Custom backup scheme enables you to specify a backup schedule and retention rules to define a desired tape rotation Use this scheme when the Grandfather
184. ation warnings and errors o Errors and warnings o Errors only e Do not log to disable logging events of the backup operations in the Application Event Log SNMP notifications This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media 102 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The option defines whether the agent s operating on the managed machine have to send the log events of the backup operations to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP managers You can choose the types of events to be sent Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP objects to SNMP management applications 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 1 0 string identifying the type of event Information Warning Error 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 2 0 string containing the text description of the event it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 in its log The preset is Use the setting set in the Machine options To select whether to send the backup operations events to the SNMP managers Choose one of the following e Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine For more information refer to Machine options p 86 e Send SNMP notifications individually for backup operation events to send the events of the backup operations to t
185. aults tree to open the detailed view of this vault p 155 and to take actions on the vault p 156 archives p 157 and backups p 158 stored in there 4 1 Centralized vaults A centralized vault is a networked location allotted by the management server administrator to serve as storage for the backup archives A centralized vault can be managed by a storage node or be unmanaged The total number and size of archives stored in a centralized vault is limited by the storage size only As soon as the management server administrator commits to creating a centralized vault the vault path and name are distributed to all machines registered on the server The shortcut to the vault appears on the machines in the Vaults gt Centralized group Any backup plan existing on the machines including local plans can use the centralized vault On a machine that is not registered on the management server a user having the privilege to back up to the centralized vault can do so by specifying the full path to the vault If the vault is managed the user s archives as well as other archives stored in the vault will be managed by the storage node Managed vaults The managed vault is a centralized vault managed by a storage node The storage node performs storage node side cleanup p 350 and storage node side validation p 350 for each archive stored in the managed vault When creating a managed vault an administrator can specify additional operations
186. ay want to create various policies applicable to different sets of machines In this case consider creating custom groups 2 11 4 Policies on machines and groups This section helps you understand the automatic deployment and revoking policies performed by the management server when a policy or a number of policies are applied to machines and nested groups of machines in various combinations when a policy is revoked from machines and groups when a machine or a group is moved from one group to another Operations with groups to which backup policies are applied will result in changing the policies on the member machines On any hierarchy change that is when moving removing creating groups adding machines to static groups or when machines enter a group based on dynamic criteria a huge number of inheritance changes may occur Please familiarize yourself with this section to be sure that your actions yield the desired result and to understand the result of the automated Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server operations What is applying deploying and revoking Applying a policy establishes the correspondence between the policy and one or more machines This process takes place inside the management server s database and does not take much time 56 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Deploying a policy transfers the established correspondence to the machines Physically a bundle of tasks is created on each machine according
187. backups stored on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node is not possible To mount an image perform the following steps Source Archive p 235 Specify the path to the archive location and select the archive containing disk backups Backup p 236 Select the backup Access credentials p 236 Optional Provide credentials for the archive location To access this option select the Advanced view check box Mount settings Volumes p 237 Select volumes to mount and configure the mount settings for every volume assign a letter or enter the mount point choose the read write or read only access mode When you complete all the required steps click OK to mount the volumes 6 5 1 Archive selection Selecting the archive 1 Enter the full path to the location in the Path field or select the desired folder in the folders tree o If the archive is stored in a centralized vault expand the Centralized group and click the vault o Ifthe archive is stored in a personal vault expand the Personal group and click the vault o Ifthe archive is stored in a local folder on the machine expand the Local folders group and click the required folder If the archive is located on removable media e g DVDs first insert the last DVD and then insert discs in order starting from the first one when the program prompts o Ifthe archive is stored on a network share expand the Network folders group then select the required networke
188. be assigned the appropriate settings create the media on the server for which the media is customized When you select an existing NIC in the wizard window its settings are selected for saving on the media The MAC address of each existing NIC is also saved on the media You can change the settings except for the MAC address or configure the settings for a non existent NIC if need be Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 245 Once the bootable agent starts on the server it retrieves the list of available NICs This list is sorted by the slots the NICs occupy the closest to the processor on top The bootable agent assigns each known NIC the appropriate settings identifying the NICs by their MAC addresses After the NICs with known MAC addresses are configured the remaining NICs are assigned the settings that you have made for non existent NICs starting from the upper non assigned NIC You can customize bootable media for any machine and not only for the machine where the media is created To do so configure the NICs according to their slot order on that machine NIC1 occupies the slot closest to the processor NIC2 is in the next slot and so on When the bootable agent starts on that machine it will find no NICs with known MAC addresses and will configure the NICs in the same order as you did Example The bootable agent could use one of the network adapters for communication with the management console through the production networ
189. be recovered together otherwise there is a high risk that the operating system will not start eesesesesesesesesesesesesa lt i lt S Oe 2 Optional To create an exact copy of a disk or volume on a physical level select the Back up sector by sector check box The resulting backup will be equal in size to the disk being backed up if the Compression level option is set to None Use the sector by sector backup for backing up drives with unrecognized or unsupported file systems and other proprietary data formats 3 Click OK What does a disk or volume backup store For supported file systems with the sector by sector option turned off a disk or volume backup stores only those sectors that contain data This reduces the resulting backup size and speeds up the backup and recovery operations Windows The swap file pagefile sys and the file that keeps the RAM content when the machine goes into hibernation hiberfil sys are not backed up After recovery the files will be re created in the appropriate place with the zero size A volume backup stores all other files and folders of the selected volume independent of their attributes including hidden and system files the boot record the file allocation table FAT if it exists the root and the zero track of the hard disk with the master boot record MBR The boot code of GPT volumes is not backed up 196 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 A disk backup stores all vo
190. be set in hours days weeks months or years For monthly backups you can also select Keep indefinitely if you want them to be saved forever The default values for each backup type are as follows Daily 1 week recommended minimum Weekly 1 month 1 month for keeping backups is equal to four weeks Monthly indefinitely The retention period for weekly backups must exceed that for daily backups the monthly backups retention period must be greater than the weekly backups retention period We recommend setting a retention period of at least one week for daily backups At all times a backup is not deleted until all backups that directly depend on it become subject to deletion as l _ well This is why you might see a weekly or a monthly backup remain in the archive for a few days past its _ expected expiration date If the schedule starts with a daily or a weekly backup a full backup is created instead Examples Each day of the past week each week of the past month Let us consider a GFS backup scheme that many may find useful e Back up files every day including weekends e Be able to recover files as of any date over the past seven days e Have access to weekly backups of the past month e Keep monthly backups indefinitely Backup scheme parameters can then be set up as follows e Start backup at 11 00 PM e Back up on All days Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 203 e Weekly monthly Saturday fo
191. ber of required tapes will be equal to 4 4 13 1 22 Using the Tower of Hanoi tape rotation scheme The ToH scheme requires fewer tapes for rotation as compared with the GFS scheme So the ToH scheme is the best choice for small tape libraries especially for autoloaders Once the ToH backup scheme is selected it is possible to specify the scheme schedule and the number of levels Best practice suggests that five levels should be used if you are applying the Tower of Hanoi to weekly backups and eight levels if you are applying it to daily backups In the first case the rotation includes Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 147 16 weekly sessions so it ensures the roll back period equal 112 days Tape rotation for the second case includes 128 daily sessions i e it allows the roll back period equal 128 days Each additional level doubles not only the number of sessions but also the oldest backup age Let s return to the analyzed case described in the Case to analyze section and suppose the ToH settings are the following e Schedule Start the task every 1 day at 11 00 PM Repeat once e Number of levels 5 The Tower of Hanoi scheme with five levels ensures the roll back period equal 16 days but it simplifies an analysis of the scheme usage examples Let s designate the backups of the levels with numbers from 1 to 5 by letters A B C D and E respectively Then the rotation template for the backup sequence in the archive is the
192. bout Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server s events by means of Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP This parameter contains three settings Common Trace Specifies when to send the SNMP notifications This setting has two sub settings Trace State Description Specifies whether to send the SNMP notifications Possible values True or False Default value False Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Trace Level Description Specifies the minimum level of severity of events for sending SNMP notifications about them Only notifications about events of levels greater than or equal to Trace Level will be sent Possible values 0 Internal event 1 Debugging information 2 Information 3 Warning 4 Error or 5 Critical error Default value 4 only errors and critical errors will be sent if Trace State is set to True Address Description Specifies the network name or IP address of the SNMP server Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value Empty string Community Description Specifies the community name for the SNMP notifications Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value public Synchronization Specifies how Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server connects to registered machines for deployment of centralized policies retrieval of logs and backup plan states and similar actions collectively called synchronization This parameter
193. can look as follows Full backup Schedule Monthly every Last Sunday of the month at 9 00 PM Incremental Schedule Weekly every workday at 7 00 PM Differential Schedule Weekly every Saturday at 8 00 PM Further we want to add conditions that have to be satisfied for a backup task to start This is set up in the Conditions fields for each backup type Full backup Conditions Location available Incremental Conditions User is logged off Differential Conditions User is idle As a result a full backup originally scheduled at 9 00 PM may actually start later as soon as the backup location becomes available Likewise backup tasks for incremental and differential backups will wait until all users are logged off and users are idle respectively Finally we create retention rules for the archive let us retain only backups that are no older than six months and let the cleanup be performed after each backup task and also on the last day of every month Retention rules Delete backups older than 6 months Apply the rules After backing up On schedule Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 209 Cleanup schedule Monthly on the Last day of All months at 10 00 PM By default a backup is not deleted as long as it has dependent backups that must be kept For example if a full backup has become subject to deletion but there are incremental or differential backups that depend on it the deletion is postponed until all the depende
194. ccessed from the Vault name actions bar on the Actions and tools pane and from the Vault name actions item of the main menu The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with centralized vaults To Do Create a managed or 1 Click PE Create an unmanaged vault 2 Inthe Type field select the vault type Managed or Unmanaged The procedure of creating centralized vaults is described in depth in the following sections Create a managed centralized vault p 127 Create an unmanaged centralized vault p 129 Edit a managed or an 1 Select the vault unmanaged vault Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 125 Validate a vault Delete a vault Explore an unmanaged vault Attach the managed vault that was deleted without removing its content Change user credentials for accessing a vault Refresh a vault s information 2 Click Edit Depending on the vault you select managed or unmanaged the respective Edit page will be opened e The Edit managed vault page lets you change the encryption password if the vault is encrypted and Comments field The Edit unmanaged vault page lets you edit the Comments field only 1 Select the vault 2 Click a Validate You will be taken to the Validation p 230 page with an already pre selected vault as a source The vault validation checks all the archives in this vault 1 Select the vault 2 Click 2 Delete You ll be asked whether to keep
195. cess Parameters In Windows the notifications can be recorded into the event log a file or both Tracing parameters are specified as the following settings in Acronis Administrative Template File Trace Minimal Level Description Specifies the minimum severity level of notifications to be recorded in the file Only notifications of levels greater than or equal to FileTraceMinLevel will be recorded Possible values Any severity level between 0 and 5 or 6 to not record any notifications Default value 2 notifications with severity levels two through five will be recorded Win32 Trace Minimal Level Description Specifies the minimum severity level of notifications to be recorded in the System event log Only notifications of levels greater than or equal to Win32TraceMinLevel will be recorded Possible values Any severity level between 0 and 5 or 6 to not record any notifications 316 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Default value 4 notifications about errors and critical errors will be recorded 1 1 7 2 Parameters set through GUI The following parameters can be set through the graphical user interface GUI e For Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server CollectingLogs WindowsEventLog and Snmp e For Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent WindowsEventLog and Snmp You will find the description of these parameters in the correspondent topic about configuration through Group Policy Plata Parameters
196. cessary to change any previously selected options To help you with your choices each parameter is supplemented with detailed instructions If you want to create a volume Run the Create volume wizard by selecting Create volume on the Wizards bar or right click any unallocated space and select Create volume in the appearing context menu Select the type of volume being created At the first step you have to specify the type of volume you want to create The following types of volume are available 266 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e Basic e Simple Spanned e Striped e Mirrored e RAID 5 You will obtain a brief description of every type of volume for better understanding of the advantages and limitations of each possible volume architecture a s If the current operating system installed on this machine does not support the selected type of volume you will receive the appropriate warning In this case the Next button will be disabled and you will have to select another _ type of volume to proceed with the new volume creation After you click the Next button you will proceed forward to the next wizard page Select destination disks p 267 Select destination disks The next wizard page will prompt you to choose the disks whose space will be used for the volume creation To create a basic volume o Select a destination disk and specify the unallocated space to create the basic volume on To create a S
197. ch full backup option is cleared o the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is cleared o the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is cleared e tape size is T_GB The Tower of Hanoi scheme with four levels A B C and D specifies the following line of backups on the tapes before the first backup will be deleted D full A B A C A B A D A B A C The specified tape options do not require using a free tape for any backup so the backup line will be automatically split and continued on a new tape when the end of the current tape is reached There is one tape set to calculate Total number of required tapes round up 2 F_GB 6 I _GB 5 D_ GB CL T_GB 1 The above described ToH Example 1 p 148 is based on the five level Tower of Hanoi backup scheme with the same tape options Its backup line was the following E full A B A C A B A D A B A C A B A E A B A C A B A D Total number of required tapes round up 2 F_GB 12 _GB 11 D_ GB CL T_GB 1 round up 2 320 12 16 11 40 1 400 1 round up 3 18 1 5 tapes 152 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Tape planning Example 2 Imagine the case with the following features e full backup size is F_GB e average size of incremental backups is _GB e average size of differential backups is D_GB compression level provides CL average reduction coefficient e selected tape rota
198. cked off correspond to column headers presented in the table 2 Click the items you want to be displayed hidden 7 1 6 Log The Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 log stores the history of actions the software does on a machine or a user does on a machine using the software For example when a user edits a task an entry is added to the log When the software executes a task it adds multiple entries saying what it is currently doing Local and centralized logging in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 has local and centralized logs of events Local event log A local event log holds information about Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 operations on a managed machine For example creating a backup plan executing a backup plan managing archives in personal vaults executing a recovery task will generate events logged in the local event log Physically a local event log is a collection of XML files stored on the machine The managed machine local event log is accessible when the console is connected to the machine Local event logging cannot be disabled 302 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Operations performed using bootable media are logged as well but the log s lifetime is limited to a current session Rebooting eliminates the log but you can save the log to a file while the machine is booted with the media Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node has its own local event log This log s e
199. cking up at 8 00 PM on workdays Here is the total schedule you have defined B stands for backup 32 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Total shade B B B B 8 BE B B E E E EB SB HE B B B B The total schedule Schedule Workdays at 8 00 PM Weekly Monthly This step forms the daily weekly and monthly cycles in the schedule Select a day of the week from the days selected in the previous step Each 1st 2nd and 3rd backup created on this day of the week will be considered as a weekly backup Each 4th backup created on this day of the week will be considered as a monthly backup Backups created on the other days will be considered as daily backups Assume you select Friday for Weekly Monthly backup Here is the total schedule marked out according to the selection D stands for the backup that is considered Daily W stands for the backup that is considered Weekly M stands for the backup that is considered Monthly 0 Je Pe ve fv Fe Bev eve ra Jo Jv Poe Jr sn ve voor Fw Total Db D D OD W D D D D W D CE W D OO D D M schedule e _ _ e The schedule marked out according to the GFS scheme Schedule Workdays at 8 00 PM Weekly Monthly Friday Acronis uses incremental and differential backups that help save storage space and optimize the cleanup so that consolidation is not needed In terms of backup methods weekly backup is differential Dif mon
200. ckup Click the items in this section to obtain the relevant information This will take you to the Backup plans and tasks p 179 view with pre filtered plans or tasks For instance if you click Local under Backup plans the Backup plans and tasks view will be opened with backup plans filtered by the Local origin 6 1 1 1 Tasks need interaction This window accumulates all the tasks that require user interaction in one place It enables you to specify your decision such as to confirm reboot or to retry after freeing up the disk space on each of the tasks Until at least one task requires interaction you can open this window at any time from the managed machine s Dashboard p 177 If you select the check box for the Do not show this window when tasks require interaction will see this information in the tasks details and dashboard parameter the tasks will be displayed on the Dashboard among other alerts and warnings Alternatively you can review the task execution states in the Backup plans and tasks p 179 view and specify your decision on each task in the Information panel or in the Task details p 187 window 6 1 2 Backup plans and tasks The Backup plans and tasks view keeps you informed of data protection on a given machine It lets you monitor and manage backup plans and tasks A backup plan is a set of rules that specify how the given data will be protected on a given machine Physically a backup plan is a bundle o
201. ckup amp Recovery 10 e What if have to reinstall the storage node or attach the tape library to another machine Install a storage node on the machine the tape library is attached to create a centralized vault on the tape library and then rescan each tape containing backups e What if have lost my storage node and need to recover data from a tape If you know which tape has the data to recover and you have a tape device with vault managed by a storage node insert the tape cartridge into the device go to the Centralized vaults view of the console select the vault rescan the tape select the archive and the backup to recover data from and create the recovery task If you don t know which tape has the data to recover you have to rescan each tape until the data is found Generally all the steps you need to do are the same as mentioned above except the rescan has to be applied to a number of tapes instead one tape e What if need to recover data from an Echo tape Use the table from the Tape compatibility table p 44 section to find out which Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components can read data from your tape 4 2 Personal vaults A vault is called personal if it was created using direct connection of the console to a managed machine Personal vaults are specific for each managed machine Personal vaults are visible to any user that can log on to the system A user s right to back up to a personal vault is defined by th
202. close the Add Standalone Snap in dialog box and then click OK to close the Add Remove Snap in dialog box Self signed certificates On machines running Windows if the certificate location contains no server certificate a self signed server certificate is automatically generated and installed during the installation of any Acronis component except Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console If the machine is renamed after its self signed certificate was generated the certificate cannot be used and you will need to generate a new one To generate a new self signed certificate 1 Logonasa member of the Administrators group 2 Inthe Start menu click Run and then type cmd 3 Run the following command note quotation marks CommonProgramFiles Acronis Utils acroniscert reinstall 4 Restart Windows or restart the running Acronis services Non self signed certificates You have the option to use trusted third party certificates or certificates created by your organization s CA as an alternative to self signed certificates by using Acronis Certificate Command line Utility To install a third party certificate Click Start then click Run and then type certmgr msc In the Certificates console double click the name of the certificate that you want to install In the Details tab in the list of fields click Thumbprint a ae oe Select and copy the field s value called a certificate thumbprint a string such a
203. column header As a result you will see that the list of log entries fully or just partly coincide with the entered value Click the column s header to sort the log entries in ascending order Click it once again to sort the log entries in descending order Configuring the log table By default the table has seven columns that are displayed others are hidden If required you can hide the shown columns and show the hidden ones To show or hide columns 1 Right click any column header to open the context menu The menu items that are ticked off correspond to column headers presented in the table 2 Click the items you want to be displayed hidden Peleus Centralized log entry details Displays detailed information on the log entry you have selected and lets you copy the details to the clipboard To copy the details click the Copy to clipboard button Log entry data fields A centralized log entry contains the following data fields e Type Type of event Error Warning Information e Date Date and time when the event took place e Policy The backup policy the event relates to if any Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 305 e Task The task the event relates to if any e Managed entity type Type of managed entity where the event has occurred if any e Managed entity The name of the managed entity where the event has occurred if any e Machine The name of the machine where the event has occ
204. command for the changes to be made permanent Until then Acronis Disk Director Lite will only demonstrate the new volume structure that will result from the operations that have been planned to be performed on disks and volumes This approach enables you to control all planned operations double check the intended changes and if necessary cancel operations before they are executed To prevent you from performing any unintentional change on your disk the program will first display the list of all pending operations The Disk management view contains the toolbar with icons to launch the Undo Redo and Commit actions intended for pending operations These actions might also be launched from the Disk management menu of the console All planned operations are added to the pending operation list Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 271 The Undo action lets you undo the latest operation in the list While the list is not empty this action is available The Redo action lets you reinstate the last pending operation that was undone The Commit action forwards you to the Pending Operations window where you will be able to view the pending operation list Clicking Proceed will launch their execution You will not be able to undo any actions or operations after you choose the Proceed operation You can also cancel the commitment by clicking Cancel Then no changes will be done to the pending operation list Quitting Acronis Disk Director Lite
205. compacting task schedule You can also manually start or stop the task from the Tasks view 2 11 6 5 Deduplication restrictions Block level deduplication restrictions During a disk backup to an archive in a deduplicating vault deduplication of a volume s disk blocks is not performed in the following cases e Ifthe volume is a compressed volume e If the volume s allocation unit size also known as cluster size or block size is not divisible by 4 KB _ Tip The allocation unit size on most NTFS and ext3 volumes is 4KB and so allows for block level _ deduplication Other examples of allocation unit sizes allowing for block level deduplication include 8 KB 16 KB and 64 KB 2 non password protected and encrypt the deduplicating vault itself with a password which you can do when creating the vault Disk blocks that were not deduplicated are stored in the archive as they would be in a non deduplicating vault File level deduplication restrictions During a file backup to an archive in a deduplicating vault deduplication of a file is not performed in the following cases e If the file is encrypted and the In archives store encrypted files in decrypted state check box in the backup options is cleared it is cleared by default e If the file is less than 4 KB in size e f you protected the archive with a password Files that were not deduplicated are stored in the archive as they would be in a non deduplicating
206. covery 10 includes the agents for backing up disks and files and the agents for backing up virtual machines residing on virtualization servers Agent side cleanup Cleanup p 343 performed by an agent p 339 according to the backup plan p 340 that produces the archive p 339 Agent side cleanup is performed in unmanaged vaults p 351 Agent side validation Validation p 351 performed by an agent p 339 according to the backup plan p 340 that produces the archive p 339 Agent side validation is performed in unmanaged vaults p 351 Archive See Backup archive p 339 B Backup The result of a single backup operation p 339 Physically it is a file or a tape record that contains a copy of the backed up data as of specific date and time Backup files created by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 have a TIB extension The TIB files resulting from backup consolidation p 343 are also called backups Backup archive Archive A set of backups p 339 created and managed by a backup plan p 340 An archive can contain multiple full backups p 347 as well as incremental p 347 and differential backups p 343 Backups belonging to the same archive are always stored in the same location Multiple backup plans can back up the same source to the same archive but the mainstream scenario is one plan one archive Backups in an archive are entirely managed by the backup plan Manual operations with archives
207. credentials TOL SOUCO ronie a teint sedvoxateituuadeusteielagietetentancdeestttatenweeennieeedes 233 Whentovyvalidate nririnn a a eae led eta a davai acces elated a ees 234 MOUNE a0 IMS Catena siricn cate tenceser on acinGaccduaueuctay ion comutewnusaaaa ian ecle nia ees eaeeeees 234 PAVING SCIOCTION 2 55 05 203 55 s8 acct tober AA ra ass oases eens eal iain sas ne taadk ee se 235 BCID sele CUON manata secs teay ge ctacpsaac an cpuveuesacua a aneuesamtesace tweet ease cieate 236 Access credentials srona oiar dled cc rele esl N danas twa lesa eee taw nilelies 236 Volume selectionarea ecedev hes cakatceececersbueuse ca O O spelen nd deviuas tae Musee 237 Walia eine Mounted images niere a a aa wide aaleenea 237 AGtONS SCCULS ZONE sienen i e eA EA O N E ENE O N AAAA ATE 237 creatine ACTONI Secure ZONE a E E A ts 238 Managing Acronis Secure ZOMG uenire o E E A A EOE AN 241 BOORDE MEd a a a a a a 242 How to create bootable media ssoneeesseseessseeesssresssseeeesseeessoseeessereessssreesserersssoreesseeessosreereeesseres 243 Connecting to a machine booted from MEIA cccsssccecsssscceesssececsssseceesssaeeceessseeeesseneeeeessaeeeees 250 Workine under pootable medi deo nana a a O A a 250 List of commands and utilities available in Linux based bootable Media ssccccssssecesssreeeesees 250 Recovering MD devices and logical VOIUMES ccssssccecssssseceesssseecssssssecesssueeeeessaseeeesssneeeeesseeeeesss 252 ACrONIS PAE
208. ct to each machine separately to check whether the data is successfully protected Instead check the cumulative status of the policy p 276 on all managed machines the policy is applied to To find out whether a backup policy is currently being deployed revoked or updated check the deployment state p 276 of the policy Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 215 Way of working with the backup policies view e Use the toolbar s operational buttons to create new policies apply the existing policies to machines or perform other operations with backup policies p 278 e Use the Information pane s tabs to view detailed information about the selected policy and perform additional operations such as revoke the policy view details of the machine group the policy is applied to etc The panel is collapsed by default To expand the panel click the chevron The content of the pane is also duplicated in the Policy details p 279 window e Use the filtering and sorting p 279 capabilities of the policy table for easy browsing and examination Tlgeieds Backup policy deployment states A backup policy deployment state is a combination of the policy deployment states on all machines the policy is applied to For example if the policy is applied to three machines and has the Deploying state on the 1st machine the Updating state on the 2nd machine and the Deployed state on the 3rd machine the state of the policy will be Deployin
209. ct to the storage node to access its managed vaults for example during backup or recovery and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server connects to the storage node to manage it for example when creating a managed vault The Client Connection Limit parameter determines the maximum number of connections of any type and from any components that the storage node can handle simultaneously When this limit is reached and another component tries to establish connection the storage node uses a queue called the backup queue see the next parameter components in the backup queue wait for an available connection to the storage node When an Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent is in the backup queue the correspondent backup or recovery task will remain in the Running state Backup Queue Limit Description Specifies the maximum number of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components in the storage node s backup queue Possible values Any integer number between 1 and 2147483647 Default value 200 The backup queue is a list of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components that are awaiting connection to the storage node when the maximum number of simultaneous connections is reached see the previous parameter When the number of components in the backup queue is equal to the value in Backup Queue Limit and another component tries to establish a connection the storage node does not put the component in the queue In this case th
210. d a deduplicating vault When you create a managed centralized vault you can specify whether to enable deduplication in it A deduplicating vault cannot be created on a tape device Deduplication database Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node managing a deduplicating vault maintains the deduplication database which contains the hash values of all items stored in the vault except for those that cannot be deduplicated such as encrypted files The deduplication database is stored in the folder which is specified by the Database path in the Create centralized vault view when creating the vault Deduplication database can be created in a local folder only The size of the deduplication database is about one percent of the total size of archives in the vault In other words each terabyte of new non duplicate data adds about 10 GB to the database In case the database is corrupted or the storage node is lost while the vault retains archives and the service folder containing metadata the new storage node rescans the vault and re creates the database 2 11 6 2 When deduplication is most effective The following are cases when deduplication produces the maximum effect Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 65 e When backing up in the full backup mode similar data from different sources Such is the case when you back up operating systems and applications deployed from a single source over the network If you back up say 10
211. d folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the System attribute If a folder is System all of its contents including files that are not System will be excluded You can view file or folder attributes in the file folder properties or by using the attrib command For more information refer to the Help and Support Center in Windows e Exclude files matching the following criteria Select this check box to skip files whose names match any of the criteria called file masks in the list use the Add Edit Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks You can use one or more wildcard characters and ina file mask The asterisk substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc txt and Document txt The question mark substitutes for exactly one character in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc1 txt and Docs txt but not the files Doc txt or Doc11 txt Exclusion examples By name File1 log Excludes all files named File1 log By path C Finance test log Excludes the file named test log located in the folder C Finance Mask Excludes all files with the log extension Mask my log Excludes all log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my The above settings are not effective for the files or folders that were explicitly selected for
212. d is often referred to as a tape rotation scheme Tape rotation schemes as such do not provide automation They just determine e how many tapes you need to enable recovery with the desired resolution time interval between recovery points and roll back period e which tapes you should overwrite with the forthcoming backup Tape rotation schemes enable you to get by with the minimal number of cartridges and not to be buried in used tapes A lot of Internet sources describe varieties of the GFS tape rotation scheme You are free to use any of the varieties when backing up to a locally attached tape device GFS by Acronis With Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 you can easily set up a backup plan that will regularly back up data and clean up the resulting archive according to the GFS scheme Create the backup plan as usual For the backup destination choose any storage device where automatic cleanup can be performed such as an HDD based storage device or robotic tape library Since the space freed on the tape after cleanup cannot be reused until all the tape becomes free take into account additional considerations when using GFS on a tape library p 141 The following is an explanation of the settings that are specific for the GFS backup scheme GFS related settings of the backup plan Start backup at Back up on This step creates the total backup schedule that is defines all the days you need to back up on Assume you select ba
213. d machine and then click the shared folder If the network share requires access credentials the program will ask for them Note for Linux users To specify a Common Internet File System CIFS network share which is mounted ona mount point such as mnt share select this mount point instead of the network share itself eT ee aD cD DD ec ee ieee tara o If the archive is stored on an FTP or SFTP server type the server name or address in the Path field as follows ftp ftp_server port number or sftp sftp_server port number If the port number is not specified port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP After entering access credentials the folders on the server become available Click the appropriate folder on the server You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access To do so Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 235 click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials _ As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer nn aeaaaee o Ifthe archive is stored on a locally attached tape device expand the Tape drives group then click the required device 2 In the table to the right of the tree select the archive The table displays the names of the archives contained in
214. d tasks view where you can examine the state and progress of the recovery task 6 3 11 Bootability troubleshooting If a system was bootable at the time of backup you expect that it will boot after recovery However the information the operating system stores and uses for booting up may become outdated during recovery especially if you change volume sizes locations or destination drives Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 automatically updates Windows loaders after recovery Other loaders might also be fixed but there are cases when you have to re activate the loaders Specifically when you recover Linux volumes it is sometimes necessary to apply fixes or make booting changes so that Linux can boot and load correctly Below is a summary of typical situations that require additional user actions Why a recovered operating system may be unbootable e The machine BIOS is configured to boot from another HDD Solution Configure the BIOS to boot from the HDD where the operating system resides e The system was recovered on dissimilar hardware and the new hardware is incompatible with the most critical drivers included in the backup 226 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Solution for Windows Recover the volume once again When configuring recovery opt for using Acronis Universal Restore and specify the appropriate HAL and mass storage drivers e Windows was recovered to a dynamic volume that cannot be bootable Solution Recover Windows
215. de quick access to program s operations and tools All items of the Actions and tools bar are duplicated in the program menu 12 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Bars Item s name actions Contains a set of actions that can be performed on the items selected in any of the navigation views Clicking the action opens the respective action page p 15 Items of different navigation views have their own set of actions The bar s name changes in accordance with the item you select For example if you select the backup plan named System backup in the Backup plans and tasks view the actions bar will be named as System backup actions and will have the set of actions typical to backup plans All actions can also be accessed in the respective menu items A menu item appears on the menu bar when you select an item in any of the navigation views Yault 15 actions Validate Delete amp View details re 2 Explore Save selected to file Archive 1 actions Create Save all to File i taida Create Acronis Secure zone Clear log p4 Delete Refresh Refresh J Refresh Examples of Item name actions bars Actions Contains a list of common operations that can be performed on a managed machine or on a management server Always the same for all views Clicking the operation opens the respective action page see the Action pages p 15 section All the actions can also be accessed in the Actions menu Ac
216. deletes all backups created before that moment None of the backups created Retention rule IS applied after this moment will be deleted f f re f nat delete _ 2 Keep the archive size within This is the maximum size of the archive Every time a retention rule is applied the program compares the actual archive size with the value you set and deletes the oldest backups to keep the archive size within this value The diagram below shows the archive content before and after the deletion Archive Archive Backup 3 a _illaximum size te There is a certain risk that all but one backup will be deleted if the maximum archive size is set improperly too small or a regular backup turns out to be too large To protect the recent backups from deletion select the Never delete backups younger than check box and specify the maximum age of backups that must be retained The diagram below illustrates the resulting rule Never delete backups younger than Delete if the maximum archive size is not delete Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 39 Combination of rules 1 and 2 You can limit both the backups lifetime and the archive size The diagram below illustrates the resulting rule cl ar Oo Retention rules 1 and 2 are applied 8 el elete backups dder than Never de
217. dia or network connection to back up or recover the data This is especially useful for mobile users e can serve as the primary location for dual destination backup Limitation Acronis Secure Zone cannot be organized on a dynamic disk p 345 or a disk using the GPT partitioning style Acronis Secure Zone is considered as a personal vault p 348 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager ASRM A modification of the bootable agent p 341 residing on the system disk and configured to start at boot time when F11 is pressed Acronis Startup Recovery Manager eliminates the need for rescue media or network connection to start the bootable rescue utility Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is especially useful for mobile users If a failure occurs the user reboots the machine hits F11 on prompt Press F11 for Acronis Startup Recovery Manager and performs data recovery in the same way as with ordinary bootable media Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 338 Limitations cannot be organized on a dynamic disk p 345 requires manual configuration of boot loaders such as LILO and GRUB requires re activation of third party loaders Agent Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent An application that performs data backup and recovery and enables other management operations on the machine p 347 such as task management and operations with hard disks The type of data that can be backed up depends on the agent type Acronis Backup amp Re
218. disks can be included into one volume thus overcoming the hardware size limitations but if at least one disk fails all data will be lost and no part of a spanned volume may be removed without destroying the entire volume So a spanned volume provides no additional reliability nor a better I O rate Striped Volume A volume also sometimes called RAID O consisting of equal sized stripes of data written across Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 265 each disk in the volume it means that to create a striped volume a user will need two or more dynamic disks The disks in a striped volume don t have to be identical but there must be unused space available on each disk that you want to include in the volume and the size of the volume will depend on the size of the smallest space Access to the data on a striped volume is usually faster than access to the same data on a single physical disk because the I O is spread across more than one disk Striped volumes are created for improved performance not for their better reliability they do not contain redundant information Mirrored Volume A fault tolerant volume also sometimes called RAID 1 whose data is duplicated on two identical physical disks All of the data on one disk is copied to another disk to provide data redundancy Almost any volume can be mirrored including the system and boot volumes and if one of the disks fails the data can still be accessed from the remaining disk
219. distribution method 5 5 At Windows Event Log event This type of schedule is effective only in Windows operating systems You can schedule a backup task to start when a certain Windows event has been recorded in one of the event logs such as the Application Security or System log For example you may want to set up a backup plan that will automatically perform an emergency full backup of your data as soon as Windows discovers that your hard disk drive is about to fail Parameters Log name Specifies the name of the log Select the name of a standard log Application Security or System from the list or type a log name for example Microsoft Office Sessions Event source Specifies the event source which typically indicates the program or the system component that caused the event for example disk Event type Specifies the event type Error Warning Information Audit success or Audit failure Event ID Specifies the event number which typically identifies the particular kind of events among events from the same source For example an Error event with Event source disk and EventID 7 occurs when Windows discovers a bad block on a disk whereas an Error event with Event source disk and Event ID 15 occurs when a disk is not ready for access yet Examples Bad block emergency backup One or more bad blocks that have suddenly appeared on a hard disk usually indicate that the hard disk drive will soon fail Suppose t
220. dividual machines In the group tree select the required group Then in the right part of the window select the machines to apply the backup policy to 2 Click OK The Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server will deploy the policy to the selected machines and machines belonging to the selected groups Filtering and sorting backup policies The following is a guideline for you to filter and sort backup policies To Do Sort backup policies by any Click the column s header to sort the backup policies in ascending order column Click it once again to sort the backup policies in descending order Filter backup policies by Type a policy s name owner s name in the fields below the corresponding name owner column s header As a result you will see the list of the backup policies whose names or their owners names fully or just partly coincide with the entered value Filter backup policies by In the field below the corresponding column s header select the required deployment state status value from the list source type last result schedule Configuring the backup policies table By default the table has seven columns that are displayed others are hidden You can adjust presentation of the columns to your needs and preferences To show or hide columns 1 Right click any column header to open the context menu The menu items that are ticked off correspond to column headers presented in the table 2 Click
221. dows C Windows Environment variables Some environment variables point to Windows folders Using such variables instead of full folder and file paths ensures that proper Windows folders are backed up regardless of where Windows is located on a particular machine To include In the Files and folders Comments column type or select Program Files folder PROGRAMFILES Points to the Program Files folder for example C Program Files Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 323 Windows folder WINDIR Points to the folder where Windows is located for example C Windows Common data for all ALLUSERSPROFILE Points to the folder where the common data of all user profiles user profiles is located typically C Documents and Settings All Users in Windows XP and C ProgramData in Windows Vista You can use other environment variables or a combination of environment variables and text For example to refer to the Acronis folder in the machines Program Files folder type PROGRAMFILES Acronis Templates Templates are similar to environment variables but are already pre customized To include In the Files and folders Comments column type or select All files on all volumes All Files Points to all files on all volumes of the machine on a machine All user profiles existing AIl Profiles Folder Points to the folder where all user profiles are on a machine located typically C Documents and Settings in Windows XP and C Us
222. drawn the storage node was registered on another management server As a result it is not possible to control the node from the current management server e Archives the total number of archives stored in all the vaults managed by the storage node e Backups the total number of backups stored within the archives in all the vaults managed by the storage node Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 299 Vaults This tab displays a list of the vaults managed by the storage node To open a managed vault for detailed examination and to perform operations on it select the vault then click 2 View vault on the tab s toolbar In the Centralized vault p 123 view perform the required actions Services This tab displays the compacting task scheduling parameters Service tasks This tab lets the management server administrator manage the compacting task and review its parameters Only one compacting task can exist on a storage node 7 1 5 Tasks The Tasks view lets you monitor and manage tasks existing on the registered machines You can view tasks details their states and execution results as well as run stop and delete tasks To find out what a task is currently doing on a machine check the task execution state The status of a task helps you to estimate whether the task is successfully accomplished To learn more about task states and statuses see the Task states p 181 and Task statuses p 182 sections Wa
223. e 4 Remove from the group Machine 3 is removed from the group The orange policy is revoked from the machine The machine remains in the All machines group 58 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Machines All machines Machines Machines All machines All All Move Delete 2 11 4 3 Inheritance of policies Policy inheritance can be easily understood if we assume that a machine can be a member of only one group besides the All machines group Let s start from this simplified approach In the diagram below the container stands for a group the two color circle stands for a machine with two applied policies the three color circle stands for a machine with three applied policies and so on Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 59 Machines Besides the All machines group we have the custom G1 group in the root and the custom G2 group which is G1 s child All machines The green policy applied to the All machines group is inherited by all machines The orange policy applied to G1 is inherited by the G1 members and all its child groups both immediate and indirect The blue policy applied to G2 is inherited only by the G2 members since G2 does not have child groups The violet policy is applied straight to machine 4 It will exist on machine 4 irrespectively of this machine s membership in any group Let s assume we create the G3 group in the root If no policies are app
224. e e The system uses Linux Loader LILO and was recovered from a normal not from a raw that is sector by sector backup LILO contains numerous references to absolute sector numbers and so cannot be repaired automatically except for the case when all data is recovered to the sectors that have the same absolute numbers as on the source disk Solution Reactivate the boot loader You might also need to fix the loader configuration file for the reason described in the previous item e The system loader points to the wrong volume This may happen when system or boot volumes are not recovered to their original location Solution Modification of the boot ini or the boot bcd files fixes this for Windows loaders Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 does this automatically and so you are not likely to experience the problem For the GRUB and LILO loaders you will need to correct the GRUB configuration files If the number of the Linux root partition has changed it is also recommended that you change etc fstab so that the SWAP volume can be accessed correctly e Linux was recovered from an LVM volume backup to a basic MBR disk Such system cannot boot because its kernel tries to mount the root file system at the LVM volume Solution Change the loader configuration and etc fstab so that the LVM is not used and reactivate the boot loader Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 227 6 3 11 1 How to reactivate GRUB or LILO and change its configu
225. e user s permission for the folder or device where the vault is located A personal vault can be organized on detachable or removable media Acronis Secure Zone is considered as a personal vault available to all users that can log on the system Personal vaults can be used by local backup plans or local tasks Centralized backup plans cannot use personal vaults except for Acronis Secure Zone Sharing a personal vault Multiple machines can refer to the same physical location say to the same shared folder but each of the machines has its own shortcut in the Vaults tree Users that back up to a shared folder can see and manage each other s archives according to their access permissions for that folder To ease archive identification the Personal vault view has the Owner column that displays the owner of each archive To find out more about the owner concept see Owners and credentials p 30 154 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Metadata The meta folder is created during backup in every personal vault This folder contains additional information about archives and backups stored in the vault such as archive owners or the machine name If you accidentally delete the meta folder it will be automatically recreated next time you access the vault But some information like owner names and machine names may be lost 4 2 1 Working with the Personal vault view This section briefly describes the main elements of the Personal vault view
226. e S_1 group b select the server c select the Backup plans and tasks tab on the Information pane When you need and have the opportunity to back up any of the servers navigate to the backup plan as described above select the plan and run it 2 11 2 2 Protecting the workstations Here is how to set up the most popular schedule weekly full backup and daily incremental backup of users default document folders In addition we will retain only backups from the last 7 days 1 Create a policy that backs up AIl Profiles Folder to the managed vault on the storage node This will back up the folder where user profiles are located for example C Documents and Settings in Windows XP Choose the Custom backup scheme a Schedule full backup as follows Weekly Every 1 week on Sunday Execute the task once at 12 00 00 AM Advanced settings Wake on LAN On You may also want to distribute the backup start time within the time window to optimize the network usage and the storage node CPU load b Schedule incremental backup as follows Weekly Every 1 week on Workdays Execute the task once at 08 00 00 PM Also set the advanced settings as required c Setup the retention rules as follows Delete backups older than 7 days When deleting a backup that has dependencies Consolidate the backups Leave the default settings for the remaining retention rules In Apply retention rules set After backup Create a dynamic group named say W_1
227. e access to the target disk This means no other disk management utilities like Windows Disk Management utility can access it at that time If you receive a message stating that the disk cannot be blocked close the disk management applications that use this disk and start again If you cannot determine which applications use the disk close them all 6 9 5 1 Disk initialization If you add any new disk to your machine Acronis Disk Director Lite will notice the configuration change and scan the added disk to include it to the disk and volume list If the disk is still not initialized or possibly has a file structure unknown to the machine system that means that no programs can be installed on it and you will not be able to store any files there Acronis Disk Director Lite will detect that the disk is unusable by the system and will prompt you to initialize it The Disk management view will show the new detected hardware as a gray block with a grayed icon thus indicating that the disk is unusable by the system The Disk Initialization prompt window will provide the basic hardware details such as the disk s number model and capacity to aid you in the choice of your possible action Delayed or immediate disk initialization If for any reason you want to keep the disk uninitialized you can decline the initialization prompt so that it will not be triggered in the future and the disk will remain unusable in the system If in the future
228. e agents operating on the machine Recover to Physical machine Available when the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or Agent for Linux is installed The selected volumes will be recovered to the physical disks of the machine the console is connected to On selecting this you proceed to the regular volume mapping procedure described below New virtual machine p 220 If Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows is installed The selected volumes will be recovered to a new virtual machine of any of the following types VMware Workstation Microsoft Virtual PC Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance The virtual machine files will be saved to the destination you specify If Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi is installed These agents enable creating a new virtual machine on the virtualization server you specify The new virtual machine will be configured automatically the source machine configuration being copied where possible The configuration is displayed in the Virtual Machine Settings p 221 section Check the settings and make changes if necessary Then you proceed to the regular volume mapping procedure described below Existing virtual machine Available when the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi is installed On selecting this you specify the virtualization server and the target virtual machine T
229. e attached to the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node There are no settings for limiting a vault size or number of backups in a vault You can limit the size of each archive using cleanup but the total size of archives stored in the vault is limited by the storage size only Why create vaults We recommend that you create a vault in each destination where you are going to store backup archives This will ease your work as follows Quick access to the vault You will not have to remember paths to the folders where the archives are stored When creating a backup plan or a task that requires selection of an archive or an archive destination place the list of vaults will be available for quick access without drilling down through the folders tree Easy archive management A vault is available for access from the Navigation pane Having selected the vault you can browse the archives stored there and perform the following archive management operations e geta list of backups included in each archive e recover data from a backup e examine backup content e validate all archives in the vault or individual archives or backups e mount a volume backup to copy files from the backup to a physical disk e safely delete archives and backups from the archives Creating vaults is highly recommended but is not obligatory You may choose not to use the shortcuts and always specify the full path to the archive vault All of the above operatio
230. e backup schemes Grandfather Father Son p 32 Tower of Hanoi p 36 considerably assist you with creating effective schedule and retention rules for backups on a tape library In combination with the tape options the backup schemes enable you to reuse in automatic mode the tapes that are considered as free after backup deletion See the Tape rotation p 139 section for more information 4 1 3 2 Hardware A tape library robotic library is a high capacity storage device that contains the following e one or more tape drives e multiple up to several thousand slots to hold tape cartridges e one or more loaders robotic mechanisms intended for relocating the tape cartridges between the slots and the tape drives e barcode readers optional Each tape may have a special label attached to the side of a cartridge and comprise of e abarcode to scan by a special reader that is usually mounted on a loader e areadable barcode digital value Such labels are used for tape identification in a tape library or especially in off site storage If all cartridges in a tape library have barcodes the library is ready to be automatically managed by software Tape libraries are a cost effective solution for data storages with huge capacity Moreover tape is perfect for archiving because cartridges can be stored off site for enhanced data security However reading even a small amount of data from a tape library takes much more time from s
231. e backup traffic and storage space taken by the archives by using deduplication p 64 prevent access to the backup archives even in case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by a malefactor by using encrypted vaults p 346 To learn more about Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node see the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node p 19 section The key elements of the Storage nodes view e Storage nodes list with toolbar The toolbar lets you perform operations p 297 with the selected storage node The list of storage nodes displays online and offline storage nodes added to the management server It also informs you about the total number of backups and archives on the storage node e Information panel Contains the detailed information about the selected storage node and lets you manage the compacting task The panel is collapsed by default To expand the panel click the al chevron The content of the pane is also duplicated in the Storage node details p 299 window Way of working with storage nodes typical workflow 1 Install the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node 2 Create a user account for each user whom you want to allow to access the storage node i Note You can skip this step if both the storage node and the users machines are in the same Active Directory domain For information about user rights on a storage node and in its managed vaults see User rights on a storage node
232. e based alerts Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows to back up the machine where the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server resides Click Install now to launch the installation wizard The alert is displayed only if Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows is installed on the management server The alert warns that no data was backed up on the management server for a period of time Back up now will take you to the Create backup plan page where you can instantly configure and run the backup operation To configure the length of time that is considered critical select Options gt Console options gt Time based alerts Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Activities The stacked column chart lets you explore the daily history of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agents activities The history is based on the log entries collected from the registered machines and from the management server The chart shows the number of log entries of each type error warning information for a particular day Statistics for the selected date are displayed to the right of the chart All the statistics fields are interactive i e if you click any field the Log view will be opened with the log entries pre filtered by this field At the top of the chart you can select the activities to display depending on the presence and severity of the errors The Select current date link focuses selecti
233. e component s connection to the storage node will fail If the component is an Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent the correspondent backup or recovery task will stop with the Failed status Compacting Trigger Threshold Description Specifies the percentage of the total size of non obsolete items to start the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 307 compacting procedure Possible values Any integer number between 0 and 100 Default value 80 In a deduplicating vault the contents of all deduplicated disk blocks are stored in the deduplication data store one after another in a single large file The contents of all deduplicated files are similarly stored in another large file Over time these files may contain obsolete items disk blocks or files that are no longer referred to from any archive The remaining non obsolete items are referred to from at least one archive If the percentage of the total size of non obsolete items in any of the two files is equal to the value in Compacting Trigger Threshold or less the compacting procedure starts and deletes the obsolete items from the correspondent file The compacting procedure also starts according to the schedule of the compacting task regardless of the percentage of obsolete items Vault Free Space Warning Limit Description Specifies the amount of free space in a managed vault in megabytes below which a warning is recorded in the storage node s log Possible values A
234. e connection will be established only if the use of SSL certificates is enabled on the server application Disabled The same as Not configured Server Encryption options Specifies whether to encrypt the transferred data when the component acts as a server application Select one of the following Not configured 76 The component will use the default setting which is to use encryption if possible see the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 following option Enabled Encryption is enabled In Encryption select one of the following Enabled Data transfer will be encrypted if encryption is enabled on the client application otherwise it will be unencrypted Disabled Encryption is disabled any connection to a client application which requires encryption will not be established Required Data transfer will be performed only if encryption is enabled on the client application see Client Encryption options it will be encrypted Authentication parameters In Use Agent Certificate Authentication select one of the following Do not use The use of SSL certificates is disabled Any connection to a client application which requires the use of SSL certificates will not be established Use if possible The use of SSL certificates is enabled The server will use SSL certificates if their use is enabled on the client application and will not use them otherwise Always use The use of SSL certificates is enabled
235. e data recovery from a full backup requires only one tape that makes the data recovery from an incremental or differential backup faster GFS Example 3 Imagine the backup plan has the following tape options e the Use a separate tape set option is selected e the Always use a free tape For each full backup option is selected e the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is selected e the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is selected 146 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 These options define the tape rotation scheme that is classical for GFS The figure shows the beginning of the rotation scheme that uses 8 tapes for daily backups 6 tapes for weekly backups and 13 tapes for monthly backups since there are 13 four week cycles in a year for the analyzed case And one tape is required for the next backup In total this rotation scheme combined with the options requires 28 tapes W ti H i w 03 To recover the data only one tape is required for a full backup two tapes for a differential backup and two or three tapes for an incremental backup This scheme has the following advantages e access to any full backup requires only one tape e backup deletion frees a tape so it can be reused The main drawback is the large number of required tapes that is used 5 10 If we have to keep a daily backup for a week 4 backups and a weekly backup for a month 4 backups the total num
236. e following statuses Error Warning OK While the policy is in the Deployed state its status reflects how successfully the policy is executed While the policy is in any other state its status reflects how successfully the policy is being modified Policy status when data to back up is not found on a machine A backup policy can be applied to a machine that does not have data meeting the selection rules p 349 No error or warning will be logged during the policy deployment because it is assumed that the data may appear in the future A backup plan is created as usual and the policy state is changed to Deployed If no data to back up is found at the time when the backup task starts the task will fail and the policy status will turn to Error If at least one of the data items is found the backup task will succeed with a warning The policy status will change accordingly 62 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The backup tasks will start on schedule as specified by the policy and produce a similar result until all data items appear on the machine or the policy is edited to exclude the non existent data items Examples Assume the selection rule states that the policy has to back up volumes D and F The policy is applied to both Linux and Windows machines Once the first backup is started the policy gets the Error status on the Linux machines and on the Windows machines that do not have such volumes The policy gets the Warning statu
237. e kept in the management server as pending and will be performed as soon as the machine becomes available to the server Machine details Accumulates in four tabs all information on the selected machine Lets the management server administrator perform operations with the backup plans and tasks existing on the machine and policies applied to the machine This information is also duplicated on the Information panel 286 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Machine The tab displays the following information on the registered machine e Name name of the selected machine taken from the Computer name in Windows e IP address IP address of the selected machine e Status the machine s status Determined as the most severe status of all backup plans p 180 both local and centralized existing on the machine and backup policies p 276 applied to the machine e Last connect how much time has passed since the management server last connected to the machine e Last successful backup how much time has passed since the last successful backup e Availability o Online the machine is available for the management server This means that the management server s last connection to the machine was successful Connection is established every 2 minutes o Offline the machine is unavailable for the management server it is turned off or its network cable is unplugged o Unknown this status is displayed until the first connecti
238. e policy from the machine Examine where the applied policy has come from Filtering and sorting The Log p 302 view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected backup policy Click F Revoke The management server will revoke the policy from the machine The policy itself remains on the management server In case the machine is a member of a group and the policy is applied to the group you cannot revoke the policy from a single machine without firstly removing the machine from the group Click P Explore inheritance The Inheritance order p 291 window will display the inheritance order of the policy appliied to the machine Filtering and sorting of the backup policies is performed in the same way as for the Backup policies view See the Filtering and sorting backup policies p 279 section for details Plans and tasks Displays a list of the plans both local and centralized and tasks existing on the selected machine Operations The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with backup plans and tasks To View details of a plan task View plan s task s log 288 Do Backup plan Click View details In the Plan Details p 189 window review the plan details Task Click View details In the Task Details p 187 window review the task details Backup plan Click View log You will be taken to the Log p 190 view containing the list of the plan related l
239. e protection p 91 i password encryption Source files exclusion p 92 1 Pre Post backup commands PE only PE only p 93 Pre Post data capture m R commands p 94 Multi volume snapshot p M 97 File level backup snapshot P p 97 Use VSS p 97 4 Compression level p 98 1 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 89 Backup performance Backup priority p 99 HDD writing speed p 99 Network connection speed p 100 Fast incremental differential backup p 103 Backup splitting p 103 File level security p 104 Preserve files security settings in archives In archives store encrypted files in decrypted state Media components p 105 Error handling p 106 Do not show messages and dialogs while processing silent mode Re attempt if an error occurs Ignore bad sectors Dual destination p 106 Task start conditions p 107 Task failure handling p 108 Additional settings p 110 Overwrite data on a tape without prompting user for confirmation Dismount media after backup is finished Ask for first media while creating backup archives on removable media Validate backup after creation 90 Dest HDD Dest network share Dest removable media Dest local Dest Tape Dest removable media Dest removable media Dest HDD Dest network share Dest removable media Dest local Dest Tape
240. e selected task ae ee Actions on log entries All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding items on the log toolbar All these operations can also be performed with the context menu by right clicking the log entry or with the Log actions bar on the Actions and tools pane The following is a guideline for you to perform actions on log entries 0 Select a single log entry Click on it Select multiple log entries View a log entry s details Save the selected log entries to a file Save all the log entries to a file Save all the filtered log entries to a file Delete all the log entries Set up the logging level 304 non contiguous hold down CTRL and click the log entries one by one contiguous select a single log entry then hold down SHIFT and click another entry All the entries between the first and last selections will be selected too Select a log entry Do one of the following Click View Details The log entry s details will be displayed in a separate window Expand the Information panel by clicking the chevron Select a single log entry or multiple log entries Click H Save Selected to File In the opened window specify a path and a name for the file Make sure that the filters are not set Click H Save All to File In the opened window specify a path and a name for the file Set filters to get a list of the log entries that satisfy the filt
241. e set for each single machine option However the second one can be useful for example when there are special requirements to store the tapes with backups from a specific machine off site When the Use a separate tape set option is enabled there might be a case when the backup has to be written onto a tape that is currently out of the tape library device Define what to do in this case e Ask for user interaction the backup task will enter the Need Interaction state and wait for the tape with the required label to be loaded into the tape library device e Use a free tape the backup will be written onto a free tape so the operation will be paused only if there is no free tape in the library Always use a free tape If you leave the options below unchanged then each backup will be written onto the tape specified by the Use a separate tape set option With some of the options below enabled the program will add new tapes to the tape set every time when a full incremental or differential backup is created e For each full backup The preset is Disabled When this option is enabled each full backup will be written onto a free tape The tape will be loaded to a drive especially for this operation If the Use a separate tape set option is enabled only incremental and differential backups of the same data will be appended to the tape e For each differential backup The preset is Disabled When this option is enabled each differ
242. e source or the target hard disk drive from the machine a a Start up the machine Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 261 If you need to leave an NT signature Click to clear the Copy NT signature check box if necessary Click to clear the Turn off the machine after the cloning operation check box if necessary Click Finish to add the pending operation Click Commit on the toolbar and then click Proceed in the Pending Operations window Ce S YY Wait until the task is finished 6 9 5 3 Disk conversion MBR to GPT You would want to convert an MBR basic disk to a GPT basic disk in the following cases e f you need more than 4 primary volumes on one disk e If you need additional disk reliability against any possible data damage If you need to convert a basic MBR disk to basic GPT 1 Select a basic MBR disk to convert to GPT 2 Right click on the selected volume and then click Convert to GPT in the context menu You will receive a warning window stating that you are about to convert MBR into GPT 3 By clicking OK you ll add a pending operation of MBR to GPT disk conversion To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them Please note A GPT partitioned disk reserves the space in the end of the partitioned area necessary for the backup area which stores copies of the GPT header and the par
243. e stored on such a volume In Windows volume labels are shown in the Explorer disk and folder tree WIN98 C WINXP D DATA E etc WIN98 WINXP and DATA are volume labels A volume label is shown in all application dialog boxes for opening and saving files If you need to change a volume label 1 Right click on the selected volume and then click Change label 2 Enter anew label in the Change label window text field 3 By clicking OK in the Change label window you ll add the pending operation of changing the volume label _ If when setting a new volume label you use characters that are unsupported by the currently installed operating system you will get the appropriate warning and the OK button will be disabled You will have to use only supported characters to proceed with changing the volume label To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them 270 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The new label will be graphically represented in the Disk Management view of the console immediately 6 9 6 6 Format volume You might want to format a volume if you want to change its file system e to save additional space which is being lost due to the cluster size on the FAT16 or FAT32 file systems e asa quick and more or less reliable way of destroying data residing in this volume If you want to format a
244. e to schedule validation to the managed machine s off peak period On the other hand if you prefer to be immediately informed whether the data is not corrupted and can be successfully recovered consider starting validation right after the task creation Choose one of the following e Now to start the validation task right after its creation that is after clicking OK on the Validation page e Later to start the one time validation task at the date and time you specify Specify the appropriate parameters as follows o Date and time the date and time when to start the task o The task will be started manually do not schedule the task select this check box if you wish to start the task manually later e On schedule to schedule the task To learn more about how to configure the scheduling parameters please see the Scheduling p 161 section 6 5 Mounting an image Mounting volumes from a disk backup image lets you access the volumes as though they were physical disks Multiple volumes contained in the same backup can be mounted within a single mount operation The mount operation is available when the console is connected to a managed machine running either Windows or Linux Mounting volumes in the read write mode enables you to modify the backup content that is save move create delete files or folders and run executables consisting of one file 234 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Limitation Mounting of volume
245. each full backup option Below the figure shows the deleted backups as actual but demonstrates tape usage during the whole year for the GFS backup scheme in combination with the specified tape options A number in the green rectangle marks an incremental backup created on Monday of the corresponding week of the year If all the backups have to be kept during the year the archive will require 28 tapes W 1i g 12 H OF ETRE H 05 W ii W OT W i g 13 W 10 W 11 g 12 g 13 W 14 g 15 W 16 W ir W 13 W 15 g 20 W 21 H 22 H 23 Eel 24 yy 25 iy 26 Ey 27 W 24 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 145 As the GFS backup scheme forces automatic deletion of the outdated backups on the first Friday of the second year the tapes keep only the backups displayed in the next figure iy 01 iy 02 iy 03 gy 04 iy 05 iy 06 Be DES E or aaa BVE EC I CU W 0e rn w 0 aaa pu OF ee iy 10 pe LEE eee g 11 E LEE eee j E 12 pu ee E 13 aie a i _ E 1 eee g 15 ee W 16 BARIH KK ia E EX amp _ E X TT W ti This figure demonstrates that the GFS Example 2 tape rotation scheme is more suitable for the case than GFS Example 1 The advantages of the GFS Example 2 tape rotation scheme for the analyzed case are the following e it uses 16 tapes instead of 25 e adata recovery task requires one 25 or two 75 tapes
246. econd Connection Attempt is set to True and a connection to the machine by using its network name has failed the management server performs a second connection attempt this time using the latest IP address which was associated with that network name We recommend setting Second Connection Atempt to True only in networks which often experience problems with their DNS servers and provided that the machines IP addresses change infrequently as in cases of fixed IP addresses or long DHCP lease times This setting has no effect on machines that were added to the management server by IP address Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows The following are the parameters of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent that can be set via Group Policy by using Acronis Administrative Template License Check Interval Description Specifies how often in days to check for license availability on Acronis License Server Possible values any integer number between 0 and 5 Default value 1 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent periodically checks whether its license key is present on the license server The first check is performed every time that Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent starts and subsequent checks are performed once in the number of days given by License Check Interval When the agent cannot connect to the license server a warning is recorded into the agent s log You can view this warning in the Dashboard If the value
247. ect a location Enter the full path to the location in the Path field or select the desired location in the folders tree e To select a centralized vault expand the Centralized group and click the appropriate vault e To select a personal vault expand the Personal group and click the appropriate vault e To select a local folder expand the Local folders group and click the required folder e To select a network share expand the Network folders group select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder If the network share requires access credentials the program will ask for them e To select FTP or SFTP server expand the corresponding group and click the appropriate folder on the server As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred _ through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer eae eee meee ee ee area ee ee eae eee aaa alee e alee a aaa eee aaa ale eee lala eee alas eee esas eae aaa eee ee alle e a aaa eae leases eels aes a ama seseresmmmmmrnrarerel Using the archives table To assist you with choosing the right location the table displays the names of the archives contained in each location you select While you are reviewing the location content archives can be added deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled opera
248. ect the desired backup in this archive Vault p 233 select a vault or other location which archives to validate Access Credentials p 233 Optional Provide credentials for accessing the source if the task account does not have enough privileges to access it To access this option select the check box for Advanced view When to validate Validate p 234 Specify when and how often to perform validation After you configure all the required settings click OK to create the validation task 6 4 1 Task credentials Provide credentials for the account under which the task will run To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Run under the current user The task will run under the credentials with which the user who starts the tasks is logged on If the task has to run on schedule you will be asked for the current user s password on completing the task creation o Use the following credentials Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 231 The task will always run under the credentials you specify whether started manually or executed on schedule Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK To learn more about using credentials in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 see the Owners and credentials p 30 section To learn more about o
249. ed for synchronization Each worker performs synchronization for exactly one machine at a time A connected machine to be synchronized waits for an available worker For this reason the actual number of workers will never exceed the maximum number of connections see Maximum Connections described previously Period Description Specifies how often in seconds to perform synchronization for machines that have a normal synchronization priority typically the machines without currently running centralized backup tasks Possible values Any integer number between 120 and 2147483647 Default value 120 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server tries to perform synchronization for each normal priority machine once in the number of seconds given by Period by using an available worker thread see Maximum Workers described previously lf there are fewer worker threads than normal priority machines the actual interval between synchronizations may be longer than the value of this parameter Period High Priority Description Specifies how often in seconds to perform synchronization for machines that have a high synchronization priority typically the machines with currently running centralized backup tasks Possible values Any integer number between 15 and 2147483647 Default value 15 This parameter is analogous to the Period parameter described previously Real Time Monitoring Description Specifies whether to perf
250. ed items that have not changed are not included in the incremental backup e The deduplicated items that have changed are not identical anymore and therefore will not be deduplicated 2 11 6 3 Deduplication ratio The deduplication ratio shows the size of archives in a deduplicating vault in relation to the size they would occupy in a non deduplicating vault The higher the deduplication ratio the more advantageous the deduplication For example suppose that you are backing up two files with identical content from two machines If the size of each file is one gigabyte then the size of the backups in a non deduplicating vault will be approximately 2 GB but this size will be just about 1GB in a deduplicating vault This gives a deduplication ratio of 2 1 Conversely if the two files had different content the backup sizes in non deduplicating and duplicating vaults would be the same 2 GB and the deduplication ratio would be 1 1 What ratio to expect Although in some situations the deduplication ratio may be very high in the previous example increasing the number of machines would lead to ratios of 3 1 4 1 etc a reasonable expectation for a typical environment is a ratio between 1 2 1 and 1 6 1 As a more realistic example suppose that you are performing a file level or disk level backup of two machines with similar disks On each machine the files common to all the machines occupy 50 of 66 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000
251. ed machine cccssscccseccesecceesccceesececeneceeeneeeeueceseuecesseeeeees 30 OWENS and credential Sasian ne a a a N 30 GES DICKIES CACO Toena N 32 Tower of Hanoi backup scheme eenia raa 36 RETO MUON UNS nr R a 38 Backing up dynamic volumes Windows sssssssssessssensssreressressseeresrreressreresererssreressrrrsseeee 41 Tape SUPPO ain a a N uns NN 43 Tapecompa upiya bl E naaa e a T lanee euateantedetassnedeee aus 44 Usinge osne le tape dr NE sai T A N 45 Proprietary Acronis teChNOlOgieS ecnzesiel eaa a a a N 46 AGONIIS SECU ZONG onanan a a A 46 Acronis Startup Recovery Managen cascceccsstscseccus nies reran Tera ce ceuga ca Wag AA AA a E AE ANE CANER SAREE 47 Universal Restore Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal R StOre ccc ccccssssssseessseceesssreeeeenes 47 ACTONSACIVERGSTOTE nissa a lens valves cawetidevanseae Revue Sulnuuss veel a a 49 Understanding centralized management cccccesecccsssecceeeccceececeeceeeneeeeeneesaeecessueeenens 51 BASIC COM CODES coca cccevivoctsnces cupeassauce E E 51 Setting up centralized data protection in a heterogeneous networK cccssccceceesssseeceeeeesseeeeeseseees 52 Grouping the registered IMAC MINES excc sectors ostcnled cacuasestaccnsiaeeetivessd haan ona ease hese a 56 Polices ON machines and CLOUDS ios 2eekicaGiucteuisvyonsdeis paces sadewch a N 56 BackUp policys state ANG StaCUSes isis os acct als asad cass Sa ot Saas aslad Sees shew heeites ta ha
252. ed space the program will take free space from the selected volumes proportionally reducing the volumes size Resizing of locked partitions requires a reboot _ Reducing a system volume to the minimum size might prevent the machine s operating system from booting 2 4 Click OK 6 7 2 2 Decreasing Acronis Secure Zone To decrease Acronis Secure Zone 1 On the Manage Acronis Secure Zone page click Decrease 2 Select volumes that will receive free space after the zone is decreased 3 Specify the new size of the zone by Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 241 o dragging the slider and selecting any size between the current and minimum values The minimum size is approximately 50MB depending on the geometry of the hard disk o typing an exact value in the Acronis Secure Zone Size field 4 Click OK 6 7 2 3 Deleting Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone deletion will automatically disable Acronis Startup Recovery Manager if it is activated and destroy all backups stored in the zone To delete the zone without uninstalling the program proceed as follows 1 Inthe Acronis Secure Zone Actions bar on the Actions and tools pane select Delete 2 In the Delete Acronis Secure Zone window select volumes to which you want to add the space freed from the zone and then click OK If you select several volumes the space will be distributed proportionally to each partition If you do not select any volume the freed
253. ed until all incremental backups that depend on it become subject to deletion too For more information see Retention rules p 38 Monthly full weekly differential and daily incremental backups plus cleanup This example demonstrates the use of all options available in the Custom scheme Suppose that we need a scheme that will produce monthly full backups weekly differential backups and daily incremental backups Then the backup schedule can look as follows Full backup Schedule Monthly every Last Sunday of the month at 9 00 PM Incremental Schedule Weekly every workday at 7 00 PM Differential Schedule Weekly every Saturday at 8 00 PM Further we want to add conditions that have to be satisfied for a backup task to start This is set up in the Conditions fields for each backup type Full backup Conditions Location available Incremental Conditions User is logged off Differential Conditions User is idle As a result a full backup originally scheduled at 9 00 PM may actually start later as soon as the backup location becomes available Likewise backup tasks for incremental and differential backups will wait until all users are logged off and users are idle respectively Finally we create retention rules for the archive let us retain only backups that are no older than six months and let the cleanup be performed after each backup task and also on the last day of every month Retention rules Delete backups older
254. ee Mls Sctsoas etedaaes 61 BYeYe iN e ech a ON o Pern it aric RR RnR eRe A es AP ren 64 Privileges for centralized MANAGEMENL ccsssccccssssccsessssececssseeeceesseeecesssssecessaeeecessaaeeeesssnseeeseeeesas 69 Communication between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 COMPONENTS ssscccesssseeeesssteeceesseeeees 73 ODTIONS aihir A sesiedbevastesasvescawabvacasteetesdtarsacndaxs 82 CONS OE OPUONS yeri A T E A S 82 aU DBE a r A ee ere 82 POD UID MESSA LES iuern r E OES A A E yes aienoeatneneuees 82 Time Dase aler Eana a OT A E EATE EAA 83 3 1 4 9 1 5 3 2 3 2 1 3 2 2 3 3 3 3 1 3 3 2 3 4 3 4 1 3 4 2 4 1 4 1 1 4 1 2 4 1 3 4 2 4 2 1 4 2 2 4 3 4 3 1 4 3 2 4 3 3 4 3 4 5 1 J2 5 3 5 4 59 5 6 5 6 1 5 6 2 5 6 3 5 6 4 5 6 5 6 1 6 1 1 6 1 2 6 1 3 6 2 6 2 1 6 2 2 6 2 3 6 2 4 6 2 5 6 2 6 FORTS aeiia ET EN 84 Management servel ODEIONS nterna e ON AT ed ask 84 SUITS WV eteacets an a a a alae ea wen caw ee cae caileuat temcneaeces 84 EVI VE ICINE oo ass deuce und chs asic cea coi ceca usa erates A RA E S 84 NIACIN CG OD LIONS burasi a a a a boseeeucee ona aaensalen 86 Machine manac ementa nni osiaeceusonvecte reac ecg ndao cue cass saa AN a a N 86 EV EME U la Cli E n ET A saasnennanuaemauc tea abiaaenmednanetentes 86 Default backup and recovery OPTIONS csseeccccssseccceesececeeecceceeeeceeeeesecessenecess
255. efer to the Help and Support Center in Windows e Exclude files matching the following criteria Select this check box to skip files whose names match any of the criteria called file masks in the list use the Add Edit Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks You can use one or more wildcard characters and ina file mask The asterisk substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc txt and Document txt The question mark substitutes for exactly one character in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc1 txt and Docs txt but not the files Doc txt or Doc11 txt Exclusion examples By name File1 log Excludes all files named File1 log By path C Finance test log Excludes the file named test log located in the folder C Finance Mask Excludes all files with the log extension Mask my log Excludes all log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my 6 2 7 Archive Specify where the archive will be stored and the name of the archive 1 Selecting the destination Enter the full path to the destination in the Path field or select the desired destination in the folders tree e To back up data to a centralized vault expand the Centralized group and click the vault e To back up data to a personal vault expand the Personal group and click the vau
256. elete the plans and tasks You can also use the Tasks view that displays all tasks existing on the registered machines The tasks can be filtered by machines backup plans and other parameters Refer to the context help for details e Viewing log To view the centralized log collected from the registered machines select Log in the Navigation tree The log entries can be filtered by machines backup plans and other parameters Refer to the context help for details e Creating centralized vaults If you opt for storing all backup archives in a single or a few networked locations create centralized vaults in these locations After a vault is created you can view and administer its content by selecting Vaults gt Centralized gt Vault name in the Navigation tree The shortcut to the vault will be deployed to all the registered machines The vault can be specified as a backup destination in any backup plan created by you or by the registered machines users The advanced way of centralized management To make the best use of the centralized management capabilities offered by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 you can opt for e Using deduplication 1 Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node p 19 and add it to the management server 2 Create the deduplicating managed vault on the storage node 3 Install the Acronis Deduplication add on to the agent on all machines that will back up to the deduplicating vault 4 Ensu
257. ely from the managed machine due to some latency Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 301 Tou Filtering and sorting tasks The following is a guideline for you to filter and sort tasks Set a number of tasks to Select Options gt Console options gt Number of tasks p 83 and set the desired display value The maximum number of tasks that can be displayed is 500 If the number of tasks exceeds the specified value use filters to display the tasks that are beyond the scope Sort tasks by column Click the column s header to sort the tasks in ascending order Click it once again to sort the tasks in descending order Filter tasks by name owner Type the task s name owner name or the backup plan name in the field below or backup plan the corresponding column header As a result you will see the list of tasks whose names owner names or backup plan names fully or just partly coincide with the entered value Filter tasks by type In a field below the corresponding header select the required value from the list execution state status type origin last result schedule Configuring tasks table By default the table has eight columns that are displayed others are hidden If required you can hide the shown columns and show the hidden ones To show or hide columns 1 Right click any column header to open the context menu The menu items that are ti
258. ental backups plus cleanup example in the Custom backup scheme p 208 section Season schedule Run the task on all workdays during the northern autumn seasons of 2009 and 2010 During a workday the task is performed every 6 hours from 12 AM midnight till 6 PM The schedule s parameters are set up as follows 1 Months September October November 2 On lt all gt lt workdays gt 3 Every 6 hours From 12 00 00 AM Until 06 00 00 PM 4 Effective From 08 30 2009 Actually the task will be started on the first workday of September By setting up this date we just define that the task must be started in 2009 To 12 01 2010 Actually the task will end on the last workday of November By setting up this date we just define that the task must be discontinued in 2010 after autumn ends in the northern hemisphere Several monthly schedules for one task In the case when the task needs to be run on different days or weeks with different time intervals depending on the month consider adding a dedicated schedule to every desired month or several months Suppose that the task goes into effect on 11 01 2009 e During northern winter the task runs once at 10PM on every workday e During northern spring and autumn the task runs every 12 hours on all workdays e During northern summer the task runs every first and fifteenth of every month at 10 PM Thus the following three schedules are added to the task First schedu
259. ential backup will be written onto a free tape This option is available only when using free tape for each full backup is selected e For each incremental backup The preset is Disabled When this option is enabled each incremental backup will be written onto a free tape This option is available only when using free tape for each full and differential backup is selected 3 4 1 21 Additional settings Specify the additional settings for the backup operation by selecting or clearing the following check boxes Overwrite data on a tape without prompting for user confirmation This option is effective only when backing up to a tape device The preset is Disabled 110 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 When starting backup to a non empty tape in a locally attached tape device the program will warn that you are about to lose data on the tape To disable this warning select this check box Dismount media after backup has finished This option is effective in Windows and Linux operating systems This option is effective when backing up to a removable media CD DVD tape or floppy disk The preset is Disabled The destination CD DVD can be ejected or the tape can be dismounted after the backup is completed Ask for the first media while backing up to removable media This option is effective only when backing up to removable media The option defines whether to display the Insert First Media prompt when backing up to removab
260. epetition and storing the identical data only once 64 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 For example if a managed vault where deduplication is enabled contains two copies of the same file whether in the same archive or in different archives the file is stored only once and a link to that file is stored instead of the second file Deduplication may also reduce network load if during a backup a file or a disk block is found to be a duplicate of an already stored one its content is not transferred over the network Deduplication is performed on disk blocks block level deduplication and on files file level deduplication for disk level and file level backups respectively In Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 deduplication consists of two steps Deduplication at source Performed on a managed machine during backup Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent uses the storage node to determine what data can be deduplicated and does not transfer the data whose duplicates are already present in the vault Deduplication at target Performed in the vault after a backup is completed The storage node analyses the vault s archives and deduplicates data in the vault When creating a backup plan you have the option to turn off deduplication at source for that plan This may lead to faster backups but a greater load on the network and storage node Deduplicating vault A managed centralized vault where deduplication is enabled is calle
261. eplaced with scheduled sessions Number of levels Select from 2 to 16 backup levels See the example stated below for details Roll back period The guaranteed number of sessions that one can go back in the archive at any time Calculated automatically depending on the schedule parameters and the numbers of levels you select See the example below for details Example Schedule parameters are set as follows e Recur Every 1 day e Frequency Once at 6 PM Number of levels 4 This is how the first 14 days or 14 sessions of this scheme s schedule look Shaded numbers denote backup levels BBB ooos A a a es Backups of different levels have different types e Last level in this case level 4 backups are full e Backups of intermediate levels 2 3 are differential e First level 1 backups are incremental A cleanup mechanism ensures that only the most recent backups of each level are kept Here is how the archive looks on day 8 a day before creating a new full backup The scheme allows for efficient data storage more backups accumulate toward the current time Having four backups we could recover data as of today yesterday half a week or a week ago 206 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Roll back period The number of days we can go back in the archive is different on different days The minimum number of days we are guaranteed to have is called the roll back period The following table shows fu
262. er and the chipset These drivers are critical to start the operating system Use the CD or DVD supplied by the hardware vendor or download the drivers from the vendor s Web site The driver files should have the inf sys or oem extensions If you download the drivers in the exe cab or zip format extract them using a third party application such as WinRAR http www rarlab com or Universal Extractor http legroom net software uniextract The best practice is to store drivers for all the hardware used in your organization in a single repository sorted by device type or by the hardware configurations You can keep a copy of the repository on a DVD or a flash drive pick some drivers and add them to the bootable media create the custom bootable media with the necessary drivers and the necessary network configuration for each of your servers Or you can simply specify the path to the repository every time Universal Restore is used Universal Restore settings Automatic driver search Specify where the program will search for the Hardware Abstraction Layer HAL HDD controller driver and network adapter driver s If the drivers are on a vendor s disc or other removable media turn on the Search removable media If the drivers are located in a networked folder or on the bootable media specify the path to the folder in the Search folder field During recovery Universal Restore will perform the recursive search in all t
263. er you have performed all the required steps click OK to create the backup policy 7 2 1 Policy credentials Provide the credentials under which the centralized tasks will run on the machines Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 319 To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use Acronis service credentials The tasks will run under the Acronis service account whether started manually or executed on schedule o Use the following credentials The tasks will run under the credentials you specify whether started manually or executed on schedule Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK To learn more about Acronis service credentials see the Rights for Acronis services p 72 section To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges see the User privileges on a managed machine p 30 section 7 2 2 Items to back up Specify selection rules for backing up items selected in the Source type field of the General section Volumes to back up selection rules p 320 Files to back up selection rules p 323 Vela nds Volumes to back up selection rules Define volume selection rules according to which the volumes will be backed up on the machines the policy will be applied to To define volume selection rules
264. ering criteria Click H Save All to File In the opened window specify a path and a name for the file As a result the log entries of that list will be saved Click 2 Clear Log All the log entries will be deleted from the log and a new log entry will be created It will contain information about who deleted the entries and when Click Configure logging level In the Logging level p 84 window specify whether to collect log events from the registered machines to the centralized log Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 7 1 6 2 Filtering and sorting log entries The following is a guideline for you to filter and sort log entries Display log entries for a given time period Filter log entries by type Filter log entries by the original backup plan or managed entity type Filter log entries by task managed entity machine code owner Sort log entries by date and time 1 Inthe From field select the date starting from which to display the log entries 2 Inthe To field select the date up to which to display the log entries Press or release the following toolbar buttons x to filter error messages A to filter warning messages wD to filter information messages Under the Backup plan or Managed entity type column header select the backup plan or the type of managed entity from the list Type the required value task name machine name owner name etc in the field below the respective
265. ers in Windows Vista Linux To include In the Files and folders column type or select Text file file txt on the dev hda3 file txt volume dev hda3 or mounted on home usr docs home usr docs file txt Home directory of the home common users The root user s home root directory Directory for all user usr related programs Directory for system etc configuration files 7 2 3 Access credentials for source Specify credentials required for access to the data you are going to back up To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the policy credentials 324 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The program will access the source data using the credentials of the backup policy account specified in the General section o Use the following credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials you specify Use this option if the policy credentials do not have access permissions to the data Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK 7 2 4 Exclusions Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up For example you may not want database hidden and system files and folders as well as files with specific extensions to be stored in the archive To specify which f
266. ess the source data using the credentials of the backup plan account specified in the General section o Use the following credentials The program will access the source data using the credentials you specify Use this option if the plan s account does not have access permissions to the data Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK 6 2 6 Exclusions Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up For example you may not want database hidden and system files and folders as well as files with specific extensions to be stored in the archive Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 197 To specify which files and folders to exclude Set up any of the following parameters e Exclude all hidden files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the Hidden attribute If a folder is Hidden all of its contents including files that are not Hidden will be excluded e Exclude all system files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the System attribute If a folder is System all of its contents including files that are not System will be excluded _ You can view file or folder attributes in the file folder properties or by using the attrib command For more _ information r
267. ess this option select the Advanced view check box What to back up Items to back up p 320 Specify which data items to back up on each machine the policy will be deployed to On each of the machines the agent will find the data items using the rules you specify For example if the selection rule is All volumes the entire machine will be backed up Access credentials p 324 Optional Provide credentials for the source data if the backup policy account does not have access permissions to the data To access this option select the Advanced view check box Exclusions p 325 Optional Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up To access this option select the Advanced view check box Where to back up Archive p 326 318 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Specify the path to the location where the backup archive will be stored and the archive name It is advisable that the archive name be unique within the location The location must be available at the time when the management server starts to deploy the policy Access credentials p 327 Optional Provide credentials for the location if the backup policy account does not have access permissions to the location To access this option select the Advanced view check box Archive comments Optional Enter comments to the archive To access this option select the Advanced view check box How to back up Backup scheme p
268. eted backups as actual but demonstrates tape usage during the whole year for the GFS backup scheme in combination with the specified tape options A number in the green rectangle marks an incremental backup created on Monday of the corresponding week of the year W ti W i W ii Gel 04 ey 05 ey ti W OT Ge 08 w it W 10 W ii W 12 W 13 W 14 W 15 W 16 W 17 W 18 W 19 ey 20 W 31 H 22 W 23 Gel 24 Tape usage during the first year Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 143 The next figure shows the actual usage of the tapes with free space instead of the deleted backups on the first Friday of the following year At the time the differential backup blue rectangle is written onto tape 24 g 0 iy 02 iy 03 B 04 iy 05 iy 06 ig 07 iy 03 iy 09 iy 10 ay 11 g 12 g 13 E 14 g 15 g 16 E 17 g 13 B 19 a 20 g 21 g 22 g 23 E 24 The full backup stored on tape 01 is deleted after the next full backup is created onto both tapes 23 and 24 on Friday of the 52nd week As all backups of tape 01 have been deleted the tape is considered as free and can be reused Further analysis of the example proves that the maximal number of tapes required to store the data backups is 25 tapes This maximum occurs on the 16th week of the following year The above mentioned figures show that a data recovery requires one or two tapes for a full backup two or three tapes for a diffe
269. etion 4 3 2 Operations with backups To perform any operation with a backup you have to select it first To select a backup expand the archive then click the backup If the archive is protected with a password you will be asked to provide it All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the toolbar These operations can be also accessed from the Backup name actions bar on the Actions and tools pane and from the Backup name actions item of the main menu The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with backups To View backup content in a separate window Recover Recover a disk volume as a virtual machine 158 Do Click amp View content In the Backup Content window examine the backup content Click ad Recover The Recover data p 211 page will be opened with the pre selected backup as a source Right click the disk backup then select Recover as virtual machine The Recover data p 211 page will be opened with the pre selected backup as a source Select the location and the type of new virtual machine and then proceed as with regular disk or volume recovery Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Validate a backup Click validate The Validation p 230 page will be opened with the pre selected backup as a source Validation of a file backup imitates recovering of all files from the backup to a dummy destination Validation of
270. ev md1 respectively A logical volume is based on the two MD devices and is mounted on dev my_volgroup my_logvol The following picture illustrates this configuration idevisda idevisdb ldevisde fdev sdd idevimy_volgroup my_logvol 3 GB Do the following to recover data from this archive Step 1 Creating the volume structure 1 2 Boot the machine from a Linux based bootable media In the management console press CTRL ALT F2 Run the following commands to create the MD devices mdadm create dev md level 1 raid devices 2 dev sd ab mdadm create dev md1 level 1 raid devices 2 dev sd cd Run the following commands to create the logical volume group lvm pvcreate dev md dev md1 lvm vgcreate my_volgroup dev md dev md1 lvm vgdisplay The output of the lvm vgdisplay command will contain lines similar to the following Volume group VG Name my volgroup VG Access read write VG Status resizable VG Size 1 99 GB Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 253 7 VG UUID Q qoQ41 Vk7W yDG3 uF11 Q2AL C0z0 vMeACu Run the following command to create the logical volume in the L parameter specify the size given by VG Size lvm lvcreate L1 99G name my_logvol my_volgroup Activate the volume group by running the following command lvm vgchange a y my_volgroup Press CTRL ALT F1 to return to the management console Step 2 Starting the recovery 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
271. everal seconds to several minutes than from other types of data storages The best practice of tape usage is LESS requests to write read LARGER amount of data So systematic access to very large quantities of data is more suitable for a tape library than random access to small portions of data Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 131 4 1 3 3 Limitations Limitations of tape library usage are the following 1 The consolidation p 343 operation is not possible for archives located on tapes Deletion of a single separate backup is impossible from a tape It is possible to delete all the backups stored on a tape However after this operation all the incremental and differential backups stored on other tapes and based on the deleted backups cannot be used for data recovery In a Custom backup plan s retention rules the If deletion of a backup affects other backups gt Consolidate the backup option is disabled Only the Postpone the deletion option is available 2 Deduplication p 343 is not available for archives located on tape storage devices 3 File recovery from a disk backup stored on tape is possible but can take a very long time 4 A tape with backups written by the storage node cannot be read on a tape device locally attached to a machine the agent is installed on because of a difference in tape format To get information about the readability of the archives on tapes written by different components of other versions of t
272. f tasks configured for execution on a managed machine To find out what a backup plan is currently doing on the machine check the backup plan execution state p 180 A backup plan state is a cumulative state of the plan s tasks The status of a backup plan p 180 helps you to estimate whether the data is successfully protected A task is a set of sequential actions to be performed on a machine when a certain time comes or certain event occurs To keep track of a task s current progress examine its state p 181 Check a task status p 182 to ascertain the result of a task Way of working e Use filters to display the desired backup plans tasks in the backup plans table By default the table displays all the plans of the managed machine sorted by name You can also hide the unneeded columns and show the hidden ones See the Filtering and sorting backup plans and tasks p 186 section for details e Inthe backup table select the backup plan task Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 179 e Use the toolbar s buttons to take an action on the selected plan task See the Actions on backup plans and tasks p 183 section for details You can run edit stop and delete the created plans and tasks e Use the Information panel to review detailed information on the selected plan task The panel is collapsed by default To expand the panel click the chevron The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Plan details p 189
273. f the backups written up to the current time is maximal for the example However if in the future a full backup will be written at the end of a tape the archive will occupy five tapes After the next backup is created on level D tape 01 is freed and can be reused It is noticed that the TOH scheme combined with the specified options has the following properties for the analyzed case e the last figure shows that the data recovery requires loading and mounting of up to three tapes one tape 16 two tapes 72 three tapes 12 as well as rewinding and reading of one 6 two 50 or three 44 backups e five level scheme requires up to five tapes for this case ToH Example 2 Suppose the backup plan has the following tape options e the Use a separate tape set option is selected e the Always use a free tape For each full backup option is selected Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 149 e the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is cleared e the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is cleared The only difference between ToH Example 2 and ToH Example 1 is that the Always use a free tape For each full backup option is selected The first figure shows the tapes usage for the ToH scheme combined with the above mentioned tape options The recurring part of the scheme contains sixteen backup sessions The figure displays the backup archive state at the moment when the 17th
274. fication when the backup operation is failed The When user interaction is required check box to send notification during the operation when user interaction is required is always selected Click Send test WinPopup message to check if the settings are correct 3 4 1 11 Event tracing It is possible to duplicate log events of the backup operations performed on the managed machine in the Application Event Log of Windows or send the events to the specified SNMP managers Windows event log This option is effective only in Windows operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media This option defines whether the agent s operating on the managed machine have to log events of the backup operations in the Application Event Log of Windows to see this log run eventvwr exe or select Control Panel gt Administrative tools gt Event Viewer You can filter the events to be logged The preset is Use the setting set in the Machine options To select whether to log the backup operations events in the Application Event Log of Windows Choose one of the following e Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine For more information refer to Machine options p 86 e Log the following event types to log events of the backup operations in the Application Event Log Specify the types of events to be logged o All events log all events inform
275. field enter the name of the machine to which notifications will be sent Multiple names are not supported Under Send notifications select the appropriate check boxes as follows o When recovery completes successfully to send notification when the recovery task has completed successfully o When recovery fails to send notification when the recovery task has failed The When user interaction is required check box to send notification during the operation when user interaction is required is always selected Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 117 4 Click Send Test WinPopup Message to check if the settings are correct 3 4 2 5 Event tracing It is possible to duplicate log events of the recovery operations performed on the managed machine in the Application Event Log of Windows or send the events to the specified SNMP managers Windows event log This option is effective only in Windows operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media This option defines whether the agent s operating on the managed machine have to log events of the recovery operations in the Application Event Log of Windows to see this log run eventvwr exe or select Control Panel gt Administrative tools gt Event Viewer You can filter the events to be logged The preset is Use the setting set in the Machine options To select whether to log the recovery operations events in the Application Event Lo
276. fined values which are referred to as presets in the documentation When creating a recovery task you can either use a default option or override the default option with the custom value that will be specific for this task only You can also customize a default option itself by changing its value against the pre defined one The new value will be used by default in all recovery tasks you will create later on this machine To view and change the default recovery options connect the console to the managed machine and then select Options gt Default backup and recovery options gt Default recovery options from the top menu Availability of the recovery options The set of available recovery options depends on e The environment the agent operates in Windows bootable media e The type of data being recovered disk file e The operating system being recovered from the disk backup The following table summarizes the availability of the recovery options 112 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Agent for Windows Bootable media Linux based or PE based Disk File Disk File recovery recovery recovery recovery also from a also froma disk disk backup backup Pre Post recovery PE only PE only commands p 114 Recovery priority p 115 2 File level security p 116 Recover files with their p security settings Error handling p 119 Do not show messages and dialogs while processing silent mode
277. following E A B A C A B A D A B A C A B A In the five level TOH scheme all the backups on the 1st level A are incremental on the 5th level E full and other backups on levels 2 3 and 4 B C and D are differential Tape rotation for the ToH scheme substantially depends on the tape options whose default settings do not always provide optimal usage of tapes and the whole tape library The goal is to choose the tape options requiring the minimal number of tapes in the rotation There are analyzed examples showing how the ToH scheme can be combined with different tape options in the following sections e ToH Example 1 p 148 The Use a separate tape set option is selected All the Always use a free tape options are cleared It requires 5 tapes in rotation e ToH Example 2 p 149 The Use a separate tape set option is selected The Always use a free tape For each full backup option is selected The other Always use a free tape options are cleared It requires 4 tapes in rotation e TOH Example 3 p 150 The Use a separate tape set option is selected All the Always use a free tape options are selected It requires 7 tapes in rotation ToH Example 2 requires 4 tapes which is the minimum for the case So its tape options settings are the best in comparison with options for other examples TOH Example 1 Suppose the backup plan has the following tape options e the Use a separate tape set option is selected e the Always u
278. fore backing up the data of VSS aware applications make sure that the volume shadow copy writers for those applications are turned on by examining the list of writers that are present in the operating system To view this list run the following command vssadmin list writers Note In Microsoft Windows Small Business Server 2003 the writer for Microsoft Exchange Server 2003 is turned _ off by default For instructions on how to turn it on see the corresponding Microsoft Help and Support article _ http support microsoft com kb 838183 en 3 4 1 8 Compression level This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media The option defines the level of compression applied to the data being backed up The preset is Normal The optimal data compression level depends on the type of data being backed up For example even maximum compression will not significantly reduce the archive size if the archive contains essentially compressed files such as jpg pdf or mp3 However formats such as doc or xls will be compressed well To specify the compression level Select one of the following e None the data will be copied as is without any compression The resulting backup size will be maximal e Normal recommended in most cases e High the resulting backup size will typically be less than for the Normal level 98 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e Maximum the data will be compressed as
279. form actions to prevent the future warnings or failure No action is required Note that a backup plan can be OK in case none of the tasks has been started yet or some of the tasks are stopped or being stopped These situations are considered as normal A task can be in one of the following states Idle Waiting Running Stopping Need interaction The initial task state is Idle Once the task is started manually or the event specified by the schedule occurs the task enters either the Running state or the Waiting state Running A task changes to the Running state when the event specified by the schedule occurs AND all the conditions set in the backup plan are met AND no other task that locks the necessary resources is running In this case nothing prevents the task from running Waiting A task changes to the Waiting state when the task is about to start but another task using the same resources is already running In particular more than one backup or recovery task cannot run simultaneously on a machine A backup task and a recovery task also cannot run simultaneously Once the other task unlocks the resource the waiting task enters the Running state A task may also change to the Waiting state when the event specified by the schedule occurs but the condition set in the backup plan is not met See Task start conditions p 107 for details Need interaction Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 181 Any running ta
280. ft VSS support Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 97 Microsoft Volume Shadow Copy Service VSS provides an infrastructure for backing up data on running systems by ensuring coordination between applications updating the data on the disks and backup applications Examples of VSS aware database servers are Microsoft Exchange and Microsoft SQL Server Enable the Volume Shadow Copy Service option if any of your databases or applications are compatible with VSS The VSS will notify the VSS aware applications that the backup is about to start This ensures the consistent state of all data used by the applications in particular completion of all database transactions at the moment of taking the data snapshot by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 The data consistency in turn ensures that the application will be recovered in the correct state and become operational immediately after recovery Snapshots provided by VSS are not used lf your database is incompatible with VSS use Pre Post data capture commands p 94 to indicate which commands should be performed before and after taking the snapshot to ensure that the data is being backed up in a consistent state For instance specify pre data capture commands that will suspend the database and flush all caches to ensure that all transactions are completed and specify post data capture commands that will resume the database operations after the snapshot is taken Volume shadow copy writers Be
281. g Updating Deployed A backup policy deployment state on a group of machines is a combination of the policy deployment states on the machines included in the group For detailed information about backup policy deployment states see the Backup policy s state and statuses p 61 section 7 1 2 2 Backup policy statuses A backup policy status is the cumulative status of the policy statuses on all machines the policy is applied to For example if the policy is applied to three machines and has the OK status on the 1st machine the Warning status on the 2nd machine and the Error status on the 3rd machine the status of the policy will be Error A backup policy status on a group of machines is the cumulative status of the policy statuses on the machines included in the group The following table shows a summary of possible backup policy statuses Status How it is determined How to handle 1 Error The policy status on at least View the log or identify the failed tasks to find out the one machine is Error reason of the failure then do one or more of the following Otherwise see 2 Remove the reason of the failure gt optionally Start the failed task manually Edit the backup policy to prevent future failure 2 Warning The policy status on at least View the log to read the warnings gt optionally Perform one machine is Warning actions to prevent future warnings or failure Otherwise see 3 3 OK The p
282. g of Windows Select one of the following e Use the setting set in the Machine options to use the setting specified for the machine For more information refer to Machine options p 86 e Log the following event types to log events of the recovery operations in the Application Event Log Specify the types of events to be logged o All events log all events information warnings and errors o Errors and warnings o Errors only e Do not log to disable logging events of the recovery operations in the Application Event Log SNMP notifications This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media The option defines whether the agent s operating on the managed machine have to send the log events of the recovery operations to the specified Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP managers You can choose the types of events to be sent Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the following Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP objects to SNMP management applications 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 1 0 string identifying the type of event Information Warning Error 1 3 6 1 4 1 24769 100 200 2 0 string containing the text description of the event it looks identical to messages published by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 in its log The preset is Use the setting set in the Machine options 118 Copyright Acronis Inc
283. g of a system volume on a machine at the startup the operating system runs from the first disk discovers the same signature on the second one automatically generates a new unique NT signature and assigns it to the second disk As a result all the volumes on the second disk will lose their letters all paths will be invalid on the disk and programs won t find their files _ You have the following two alternatives to retain system bootability on the target disk volume 1 Copy NT signature to provide the target disk with the source disk NT signature matched with the Registry keys also copied on the target disk 2 Leave NT signature to keep the old target disk signature and update the operating system according to the signature If you need to copy the NT signature 1 Select the Copy NT signature check box You receive the warning If there is an operating system on the hard disk uninstall either the source or the target hard disk drive from your machine prior to starting the machine again Otherwise the OS will start from the first of the two and the OS on the second disk will become unbootable The Turn off the machine after the cloning operation check box is selected and disabled automatically Click Finish to add the pending operation Click Commit on the toolbar and then click Proceed in the Pending Operations window Wait until the task is finished Wait until the machine is turned off Disconnect either th
284. g the final layout of the volumes the program will first use unallocated space at the end e f there is no or not enough unallocated space at the end of the disk but there is unallocated space between volumes the volumes will be moved to add more unallocated space to the end e When all unallocated space is collected but it is still not enough the program will take free space from the volumes you select proportionally reducing the volumes size Resizing of locked volumes requires a reboot e However there should be free space on a volume so that the operating system and applications can operate for example for creating temporary files The program will not decrease a volume where free space is or becomes less than 25 of the total volume size Only when all volumes on the disk have 25 or less free space will the program continue decreasing the volumes proportionally As is apparent from the above setting the maximum possible zone size is not advisable You will end up with no free space on any volume which might cause the operating system or applications to work unstably and even fail to start 240 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 7 2 Managing Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone is considered as a personal vault p 352 Once created on a managed machine the zone is always present in the list of Personal vaults Centralized backup plans can use Acronis Secure Zone as well as local plans If you have used the Ac
285. ge and other factors like disk I O speed or network traffic The preset is Normal To specify the recovery process priority Select one of the following Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 115 e Low to minimize resources taken by the recovery process leaving more resources to other processes running on the machine e Normal to run the recovery process with normal speed allocating resources on a par with other processes e High to maximize the recovery process speed by taking resources from the other processes 3 4 2 3 File level security This option is effective only for recovery from file level backup of Windows files This option defines whether to recover NTFS permissions for files along with the files The preset is Recover files with their security settings If the file NTFS permissions were preserved during backup p 104 you can choose whether to recover the permissions or let the files inherit the NTFS permissions from the folder to which they are recovered 3 4 2 4 Notifications Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the ability of notifying users about recovery completion through e mail or the messaging service E mail This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media The option enables you to receive e mail notifications about the recovery task s successful completion failure or need for interaction along wit
286. gh the machine s BIOS This may be Acronis Secure Zone a USB hard drive a flash drive or any internal hard drive Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 49 How it works When configuring a recovery operation you select disks or volumes to recover from a backup Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 scans the selected disks or volumes in the backup If this scan finds a supported operating system the Acronis Active Restore option becomes available If you do not enable the option the system recovery will proceed in the usual way and the machine will become operational after the recovery is completed If you enable the option the sequence of actions will be set as follows Once the system recovery is started the operating system boots from the backup The machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services The data required to serve incoming requests is recovered with the highest priority everything else is recovered in the background Because serving requests is performed simultaneously with recovery the system operation can slow down even if recovery priority in the recovery options is set to Low This way the system downtime is reduced to a minimum at the cost of a temporary performance downgrade Usage scenarios 1 The system uptime is one of the efficiency criteria Examples Client oriented online services Web retailers polling stations 2 The system storage space ratio is heavily biased toward storage
287. gnoring bad sectors The rest of the data will be backed up and you will be able to mount the resulting disk backup and extract valid files to another disk 3 4 1 17 Dual destination This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems when the primary backup destination is a local folder or Acronis Secure Zone and the secondary destination is another local folder or network share Managed vaults and FIP servers are not supported as secondary destinations The preset is Disabled 106 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 When dual destination is enabled the agent will automatically copy each backup being created locally to the secondary destination such as a network share Once the backup to the primary destination is completed the agent compares the updated archive contents to the secondary archive contents and copies to the secondary destination all backups that are missing there along with the new backup This option enables quick machine backup to the internal drive as an intermediate step before saving the ready backup on the network This comes in handy in cases of slow or busy networks and time consuming backup procedures Disconnection during the copy transfer will not affect the backup operation as opposed to backing up directly to the remote location Other advantages e Replication enhances the archive reliability e Roaming users can back up their portable computers to Acronis Secure Zone while on the
288. gt VSS Suspend gt Data capture gt VSS Resume gt After data capture commands Using the pre post data capture commands you can suspend and resume a database or application that is not compatible with VSS As opposed to the Pre Post commands p 93 the pre post data capture commands will be executed before and after the data capture process which takes seconds while the entire backup procedure may take much longer depending on the amount of data to be backed up Therefore the database or application idle time will be minimal To specify pre post data capture commands 1 Enable pre post data capture commands execution by checking the following options o Execute before the data capture o Execute after the data capture 2 Do any ofthe following o Click Edit to specify a new command or a batch file o Select the existing command or the batch file from the drop down list 3 Click OK Pre data capture command To specify a command batch file to be executed before data capture 1 In the Command field type a command or browse to a batch file The program does not support interactive commands i e commands that require user input for example pause 2 Inthe Working directory field specify a path to a directory where the command batch file will be executed 3 Inthe Arguments field specify the command s execution arguments if required 4 Depending on the result you want to obtain select the appropriate options
289. guration must allow waking up the machine from the powered off state also known as the S5 or G2 power state Distribute start time within the time window This setting is available only when creating a backup policy When this setting is enabled the backup task on each registered machine will start with a specific delay from the start time set in the policy This distributes the tasks actual start times within a time interval You may want to use this setting when creating a backup policy for backing up multiple machines to a network location to avoid excessive network load Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 169 Delay values range from zero to the specified maximum delay value and are determined according to the chosen distribution method The delay value for each machine is determined when the policy is deployed to the machine and remains the same until you edit the policy and change the maximum delay value The conditions if any will be checked at the task s actual start time on each machine The following examples illustrate this setting Example 1 Suppose that you are deploying a backup policy with the following schedule to three machines Run the task Daily Once at 09 00 00 AM Distribute start time within the time window Maximum delay 1 Hour s Distribution method Random Then the task s start time on each machine may be any time between 09 00 00 AM and 09 59 59 AM for instance First machine Every
290. h backups will be deleted D Deduplicating vault A managed vault p 348 in which deduplication p 343 is enabled Deduplication A method of storing different duplicates of the same information only once Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 can apply the deduplication technology to backup archives p 339 stored on storage nodes p 350 This minimizes storage space taken by the archives backup traffic and network usage during backup Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 343 Differential backup A differential backup stores changes to the data against the latest full backup p 347 You need access to the corresponding full backup to recover the data from a differential backup Direct management Any management operation that is performed on a managed machine p 348 using the direct console p 343 agent p 339 connection as opposed to centralized management p 342 when the operations are configured on the management server p 348 and propagated by the server to the managed machines The direct management operations include e creating and managing local backup plans p 347 e creating and managing local tasks p 347 such as recovery tasks e creating and managing personal vaults p 348 and archives stored there e viewing the state progress and properties of the centralized tasks p 342 existing on the machine e viewing and managing the log of the agent s operations e disk management operations such as
291. h the full log of the task The preset is Disabled To configure e mail notification 1 Select the Send e mail notifications check box to activate notifications 2 In the E mail addresses field type the e mail address to which notifications will be sent You can enter several addresses separated by semicolons 3 Under Send notifications select the appropriate check boxes as follows o When backup completes successfully to send a notification when the backup task has completed successfully o When backup fails to send a notification when the backup task has failed The When user interaction is required check box is always selected 4 For the e mail message to include the log entries related to the backup select the Add full log to the notification check box 5 Click Additional e mail parameters to configure additional e mail parameters as follows then click OK 116 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 o From type the e mail address of the user from whom the message will be sent If you leave this field empty messages will be constructed as if they are from the destination address o Use encryption you can opt for encrypted connection to the mail server SSL and TLS encryption types are available for selection o Some Internet service providers require authentication on the incoming mail server before being allowed to send something If this is your case select the Log on to incoming mail server check box
292. hat you want to create a backup plan that will back up hard disk data as soon as such a situation occurs When Windows detects a bad block on a hard disk it records an event with the event source disk and the event number 7 into the System log the type of this event is Error When creating the plan type or select the following in the Schedule area e Log name System e Event source disk Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 171 e Event type Error e Event ID 7 Important To ensure that such a task will complete despite the presence of bad blocks you must make the task ignore bad blocks To do this in Backup options go to Error handling and then select the Ignore bad sectors check box Pre update backup in Vista Suppose that you want to create a backup plan that will automatically perform a backup of the system for example by backing up the volume where Windows is installed every time that Windows is about to install updates Having downloaded one or more updates and scheduled their installation the Microsoft Windows Vista operating system records an event with the event source Microsoft Windows WindowsUpdateClient and event number 18 into the System log the type of this event is Information When creating the plan type or select the following in the Schedule area e Log name System e Event source Microsoft Windows WindowsUpdateClient e Event type Information e Event ID 18 _ Tip To set up a simila
293. have to run the task once again Edit a plan task Backup plan Click Edit Backup plan editing is performed in the same way as creation p 193 except for the following limitations It is not always possible to change backup scheme properties if the created archive is not empty i e contains backups 1 Itis not possible to change the scheme to Grandfather Father Son or Tower of Hanoi 2 If the Tower of Hanoi scheme is used it is not possible to change the number of levels In all other cases the scheme can be changed and should continue to operate as if the existing archives were created by a new scheme For empty archives all changes are possible Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 289 Delete a plan task Refresh table 290 Why can t I edit the backup plan The backup plan is currently running Editing of the currently running backup plan is impossible The backup plan has a centralized origin Direct editing of centralized backup plans is not possible You need to edit the original backup policy Task Click Edit Why can t I edit the task Task belongs to a backup plan Only tasks that do not belong to a backup plan such as a recovery task can be modified by direct editing When you need to modify a task belonging to a local backup plan edit the backup plan A task belonging to a centralized backup plan can be modified by editing the centralized policy that soawned the plan Backup
294. he SMTP server e Port set the port of the SMTP server By default the port is set to 25 e User name enter the user name e Password enter the password 6 Click Send test e mail message to check if the settings are correct Messenger service WinPopup This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems on the sending machine and only for Windows on the receiving machine This option is not available when operating under bootable media The option enables you to receive WinPopup notifications about the backup task s successful completion failure or need for interaction The preset is Disabled Before configuring WinPopup notifications make sure the Messenger service is started on both the machine executing the task and the machine that will receive messages The Messenger service is not started by default in the Microsoft Windows Server 2003 family Change the service Startup mode to Automatic and start the service To configure WinPopup notifications 1 Select the Send WinPopup notifications check box Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 101 2 In the Machine name field enter the name of the machine to which notifications will be sent Multiple names are not supported Under Send notifications select the appropriate check boxes as follows o When backup completes successfully to send notification when the backup operation is completed successfully o When backup fails to send noti
295. he data backups Tape set is a logical group of one or more tapes which contain backups of the specific protected data A tape set can contain backups of other data as well Separate tape set is a tape set which contains only backups of the specific protected data Other backups cannot be written to a separate tape set For the backup policy plan to be created Use a separate tape set The preset is Disabled If you leave this option unchanged then the backups belonging to the policy or plan being created might be written onto tapes containing backups written by different backup policies and comprising of data from different machines Similarly backups from other policies might be written onto the tapes containing this policy s backups You will not have a problem with such tapes as the program manages all the tapes automatically When this option is enabled the backups belonging to the policy or plan being created will be located on a separate tape set Other backups will not be written to this tape set Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 109 If the console is connected to the management server The Use a separate tape set option has more precise definitions So for the backup policy to be created you can use a separate tape set for all machines or for each single machine The A single tape set for all machines option is selected by default Generally this option ensures more efficient usage of tapes than the A separate tap
296. he first backup is always full So if the backup policy plan starts on Wednesday and full backups should be created on every fourth Friday on Wednesday the first backup will be full instead of an incremental one There are analyzed examples showing how the GFS scheme can be combined with different tape options in the following sections e GFS Example 1 p 141 The Use a separate tape set option is selected All the Always use a free tape options are cleared It requires 25 tapes in rotation e GFS Example 2 p 145 The Use a separate tape set option is selected The Always use a free tape For each full backup option is selected Other Always use a free tape options are cleared It requires 16 tapes in rotation e GFS Example 3 p 146 The Use a separate tape set option is selected All the Always use a free tape options are selected It requires 28 tapes in rotation These examples demonstrate how the number of tapes required for automated rotation depends on the tape options If a tape library does not have enough tapes for automated rotation the Tasks Need Interaction window will sometimes ask you to load a free tape into the library GFS Example 1 Suppose the backup plan has the following tape options e the Use a separate tape set option is selected Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 141 e the Always use a free tape For each full backup option is cleared e the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option
297. he machine with the tape library device and registered in the management server Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 133 Tape library as a managed vault To enable data protection operations using a tape library you have to create a managed vault on the tape library You can create a vault from the Centralized vaults view of the console See the Creating a managed centralized vault p 127 section for more information But the simplest way is to create a vault from the Storage Nodes view In addition to that select the storage node the tape library is attached to and then click Create vault The Create centralized vault page will be displayed with the pre selected parameters All you need to do is to specify the vault Name before you click OK Once the vault is created it is accessible from the Centralized vaults view of the console Then the tape library can be used for backing up Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 allows creating only one vault per tape device If all cartridges in a tape library have barcodes and the RSM Free pool contains enough tapes for a chosen backup scheme the library is ready to fully work automatically You can start working with the vault even though all the tape library slots are empty If there are no available tapes in the tape library slots during the backup operation the Tasks Need Interaction window asks you to load a tape If the tape barcode cannot be read another Tasks Need Interaction window
298. he operating system start up such as storage controllers motherboard or chipset The Universal Restore is not available e when the machine is booted with Acronis Startup Recovery Manager p 338 using F11 or e the image being recovered is located in Acronis Secure Zone p 338 or e when using Acronis Active Restore p 338 because these features are primarily meant for instant data recovery on the same machine Universal Restore is not available when recovering Linux Unmanaged vault Any vault p 352 that is not a managed vault p 348 V Validation An operation that checks the possibility of data recovery from a backup p 339 Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination The previous product versions considered a file backup valid when the metadata contained in its header was consistent The current method is time consuming but much more reliable Validation of a volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup This procedure is also resource intensive Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 351 While the successful validation means a high probability of successful recovery it does not check all factors that influence the recovery process If you back up the operating system only a test recovery under the bootable media to a spare hard drive can guarantee successful recovery in the future Validation rules A part of the backup pla
299. he product by means of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 see the Tape compatibility table p 44 section 5 Barcode printers are not used 4 1 3 4 RSM Media Pools Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 uses Windows Removable Storage Manager RSM to manage tape cartridges belonging to tape libraries To separate access to media by different programs the RSM uses so called Media Pools that are logical media groups There are two categories of media pools in the manager System and Application System media pools include Free pool Import pool and Unrecognized pool The System pools hold media that are not currently used by applications The Free pool holds media that are considered as free and can be used by applications The Import and Unrecognized pools are temporary pools for media that are new in certain library Through RSM an application can get its own pools with proper names move media from the Free pool into its own pools use its own pools media for correct purpose return media to the Free pool etc Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node manages the tapes belonging to the Acronis pool If you fill tape library slots with unused tapes all the tapes will be included into the Free pool automatically If a tape was used previously the RSM tries to detect the registered application the tape is concerned to If the application is not found the RSM will move the tape into the Unrecognized pool If the application is not fo
300. he second ring at intervals of four moves moves 2 6 10 the third ring at intervals of eight moves moves 4 12 and so on 36 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 For example if there are five rings labeled A B C D and E in the puzzle the solution gives the following order of moves Se T The Tower of Hanoi backup scheme is based on the same patterns It operates with Sessions instead of Moves and with Backup levels instead of Rings Commonly an N level scheme pattern contains N th power of two sessions So the five level Tower of Hanoi backup scheme cycles the pattern that consists of 16 sessions moves from 1 to 16 in the above figure The table shows the pattern for the five level backup scheme The pattern consists of 16 sessions pt fal fal fa A Se eee E AA a The Tower of Hanoi backup scheme implies keeping only one backup per level All the outdated backups have to be deleted So the scheme allows for efficient data storage more backups accumulate toward the present time Having four backups you can recover data as of today yesterday half a week ago or a week ago For the five level scheme you can also recover data backed up two weeks ago So every additional backup level doubles the maximal roll back period for your data Tower of Hanoi by Acronis The Tower of Hanoi backup scheme is generally too complex to mentally calculate the next media to be used But Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 prov
301. he specified SNMP managers o Types of events to send choose the types of events to be sent All events Errors and warnings or Errors only o Server name IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management application the messages will be sent to o Community type the name of the SNMP community to which both the host running the SNMP management application and the sending machine belong The typical community is public Click Send test message to check if the settings are correct e Do not send SNMP notifications to disable sending the log events of the backup operations to SNMP managers 3 4 1 12 Fast incremental differential backup The option is effective in Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media This option is effective for incremental and differential disk level backup This option defines whether a file change is detected using the file size and time stamp or by comparing the file contents to those stored in the archive The preset is Enabled Incremental or differential backup captures only data changes To speed up the backup process the program determines whether a file has changed or not by the file size and the date time when the file was last modified Disabling this feature will make the program compare the entire file contents to those stored in the archive 3 4 1 13 Backup splitting This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable
302. he sub folders of the specified folder find the most suitable HAL and HDD controller drivers of all those available and install them into the recovered system Universal Restore also searches for the network adapter driver the path to the found driver is then transmitted by Universal Restore to the operating system If the hardware has multiple network interface cards Universal Restore will try to configure all the cards drivers In case Universal Restore cannot find a compatible driver in the specified locations it will specify the problem device and ask for a disc or a network path to the driver Once Windows boots it will initialize the standard procedure for installing new hardware The network adapter driver will be installed silently if the driver has the Microsoft Windows signature Otherwise Windows will ask for confirmation whether to install the unsigned driver After that you will be able to configure the network connection and specify drivers for the video adapter USB and other devices 224 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Mass storage drivers to install anyway To access this option select the Advanced view check box If the target hardware has a specific mass storage controller such as RAID especially NVIDIA RAID or a fibre channel adapter specify the appropriate drivers in the Drivers field The drivers defined here will have priority They will be installed with appropriate warnings even if the program finds
303. hen you proceed to the regular volume mapping procedure described below _ Please be aware that the target machine will be powered off automatically before recovery If you prefer to power it off manually modify the VM power management option 218 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Volume Letter Disk Volume p 219 Sequentially map each of the source volumes to a volume or an unallocated space on the destination disk Size p 219 Optional Change the recovered volume size location and other properties Volume destination To specify a destination volume 1 Select a volume or unallocated space where you want the selected volume to be recovered to The destination volume unallocated space should be at least the same size as the uncompressed image data 2 Click OK All the data stored on the target volume will be replaced by the backed up data so be careful and watch out for f _hon backed up data that you might need _ When using bootable media Disk letters seen under Windows style bootable media might differ from the way Windows identifies drives For example the D drive in the rescue utility might correspond to the E drive in Windows Be careful To be on the safe side it is advisable to assign unique names to the volumes The Linux style bootable media shows local disks and volumes as unmounted sda1 sda2 Volume properties Resizing and relocating When recovering a volume to
304. herwise there is a high risk that the operating system will not start 2 Create bootable media 3 If a system failure occurs boot the machine using the bootable media Start the console and connect to the bootable agent 4 Configure the system recovery select the system disk or volume and select the Use Acronis Active Restore check box Acronis Active Restore will choose for the boot up and subsequent recovery the first operating system found _ during the backup scan Do not try to recover more than one operating system using Active Restore if you 50 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 want the result to be predictable When recovering a multi boot system choose only one system volume 5 Once the system recovery is started the operating system boots from the backup The Acronis Active Restore icon appears in the system tray The machine becomes operational and ready to provide necessary services The immediate user sees the drive tree and icons and can open files or launch applications even though they were not yet recovered The Acronis Active Restore drivers intercept system queries and set the immediate priority for recovery of the files that are necessary to serve the incoming requests While this on the fly recovery proceeds the continuing recovery process is transferred to the background eee ee eee ee ee ee Se Se ee ee a a ae aaa aa aaa aa eae eles am amam aa eae am am am eaa a am mm am _ If you try to log
305. hey must be identical on the source and the target computers see Microsoft Knowledge Base articles 302577 and 216915 The Universal Restore technology provides an efficient solution for hardware independent system recovery by replacing the crucial Hardware Abstraction Layer HAL and mass storage device drivers Universal Restore is applicable for 1 Instant recovery of a failed system on different hardware 2 Hardware independent cloning and deployment of operating systems 3 Physical to physical physical to virtual and virtual to physical machine migration The Universal Restore principles 1 Automatic HAL and mass storage driver selection Universal Restore searches for drivers in the network folders you specify on removable media and in the default driver storage folders of the system being recovered Universal Restore analyzes the compatibility level of all found drivers and installs HAL and mass storage drivers that better fit the target hardware Drivers for network adapters are also searched and passed to the operating system which installs them automatically when first started _ The Windows default driver storage folder is determined in _ the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE SOFTWARE Microsoft Windows Current version DevicePath This storage folder is usually WINDOWS inf 2 Manual selection of the mass storage device driver If the target hardware has a specific mass storage controller such as a SCSI RAID or
306. hive and the vault the backup is stored in Settings The Settings tab displays information on scheduling and the options changed against the default values Progress The Progress tab is available while the task is running It is common for all types of tasks The tab provides information about task progress elapsed time and other parameters Backup plan details The Backup plan details window also duplicated on the Information panel aggregates in four tabs all the information on the selected backup plan The respective message will appear at the top of the tabs if one of the plan s tasks requires user interaction It contains a brief description of the problem and action buttons that let you select the appropriate action or stop the plan Backup plan The Backup plan tab provides the following general information on the selected plan e Name name of the backup plan e Origin whether the plan was created on the managed machine using direct management local origin or appeared on the machine as a result of deploying a backup policy from the management server centralized origin e Policy for backup plans with centralized origin name of the backup policy whose deployment created the backup plan e Account the name of the account under which the plan runs e Owner the name of the user who created or last modified the plan e State execution state p 180 of the backup plan e Status status p 180 of the backu
307. iatatatatatatatatatatatatatatatate Log Entry Details Type Information Date and time DD MM YYYY HH MM SS Backup plan Backup plan name Task Task name Message Description of the operation Code 12 3x45678A Module Module name Owner Owner of the plan Date and time presentation varies depending on your locale settings 6 2 Creating a backup plan Before creating your first backup plan p 340 please familiarize yourself with the basic concepts p 24 used in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 To create a backup plan perform the following steps General Plan name Optional Enter a unique name for the backup plan A conscious name lets you identify the plan among others Plan s credentials p 195 Optional The backup plan will run on behalf of the user who is creating the plan You can change the plan account credentials if necessary To access this option select the Advanced view check box Comments Optional Type a description of the backup plan To access this option select the Advanced view check box What to backup Source type p 195 Select the type of data to back up The type of data depends on the agents installed on the machine Items to backup p 196 Specify the data items to back up A list of items to backup depends on the data type specified previously Access credentials p 197 Optional Provide credentials for the source data if the plan s acc
308. ication the messages will be sent to o Community type the name of the SNMP community to which both the host running SNMP management application and the sending machine belong The typical community is public To disable sending SNMP messages clear the Send messages to SNMP server check box The messages are sent over UDP Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 85 3 3 Machine options The machine options define the general behavior of all Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agents operating on the managed machine and so the options are considered machine specific To access the machine options connect the console to the managed machine and then select Options gt Machine options from the top menu 3 3 1 Machine management This option defines whether the machine has to be managed centrally by the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server You have the opportunity to register the machine on the management server when installing an Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent If the machine is not registered selecting Centralized management here will initiate the registration p 349 Or you can add the machine to the management server on the server side Any of the three registration methods require the server administrator privileges Selecting Standalone management on a registered machine will result in the machine stopping communication with the server Once the management server alerts that it could not connect to the
309. ication options If you do nothing in this section the default values p 112 will be used After any of the settings is changed against the default value a new line that displays the newly set value appears The setting status changes from Default to Custom Should you modify the setting again the line will display the new value unless the new value is the default one When the default value is set the line disappears and so you always see only the settings that differ from the default values in the Settings section Clicking Reset to default resets all the settings to default values After you complete all the required steps click OK to create the commit creating of the recovery task 6 3 1 Task credentials Provide credentials for the account under which the task will run To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Run under the current user The task will run under the credentials with which the user who starts the tasks is logged on If the task has to run on schedule you will be asked for the current user s password on completing the task creation o Use the following credentials The task will always run under the credentials you specify whether started manually or executed on schedule Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK To
310. icking the corresponding items on the log toolbar All these operations can also be performed with the context menu by right clicking the log entry or with the Log actions bar on the Actions and tools pane The following is a guideline for you to perform actions on log entries noo e Select a single log entry Click on it Select multiple log non contiguous hold down CTRL and click the log entries one by one entries contiguous select a single log entry then hold down SHIFT and click another entry All the entries between the first and last selections will be selected too View a log entry s 1 Select a log entry details 2 Doone ofthe following Click View Details The log entry s details will be displayed in a separate window Expand the Information panel by clicking the chevron Save the selected log Select a single log entry or multiple log entries entries to a file Click EF Save Selected to File In the opened window specify a path and a name for the file Save all the log entries Make sure that the filters are not set to a file Click H save All to File In the opened window specify a path and a name for the file Save all the filtered log Set filters to get a list of the log entries that satisfy the filtering criteria entries to a file i Click P Save All to File In the opened window specify a path and a name for the file As a result the log entries of that list will be saved Dele
311. ides you with automation of the scheme usage You can set up the backup scheme while creating a backup plan Acronis implementation for the scheme has the following features e upto 16 backup levels e incremental backups on first level A to gain time and storage savings for the most frequent backup operations but data recovery from such backups takes longer because it generally requires access to three backups e full backups on the last level E for five level pattern the rarest backups in the scheme take more time and occupy more space in storage Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 37 e differential backups on all intermediate levels B C and D for five level pattern e the pattern starts with a full backup since the very first backup cannot be incremental e the scheme forces every backup level to keep only the most recent backup other backups from the level have to be deleted however backup deletion is postponed in cases where the backup is a base for another incremental or differential one e anold backup on a level is kept until a new backup has been successfully created on the level The table shows the pattern for the five level backup scheme The pattern consists of 16 sessions Backup 2 3 718 10 11 12 13 14 15 1 level 1 Incremental 1 Incremental A HH 2 Dera DRN DAR DEN BAR 3 Diferential EHHH arterei T sew E As a result of using incremental and differential backups the situation may arise
312. if the archive has exceeded its maximum size and or for expired backups This may or may not result in deleting backups depending on whether the retention rules are violated or not For more information please refer to Retention rules p 38 Console Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console A tool for remote or local access to Acronis agents p 339 and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server p 348 Having connected the console to the management server the administrator sets up and manages backup policies p 340 and accesses other management server functionality that is performs centralized management p 342 Using the direct console agent connection the administrator performs direct management p 344 Consolidation Combining two or more subsequent backups p 339 belonging to the same archive p 339 into a single backup Consolidation might be needed when deleting backups either manually or during cleanup p 343 For example the retention rules require to delete a full backup p 347 that has expired but retain the next incremental p 347 one The backups will be combined into a single full backup which will be dated with the incremental backup s date Since consolidation may take a lot of time and system resources retention rules provide an option to not delete backups with dependencies In our example the full backup will be retained until the incremental one also becomes obsolete Then bot
313. ified in the permissions you may not be able to read or modify this file To completely eliminate this kind of problem disable preserving file security settings in archives The recovered files and folders will always inherit the permissions from the folder to which they are recovered or from the disk if recovered to the root Alternatively you can disable recovery p 116 of the security settings even if they are available in the archive The result will be the same the files will inherit the permissions from the parent folder To access file or folder NTFS permissions select Properties gt Security 3 4 1 15 Media components This option is effective for both Windows and Linux operating systems when the backup destination is removable media When backing up to removable media you can make this media work as regular Linux based bootable media p 341 by writing additional components to it As a result you will not need a separate rescue disc The preset is None selected Select the check boxes for the components you want to put on the bootable media e One Click Restore is the minimal addition to a disk backup stored on removable media allowing for easy recovery from this backup If you boot a machine from the media and click Run Acronis One click Restore the disk will be immediately recovered from the backup contained on the same media Caution Because the one click approach does not presume user selections such as
314. il the Selected Selected Cleared Cleared command execution is complete Result Preset Continue the N A Continue the Coniniethe backup after the backup command is concurrently with backup only after executed despite the command the command is command execution and successfully i execution failure irrespective of the executed Delete Or success command 96 the TIB file and temporary files and fail the task if the command execution fails execution result Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 ok File level backup snapshot This option is effective only for file level backup in Windows and Linux operating systems This option defines whether to back up files one by one or by taking an instant data snapshot Note Files that are stored on network shares are always backed up one by one The preset is Create snapshot if it is possible Select one of the following e Always create a snapshot The snapshot enables backing up of all files including files opened for exclusive access The files will be backed up at the same point in time Choose this setting only if these factors are critical that is backing up files without a snapshot does not make sense To use a snapshot the backup plan has to run under the account with the Administrator or Backup Operator privileges If a snapshot cannot be taken the backup will fail e Create a snapshot if it is possible Back up files directly if taking a snapshot is not p
315. ile and folder structure in Windows For example let a Linux machine contain a hard disk which is split into three volumes or partitions the first second and third partitions These partitions are available in the tree as dev hda1 dev hda2 and dev hda3 respectively To perform a disk backup of the say third partition one can type dev hda3 in the row of the Volumes to back up selection rules dialog box Furthermore a Linux partition can be mounted anywhere inside the tree Say dev hda3 can be mounted as a subdirectory inside the tree such as home usr docs In this case one can type either dev hda3 or home usr docs in the Volume field to perform a disk backup of the third partition In general when setting up a centralized policy to perform volume backups of Linux machines make sure that the paths entered in the Volume field correspond to partitions such as dev hda2 or home usr docs in the previous example and not to directories Standard names for Linux partitions Names such as dev hdai reflect the standard way of naming IDE hard disk partitions in Linux The prefix hd signifies the disk type IDE a means that this is the first IDE hard disk on the system and 1 denotes the first partition on the disk In general the standard name for a Linux partition consists of three components e Disk type hd for IDE drives sd for SCSI drives md for software RAID drives for example dynamic volumes Disk nu
316. iles and folders to exclude Set up any of the following parameters e Exclude all hidden files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the Hidden attribute If a folder is Hidden all of its contents including files that are not Hidden will be excluded e Exclude all system files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the System attribute If a folder is System all of its contents including files that are not System will be excluded You can view file or folder attributes in the file folder properties or by using the attrib command For more _ information refer to the Help and Support Center in Windows e Exclude files matching the following criteria Select this check box to skip files whose names match any of the criteria called file masks in the list use the Add Edit Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks You can use one or more wildcard characters and ina file mask The asterisk substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc txt and Document txt The question mark substitutes for exactly one character in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc1 txt and Docs txt but not the files Doc txt or Doc11 txt Exclusion examples By name File1 log Excludes all files named File1 log By path C Finance test log Exc
317. imately 320 GB e the approximate size of daily changes of data is about 16 GB e the approximate size of weekly changes of data is no more than 40 GB e tape capacity is 400 GB Let s analyze the results of a combination of GFS and ToH schemes with different tape options for the case All the below analyzed examples are a simplistic approach to a real case but provide you with a general conception of backup distribution onto tapes 140 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Legend for the case example figures Any daily incremental backup 16 GB is shown in the figures as a green rectangle II Weekly differential backups 40 GB are displayed as a blue rectangle MM Any full monthly backup 320 GB is drawn in orange LJ A whole tape 400 GB is drawn as a gray rectangle _ __Q _ __ _________ Using the Grandfather Father Son tape rotation scheme Tape rotation for the GFS backup scheme is substantially defined by the tape options specified for the backup policy plan to be created Assume the GFS settings are the following e Start backup at 11 00 00 PM e Back up on Workdays e Weekly Monthly Friday e Keep backups Daily 2 weeks Weekly 2 months Monthly 1 year The main goal is to achieve full automation of tape rotation for these settings Keep in mind that a monthly backup is full a weekly backup is differential and a daily backup is incremental in this implementation of the GFS scheme T
318. imple Spanned volume o Select one or more destination disks to create the volume on To create a Mirrored volume o Select two destination disks to create the volume on To create a Striped volume o Select two or more destination disks to create the volume on To create a RAID 5 volume o Select three destination disks to create the volume on After you choose the disks the wizard will calculate the maximum size of the resulting volume depending on the size of the unallocated space on the disks you chose and the requirements of the volume type you have previously decided upon If you are creating a dynamic volume and select one or several basic disks as its destination you will receive a warning that the selected disk will be converted to dynamic automatically If need be you will be prompted to add the necessary number of disks to your selection according to the chosen type of the future volume If you click the Back button you will be returned to the previous page Select the type of volume being created p 266 If you click the Next button you will proceed to the next page Set the volume size p 268 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 267 Set the volume size On the third wizard page you will be able to define the size of the future volume according to the previously made selections In order to choose the necessary size between the minimum and the maximum values use the slider or enter the necessary v
319. import to the management server The management console addresses to the agent and initiates the registration procedure Because registration requires the agent s participation it cannot take place when the machine is offline An additional agent installed on a registered machine becomes registered on the same management server automatically Multiple agents are jointly registered and deregistered Applying policies To Do Apply a backup policy to a Click Apply backup policy machine In the Policy selection p 286 window specify the backup policy you need to apply to the selected machine 282 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Grouping actions To Do Create a custom static or Click re Create group dynamic group In the Create group p 293 window specify the required parameters of the group The new group will be created in the group the selected machine is a member of except for the built in ho all physical machines group Add a machine to another Click z Add to another group static group In the Add to group p 286 window specify the group to copy the selected machine to The backup policies applied to the groups the machine is a member of will be applied to the machine For machines in custom groups Add machines to a static Click TA Add machines to group group In the Add machines to group p 286 window select the machines that you need to add Move a machine to another Click IE Move to
320. in the 174 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 specified time interval or logs off at any other time do not back up the users data i e skip task execution e Event When logging off The following user Any user e Condition Fits the time interval from 04 30 00 PM until 10 00 00 PM e Task start conditions Skip the task execution As a result 1 if the user logs off between 04 30 00 PM and 10 00 00 PM the backup task will start immediately following the logging off 2 if the user logs off at any other time the task will be skipped What if What if a task is scheduled to be executed at a certain time and this time is outside the specified time interval For example e Event Daily Every 1 day s Once at 03 00 00 PM e Condition Fits time interval from 06 00 00 PM until 11 59 59 PM In this case whether and when the task will run depends on the task start conditions e Ifthe task start conditions are Skip the task execution the task will never run e lf the task start conditions are Wait until the conditions are met and the Run the task anyway after check box is cleared the task scheduled to run at 3 00 PM will start at 6 00 PM the time when the condition is met e If the task start conditions are Wait until the conditions are met and the Run the task anyway after check box is selected with say the 1 Hour waiting time the task scheduled to run at 3 00 PM will start at 4 00 PM the time
321. in the archive by using the mdadm utility for MD devices the lvm utility for logical volumes or both Note Logical Volume Manager utilities such as pvcreate and vgcreate which are normally available in _ Linux are not included in the bootable media environment so you need to use the lvm utility with a _correspondent command lvm pvcreate lvm vgcreate etc 6 If you previously mounted the backup by using the trueimagemnt utility use this utility again to unmount the backup see Mounting backup volumes later in this topic 7 Return to the management console by pressing CTRL ALT F1 or by running the command bin product Do not reboot the machine at this point Otherwise you will have to create the volume structure again 8 Click Recover then specify the path to the archive and other required parameters and then click OK Note This procedure does not work when connected to Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Bootable Agent remotely because the command shell is not available in this case 252 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Example Suppose that you previously performed a disk backup of a machine with the following disk configuration The machine has two 1 gigabyte and two 2 gigabyte SCSI hard disks mounted on dev sda dev sdb dev sdc and dev sdd respectively The first and second pairs of hard disks are configured as two MD devices both in the RAID 1 configuration and are mounted on dev mdO and d
322. in the storage node s log indicating the vault in question You can view storage node warnings in the Dashboard The database is stored on the storage node in a local folder whose name is specified in Database path when creating the vault Vault Database FreeSpace Error Limit Description Specifies the amount of free space on the volume containing a managed vault s database in megabytes below which an error is recorded in the storage node s log and any backup to the vault becomes prohibited Possible values Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value 10 If the amount of free space on the disk containing a managed vault s database is less than the value of Vault Database Free Space Error Limit an error is recorded in the storage node s log Backups performed to the vault will keep failing until the amount of free space is above the limit You can view storage node errors in the Dashboard The database is stored on the storage node in a local folder whose name is specified in Database path when creating the vault Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server The following are the parameters of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server that can be set via Group Policy by using Acronis Administrative Template Collecting Logs Specifies when to collect log entries from machines managed by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 309 This parameter co
323. incremental backup on Sundays at 10 00PM Delete backups that are older than 3 months this is a backup scheme e validate the last backup immediately after its creation this is a validation rule e protect the archive with a password this is an option Physically a backup plan is a bundle of tasks p 350 configured for execution on a managed machine p 348 A backup plan can be created directly on the machine local plan or appears on the machine as a result of a backup policy p 340 deployment centralized plan p 342 Backup policy Policy A backup plan template created by the management server p 348 administrator and stored on the management server A backup policy contains the same rules as a backup plan but might not explicitly specify what data items to back up Instead selection rules p 349 such as environment variables can be used Because of this flexible selection a backup policy can be centrally applied to multiple machines If a data item is specified explicitly e g dev sda or C Windows the policy will back up this item on each machine where this exact path is found By applying a policy to a group of machines the administrator deploys multiple backup plans with a single action The workflow when using policies is as follows 1 The administrator creates a backup policy 2 The administrator applies the policy to a group of machines or a single machine p 347 340 Copyright Acronis Inc
324. ine to a centralized vault managed by a storage node On the storage node let these users have regular non administrative accounts UserA_SN and UserB_ SN respectively Normally UserA can access only the archives created by UserA and owned by UserA_SN and UserB can access only the archives created by UserB and owned by UserB_ SN However if UserA is a member of the Administrators group on the machine this user can additionally access the archives created from this machine by UserB even though UserA s account on the storage node is a regular one 2 11 7 6 Management server administrator rights Normally the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server administrator operates on a registered machine on behalf of the Acronis Managed Machine Service also known as the Acronis service on that machine and has the same privileges as the service has Alternatively when creating a backup policy the management server administrator has the option to explicitly specify a user account under which the centralized backup plans will run on the registered machines In this case the user account must exist on all the machines to which the centralized policy will be deployed This is not always efficient To be a management server administrator the user must be a member of the Acronis Centralized Admins group on the machine where the management server is installed 2 11 7 7 Rights for Acronis services In Windows most Acronis componen
325. ined by License Check Interval License Server Address Description Specifies the network name or IP address of Acronis License Server Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value Empty string AMS Host Description Specifies the network name or IP address of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server AMS Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value Empty string Centrally Managed Description Specifies whether the machine is managed by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server Possible values True or False Default value False If the value is False the machine acts as a stand alone machine If the value is True the machine acts as a registered machine managed by the management server whose name is specified in AMS Host When Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent first starts on such machine it connects to the management server and adds the machine to it If you set Centrally Managed to True you must specify the name of the management server in AMS Host all Configured parameters including Centrally Managed will affect all machines in that domain or organizational unit In particular all its currently stand alone machines will become managed machines or vice _ versa depending on the parameter value Windows Event Log Specifies when to record Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent s events into the Application event log in Windows Copyrigh
326. ing for the condition required by the previous event The event will be ignored e What if the condition is not met for a very long time If delaying a backup is getting risky you can force the condition tell the users to log off or run the task manually To automatically handle this situation you can set the time interval after which the task will run regardless of the condition 5 1 Daily schedule Daily schedule is effective in Windows and Linux operating systems To specify a daily schedule In the Schedule area select the appropriate parameter as follows Every lt gt day s Set up the certain number of days you want the task to be run For example if you set Every 2 day s the task will be started on every other day In the During the day execute the task area select one of the following Once at lt gt Set up the time at which the task will be run once Every lt gt Set up how many times the task will be restarted during the specified time interval For example setting the task frequency to Every 1 hour From 10 00 00 AM until 10 00 00 PM allows the task to run 12 times from 10 AM to 10 PM during one day From lt gt Until lt gt In the Effective area set the following settings From lt gt Set up a date when this schedule will be enabled an effective date If this check box is cleared the task will be started on the nearest day and time you have specified above To
327. intext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer e To back up data to a locally attached tape device expand the Tape drives group then click the required device 2 Using the archives table To assist you with choosing the right destination the table displays the names of the archives contained in each location you select While you are reviewing the location content archives can be added deleted or modified by another user or by the program itself according to scheduled operations Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives You can switch between displaying archives by names and displaying the physical representation of the archives as TIB files using the Show archives and Show TIB files buttons 3 Naming the new archive Once you select the archive destination the program generates a name for the new archive and displays it in the Name field The name commonly looks like Archive 1 The generated name is unique within the selected location If you are satisfied with the automatically generated name click OK Otherwise enter another unique name and click OK Backing up to an existing archive You can configure the backup plan to back up to an existing archive To do so select the archive in the archives table or type the archive name in the Name field If the archive is protected with a password the program will ask for it in the pop up window By selec
328. ion p 240 window review the expected layout and click OK to start creating the zone 6 7 1 1 Acronis Secure Zone Disk The Acronis Secure Zone can be located on any fixed hard drive Acronis Secure Zone is always created at the end of the hard disk A machine can have only one Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone is created using unallocated space if available or at the expense of the volumes free space _ The Acronis Secure Zone cannot be organized on a dynamic disk or a disk using the GPT partitioning style 238 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 To allocate space for Acronis Secure Zone 1 Choose a hard disk if several on which to create the zone The unallocated space is selected by default The program displays the total space available for the Acronis Secure Zone 2 If you need to allocate more space for the zone you can select volumes from which free space can be taken Again the program displays the total space available for the Acronis Secure Zone depending on your selection You will be able to set the exact zone size in the Acronis Secure Zone Size p 239 window 3 Click OK 6 7 1 2 Acronis Secure Zone Size Enter the Acronis Secure Zone size or drag the slider to select any size between the minimum and the maximum ones The minimum size is approximately 50MB depending on the geometry of the hard disk The maximum size is equal to the disk s unallocated space plus the total free space on all the volumes
329. ion boot sector the rest is in the files bootmgr boot bcd At starting Windows boot bcd is mounted to the registry key HKLM BCDOOOOO0O000 6 3 12 Recovering a vast number of files from a file backup Applies to Microsoft Windows Server 2003 When recovering a very large number of files at a time hundreds of thousands or millions from a file backup you might encounter the following problem e The recovery process fails and the message Error reading the file appears e Not all of the files are recovered The most likely cause of the problem is an insufficient amount of memory allocated to the recovery process by the operating system s cache manager You can either work around this problem or modify the registry to increase the amount of allocated memory as described below To resolve the problem do either of the following e Recover the files as two or more groups For example if the problem occurs when recovering 1 million files try recovering the first 500 000 of them and then the remaining 500 000 e Modify the registry as follows Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 229 _ Note This procedure requires restarting the machine Use standard precautions when modifying the registry Se a a a a a ne 1 In Registry Editor open the following registry subkey HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE SYSTEM CurrentControlSet Control Session Manager Memory Management 2 Add the PoolUsageMaximum entry to the subkey e Entry type
330. ions and Tools pane Note that the list of available operations in the context menu the Disk management menu and the 2 Operations bar depends on the selected volume or disk type The same is true for unallocated space as well Displaying operation results The results of any disk or volume operation you have just planned are immediately displayed in the Disk management view of the console For example if you create a volume it will be immediately 258 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 shown in the table as well as in graphical form at the bottom of the view Any volume changes including changing the volume letter or label are also immediately displayed in the view 6 9 5 Disk operations Acronis Disk Director Lite includes the following operations that can be performed on disks e Disk Initialization p 259 initializes the new hardware added to the system e Basic disk cloning p 260 transfers complete data from the source basic MBR disk to the target e Disk conversion MBR to GPT p 262 converts an MBR partition table to GPT e Disk conversion GPT to MBR p 262 converts a GPT partition table to MBR e Disk conversion Basic to Dynamic p 263 converts a basic disk to dynamic e Disk conversion Dynamic to Basic p 264 converts a dynamic disk to basic The full version of Acronis Disk Director will provide more tools and utilities for working with disks Acronis Disk Director Lite must obtain exclusiv
331. ip all tmp files In this case all tmp files in the folder MyFolder will be skipped during the recovery process but the file MyFile tmp will not be skipped 222 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Overwriting Choose what to do if the program finds in the target folder a file with the same name as in the archive e Overwrite existing file this will give the file in the backup priority over the file on the hard disk e Overwrite existing file if it is older this will give priority to the most recent file modification whether it be in the backup or on the disk e Do not overwrite existing file this will give the file on the hard disk priority over the file in the backup If you allow overwriting files you still have an option to prevent overwriting p 222 e hidden files and folders e system files and folders e any files you specify by name or using wildcards e any folder you specify by path 6 3 7 Access credentials for destination To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the task credentials The program will access the destination using the credentials of the task account specified in the General section o Use the following credentials The program will access the destination using the credentials you specify Use this option if the task account does not have access permissions to the destination Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account
332. iple virtual processors are generally available on multi processor hosts A multicore host CPU or hyperthreading may enable multiple virtual processors on a single processor host 6 3 6 5 File destination To specify a destination 1 Select a location to recover the backed up files to o Original location files and folders will be recovered to the same path s as they are in the backup For example if you have backed up all files and folders in Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 221 C Documents Finance Reports the files will be recovered to the same path If the folder does not exist it will be created automatically o New location files will be recovered to the location that you specify in the tree The files and folders will be recovered without recreating a full path unless you clear the Recover without full path check box 2 Click OK Exclusions Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to be overwritten during recovery To specify which files and folders to exclude Set up any of the following parameters e Exclude all hidden files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the Hidden attribute If a folder is Hidden all of its contents including files that are not Hidden will be excluded e Exclude all system files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the System attribute If a folder is System all of its contents inc
333. is Inc 2000 2009 5 7 1 The same policy can be applied to a group and to a machine Nothing changes on the machine at the second application of the same policy but the server remembers that the policy has been applied twice 2 A policy revoked from the group remains on the machine 3 A policy revoked from the machine remains on the group and therefore on the machine 4 To completely revoke the policy from the machine revoke it from both the group and the machine 2 11 4 2 Operations with a machine This section is a simplified illustration of what happens with the policies on a machine when the machine is moved copied or deleted from a group In the diagram below the container stands for a group the one color circle stands for a machine with one applied policy the two color circle stands for a machine with two applied policies the white circle stands for a machine with no policy applied 1 Here is the initial state two custom groups contain different machines A policy is applied to one group another policy is applied to another group The next schemes illustrate results of the specified actions 2 Move to another group Machine 3 is moved from one group to another The orange policy is revoked the blue policy is applied to the machine 3 Add to another group Machine 3 is added to another group It becomes a member of both groups The blue policy is applied but the orange policy remains on the machin
334. is True Image 9 1 product families 2 10 1 Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone is a secure partition that enables keeping backup archives on a managed machine disk space and therefore recovery of a disk to the same disk where the backup resides Certain Windows applications such as Acronis disk management tools can access the zone Should the disk experience a physical failure the zone and the archives located there will be lost That s why Acronis Secure Zone should not be the only location where a backup is stored In enterprise environments Acronis Secure Zone can be thought of as an intermediate location used for backup when an ordinary location is temporarily unavailable or connected through a slow or busy channel Advantages Acronis Secure Zone e Enables recovery of a disk to the same disk where the disk s backup resides e Offers a cost effective and handy method for protecting data from software malfunction virus attack operator error e Being an internal archive storage eliminates the need for a separate media or network connection to back up or recover the data This is especially useful for mobile users e Can serve as a primary destination when using dual destination p 106 backup Limitations e The zone cannot be organized on a dynamic disk or a disk using the GPT partitioning style Managing the Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone is considered as a personal vault p 352 Once created on a man
335. is cleared e the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is cleared Imagine the first backup operation is scheduled on Friday 1st of January On that day at 11 00 PM the first full backup 320 Gb on the tape whose size is 400 Gb is created As the Use a separate tape set option is selected the currently mounted tape is ejected if it is not a free tape Then a free tape is loaded especially for backing up the data The tape is marked with number 01 in the figure below In accordance with the legend described in the Case to analyze p 140 section the full data backup is displayed as an orange rectangle in the figure The specified GFS backup scheme settings force the data to be backed up on Workdays only so the next backup is created at the same time 11 00 PM on Monday 4th of January This backup is an incremental one 16 Gb that is written onto the same tape 01 because the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is cleared The backup is drawn as a green rectangle in the figure Bj t The next three incremental backups are written onto tape 01 on 5th 6th and 7th of January As a result the free space on the tape is only 16 Gb at the moment On 8th of January the data differential backup 40 Gb is recorded onto the same tape 01 as the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is cleared However the tape reached the end after the first 16 Gb of the backup is written Then the ta
336. isk without any loss If such transfer with proportional resizing of the source disk volumes is possible but without any data loss then the user will be allowed to proceed If due to the size limitations safe transfer of all the source disk data to the target disk is impossible even with the proportional resizing of the volumes then the Clone basic disk operation will be impossible and the user will not be able to continue If you are about to clone a disk comprising of a system volume pay attention to the Advanced options By clicking Finish you ll add the pending operation of the disk cloning To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them Using advanced options When cloning a disk comprising of a system volume you need to retain an operating system bootability on the target disk volume It means that the operating system must have the system volume information e g volume letter matched with the disk NT signature which is kept in the MBR disk record But two disks with the same NT signature cannot work properly under one operating system tm ew we we ewe oe ee oe ee Oe ee ee Oe Oe Oe ee Oe Oe Oe Ee Oe ee Be Oe Be Oe Be Oe Be Oe Oe Oe 8 Oe Oe Oe ee Oe ee Oe Oe Oe ee ee ee ee eee eee eee eee eee eee _The operating system on that disk will be unbootable _ If there are two disks having the same NT signature and comprisin
337. ists all the archives that contain file backups Related sections Operations with archives stored in a vault p 157 Operations with backups p 158 Filtering and sorting archives p 159 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 155 Bars of the Actions and tools pane e Vault Name The Actions bar is available when clicking the vault in the vaults tree Duplicates actions of the vault s toolbar e Archive Name The Actions bar is available when you select an archive in the archives table Duplicates actions of the archives toolbar e Backup Name The Actions bar is available when you expand the archive and click on any of its backups Duplicates actions of the archives toolbar 4 2 2 Actions on personal vaults To perform any operation except for creation with a vault you must select it first All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the toolbar These operations can be also accessed from the Vault name actions bar on the Actions and Tools pane and from the Vault name actions item of the main menu respectively The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with personal vaults To Create a personal vault Change user account for accessing a vault Create Acronis Secure Zone Explore a vault s content Validate a vault Delete a vault Refresh vault table information 156 Do Click fie Create The procedure of creating personal
338. it was created Keep monthly backups for half a year Backup scheme parameters can then be set up as follows e Start backup at 6 00 PM e Back up on Workdays e Weekly monthly Friday Keep backups o Daily 1 week o Weekly 10 days o Monthly 6 months With this scheme you will have a week to recover a previous version of a damaged file from a daily backup as well as 10 day access to weekly backups Each monthly full backup will be available for six months since the creation date Work schedule Suppose you are a part time financial consultant and work in a company on Tuesdays and Thursdays On these days you often make changes to your financial documents statements and update the spreadsheets etc on your laptop To back up this data you may want to e Track changes to the financial statements spreadsheets etc performed on Tuesdays and Thursdays daily incremental backup e Have a weekly summary of file changes since last month Friday weekly differential backup e Have a monthly full backup of your files Moreover assume that you want to retain access to all backups including the daily ones for at least six months The following GFS scheme suits such purposes e Start backup at 11 30 PM e Back up on Tuesday Thursday Friday e Weekly monthly Friday Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 331 e Keep backups o Daily 6 months o Weekly 6 months o Monthly 5 years Here daily incremental backups
339. ive state and status of a policy 64 Custom backup scheme 165 166 168 208 334 D Daily schedule 162 206 298 332 Dashboard 177 179 273 Data type 212 214 Decreasing Acronis Secure Zone 241 Deduplicating vault 343 Deduplication 18 20 52 64 125 132 343 348 350 Deduplication ratio 66 Deduplication restrictions 67 68 Default backup and recovery options 86 87 89 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Default backup options 89 194 319 Default recovery options 112 213 Delete volume 265 269 Deleting Acronis Secure Zone 242 Deleting archives and backups 158 159 Destination selection 216 Differential backup 339 344 Direct management 52 177 338 343 344 347 349 Disk backup Image 338 344 347 Disk conversion basic to dynamic 259 262 263 dynamic to basic 259 262 264 GPT to MBR e 259 262 MBR to GPT 259 262 Disk destination 217 Disk group 41 344 346 Disk initialization 259 Disk management 43 211 256 Disk operations 259 Disks 212 216 Disks volumes selection 215 Drivers for Universal Restore 245 246 Dual destination 46 90 106 Dynamic disk 41 338 339 344 345 346 Dynamic group 342 346 Dynamic volume 41 341 346 E Editing custom groups 293 295 E mail e 91 100 113 116 Encrypted archive 346 347 Encrypted vault 297 347 350 Error handling 90 106 113 119
340. ix months since the creation date Work schedule Suppose you are a part time financial consultant and work in a company on Tuesdays and Thursdays On these days you often make changes to your financial documents statements and update the spreadsheets etc on your laptop To back up this data you may want to e Track changes to the financial statements spreadsheets etc performed on Tuesdays and Thursdays daily incremental backup e Have a weekly summary of file changes since last month Friday weekly differential backup e Have a monthly full backup of your files 204 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Moreover assume that you want to retain access to all backups including the daily ones for at least six months The following GFS scheme suits such purposes e Start backup at 11 30 PM e Back up on Tuesday Thursday Friday e Weekly monthly Friday e Keep backups o Daily 6 months o Weekly 6 months o Monthly 5 years Here daily incremental backups will be created on Tuesdays and Thursdays with weekly and monthly backups performed on Fridays Note that in order to choose Friday in the Weekly monthly field you need to first select it in the Back up on field Such an archive would allow you to compare your financial documents as of the first and the last day of work and have a five year history of all documents etc No daily backups Consider a more exotic GFS scheme e Start backup at 12 00 PM e B
341. k Automatic configuration could be done for this connection Sizeable data for recovery could be transferred through the second NIC included in the dedicated backup network by means of static TCP IP settings Network port While creating bootable media you have an option to pre configure the network port that the bootable agent listens for incoming connection The choice is available between e the default port e the currently used port e the new port enter the port number If the port has not been pre configured the agent uses the default port number 9876 This port is also used as default by the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console Drivers for Universal Restore While creating bootable media you have an option to add Windows drivers to the media The drivers will be used by Universal Restore when recovering Windows on a machine with a dissimilar processor different motherboard or different mass storage device than in the backed up system You will be able to configure the Universal Restore e to search the media for the drivers that best fit the target hardware e to get the mass storage drivers that you explicitly specify from the media This is necessary when the target hardware has a specific mass storage controller such as a SCSI RAID or Fiber Channel adapter for the hard disk For more information please refer to Universal Restore p 223 The drivers will be placed in the visible Drivers folder on
342. k account specified in the General section o Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify Use this option if the task account does not have access permissions to the location You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer E AR ee ee Se a M a ee ee ee ee ee ee ee ee ee ee ee eee eee ee ee ee ee eee ee eee ee eee eee ee See eee ee eee ee ee ee ee eee eee 6 3 6 Destination selection Specify the destination the selected data will be recovered to 6 3 0 4 Disks Available disk destinations depend on the agents operating on the machine Recover to Physical machine Available when the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or Agent for Linux is installed The selected disks will be recovered to the physical disks of the machine the console is connected to On selecting this you proceed to the regular disk mapping procedure described below New virtual machine p
343. k box automatically selects the corresponding check boxes Mon Tue Wed Thu and Fri and leaves the remaining ones unchanged 2 Once at 09 00 00 PM 3 Effective From empty If you have created the task say on Monday at 11 30 AM the task will be started on the same day at 9 PM If the task was created say on Friday after 9 PM then it will be started for the first time on the nearest workday Monday in our example at 9 PM End date empty The task will be restarted for an indefinite number of weeks This schedule is widely used when creating a custom backup scheme The Workdays like schedule is added to the incremental backups while the full backup is scheduled to be performed one day in the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 165 week For more details see the Full and incremental backups plus cleanup example in the Custom backup scheme p 208 section Several weekly schedules for one task In the case when the task needs to be run on different days of the weeks with different time intervals consider adding a dedicated schedule to every desired day of the week or to several days For example you need the task to be run with the following schedule Monday twice at 12 PM noon and 9 PM Tuesday every 3 hours from 9 AM till 9 PM Wednesday every 3 hours from 9 AM till 9 PM Thursday every 3 hours from 9 AM till 9 PM Friday twice at 12 PM and 9 PM i e same as on Monday Saturday once at 9 PM Sunday
344. ks owned by other users Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 185 Delete a plan task Backup plan Click 4 Delete What will happen if delete the backup plan The plan s deletion deletes all its tasks Why can t I delete the backup plan The backup plan is in the Running state A backup plan cannot be deleted if at least one of its tasks is running Do not have the appropriate privilege Without the Administrator s privileges on the machine a user cannot delete plans owned by other users The backup plan has a centralized origin A centralized plan can be deleted by the management server administrator by revoking the backup policy that produced the plan Task Click p 4 Delete Why can t I delete the task e Task belongs to a backup plan A task belonging to a backup plan cannot be deleted separately from the plan Edit the plan to remove the task or delete the entire plan Do not have the appropriate privilege Without the Administrator privileges on the machine a user cannot delete tasks owned by other users Refresh table Click t Refresh The management console will update the list of backup plans and tasks existing on the machine with the most recent information Though the list is refreshed automatically based on events the data may not be retrieved immediately from the managed machine due to some latency Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed Filtering and s
345. kup image is located in the Acronis Secure Zone or e when using Acronis Active Restore because these features are primarily meant for instant data recovery on the same machine Universal Restore is not available when recovering Linux Getting Universal Restore Universal Restore comes free with Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Advanced Server SBS Edition and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Advanced Server Virtual Edition Universal Restore for the other product editions is purchased separately has its own license and is installed as a separate feature from the setup file You need to re create bootable media to make the newly installed add on operational in the bootable environment 2 10 4 Acronis Active Restore Active Restore is the Acronis proprietary technology that brings a system online immediately after the system recovery is started Customers familiar with Acronis Recovery for Microsoft Exchange can note that this product uses Active Restore to achieve immediate availability of an Exchange information store after starting the recovery While based on the same technology recovery of the Information Store proceeds in quite a different way than the operating system recovery described in this section Supported operating systems Acronis Active Restore is available when recovering Windows starting from Windows 2000 Limitation The only supported archive location is a local drive or more precisely any device available throu
346. l i The backup archives belonging to a deleting centralized vault on a tape library will be deleted as well but these _ archives might be recovered by any storage node through the Rescan operation 134 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Actions with archives on tapes in a library The following are common functions for archive data management for a backup archive selected in the Centralized vaults view of the console when the current vault is a tape library Validate Delete Delete all archives Deletion in the storage node database is performed without access to tapes A backup archive deleted from a tape library vault can be restored after the deletion by the Rescan p 137 operation which is performed for all the tapes keeping the archive s data The Rescan operation for a tape where a backup was deleted from can recover the backup as it recreates information on the content of the backup in the storage node database If all the backups are deleted from a tape it is considered as free So the deleted backups will be irrevocably lost l after the first writing to the tape Backing up to tape library At creating a backup policy plan with a tape library destination you set up the backing up in the same way as with other storage devices The only difference is the additional Tape options p 109 that can be set up during the backup policy plan creation These options enable you to specify how the created backup policy
347. l as individual folders or files File backup File level data protection is based on backing up files and folders residing on the machine where the agent is installed or on a network share Files can be recovered to their original location or to another place It is possible to recover all files and folders that were backed up or select which of them to recover Other operations Conversion to a virtual machine Rather than converting a disk backup to a virtual disk file which requires additional operations to bring the virtual disk into use Agent for Windows performs the conversion by recovering a disk backup to a new virtual machine of any of the following types VMware Workstation Microsoft Virtual PC Parallels Workstation or Citrix XenServer virtual appliance Files of the fully configured and Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 17 operational machine will be placed in the folder you select You can start the machine using the respective virtualization software or prepare the machine files for further usage Disk management Agent for Windows includes Acronis Disk Director Lite a handy disk management utility Disk management operations such as cloning disks converting disks creating formatting and deleting volumes changing a disk partitioning style between MBR and GPT or changing a disk label can be performed either in the operating system or using bootable media 1 3 1 1 Universal Restore The Universal Restore add o
348. le Months December January February On lt All gt lt All workdays gt Once at 10 00 00 PM ge es tee S Effective From 11 01 2009 To not set Second schedule 1 Months March April May September October November 168 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 2 On lt All gt lt All workdays gt 3 Every 12 hours From 12 00 00 AM Until 12 00 00 PM 4 Effective From 11 01 2009 To not set Third schedule 1 Months June July August 2 Days 1 15 3 Once at 10 00 00 PM 4 Effective From 11 01 2009 To not set 5 4 Advanced scheduling settings The following advanced settings are available when you select a daily weekly or monthly schedule for machines registered on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server Use Wake on LAN This setting is available when creating a backup policy or a backup plan When this setting is enabled Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server will use the Wake on LAN WOL functionality to wake up turned off registered machines when backup is scheduled to start If the backup task on each machine starts with a delay see the next setting the management server will wake up the machines according to those delays Before using this setting make sure that you have enabled Wake on LAN on the registered machines The machine s basic input output system BIOS configuration network adapter configuration and the operating system confi
349. le media The preset is Enabled When the option is enabled backing up to removable media may be not possible if the user is away because the program will wait for someone to press OK in the prompt box Hence you should disable the prompt when scheduling a backup to removable media Then if the removable media is available for example a DVD is inserted the task can run unattended Reset archive bit The option is effective only for file level backup in Windows operating systems and in bootable media The preset is Disabled In Windows operating systems each file has the File is ready for archiving attribute available by selecting File gt Properties gt General gt Advanced gt Archive and Index attributes This attribute also known as the archive bit is set by the operating system each time the file is changed and can be reset by backup applications each time they include the file in a backup The archive bit value is used by various applications such as databases When the Reset archive bit check box is selected Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will reset the archive bits of all files being backed up Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 itself does not use the archive bit value When performing incremental or differential backup it determines whether a file has changed by the file size and the date time when the file was last saved Restart the machine automatically after backup is finished This option is available on
350. le media To create Acronis Secure Zone perform the following steps Space Disk p 238 Choose a hard disk if several on which to create the zone Acronis Secure Zone is created using unallocated space if available or at the expense of the volume s free space Size p 239 Specify the exact size of the zone Moving or resizing of locked volumes such as the volume containing the currently active operating system requires a reboot Settings Password p 239 Optional Protect the Acronis Secure Zone from unauthorized access with a password The prompt for the password appear at any operation relating to the zone including using the Acronis Startup Recovery Manager p 338 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager p 239 Optional To enable using Acronis Startup Recovery Manager select Activate Acronis Startup Recovery Manager activation overwrites the Master Boot Record MBR with its own boot code You will have to reactivate third party boot loaders if installed Under Linux consider installing the LILO or GRUB loader to a Linux root or boot partition boot record instead of the MBR before activation Otherwise reconfigure these boot loaders manually after activation To disable Acronis Startup Recovery Manager select Do not activate You can activate Acronis Startup Recovery Manager later from the Manage Acronis Secure Zone p 241 page After you configure the required settings click OK In the Result confirmat
351. lease note A dynamic disk occupies the last megabyte of the physical disk to store the database including _ the four level description Volume Component Partition Disk for each dynamic volume If during the 2 conversion to dynamic it turns out that the basic disk is full and the size of its volumes cannot be decreased ee De eS ED De ety Should you decide to revert your dynamic disks back to basic ones e g if you want to start using an OS on your machine that does not support dynamic disks you can convert your disks using the same menu items though the operation now will be named Convert to basic System disk conversion Acronis Disk Director Lite does not require an operating system reboot after basic to dynamic conversion of the disk if 1 There is a single Windows 2008 Vista operating system installed on the disk 2 The machine runs this operating system Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 263 Basic to dynamic conversion of the disk comprising of system volumes takes a certain amount of time and any power loss unintentional turning off of the machine or accidental pressing of the Reset button during the procedure could result in bootability loss In contrast to Windows Disk Manager the program ensures bootability of an offline operating system on the disk after the operation 6 9 5 6 Disk conversion dynamic to basic You would want to convert dynamic disks back to basic ones e g if you want to start using
352. lect the desired folder or enter the full path to the folder in the Path field To create a new folder for the database click fz Create folder 2 Click OK Vault encryption If you protect a vault with encryption anything written to the vault will be encrypted and anything read from it will be decrypted transparently by the storage node using a vault specific encryption key stored on the node In case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by an unauthorized person the malefactor will not be able to decrypt the vault contents without access to the storage node This encryption has nothing to do with the archive encryption specified by the backup plan and performed by an agent If the archive is already encrypted the storage node side encryption is applied over the encryption performed by the agent To protect the vault with encryption Select the Encrypt check box In the Enter the password field type a password In the Confirm the password field re type the password E E o Select one of the following o AES 128 the vault contents will be encrypted using the Advanced Standard Encryption AES algorithm with a 128 bit key o AES 192 the vault contents will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 192 bit key o AES 256 the vault contents will be encrypted using the AES algorithm with a 256 bit key 5 Click OK The AES cryptographic algorithm operates in the Cipher block chaining CBC mode and uses a rando
353. lete backups younger than f l i ff LFF i f Delete if the maximum a j at d elete I archive size is exceeded Example Delete backups older than 3 Months Keep the archive size within 200GB Never delete backups younger than 10 Days Every time the retention rules are applied the program will delete all backups created more than 3 months or more exactly 90 days ago If after the deletion the archive size is more than 200GB and the oldest backup is older than 10 days the program will delete that backup Then if necessary the next old backup will be deleted until the archive size decreases to the preset limit or the oldest backup age reaches 10 days Deleting backups with dependencies Both retention rules presume deleting some backups while retaining the others What if the archive contains incremental and differential backups that depend on each other and on the full backups they are based on You cannot say delete an outdated full backup and keep its incremental children When deletion of a backup affects other backups one of the following rules is applied 40 Retain the backup until all dependent backups become subject to deletion The outdated backup will be kept until all backups that depend on it also become outdated Then all the chain will be deleted at once during the regular cleanup This mode helps to avoid the potentially time consuming consolidation b
354. licy applied to the group Filtering and sorting Filtering and sorting of the backup policies is performed in the same way as for the Backup policies view See the Filtering and sorting backup policies p 279 section for details Inheritance order The Inheritance order window lets you examine where the policy applied to the group came from The policy that is directly applied to the group is displayed as follows Ed Group name The following example illustrates how the policy that is applied on the group through inheritance is displayed Group1 gt kal Group2 gt Group3 Group1 in the root contains Group2 to which the policy is applied directly Group2 in turn contains child Group3 that inherits the policy from the parent The group to which the policy was applied directly is boldfaced and marked with an icon All items are interactive i e when you click on a group its parent group view will be opened 7 1 4 Storage nodes Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node helps you to optimize usage of various resources required for the enterprise data protection This goal is achieved through organizing managed vaults p 348 that serve as dedicated storages of the enterprise backup archives 296 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Storage node enables you to e relieve managed machines of unnecessary CPU load by using the storage node side cleanup p 350 and storage node side validation p 350 e drastically reduc
355. lied to the group all its members are supposed to be green But if we add say the 1 machine to G3 the machine will bear both orange and green policies in spite of the fact that G3 has nothing to do with the orange policy That s why it is difficult to track the policies inheritance from the top of the hierarchy if the same machine is included in multiple groups In real life it s much easier to view the inheritance from the machine s side To do so navigate to any group that contains the machine select the machine and then select the Backup policies tab on the Information pane The Inheritance column shows whether a policy is inherited or applied directly to the machine Click Explore inheritance to view the inheritance order of the policy In our example the policy names the Inheritance column and the inheritance order will be as follows For machine Name of the policy Inheritance Inheritance order 1or 2or 3 green Inherited All machines gt 1 or 2 or 3 orange Inherited G1 gt 1 or 2 or 3 60 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 4 green Inherited All machines gt 4 orange Inherited G1 gt G2 gt 4 blue Inherited G2 gt 4 violet Applied directly 5 or 6 green Inherited All machines gt 5 or 6 orange Inherited G1 gt G2 gt 5 or 6 blue Inherited G2 gt 5 or 6 2 11 5 Backup policy s state and statuses Centralized management presumes that the administrator can
356. ll backup and roll back periods for schemes of various levels Number of Full backup On different Roll back levels every days can go period back 2 2 days 1 to 2 days 1 day 3 4 days 2 to 5 days 2 days 4 8 days 4 to 11 days 4 days 5 16 days 8 to 23 days 8 days 6 32 days 16to 47 days 16 days Adding a level doubles the full backup and roll back periods To see why the number of recovery days varies let us return to the previous example Here are the backups we have on day 12 numbers in gray denote deleted backups A new level 3 differential backup has not yet been created so the backup of day five is still stored Since it depends on the full backup of day one that backup is available as well This enables us to go as far back as 11 days which is the best case scenario The following day however a new third level differential backup is created and the old full backup is deleted This gives us only a four day recovery interval which turns out to be the worst case scenario On day 14 the interval is five days It increases on subsequent days before decreasing again and so on The roll back period shows how many days we are guaranteed to have even in the worst case For a four level scheme it is four days Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 207 6 2 9 0 At a glance Custom backup scheme e Custom schedule and conditions for backups of each type e Custom schedule and retention rules Parameters
357. ll be recorded if Trace State is set to True Address Description Specifies the network name or IP address of the SNMP server Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value Empty string Community Description Specifies the community name for the SNMP notifications Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value public Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 315 Event tracing parameters Parameters called tracing parameters specify when to record notifications about events from Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node into the event log or a file Severity levels Event notifications are rated on a scale from O to 5 based on the event s severity as shown in the following table tevel Name Description Unknown Notification about an event whose level of severity is unknown or not applicable Notification used for debug purposes Information Informational notification such as one about successful completion of an operation or startup of a service Warning Notification about a possible impending problem such as low free space in a vault Error Notification about an event that resulted in loss of data or functionality Critical error Notification about an event that resulted in the termination of a process such as the agent s pro
358. llar sign is surrounded by a single space on either side e Instead of explicitly including the names of all members of the Administrators group the Administrators group itself is included Tip To ensure proper group names you should install Acronis components in a domain controller after you have set up the domain controller itself If the components were installed before you set up the domain controller create the groups DCNAME Acronis Remote Users and DCNAME S Acronis Centralized Admins manually and _ then include the members of Acronis Remote Users and Acronis Centralized Admins in the newly created groups 2 11 7 5 User privileges on a storage node The scope of a user s privileges on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node depends on the user s rights on the machine where the storage node is installed A regular user such as a member of the Users group on the storage node can e Create archives in any centralized vault managed by the storage node e View and manage archives owned by the user A user who is a member of the Administrators group on the storage node can additionally e View and manage any archive in any centralized vault managed by the storage node e Create centralized vaults to be managed by the storage node provided that the user is also an Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server administrator e Re schedule the compacting task as described in Operations with storage nodes p 297
359. lock chaining CBC mode and uses a randomly generated key with a user defined size of 128 192 or 256 bits The larger the key size the longer it will take for the program to encrypt the archive and the more secure your data will be The encryption key is then encrypted with AES 256 using a SHA 256 hash of the password as a key The password itself is not stored anywhere on the disk or in the backup file the password hash is used for verification purposes With this two level security the backup data is protected from any unauthorized access but recovering a lost password is not possible Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 91 3 4 1 2 Source files exclusion This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media This option is effective for disk level backup of NTFS and FAT file systems only This option is effective for file level backup of all supported file systems The option defines which files and folders to skip during the backup process and thus exclude from the list of backed up items The preset is Exclude files matching the following criteria tmp bak To specify which files and folders to exclude Set up any of the following parameters e Exclude all hidden files and folders Select this check box to skip files and folders with the Hidden attribute If a folder is Hidden all of its contents including files that are not Hidden will be excluded e Exclude all system files an
360. logs while processing silent mode The preset is Disabled With the silent mode enabled the program will automatically handle situations requiring user interaction except for handling bad sectors which is defined as a separate option If an operation cannot continue without user interaction it will fail Details of the operation including errors if any can be found in the operation log Re attempt if an error occurs The preset is Enabled Number of attempts 5 Interval between attempts 30 seconds When a recoverable error occurs the program re attempts to perform the unsuccessful operation You can set the time interval and the number of attempts The attempts will be stopped as soon as the operation succeeds OR the specified number of attempts is performed depending on which comes first For example if the backup destination on the network becomes unavailable or not reachable the program will attempt to reach the destination every 30 seconds but no more than 5 times The attempts will be stopped as soon as the connection is resumed OR the specified number of attempts is performed depending on which comes first Ignore bad sectors The preset is Disabled When the option is disabled the program will display a pop up window each time it comes across a bad sector and ask for a user decision as to whether to continue or stop the backup procedure In order to back up the valid information on a rapidly dying disk enable i
361. lt e To back up data to a local folder on the machine expand the Local folders group and click the required folder 198 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e To back up data to a network share expand the Network folders group select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder If the network share requires access credentials the program will ask for them Note for Linux users To specify a Common Internet File System CIFS network share which is mounted ona mount point such as mnt share select this mount point instead of the network share itself nN ______________ ll _____________________________________________________________l________________________T_____________________fl________N________v_____ ________________ _ _____________________ e To back up data to an FTP or SFTP server type the server name or address in the Path field as follows ftp ftp_server port number or sftp sftp_server port number If the port number is not specified port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP After entering access credentials the folders on the server become available Click the appropriate folder on the server You can access the server as an anonymous user if the server enables such access To do so click Use anonymous access instead of entering credentials As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred _ through a network as pla
362. ludes the file named test log located in the folder C Finance Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 325 Excludes all log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my 7 2 5 Archive Specify where to store the archives and define names for the new backup archives 1 Selecting the archives destination Choose where to store machines archives e Store all machines archives in a single location o To store archives in a centralized vault expand the Centralized group and click the vault o To store archives on a network share expand the Network folders group then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder If the network share requires access credentials the program will ask for them o To store archives on an FTP or SFTP server expand the corresponding group and reach the appropriate server then select the folder that will be used for storing archives nee eee eee eee me eee ee alee a alee a aaa ee aaa alee ae aaa aaa a ae aaa aaa ae alae a al aaa aaa aa aaa a eee alae alee alesse ieleiermmmnrererere _ As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred _ through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an eavesdropper using a packet sniffer e Store each machine s archive in the specified folder on the machine Enter the full path to the folder in the
363. luding files that are not System will be excluded You can view file or folder attributes in the file folder properties or by using the attrib command For more _ information refer to the Help and Support Center in Windows e Exclude files matching the following criteria Select this check box to skip files whose names match any of the criteria called file masks in the list use the Add Edit Remove and Remove All buttons to create the list of file masks You can use one or more wildcard characters and ina file mask The asterisk substitutes for zero or more characters in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc txt and Document txt The question mark substitutes for exactly one character in a file name for example the file mask Doc txt yields files such as Doc1 txt and Docs txt but not the files Doc txt or Doc11 txt Exclusion examples By name File1 log Excludes all files named File1 log By path C Finance test log Excludes the file named test log located in the folder C Finance Mask Excludes all files with the log extension Mask my log Excludes all log files with names consisting of five symbols and starting with my The above settings are not effective for the files or folders that were explicitly selected for recovery For example assume that you selected the folder MyFolder and the file MyFile tmp outside that folder and selected to sk
364. lumes of the selected disk including hidden volumes such as the vendor s maintenance partitions and the zero track with the master boot record Linux A volume backup stores all files and folders of the selected volume independent of their attributes a boot record and the file system super block A disk backup stores all disk volumes as well as the zero track with the master boot record 6 2 4 2 Selecting files and folders To select files and or folders for backing up 1 Expand the local folders tree items in order to view its nested folders and files 2 Select an item by checking the corresponding check box in the tree Selecting a check box for a folder means that all its content files and folders will be backed up That is also the case for new files that will appear there in the future A file based backup is not sufficient for recovery of the operating system In order to recover your operating _ system you have to perform a disk backup Use the table in the right part of the window to browse and select the nested items Selecting the check box beside the Name column s header automatically selects all items in the table Clearing this check box automatically deselects all items 3 Click OK 6 2 5 Access credentials for source Specify the credentials required for access to the data you are going to backup To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the plan s credentials The program will acc
365. ly if deduplication is enabled Encryption p 128 Optional Select whether to protect the vault with encryption Anything written to the vault will be encrypted and anything read from it will be decrypted transparently by the storage node using a vault specific encryption key stored on the storage node After you have performed all the required steps click OK to commit creating the managed vault Vault path To specify the path where the managed vault will be created 1 Enter the full path to the folder in the Path field or select the desired folder in the folders tree Managed vaults can be organized Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 127 o onthe hard drives local to the storage node o ona network share o Ona Storage Area Network SAN o on a Network Attached Storage NAS o ona tape library locally attached to the storage node To create a new folder for the vault in the selected location click ES Create folder 2 Click OK A vault can be created in an empty folder only We do not recommend creating a deduplicating managed vault on a FAT32 volume The reason is that such vault stores all deduplicated items in two potentially large files Because the maximum file size in the FAT file systems is limited to 4 GB the storage node may stop working when this limit is reached Vault database path To specify the path where the vault s database will be created 1 In the Local folders of the storage node se
366. ly when operating under bootable media The preset is Disabled Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 111 When the option is enabled Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will restart the machine after the backup process is completed For example if the machine boots from a hard disk drive by default and you select this check box the machine will be restarted and the operating system will start as soon as the bootable agent has finished creating the backup Deduplicate the backup only after transferring it to the vault do not deduplicate at source This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media when the backup destination is a deduplicating vault The preset is Disabled Enabling this option turns off deduplicating backups at source meaning that deduplication will be performed by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node after the backup is saved to the vault this is called deduplication at target Turning off deduplication at source may lead to faster backup processes but greater network traffic and heavier load of the storage node The eventual size of the backup in the vault is independent of whether deduplication at source is turned on Deduplication at source and deduplication at target are described in Deduplication overview p 64 3 4 2 Default recovery options Each Acronis agent has its own default recovery options Once an agent is installed the default options have pre de
367. m of the page In the Backup type field select whether you want to create a full incremental or differential backup p 28 6 2 9 2 Back up later scheme With the Back up later scheme the backup will be performed only once at the date and time you specify Specify the appropriate settings as follows Backup type Select the type of backup full incremental or differential If there is no full backup in the archive a full backup will be created regardless of your selection Date and time Specify when to start the backup The task will be Select this check box if you do not need to put the backup task on a schedule and started manually wish to start it manually afterwards 6 2 9 3 Simple scheme With the simple backup scheme you just schedule when and how often to back up data and set the retention rule At the first time a full backup will be created The next backups will be incremental To set up the simple backup scheme specify the appropriate settings as follows Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 201 Backup Set up the backup schedule when and how often to back up the data To learn more about setting up the schedule see the Scheduling p 161 section Retention rule With the simple scheme only one retention rule p 38 is available Set the retention period for the backups 6 2 9 4 Grandfather Father Son scheme At a glance e Daily incremental weekly differential and monthly full backups e Custom day
368. mber a for the first disk b for the second disk etc 322 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e Partition number on the disk 1 for the first partition 2 for the second partition etc To guarantee backing up selected disks regardless of their type consider including three entries in the Volumes to back up selection rules dialog box one for each possible type For example to back up the first hard disk of each Linux machine under a centralized policy you may want to type the following lines in the Volume field dev hda1 dev sda1 dev mda1 ieee Files to back up selection rules Define file selection rules according to which the files and or folders will be backed up on the machines the policy will be applied to To define file selection rules In the first line select the rule from the list or type it manually To add another rule click the next empty line and select the rule from the list or type it manually The program remembers the rules typed manually and the next time you open the window these rules will be available for selection in the list along with the default ones Windows Full path Point to the folders and files to be backed up If you specified a path to a file or folder explicitly the policy will back up this item on each machine where this exact path will be found To include In the Files and folders column type or select File Text doc in folder D Work Text doc D Work Folder C Win
369. media Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 103 The option defines how a backup can be split The preset is Automatic The following settings are available Automatic With this setting Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 will act as follows e When backing up to a hard disk A single backup file will be created if the destination disk s file system allows the estimated file size The backup will automatically be split into several files if the destination disk s file system does not allow the estimated file size Such might be the case when the backup is placed on FAT16 and FAT32 file systems that have a 4GB file size limit If the destination disk runs out of free space while creating the backup the task enters the Need interaction state You have the ability to free additional space and retry the operation If you do so the resulting backup will be split into the parts created before and after the retry e When backing up to removable media CD DVD or a tape device locally attached to the managed machine The task will enter the Need interaction state and ask for a new media when the previous one is full Fixed size Enter the desired file size or select it from the drop down list The backup will then be split into multiple files of the specified size This comes in handy when creating a backup that you plan to burn to multiple CDs or DVDs later on You might also want to split the backup destined to an FTP server since
370. ment server updates the policy on all machines the policy was deployed to Click 2 Delete As a result the policy will be revoked from the machines it was deployed to and deleted from the management server If the machine is currently offline the policy will be revoked when the machine comes online again Click View details In the Policy details p 279 window examine information on the selected policy There you can also revoke the policy from the machines or groups the policy is applied to Click fa View tasks The Tasks p 300 view will display a list of the tasks related to the selected policy Click l View log The Log p 302 view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected policy Click J Refresh The management console will update the list of backup policies from the management server with the most recent information Though the list of policies is refreshed automatically based on events the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed Machines selection To apply the backup policy to machines or to groups of machines 1 Choose whether to apply the selected backup policy to 278 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 o Groups In the group tree select the group s the policy will be applied to The right part of the window lists the machines of the selected group o In
371. meter select Backup policies in the tree The Deployment state column displays the cumulative deployment state for each policy This state is defined as a combination of deployment states of the policy on all machines the policy is applied to directly or through inheritance If the policy is currently not applied to any machine it does not have a deployment state and the column shows Not applied For example you applied the policy to machine A The policy was successfully deployed Then you modify the policy and immediately apply it to the group consisting of machines B and C The policy has to be updated on A and deployed to B and C While the processes take place the policy s cumulative state may look like Updating Deploying then change to Updating Deployed or Deployed Deploying and will normally end up with Deployed The cumulative status of a backup policy To see this parameter select Backup policies in the tree The Status column displays the cumulative status for each policy This status is defined as the most severe status of the policy on all machines the policy is applied to If the policy is not applied to any machine its status is OK 2 11 6 Deduplication This section describes deduplication a mechanism designed to eliminate data repetition by storing identical data in archives only once 2 11 6 1 Overview Deduplication is the process of minimizing storage space taken by the data by detecting data r
372. mly generated key with a user defined size of 128 192 or 256 bits The larger the key size the longer it will take for the program to encrypt the archives stored in the vault and the more secure the archives will be 128 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The encryption key is then encrypted with AES 256 using a SHA 256 hash of the password as a key The password itself is not stored anywhere on the disk the password hash is used for verification purposes With this two level security the archives are protected from any unauthorized access but recovering a lost password is not possible 4 1 2 2 Creating an unmanaged centralized vault To create an unmanaged centralized vault perform the following steps Vault Name Specify a unique name for the vault The creation of two centralized vaults with the same name is prohibited Comments Enter the distinctive description of the vault Type Select the Unmanaged type Path p 129 Specify where the vault will be created After you have performed all the required steps click OK to commit creating the unmanaged centralized vault Vault path To specify the path where the managed vault will be created 1 Enter the full path to the folder in the Path field or select the desired folder in the folders tree Unmanaged vaults can be organized o ona network share o Ona Storage Area Network SAN o on a Network Attached Storage NAS o on FTP and SFTP servers As appe
373. mong the tapes 2 Some combinations of tape options might degrade usage efficiency of both the whole tape library and each _ tape If you are not forced to modify these options by some specific needs leave them unchanged An archive can occupy several tapes In such cases a so called tape set is used for keeping the data backups Tape set is a logical group of one or more tapes which contain backups of the specific protected data A tape set can contain backups of other data as well Separate tape set is a tape set which contains only backups of the specific protected data Other backups cannot be written to a separate tape set For the backup policy plan to be created Use a separate tape set The preset is Disabled If you leave this option unchanged then the backups belonging to the policy or plan being created might be written onto tapes containing backups written by different backup policies and comprising of data from different machines Similarly backups from other policies might be written onto the tapes containing this policy s backups You will not have a problem with such tapes as the program manages all the tapes automatically When this option is enabled the backups belonging to the policy or plan being created will be located on a separate tape set Other backups will not be written to this tape set If the console is connected to the management server The Use a separate tape set option has more precise defini
374. monthly backup and delete all monthly backups that are older than you specify The monthly backups retention period cannot be less than the weekly backups retention period It is usually set several times longer You have the option to keep the monthly backups infinitely The resulting archive ideal Assume you select to keep daily backups for 7 days weekly backups for 2 weeks and monthly backups for 6 months Here is how your archive would appear after the backup plan is launched if all the backups were full and so could be deleted as soon as the scheme requires The left column shows days of the week For each day of the week the content of the archive after the regular backup and the subsequent cleanup is shown D stands for the backup that is considered Daily W stands for the backup that is considered Weekly M stands for the backup that is considered Monthly 34 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 ev Pe a Sa Bo ee rs a Jv em ve Pe Fa vo w e J Total D DOD Ww D DDbBODW D D D W D D M schedule lon D Te D D We D D Thu OF D D D mi D D D DO W Sal D D W Sn D DB D OD W Mon Doo W ia D Tue DoD OWS ae 0 D We Dw D D D Thu Wu gt D D D D Fri We SDODDW Sal w 8D DOD W Sun ws yo 000 W Man Woy D D D W D Tue D D W D D We W D W D D D Thu W W D D D D Fri W D DOD W Sal W D D D D W Sun W D DOD W Mon W D DDW D Tug W D D W D D We W D wW D D Thu WW W D
375. months Specifies when to apply the retention rules p 38 For example the cleanup procedure can be set up to run after each backup and also on schedule This option is available only if you have set at least one retention rule in Retention rules Specifies a schedule for archive cleanup For example the cleanup can be scheduled to start on the last day of each month This option is available only if you selected On schedule in Apply the rules The following scheme yields a full backup performed every Friday night Full backup Schedule Weekly every Friday at 10 00 PM Here all parameters except Schedule in Full backup are left empty All backups in the archive are kept indefinitely no archive cleanup is performed Full and incremental backup plus cleanup With the following scheme the archive will consist of weekly full backups and daily incremental backups We further require that a full backup begin only after all users have logged off Full backup Schedule Weekly every Friday at 10 00 PM Full backup Conditions User is logged off Incremental Schedule Weekly every workday at 9 00 PM Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 335 Also let all backups older than one year be deleted from the archive and let the cleanup be performed upon creating a new backup Retention rules Delete backups older than 12 months Apply the rules After backing up By default a one year old full backup will not be delet
376. mp Recovery 10 Management Console p 21 on the machine from which you prefer to operate We recommend that you use the console that installs on Windows if you have a choice between Windows and Linux console distributions Install Acronis Bootable Media Builder Start the console Create the bootable media Connect the console to the management server Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The simplified way of centralized management e Backup Using the Back up control select the machine which you want to back up and then create a backup plan p 340 on the machine You can create backup plans on multiple machines in turn e Recovery Using the Recover control select the machine where the data recovery is required and create a recovery task on the machine You can create recovery tasks on multiple machines in turn To recover the entire machine or the operating system that fails to start use the bootable media p 341 You cannot control operations under bootable media using the management server but you can disconnect the console from the server and connect it to the machine booted from the media e Managing plans and tasks To manage the plans and tasks existing on the registered machines select Machines gt All machines in the Navigation tree and then select each machine in turn The Information pane below shows the state and the details of plans and tasks existing on each machine and enables you to start stop edit and d
377. mponents cccsssscecsssseceeessseeesssseeeesssseeeeesssaeeees 306 7 2 Creatine a Dd CKUD DON CY cirri 318 7 2 1 Poly erede nt ai iepa E E tou suscecnueauasesentvest 319 7 2 2 RENTS Opak UDe a O seve sown anid ode canadien ocuas tu ucecaner tented adds 320 7 2 3 ACCESS ChEGenitldls TOF SOURCC onnon E a nl aaah is N Me tion puese ul ee 324 7 2 4 EM CLES OVS adase es Seca va Toca cs E oe linen eed a ict hacia coastaathess se denied duis suldia shia eaeean 325 7 2 5 Are Gronna ana a tsa tics gic NOA a A 326 7 2 6 Access credentials TOr location rean A R 327 7 2 7 BACKUP scheme selection ra csaseserveaddsccsveteusedconsaus r AN NANN AN voeaseee 327 7 2 8 AGEINVE validati onanesdata ana o a a a aao a tarde 337 GIOSS ANY cccrsoresranisen a E EEE E E EE EEE 338 1 Introducing Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 1 1 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 overview Based on Acronis patented disk imaging and bare metal restore technologies Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 succeeds Acronis True Image Echo as the next generation disaster recovery solution Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Advanced Workstation inherits the benefits of the Acronis True Image Echo product family e Backup of an entire disk or volume including the operating system all applications and data e Bare metal recovery to any hardware e File and folder backup and recovery e Scalability from a single machine to an enterprise e Centralized management for dist
378. n To make certain of your selection check the task information gathered in tabs at the bottom of the window This information is also duplicated in the Task details p 187 window 2 Click OK Temporarily disabling a backup plan Temporarily disabling a backup plan is needed when moving archives from one vault to another by means of the third party file manager Applies to backup plans that use custom backup schemes only To disable a backup plan 1 Click Edit 2 Enter the backup scheme scheduling option and disable the schedule for the desired period by changing the Start date and or End date parameters Task details The Task details window also duplicated on the Information panel aggregates all information on the selected task When a task requires user interaction a message and action buttons appear above the tabs The message contains a brief description of the problem The buttons allow you to retry or stop the task or the backup plan Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 187 Types of tasks Task name Backup disk Backup file Backup virtual machine Recovery disk Recovery file Recovery volume Recovery MBR Recovery disk to existing VM Recovery disk to new VM Recovery existing VM Recovery new VM Validation archive Validation backup Validation vault Cleanup ASZ creation ASZ management Disk management Compacting Description Backing up disks and volumes
379. n p 340 Rules that define when and how often to perform validation p 351 and whether to validate the entire archive p 339 or the latest backup in the archive Vault A place for storing backup archives p 339 A vault can be organized on a local or networked drive or detachable media such as an external USB drive There are no settings for limiting a vault size or the number of backups in a vault You can limit the size of each archive using cleanup p 343 but the total size of archives stored in the vault is limited by the storage size only Virtual machine On Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server a machine p 347 is considered virtual if it can be backed up from the virtualization host without installing an agent p 339 on the machine A virtual machine appears on the management server after registration of the virtualization server that hosts the machine provided that Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent for virtual machines is installed on that server W WinPE Windows Preinstallation Environment A minimal Windows system based on any of the following kernels e Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 2 PE 1 5 e Windows Server 2003 with Service Pack 1 PE 1 6 e Windows Vista PE 2 0 e Windows Vista SP1 and Windows Server 2008 PE 2 1 WinPE is commonly used by OEMs and corporations for deployment test diagnostic and system repair purposes A machine can be booted into WinPE via PXE CD R
380. n Apply the rules The following scheme yields a full backup performed every Friday night Full backup Schedule Weekly every Friday at 10 00 PM Here all parameters except Schedule in Full backup are left empty All backups in the archive are kept indefinitely no archive cleanup is performed 208 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Full and incremental backup plus cleanup With the following scheme the archive will consist of weekly full backups and daily incremental backups We further require that a full backup begin only after all users have logged off Full backup Schedule Weekly every Friday at 10 00 PM Full backup Conditions User is logged off Incremental Schedule Weekly every workday at 9 00 PM Also let all backups older than one year be deleted from the archive and let the cleanup be performed upon creating a new backup Retention rules Delete backups older than 12 months Apply the rules After backing up By default a one year old full backup will not be deleted until all incremental backups that depend on it become subject to deletion too For more information see Retention rules p 38 Monthly full weekly differential and daily incremental backups plus cleanup This example demonstrates the use of all options available in the Custom scheme Suppose that we need a scheme that will produce monthly full backups weekly differential backups and daily incremental backups Then the backup schedule
381. n be managed through the management server only since a well thought out policy functions automatically and rarely requires human intervention Using the management server you can create one or more centralized archive storages centralized vaults p 342 which will be shared by the registered machines A centralized vault can be used by any backup policy as well as by any backup plan created on the registered machines using direct management Organizing a managed archive storage What should the capacity of your centralized vault be What if transferring sizeable backups to the vault will cause network congestion Does backup of an online production server affect the server performance To ensure that the centralized backup will not slow down business processes in your company and to minimize the resources required for the data protection you install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node p 350 and configure it to manage a centralized vault or multiple centralized vaults Such vaults are called managed vaults p 348 The storage node helps the agent deduplicate p 343 backups before transferring them to managed vaults and deduplicates the backups already saved in the vaults Deduplication results in reducing backup traffic and saving storage space The storage node also undertakes operations with archives such as validation and cleanup which otherwise are performed by the agent and thus relieves the managed machines from unnece
382. n be thought of as a kind of bootable media too You can create bootable media or configure the PXE server or WDS RIS using the same wizard 242 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Linux based bootable media Linux based media contains Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Bootable Agent based on Linux kernel The agent can boot and perform operations on any PC compatible hardware including bare metal and machines with corrupted or non supported file systems The operations can be configured and controlled either locally or remotely using the management console PE based bootable media PE based bootable media contains a minimal Windows system called Windows Preinstallation Environment WinPE and Acronis Plug in for WinPE that is a modification of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent that can run in the preinstallation environment WinPE proved to be the most convenient bootable solution in large environments with heterogeneous hardware Advantages e Using Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 in Windows Preinstallation Environment provides more functionality than using Linux based bootable media Having booted PC compatible hardware into WinPE you can use not only Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent but also PE commands and scripts and other plug ins you ve added to the PE e PE based bootable media helps overcome some Linux related bootable media issues such as support for certain RAID controllers or certain levels of RAID arrays onl
383. n enables you to use the restore to dissimilar hardware functionality on the machine where the agent is installed and create bootable media with this functionality Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for Windows start up such as storage controllers motherboard or chipset 1 3 1 2 Deduplication This add on enables the agent to back up data to deduplicating vaults managed by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node 1 3 2 Bootable components and media builder Bootable components of the agent enable operations with reboot such as recovery of the volume containing the currently active operating system Once the operations are completed the machine boots into the operating system again The bootable components are based on the Linux kernel You can choose not to install the bootable components and perform operations that require reboot using bootable media Acronis Bootable Media Builder is a dedicated tool for creating bootable media p 341 containing the bootable components The media builder delivered with Agent for Windows creates bootable media that represents volumes and network in the Windows like style C D server share The Universal Restore add on enables you to use the restore to dissimilar hardware functionality on the machine where the agent is installed and create bootable media with this functionality Universal Restore handles differences in devices that are critical for Windows s
384. n from midnight Effective From 09 15 2009 If September 15 2009 is the current date of the task s creation and say 01 15 PM is the task s creation time the task will be started when the nearest time interval comes at 03 00 PM in our example To 12 15 2009 On this date the task will be performed for the last time but the task itself is still available in the Tasks view Several daily schedules for one task There are some cases when you might need the task to be run several times a day or even several times a day with different time intervals For such cases consider adding several schedules to a single task For example suppose that the task has to be run every 3rd day starting from 09 20 2009 five times a day e first at 8 AM e second at 12 PM noon e third at3 PM e fourth at 5 PM e fifth at 7PM Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 163 The obvious way is to add five simple schedules If you spend one minute for examination you can think out a more optimal way As you can see the time interval between the first and the second task s recurrences is 4 hours and between the third fourth and fifth is 2 hours In this case the optimal way is to add two schedules to the task First daily schedule 1 Every 3 day s 2 Every 4 hours From 08 00 00 AM Until 12 00 00 PM 3 Effective From 09 20 2009 To not set Second daily schedule 1 Every 3 day s 2 Every 2 hour s From 03 00 00 P
385. n panel Group Displays the following information on the group Name name of the selected group Parent group for subgroups only name of the parent group Machines number of machines in the group Type type of the group static or dynamic Criteria for dynamic groups only grouping criteria Comments the group description if specified Backup policies Displays a list of backup policies related to the group and allows performing the following operations To Do View details of a policy Click View details In the Policy details p 279 window examine all information related to the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 295 selected backup policy View tasks of a policy Click fa View tasks The Tasks p 300 view will display a list of the tasks related to the selected backup policy View log of a policy Click t5 View log The Log p 302 view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected backup policy Revoke a policy from the Click Revoke group The management server revokes the policy from the group While the changes are being transferred to the machines and the agents are deleting the backup plans the policy state of the group is Revoking The policy itself remains on the management server Examine where the policy Click amp Explore inheritance applied to the group came fron The Inheritance order p 296 window will display the inheritance order of the po
386. n that was set previously 1 2 1 4 Main area views and action pages The main area is a basic place where you work with the console Here you create edit and manage backup plans policies tasks and perform other operations The main area displays different views and action pages according the items you select in the menu Navigation tree or on the Actions and Tools pane Views A view appears on the main area when clicking any item in the Navigation tree in the Navigation pane p 11 14 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Arani fae fog Rint ore 1 i ted Fra Hachi CLeeal Cate iin Weve Pete Mr Me Taji Backup plans and tasks JE Mihai EJ Orhtewd i G Bsdup plans ard teda 7s FSA D HE vais Byra ai Dentin tate ebs Typa Gra ag i a Ded maragement pen Al Al AI E ge hesia Sianas 22348 nie D BIiuppen Laa E Chern LHA OAOT S a ice ice Ter Local RP Laca matra Machine 1 2 Diferenta hacia iie ce Bskup fie Local Pull babi eth Cac Becki hie Leal Irreal Bachu Iie E ecu Me Local Task fo vabision at Tice Cx Wake stir a Local Task for yakdeton dte Idle ce Waldation far Local ide ox Tadam yi Loca gt Ei E n I a Settings Mame Myvebdation_t Schedule Scheduled thee lds Lae ren Tea Vaden yak Lasi Gee ee hrr Ongn Local Gerar Tasks view Common way of
387. n the Backup plans and tasks view Continue executing the backup plan The plan s tasks will be executed on schedule as though the failure did not occur 108 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 In addition the program can try to execute the failed task again Select the Restart a failed task check box and specify the number of attempts and the time interval between the attempts The program stops trying as soon as an attempt completes successfully OR the specified number of attempts is performed depending on which comes first d Failed Failed Succeded ide Running Idle Running Idle Task state Interval between attempts j Failed Failed Falled Failed Running Idle Running Idle Task state j If the task fails because of a mistake in the backup plan you can edit the plan while the task is in the Idle state _ While the task is running you have to stop it prior to editing the backup plan 3 4 1 20 Tape options These options are effective when the backup destination is a managed vault located on a tape library Tape options enable you to specify how the backup tasks will distribute backups among the tapes Some combinations of tape options might degrade usage efficiency of both the whole tape library and each tape If you are not forced to modify these options by some specific needs leave them unchanged An archive can occupy several tapes In such cases a so called tape set is used for keeping t
388. n the toolbar click Connect then point to New connection and then click Manage a remote machine 2 In Machine type or select the name or IP address of the remote machine to which you want to connect or click Browse to select the machine from the list 3 To specify credentials for connection click Options and then type the user name and password in the User name and Password boxes respectively In Windows if you leave the User name box empty the credentials under which the console is running will be used 4 To save the password for the specified user name select the Save password check box the password will be saved in a secure storage on the machine where the console is running 2 11 7 2 Privileges for local connection Local connection on a machine running Windows can be established by any user who has the Log on locally user right on the machine 2 11 7 3 Privileges for remote connection in Windows To establish a remote connection to a machine running Windows the user must be a member of the Acronis Remote Users security group on that machine After remote connection is established the user has management rights on the remote machine as described in User rights on a managed machine p 30 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 69 Note On a remote machine running Windows Vista with enabled User Account Control UAC and which is not part of a domain only members of the Administrators group can back up data T
389. naged vaults only deduplication p 64 state On Off e for managed vaults only encryption state Yes No Vault content The Vault content section contains the archives table and toolbar The archives table displays archives and backups that are stored in the vault Use the archives toolbar to perform actions on the selected archives and backups The list of backups is expanded by clicking the plus sign to the left of the archive s name All the archives are grouped by type on the following tabs e The Disk archives tab lists all the archives that contain disk or volume backups images e The File archives tab lists all the archives that contain file backups Related sections Operations with archives stored in a vault p 157 Operations with backups p 158 Filtering and sorting archives p 159 Bars of the Actions and tools pane e Vault Name The Actions bar is available when clicking the vault in the vaults tree Duplicates actions of the vault s toolbar e Archive Name The Actions bar is available when you select an archive in the archives table Duplicates actions of the archives toolbar e Backup Name The Actions bar is available when you expand the archive and click on any of its backups Duplicates actions of the archives toolbar 4 1 2 Actions on centralized vaults All the operations described here are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the vaults toolbar These operations can be also a
390. ndows 2000 OR Windows 2003 b Entries of different criteria are combined by logical multiplication AND For example the following set of criteria Operating system Windows Server 2008 Operating system Windows Server 2003 Organizational unit SERVERS IP range 192 168 17 0 192 168 17 55 will add to the same group all the machines whose operating system is Windows 2000 or Windows 2003 and belong to the SERVERS organizational unit and whose IP addresses are within the range 192 168 17 0 192 168 17 55 How long does a dynamic group member remain in the group A dynamic group member remains in the group as long as the member meets the criteria The member is removed from the group automatically as soon as e the member changes so that it no longer meets the criteria e the administrator changes the criteria so that the member no longer meets the criteria There is no way to remove a machine from a dynamic group manually except for deleting the machine from the management server Organizational unit criterion Organizational unit criterion is specified for the domain the management server is currently in as follows OU OU1 For example suppose that the domain us corp example com has OU1 which is in the root OU1 has OU2 and OU2 has OU3 And you need to add the machines of OU3 So the criterion will be OU 0U3 OU OU2 OU OU1 If OU3 has child containers and you also need to add the machines of those containers to the group selec
391. nected to the managed machine Choos the action to perium of the tool to use To J Machina i2 Check for ar andl ree Shans panagaie to the Dechiooand view E babord Baca piss aed besks HE tais Ling pn Dirk manet Shastruts 4 Rigserecer Actions E vadite Back up Ea Create personal vault P j raa drr Tar Ta aa Jeahe a backup plan to protect cata on the machine ep Crete Arons Seomra zoma g Reon Becca Die data Mom 2 badag archive created by your Backo piyi cy wu J Local machine Machine Z gt Mount image td Paar Pi aed Tools Pp Create bootable meds od valha Ee Cente paricama vail Manage mane peg MB rei arois components Rin Arani Accents oe Pireo Eoee Burn Aroni Aatireiry Ii M Create Airan Cecin Pane ated ON i Lt i A z Pirie arrin Tools ig Liga big mar Curae a Ceeate bootable reeds p Fal ten Aireak Beceeery or Hirer SOL terver iy feel oll Arrar eres 2 j age lene E h J 2 Een Arrali Berien lor Microcall Fir daii ie Dirt ma P 9 L me itu deer thea Doria rl of thee cue ea ee Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console Welcome screen 10 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Key elements of the console workspace Name Description ep Navigation pane Contains the Navigation tree and the Shortcuts bar and lets you navigate to the different views see the Navigation pane p 11 section g Actions and tools pane Contains ba
392. ned above will be updated accordingly 3 1 2 Pop up messages About tasks that need interaction This option is effective when the console is connected to a managed machine or to the management server The option defines whether to display the pop up window when one or more tasks require user interaction This window enables you to specify your decision such as to confirm reboot or to retry after freeing up the disk space on all the tasks in the same place Until at least one task requires interaction you can open this window at any time from the managed machine s Dashboard Alternatively you can review the task execution states in the Tasks view and specify you decision on each task in the Information pane The preset is Enabled To make a selection select or clear the Pop up the Tasks Need Interaction window check box About the task execution results This option is effective only when the console is connected to a managed machine Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 82 The option defines whether to display the pop up messages about task run results successful completion failure or success with warnings When displaying of pop up messages is disabled you can review the task execution states and results in the Tasks view The preset is Enabled for all results To make a setting for each result successful completion failure or success with warnings individually select or clear the respective check box 3 1 3
393. need to take out only a few files and folders from a volume backup you do not have to perform the recovery procedure Exploring images Exploring mounted volumes lets you view and modify if mounted in the read write mode the volume s content To explore a mounted volume select it in the table and click Q Explore The default file manager window opens allowing the user to examine the mounted volume contents Unmounting images Maintaining the mounted volumes takes considerable system resources It is recommended that you unmount the volumes after the necessary operations are completed If not unmounted manually a volume will remain mounted until the operating system restarts To unmount an image select it in the table and click Unmount To unmount all the mounted volumes click Ea Unmount all 6 7 Acronis Secure Zone Acronis Secure Zone is a secure partition that enables keeping backup archives on a managed machine disk space and therefore recovery of a disk to the same disk where the backup resides Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 237 Certain Windows applications such as Acronis disk management tools can access the zone To learn more about the advantages and limitations of the Acronis Secure Zone see the Acronis Secure Zone p 46 topic in the Proprietary Acronis technologies section 6 7 1 Creating Acronis Secure Zone You can create Acronis Secure Zone while the operating system is running or using bootab
394. nes to the server Once the storage node is added to the management server you will be able to create managed vaults on the node Click 4 Remove Once the storage node is removed from the management server the vaults being managed by the storage node disappear from the vault list p 122 and become unavailable for performing operations All the plans and tasks that use these vaults will fail All the databases and vaults of this storage node remain untouched It is possible to add the previously removed storage node to the management server again As a result all the vaults managed by the storage node will appear in the vault list and become available once again for all the plans and tasks that used these vaults Click re Create vault The Create managed vault page p 127 will be opened with the pre selected storage node Perform the remaining steps to create the vault After deleting backups from deduplicating vaults either manually or during cleanup unreferenced data may appear in the deduplicating vaults and their databases The compacting procedure deletes such data in order to free up more storage space Only one compacting task is available per storage node Click Reschedule compacting In the Schedule window set up the schedule for the compacting procedure Only the time events daily p 162 weekly p 164 and monthly p 167 schedules are available for setting up The preset is Start the task every 1 week on
395. nfiguration Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server has not been backed up for X day s Create now Show list View the machines Install Acronis components Back up now agent will stop working until a successful license check The alert is displayed if at least one centralized vault has less than 10 free space View vaults will take you to the Centralized vaults p 124 view where you can examine the vault size free space content and take the necessary steps to increase the free space To be able to recover an operating system when the machine fails to boot you must 1 Back up the system volume and the boot volume if it is different 2 Create at least one bootable media p 341 Create now will launch the Bootable Media Builder p 348 The Dashboard warns you that no data was backed up on some of the registered machines for a period of time To configure the length of time that is considered critical select Options gt Console options gt Time based alerts The Dashboard warns you that no connection was established between some of the registered machines and the management server for a period of time thus indicating that the machines might not be centrally managed Click View the machines to open the Machines view with the list of machines filtered by the Last connect field To configure the length of time that is considered critical select Options gt Console options gt Tim
396. ng of a system volume on a machine at the startup the operating system runs from the first disk discovers the same signature on the second one automatically generates a new unique NT signature and assigns it to the second disk As a result all the volumes _ on the second disk will lose their letters all paths will be invalid on the disk and programs won t find their files i The operating system on that disk will be unbootable To retain system bootability on the target disk volume choose one of the following e Create new The program will generate a new NT signature for the target hard disk drive Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 217 e Recover from backup The program will replace the NT signature of the target hard disk with one from the disk backup Recovering the disk signature may be desirable due to the following reasons o Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 creates scheduled tasks using the signature of the source hard disk If you recover the same disk signature you don t need to re create or edit the tasks created previously o Some installed applications use disk signature for licensing and other purposes o Enables to keep all the Windows Restore Points on the recovered disk o to recover VSS snapshots used by Windows Vista s Previous Versions feature e Keep existing The program will leave the existing NT signature of the target hard disk as is 6 3 6 2 Volumes Available volume destinations depend on th
397. nistrators can connect to the management server by using Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console they have the same management rights on the registered machines as users with administrative privileges on those machines regardless of the contents of Acronis security groups there To be able to connect to the management server remotely an administrator of the management server must also be a member of the Acronis Remote Users group No user even a member of the Administrators group can be an administrator of the management server without being a member of the Acronis Centralized Admins group By default this group includes all members of the Administrators group Acronis Remote Users A user who is a member of this group can connect to the management server remotely by using Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console provided that the user is also a member of the Acronis Centralized Admins group By default this group includes all members of the Administrators group 70 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 On a domain controller If a machine is a domain controller in an Active Directory domain the names and default contents of Acronis security groups are different e Instead of Acronis Remote Users and Acronis Centralized Admins the groups are named DCNAME Acronis Remote Users and DCNAME Acronis Centralized Admins respectively here DCNAME stands for the NetBIOS name of the domain controller Each do
398. nmanaged vaults rename and delete the existing ones Storage nodes Use this view to manage storage nodes Add a storage node to be able to create centralized vaults that will be managed by the node E Tasks Use this view to manage tasks run edit stop and delete tasks monitor their states examine task history Log Use this view to examine the history of centralized management operations such as creating a managed entities group applying a policy managing a centralized vault as well as the history of operations logged in the local logs of the registered machines and the storage nodes Shortcuts bar The Shortcuts bar appears under the navigation tree It offers you an easy and convenient way of connection to the machines in demand by adding them as shortcuts To add a shortcut to a machine I 2 Connect the console to a managed machine In the navigation tree right click the machine s name a root element of the navigation tree and then select Create shortcut If the console and agent are installed on the same machine the shortcut to this machine will be added to the shortcuts bar automatically as Local machine Machine name If the console has ever been connected to Acronis Management Server the shortcut is added automatically as AMS Machine name 1 2 1 2 Actions and tools pane The Actions and tools pane enables you to easily and efficiently work with Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 The pane s bars provi
399. nnot continue without user interaction it will fail Details of the operation including errors if any can be found in the operation log Re attempt if an error occurs The preset is Enabled Number of attempts 5 Interval between attempts 30 seconds When a recoverable error occurs the program re attempts to perform the unsuccessful operation You can set the time interval and the number of attempts The attempts will be stopped as soon as the operation succeeds OR the specified number of attempts is performed depending on which comes first For example if the network location becomes unavailable or not reachable the program will attempt to reach the location every 30 seconds but no more than five times The attempts will be stopped as soon as the connection is resumed OR the specified number of attempts is performed depending on which comes first 3 4 2 7 Additional settings Specify the additional settings for the recovery operation by selecting or clearing the following check boxes Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 119 Set current date and time for recovered files This option is effective only when recovering files The preset is Enabled This option defines whether to recover the files date and time from the archive or assign the files the current date and time Validate backup before recovery The preset is Disabled This option defines whether to validate a backup to ensure that the backup is not corrupted
400. ns except for archive and backup deletion can be performed without creating vaults The operation of creating a vault results in adding the vault name to the Vaults section of the Navigation pane Centralized and personal vaults A centralized vault is a networked location allotted by the management server administrator to serve as storage for the backup archives A centralized vault can be managed by a storage node managed vault or be unmanaged Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 122 A vault is called personal if it was created using direct connection of the console to a managed machine Personal vaults are specific for each managed machine Way of working with the Vaults view E Vaults on the navigation pane top element of the vaults tree Click this item to display groups of centralized and personal vaults F centralized This group is available when the console is connected to a managed machine or to a management server Expand this group to display a list of centralized vaults added by the management server administrator Click any centralized vault in the vaults tree to open the detailed view of this vault p 124 and to take actions on the vault p 125 archives p 157 and backups p 158 stored in there FS Personal This group is available when the console is connected to a managed machine Expand this group to display a list of personal vaults created on the managed machine Click any personal vault in the v
401. nt backups can be deleted as well For more information see Retention rules p 38 Resulting tasks Any custom scheme always produces three backup tasks and in case the retention rules are specified a cleanup task Each task is listed in the list of tasks either as Scheduled if the schedule has been set up or as Manual if the schedule has not been set up You can manually run any backup task or cleanup task at any time regardless of whether it has a schedule In the first of the previous examples we set up a schedule only for full backups However the scheme will still result in three backup tasks enabling you to manually start a backup of any type e Full backup runs every Friday at 10 00 PM e Incremental backup runs manually e Differential backup runs manually You can run any of these backup tasks by selecting it from the list of tasks in the Backup plans and tasks section in the left pane If you have also specified the retention rules in your backup scheme the scheme will result in four tasks three backup tasks and one cleanup task 6 2 10 Archive validation Set up the validation task to check if the backed up data is recoverable If the backup could not pass the validation successfully the validation task fails and the backup plan gets the Error status To set up validation specify the following parameters 1 When to validate select when to perform the validation As the validation is a resource in
402. ntains two settings Trace State Description Specifies whether to collect the log entries about Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components events from the registered machines Possible values True or False Default value True Trace Level Description Specifies the minimum level of severity of collected entries Only entries of levels greater than or equal to the value in Trace Level will be collected Possible values 0 Internal event 1 Debugging information 2 Information 3 Warning 4 Error or 5 Critical error Default value 0 all entries will be collected Windows Event Log Specifies when to record Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server s events into the Application event log in Windows This parameter has two settings Trace State Description Specifies whether to record Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server s events into the event log Possible values True or False Default value False Trace Level Description Specifies the minimum level of severity of events to be recorded into the event log Only events of levels greater than or equal to the value in Trace Level will be recorded Possible values 0 Internal event 1 Debugging information 2 Information 3 Warning 4 Error or 5 Critical error Default value 4 only errors and critical errors will be recorded if Trace State is set to True SNMP 310 Specifies the parameters for sending notifications a
403. ntral server that drives data protection within the enterprise network Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server provides the administrator with e asingle entry point to the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 infrastructure e an easy way to protect data on numerous machines p 347 using backup policies p 340 and grouping e enterprise wide monitoring functionality e the ability to create centralized vaults p 342 for storing enterprise backup archives p 339 e the ability to manage storage nodes p 350 If there are multiple management servers on the network they operate independently manage different machines and use different centralized vaults for storing archives Media builder A dedicated tool for creating bootable media p 341 348 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 D Personal vault A local or networked vault p 352 created using direct management p 344 Once a personal vault is created a shortcut to it appears under the Personal vaults item of the Navigation pane Multiple machines can use the same physical location for example a network share as a personal vault Physical machine On Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server a physical machine is the same as a registered machine p 349 A virtual machine is considered physical if an Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent is installed on the machine and the machine is registered on the management server Plan See Backup pl
404. nts Tracking the plans execution on each machine separately is also time consuming To be able to propagate the management operations to multiple machines you install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server p 348 and register p 349 the machines on the server After that you can create groups of machines and thus manage multiple machines as a whole You can protect all of them or your selection by setting up a common backup plan which is called a backup policy p 340 Once you apply the policy to a group of machines the management server deploys the policy to each of the machines On each machine the agents find the items to back up and create corresponding centralized backup plans p 342 You will be able to monitor the policies statuses on a single screen and navigate if required to each machine plan or task to see their status and log entries The management server also enables you to monitor and manage the agent s locally originated activities Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 51 Since you connect the console to the management server rather than to each machine and perform all management operations through the central management unit this way of management is called centralized management p 342 Centralized management does not rule out the direct management p 344 of each machine You can connect the console to each machine and perform any direct management operation However centralized backup plans ca
405. nts the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency Manual Refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed Creating a custom static or dynamic group To create a group 1 Inthe Group name field enter a name for the group being created 2 Choose the type of group a Static to create a group that will contain machines added manually b Dynamic to create a group that will contain machines added automatically according to the specified criteria Click the Add criteria and select the criterion pattern e Operating system All the machines running the selected operating system will be members of the dynamic group e Organizational unit p 294 All the machines belonging to the specified organizational unit OU will be members of the dynamic group e IP range All the machines whose IP addresses are within the specified IP range will be members of the dynamic group 3 Inthe Comments field enter a description of the created group 4 Click OK Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 293 Adding multiple criteria Adding multiple criteria forms a condition according to the following rules a All the entries of the same criteria are combined by logical addition OR For example the following set of criteria Operating system Windows Server 2008 Operating system Windows Server 2003 will add to the same group all the machines whose operating system is Wi
406. ny integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value 200 A vault s free space is the amount of free space on the medium such as a disk volume that stores the vault When the amount of free space in a vault is equal to the value in Vault Free Space Warning Limit or less a warning is recorded in the storage node s log indicating the vault in question You can view storage node warnings in the Dashboard Vault Free Space Warning Percentage Description Specifies the amount of free space in a managed vault as a percentage of its total size below which a warning is recorded in the storage node s log Possible values Any integer number between 0 and 100 Default value 10 The total size of a vault is the vault s free space plus the size of all archives that are contained in the vault For example suppose that two vaults Vault A and Vault B are both stored on a disk volume Suppose further that the size of the archives in Vault A is 20 GB and the size of the archives in Vault B is 45 GB If the volume has 5 GB of free space then the total size of Vault A is 20 GB 5 GB 25 GB and that of Vault B is 45 GB 5 GB 50 GB regardless of the size of the volume The percentage of free space in a vault is the vault s free space divided by the vault s total size In the previous example Vault A has 5GB 25GB 20 of free space and VaultB has 5 GB 50 GB 10 of free space When the percentage of free space in a vault is equal
407. o Remove the reason of the failure After that you may want to start the failed task manually to maintain the backup scheme consistency for example if the policy uses the GFS or Tower of Hanoi backup scheme o Edit the backup policy to prevent future failure Use the Activities section of the Dashboard to quickly access the error log entries What to do if a policy has the Warning status 1 To find out the reason of the warning do one or more of the following o Click the Warning hyperlink to see the log entry of the latest warning o Select the policy and click View tasks Check the tasks that have Succeeded with warnings as their last result select a task and then click View log This approach comes in handy if the policy state is Deployed that is the policies tasks already exist on the managed machines o Select the policy and click View log Check the warning log entries to find out the reason for the warnings select a log entry and then click View details This approach comes in handy if the policy has warnings while being deployed revoked or updated In the Tasks view apply the Last result gt Succeeded with warnings filter if there are too many tasks You can also sort the tasks succeeded with warnings by backup plans or by machines In the Log view apply the Warning amp filter if there are too many log entries You can also sort the warning entries by backup plans managed entities or machines
408. o overcome the restriction include the machine into a domain or disable UAC on the machine by default UAC is enabled For information about Acronis security groups and their default members see Acronis security groups p 70 2 11 7 4 Acronis security groups On a machine running Windows Acronis security groups determine who can manage the machine remotely and act as Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server administrator These groups are created when Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agents or Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server are being installed During installation you can specify what users to include in each group Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agents When Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows is being installed on a machine the Acronis Remote Users group is created or updated A user who is a member of this group can manage the machine remotely by using Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console according to the management rights described in Users privileges on a managed machine p 30 By default this group includes all members of the Administrators group Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server When Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server is being installed on a machine two groups are created or updated Acronis Centralized Admins A user who is a member of this group is a management server administrator Management server admi
409. o recover data to bare metal you boot the machine using the bootable media and configure the recovery operation in the same way as the recovery task The following diagram illustrates the recovery using the bootable media Managed Machine Vault lA b gt Bootable Agent i ESN Archive 1 F Backup 2 F Backup 0 Restore ati D Backup 3 operation Solaa Restore Data from backup acKup Backup 4 2 2 Full incremental and differential backups Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the capability to use popular backup schemes such as Grandfather Father Son and Tower of Hanoi as well as to create custom backup schemes All backup schemes are based on full incremental and differential backup methods The term scheme in fact denotes the algorithm of applying these methods plus the algorithm of the archive cleanup Comparing backup methods with each other does not make much sense because the methods work as a team in a backup scheme Each method should play its specific role according to its advantages A competent backup scheme will benefit from the advantages of all backup methods and lessen the influence of all the methods shortcomings For example weekly differential backup facilitates archive cleanup because it can be easily deleted along with the weekly set of daily incremental backups depending on it Backing up with the full incremental or differential backup method results in a backup p 339 of the c
410. og entries Task Click View log You will be taken to the Log p 190 view containing the list of the task related log entries Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Run a plan task Backup plan Click f Run In the Run Backup Plan p 187 window select the task you need to run Running the backup plan starts the selected task of that plan immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions Task Click f Run The task will be executed immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions Stop a plan task Backup plan Click Stop Stopping the running backup plan stops all its tasks Thus all the task operations will be aborted Task Click l Stop What will happen if I stop the task Generally stopping the task aborts its operation backup recovery validation exporting conversion migration The task enters the Stopping state first then becomes Idle The task schedule if created remains valid To complete the operation you will have to run the task again recovery task from the disk backup The target volume will be deleted and its space unallocated you will get the same result if the recovery is unsuccessful To recover the lost volume you will have to run the task once again recovery task from the file backup The aborted operation may cause changes in the destination folder Some files may be recovered but some not depending when you stopped the task To recover all the files you will
411. olicy status on all No action is required Note that if a backup policy is not machines is OK applied to any machine its state is also OK 276 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 What to do if a policy has the Error status 1 To find out the reason of the failure do one or more of the following o Click the Error hyperlink to see the log entry of the latest occurred error o Select the policy and click View tasks Check the tasks that have Failed as their last result select a task and then click View log Select a log entry and then click View details This approach comes in handy if the policy state is Deployed that is the policies tasks already exist on the managed machines o Select the policy and click View log Check the error log entries to find out the reason of the failure select a log entry and then click View details This approach comes in handy if the policy has errors while being deployed revoked or updated eee ee ee ee eee a ee a eS ee ee ee aa a aaa aa a ale aaa aaa lela am am ma eae am am ame aa a a a G _ In the Tasks view apply the Last result gt Failed filter if there are too many tasks You can also sort the failed tasks by backup plans or by machines I In the Log view apply the Error filter if there are too many log entries You can also sort the error entries by backup plans managed entities or machines 2 Once the reason of the failure is clear do one or more of the following
412. olumes p 218 Files p 221 You may have to specify credentials for the destination Skip this step when operating on a machine booted with bootable media Access credentials p 223 Optional Provide credentials for the destination if the task credentials do not enable recovery of the selected data To access this option select the Advanced view check box When to recover Recover p 223 Select when to start recovery The task can start immediately after its creation be scheduled for a specified date and time in the future or simply saved for manual execution Optional Acronis Universal Restore Applies to Windows OS and system volume recovery Universal Restore p 223 Use the Acronis Universal Restore when you need to recover and boot up Windows on dissimilar hardware Automatic drivers search Specify where the program should search for HAL mass storage and network adapter drivers Acronis Universal Restore will install drivers that better fit the target hardware Mass storage drivers to install anyway Optional Specify the mass storage drivers manually if the automatic drivers search has not found the appropriate drivers To access this option select the Advanced view check box 212 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Recovery options Settings Optional Customize the recovery operation by configuring the recovery options such as pre post recovery commands recovery priority error handling or notif
413. on between the management server and the machine is established after adding the machine or starting the management server s service o Withdrawn the machine was registered on another management server or the Stand alone management parameter is selected in the Options gt Machine options gt Machine management p 86 As a result it is not possible to control the machine from the current management server However you are able to regain control over the machine by specifying the management server address in the Machine management settings e Installed agents full name of Acronis agents installed on the machine e Operating system the operating system the machine s agent runs e Processor the type of CPU used in the managed machine e CPU clock clock rate of the CPU e RAM memory size e Comments the machine s description taken from the Computer description in Windows Backup policies Displays a list of backup policies applied to the selected machine and lets the management server administrator perform the following operations To Do View details of a policy Click View details In the Policy details p 279 window examine all information related to the selected backup policy View tasks of a policy Click Ea View tasks The Tasks p 300 view will display a list of the tasks related to the selected backup policy View log of a policy Click t View log Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 287 Revok
414. on if possible and to trust self signed SSL certificates see the following option Enabled Encryption is enabled In Encryption select one of the following Enabled Data transfer will be encrypted if encryption is enabled on the server application otherwise it will be unencrypted Disabled Encryption is disabled any connection to a server application which requires encryption will not be established Required Data transfer will be performed only if encryption is enabled on the server application see Server Encryption options it will be encrypted Authentication parameters Selecting the Trust self signed certificates check box allows the client to connect to the server applications that use self signed SSL certificates such as certificates created during the installation of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components see SSL certificates p 79 You should keep this check box selected unless you have a Public Key Infrastructure PKI in your environment In Use Agent Certificate Authentication select one of the following Do not use The use of SSL certificates is disabled Any connection to a server application which requires the use of SSL certificates will not be established Use if possible The use of SSL certificates is enabled The client will use SSL certificates if their use is enabled on the server application and will not use them otherwise Always use The use of SSL certificates is enabled Th
415. on of when and why you need to organize groups of machines can be found in the Grouping the registered machines p 56 section Here are some scenarios supported by the aforementioned Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 implementation 2 11 2 1 Protecting the servers You will most likely create individual backup plans on each of the servers depending on their roles But it is necessary to perform a full backup of the entire server at least once You might want to back up the server during a maintenance window or backup window after installing or updating software before relocation etc In our example there is no need to back up entire servers on a regular basis You can manually delete old backups since they are not numerous 1 Create a policy that backs up All Volumes to the managed vault on the storage node Choose Back up later manual start and Full backup type 2 Create a static group named say S_1 Add all the servers to this group A storage node can be added in case the managed vault is not on the local node s drives Otherwise the archive storage will be backed up to itself 54 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Apply the policy to the S_1 group Make sure that the policy has been successfully deployed to each of the servers The policy deployment state has to change from Deploying to Deployed and its status has to be OK To see the resulting backup plans on each of the servers a navigate to the All machines group or th
416. on to the current date System view The System view section shows summarized statistics of registered machines tasks backup policies and centralized backup plans Click the items in these sections except for centralized backup plans to obtain the relevant information This will take you to the appropriate view with pre filtered machines tasks or backup policies respectively For instance if you click Idle under Tasks the Tasks view will be opened with tasks filtered by the Idle state Information presented in the System view section is refreshed every time the management server synchronizes with the machines Information in other sections is refreshed every 10 minutes and every time you access the Dashboard Vaults The Vaults section displays information about centralized managed vaults You can sort vaults by name or by used space In some cases information about free space in a vault might be not available for example if the vault is located on a tape library If the vault itself is not available offline the Vault is not available message will be displayed 7 1 2 Backup policies To be able to manage and protect multiple machines as a whole you can create a backup plan template called a backup policy By applying this template to a group of machines you will deploy multiple backup plans with a single action Backup policies exist only on the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server You do not have to conne
417. once at 9 PM Combining the identical times the following three schedules can be added to the task First schedule Every 1 week s on Mon Fri Every 9 hours From 12 00 00 PM Until 09 00 00 PM Effective From not set To not set Second schedule Every 1 week s on Tue Wed Thu Every 3 hours From 09 00 00 AM until 09 00 00 PM Effective From not set To not set Third schedule 166 Every 1 week s on Sat Sun Once at 09 00 00 PM Effective From not set To not set Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 5 3 Monthly schedule Monthly schedule is effective in Windows and Linux operating systems To specify a monthly schedule In the Schedule area select the appropriate parameter as follows Months lt gt Select a certain month s you want to run the task in Days lt gt Select specific days of the month to run the task on You can also select the last day of the month irrespective of its actual date On lt gt lt gt Select specific days of the weeks to run the task on In the During the day execute the task area select one of the following Once at lt gt Set up the time at which the task will be run once Every lt gt Set up how many times the task will be run during the specified time interval For example setting the task frequency to Every 1 hour From 10 00 00 AM until 10 00 00 PM allows the task to be run 12 times from 10 AM to 10
418. ons as follows o Types of events to send choose the types of events All events Errors and warnings or Errors only o Server name IP type the name or IP address of the host running the SNMP management application the messages will be sent to o Community type the name of the SNMP community to which both the host running SNMP management application and the sending machine belong The typical community is public To disable sending SNMP messages clear the Send messages to SNMP server check box The messages are sent over UDP The next section contains additional information about Setting up SNMP services on the receiving machine p 88 3 3 2 3 Setting up SNMP services on the receiving machine Windows To install the SNMP service on a machine running Windows Start gt Control Panel gt Add or Remove Programs gt Add Remove Windows Components Select Management and Monitoring Tools Click Details Select the Simple Network Management Protocol check box Click OK ee ES FE You might be asked for Immib2 dll that can be found on the installation disc of your operating system Linux To receive SNMP messages on a machine running Linux the net snmp for RHEL and SUSE or the snmpd for Debian package has to be installed SNMP can be configured using the snmpconf command The default configuration files are located in the etc snmp directory e etc snmp snmpd conf configuration file for the Net SNM
419. opyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 4 1 2 1 Creating a managed centralized vault To create a managed centralized vault perform the following steps Vault Name Specify a unique name for the vault Creation of two centralized vaults with the same name is prohibited Comments Optional Enter the distinctive description of the vault being created Type Select the Managed type Storage node Select the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node that will manage the vault You may need to enter access credentials for the storage node Path p 127 Specify where the vault will be created Managed centralized vaults can reside on a network share SAN NAS or on a hard drive local to the storage node Database path p 128 Specify a local folder on the storage server to create a vault specific database This database will store the metadata required for cataloguing the archives and performing deduplication Deduplication Optional Select whether to enable archive deduplication in the vault Deduplication minimizes storage space taken by the archives and backup traffic It reduces the size of archives in the vault by eliminating redundant data such as duplicate files or disk blocks Deduplication is not possible on tape devices To learn more about how deduplication works see the Deduplication p 64 section Compression Optional Select whether to compress the deduplication data store This setting is available on
420. or Acronis Startup Recovery Manager If the system fails to boot you will be able to start the bootable rescue utility by pressing F11 Acronis Startup Recovery Manager activation overwrites the Master Boot Record MBR with its own boot code You will have to reactivate third party boot loaders if installed Under Linux consider installing the LILO or GRUB loader to a Linux root or boot partition boot record instead of the MBR before activation Otherwise reconfigure these boot loaders manually after activation Do not activate Disables boot time prompt Press F11 for Acronis Startup Recovery Manager If Acronis Startup Recovery Manager is not activated you will need one of the following to recover the system when it fails to boot e boot the machine from a separate bootable rescue media e use network boot from Acronis PXE Server or Microsoft Remote Installation Services RIS See the Bootable media p 242 section for details 6 7 1 5 Result confirmation The Result confirmation window displays the expected partition layout according to the settings you have chosen Click OK if you are satisfied with the layout and the Acronis Secure Zone creation will start How the settings you make will be processed This helps you to understand how creating the Acronis Secure Zone will transform a disk containing multiple volumes e Acronis Secure Zone is always created at the end of the hard disk When calculatin
421. or field type the machine s or the organizational unit name then click 2 Search You can use the asterisk to substitute for zero or more characters in a machine or an organizational unit name The left part of the window displays the machine or organizational unit names that fully or just partly coincide with the entered value Click the item you want to add for import then click Add gt gt The item will be moved to the right part of the window To add all the found items click Add all gt gt The right part of the window displays the items you selected for import If required remove the erroneously selected items by using the respective 2 Remove and Remove all buttons 4 Click OK to start import Importing machines from a text file To import machines from a file 1 Inthe Navigation tree select Physical machines or a All physical machines 2 Click ie Import machines from Active Directory on the toolbar 3 In the Path field enter a path to the txt or csv file or click browse and select the file in the Browse window A txt or csv file should contain machine names or their IP addresses beginning from a new line for each of the machines Example Machine name 1 Machine name 2 192 168 1 14 192 168 s1 15 4 Click OK to start import Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 285 Policy selection To apply the backup policy to the selected machine group 1 From the list select the back
422. or machines registered on Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server To specify these settings click Change in the Advanced settings area All the settings you made are displayed in the Result field at the bottom of the window Examples One day in the week schedule Run the task every Friday at 10PM starting from a certain date say 05 14 2009 and ending after six months The schedule s parameters are thus set up as follows 1 Every 1 week s on Fri 2 Once at 10 00 00 PM 3 Effective From 05 13 2009 The task will be started on the nearest Friday at 10 PM To 11 13 2009 The task will be performed for the last time on this date but the task itself will still be available in the Tasks view after this date If this date were not a Friday the task would be last performed on the last Friday preceding this date This schedule is widely used when creating a custom backup scheme The One day in the week like schedule is added to the full backups while the incremental backups are scheduled to be performed on workdays For more details see the Full and incremental backups plus cleanup example in the Custom backup scheme p 208 section Workdays schedule Run the task every week on workdays from Monday through Friday During a workday the task starts only once at 9 PM The schedule s parameters are thus set up as follows 1 Every 1 week s on lt Workdays gt selecting the lt Workdays gt chec
423. orm real time monitoring of registered machines instead of using a polling mechanism Possible values True or False Default value False By default Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server connects to registered machines to perform synchronization in particular to retrieve data such as backup logs This approach is known as a polling mechanism lf Real Time Monitoring is set to True the management server instead sends requests to machines to provide new data whenever it will appear and then enters a listening mode This approach is called real time monitoring Real time monitoring may reduce network traffic for example when centralized backup tasks run infrequently However it is effective only when there are relatively few registered machines Avoid enabling real time monitoring if the number of registered machines exceeds the maximum number of simultaneous connections see Maximum Connections earlier in this topic Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Second Connection Attempt Description Specifies whether to try to connect to a registered machine by using its last known IP address after an attempt to connect to it by using its host name has failed Possible values True or False Default value False When connecting to a registered machine Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server first uses the machine s network name provided that the machine was added to the management server by name If S
424. orresponding type Full backup A full backup stores all data selected for backup A full backup underlies any archive and forms the base for incremental and differential backups An archive can contain multiple full backups or consist of only full backups A full backup is self sufficient you do not need access to any other backup to recover data from a full backup 28 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 It is widely accepted that a full backup is the slowest to do but the fastest to restore With Acronis technologies recovery from an incremental backup may be not slower than recovery from a full one A full backup is most useful when e you need to roll back the system to its initial state e this initial state does not change often so there is no need for regular backup Example An Internet cafe school or university lab where the administrator often undoes changes made by the students or guests but rarely updates the reference backup in fact after installing software updates only The backup time is not crucial in this case and the recovery time will be minimal when recovering the systems from the full backup The administrator can have several copies of the full backup for additional reliability Incremental backup An incremental backup stores changes to the data against the latest backup You need access to other backups from the same archive to recover data from an incremental backup An incremental backup is most useful
425. orting backup plans and tasks Sort backup plans and tasks Click the column s header to sort the backup plans and tasks in ascending by name state status type order origin etc Click it once again to sort the plans and tasks in descending order 186 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Filter plans tasks by name or Type a plan s task s name or an owner s name in the field below the owner corresponding header name As a result you will see the list of tasks whose names owners names fully or just partly coincide with the entered value Filter plans and tasks by In the field below the corresponding header select the required value from State status type origin the list last result schedule Configuring backup plans and the tasks table By default the table has six columns that are displayed others are hidden If required you can hide the displayed columns and show hidden ones To show or hide columns 1 Right click any column header to open the context menu The menu items that are ticked off correspond to column headers presented in the table 2 Click the items you want to be displayed hidden Run backup plan The backup plan is considered as running if at least one of its tasks is running The Run backup plan window lets you run the task of the selected backup plan manually in spite of its schedule To run a task of the selected backup plan 1 Select the task of the backup plan you need to ru
426. ory p 136 e Rescan p 137 e Labeling p 137 Any user with access to a managed vault on a tape library is able to perform these operations However two or more users cannot manage a tape library drive simultaneously because some operations can take minutes hours or even days For example if a user launches a tape library Rescan task all other users requests to perform the same task will be canceled automatically as it is already running on the vault Inventory A storage node needs information about a tape in its own database to be able to operate with the tape So after the vault is created generally the next step is to inventory tapes Inventorying is a procedure that allows the storage node recognize tapes that are currently loaded into the tape library slots It is relatively fast and normally requires reading the cartridge barcodes without reading the tape data If a barcode cannot be read the tape will be mounted to read its GUID identifier only The Inventory procedure can be run manually by a user or automatically when access to recently added tapes is required To launch the procedure select the tape library vault in the Navigation pane of the console click Manage tapes and then click Start inventory on the Tape Management window When inventorying is completed a user has the list of tapes currently loaded into the library 136 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Perform the procedure every time you load new
427. ossible e Do not create a snapshot Always back up files directly Administrator or Backup Operator privileges are not required Trying to back up files that are opened for exclusive access will result in a read error Files in the backup may be not time consistent 3 4 1 6 Multi volume snapshot This option is effective only for Windows operating systems This option applies to disk level backup This option also applies to file level backup when the file level backup is performed by taking a snapshot The File level backup snapshot p 97 option determines whether a snapshot will be taken during file level backup The option determines whether to take snapshots of multiple volumes at the same time or one by one The preset is Enable When this option is set to Enable snapshots of all volumes being backed up will be created simultaneously Use this option to create a time consistent backup of data spanned across multiple volumes for instance for an Oracle database When this option is set to Disable the volumes snapshots will be taken one after the other As a result if the data spans across several volumes the resulting backup may be not consistent 3 4 1 7 Volume Shadow Copy Service This option is effective only for Windows operating systems The option defines whether Microsoft Volume Shadow Copy Service VSS has to notify VSS aware applications that the backup is about to start The preset is Disable Microso
428. ount does not have access permissions to the data To access this option select the Advanced view check box Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 193 Exclusions p 197 Optional Set up exclusions for the specific types of files you do not wish to back up To access this option select the Advanced view check box Where to back up Archive p 198 Specify path to the location where the backup archive will be stored and the archive name It is advisable that the archive name be unique within the location The default archive name is Archive N where N is the sequence number of the archive in the location you have selected Access credentials p 200 Optional Provide credentials for the location if the plan account does not have access permissions to the location To access this option select the Advanced view check box Archive comments Optional Enter comments on the archive To access this option select the Advanced view check box How to back up Backup scheme p 200 Specify when and how often to back up your data define for how long to keep the created backup archives in the selected location set up schedule for the archive cleanup procedure Use well known optimized backup schemes such as Grandfather Father Son and Tower of Hanoi create a custom backup scheme or back up data once Archive validation When to validate p 210 Optional Define when and how often to perform validation and whether to valid
429. our password specify another account or change the scheduled start to manual 6 2 2 Backup plan s credentials Provide the credentials for the account under which the plan s tasks will run To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Run under the current user The tasks will run under the credentials with which the user who starts the tasks is logged on If any of the tasks has to run on schedule you will be asked for the current user s password on completing the plan creation o Use the following credentials The tasks will always run under the credentials you specify whether started manually or executed on schedule Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK To learn more about operations available depending on the user privileges see the Users privileges on a managed machine p 30 section 6 2 3 Source type Select the type of data you want to be backed up on the managed machine The list of available data types depends on the agents managing on the machine Files Available if the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or for Linux is installed Select this option to back up specific files and folders If you are not concerned about recovery of the operating system along with all the settings and applications
430. ox 2 Select General gt Plan s Task credentials gt Change 3 Enter the credentials under which the plan task will run Scheduled or postponed start The plan task credentials are mandatory If you skip the credentials step you will be asked for credentials after finishing the plan task creation Why does the program compel me to specify credentials A scheduled or postponed task has to run anyway regardless if any user is logged on or not for example the system is at the Windows Welcome screen or a user other than the task owner is logged on It is sufficient that the machine be on that is not in standby or hibernate at the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 31 scheduled task start time That s why the Acronis scheduler needs the explicitly specified credentials to be able to start the task 2 5 GFS backup scheme This section covers implementation of the Grandfather Father Son GFS backup scheme in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 With this backup scheme you are not allowed to back up more often than once a day The scheme enables you to mark out the daily weekly and monthly cycles in your daily backup schedule and set the retention periods for the daily monthly and weekly backups The daily backups are referred to as sons weekly backups are referred to as fathers the longest lived monthly backups are called grandfathers GFS as a tape rotation scheme GFS was initially created an
431. p 71 3 Add p 299 the storage node to the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server 4 Create a managed vault p 127 specify the path to the vault select the storage node that will manage the vault and select the management operations such as deduplication or encryption 5 Create a backup policy p 318 or a backup plan that will use the managed vault 7 1 4 1 Actions on storage nodes All the operations described here are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the toolbar The operations can be also accessed from the Storage nodes bar on the Actions and tools pane and from the Storage nodes item of the main menu To perform an operation with a storage node added to the management server first select the storage node The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with storage nodes Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 297 To Add a storage node to the management server Remove a storage node from the management server Create a centralized managed vault on the selected storage node Change the compacting task schedule View details of the storage node Refresh the list of storage nodes 298 Do Click amp amp Add In the Add storage node p 299 window specify the machine the storage node is installed on Adding a storage node establishes a trusted relationship between the management server and the storage node in the same way as when you add machi
432. p plan e Schedule whether the task is scheduled or set to start manually e Last backup how much time has passed since the last backup e Creation backup plan creation date e Comments description of the plan if provided Source The Source tab provides the following information on the data selected for backup e Source type the type of data p 195 selected for backing up e Items to back up items selected to back up and their size Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 189 Destination The Destination tab provides the following information e Location name of the vault or path to the folder where the archive is stored e Archive name name of the archive e Archive comments comments on the archive if provided Settings The Settings tab displays the following information e Backup scheme the selected backup scheme and all its settings with schedules e Validation if selected events before or after which the validation is performed and validation schedule e Backup options backup options changed against the default values 6 1 3 Log The Log stores the history of operations performed by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 on the machine or actions a user takes on the machine using the program For instance when a user edits a task the respective entry is added to the log When the program executes a task it adds multiple entries With the log you can examine operations results of
433. p plan for each machine The plan will back up the volumes you specify e Register the virtual appliance Agent for ESX on the management server All virtual machines except for the virtual appliance will appear in the All virtual machines group You can group these machines and apply any policy that backs up disks or volumes to them e Install Agent for Windows or Agent for Linux on each virtual machine Register the machines on the management server The machines will be considered as physical machines You can apply a backup policy to these machines or create a backup plan on each machine separately If any of the machines meets membership criteria set for a dynamic group of physical machines the machine will be protected by the policy applied to this group Advanced product editions other than Virtual Edition Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Advanced Server Advanced Server SBS Edition and Advanced Workstation allow using only the last of the above methods 2 11 3 Grouping the registered machines As soon as a machine is registered p 349 on the management server the machine appears in the All machines built in group p 341 By applying a backup policy to this group you protect all the registered machines The thing is that a single policy may not be satisfactory because of the different roles of the machines The backed up data is specific for each department some data has to be backed up frequently other twice a year so you m
434. pe Low quality or old tape as well as dirt on the magnetic head might lead to pauses that can last up to several minutes Limitations 1 Multiple full backups within one archive are not supported 2 Individual files cannot be recovered from a disk backup 3 Backups cannot be deleted from a tape either manually or automatically during cleanup Retention rules and backup schemes that use automatic cleanup GFS Tower of Hanoi are disabled in the GUI when backing up to a locally attached tape 4 Personal vaults cannot be created on tape devices 5 Because the presence of an operating system cannot be detected in a backup located on a tape Acronis Universal Restore p 351 is proposed at every disk or volume recovery even when recovering a Linux or non system Windows volume 6 Acronis Active Restore p 338 is not available when recovering from a tape Recovery from a locally attached tape device Before creating a recovery task insert or mount the tape containing the backup you need to recover When creating a recovery task select the tape device from the list of available locations and then select the backup After recovery is started you will be prompted for other tapes if the tapes are needed for recovery Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 45 2 10 Proprietary Acronis technologies This section describes the proprietary technologies inherited by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 from Acronis True Image Echo and Acron
435. pe is dismounted and ejected from the drive into a slot by the loader Further a free tape is loaded into the same drive and mounted and then the backup last 24 Gb is continued onto the beginning of the new tape The next figure demonstrates the data backup archive at the moment The differential backup is drawn as a blue rectangle in the figure Number 1 in the green rectangle marks the incremental backup created on Monday of the 1st week of the year ig 01 GA 02 aaa aaa aaa Then the following backups are written onto tape 02 e four incremental and one differential backup on the second week e four incremental and one differential backup on the third week e four incremental backups on the 4th week The next full backup 320 Gb should be written on Friday of the 4th week However tape 02 has only 104 Gb of free space at the moment So after the tape reaches the end the recording continues from the beginning of free tape 03 Bal t Pe S S T A s s T T W i E ee 142 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Keep in mind that the Cleanup task is launched after each backup operation for the GFS scheme This task deletes all the outdated backups The next figure shows dark gray rectangles instead of the backups deleted up to the current time m a Gy 02 Gy OS Physically the deleted backups are still on the tapes however information about the backups is deleted from the storage node database Below the figure shows the del
436. peration configure it from scratch 5 The log lifetime is limited to the current session You can save the entire log or the filtered log entries to a file 6 Centralized vaults are not displayed in the folder tree of the Archive window To access a managed vault type the following string in the Path field bsp node_address vault_name To access an unmanaged centralized vault type the full path to the vault s folder After entering access credentials you will see a list of archives located in the vault 6 8 4 List of commands and utilities available in Linux based bootable media Linux based bootable media contains the following commands and command line utilities which you can use when running a command shell To start the command shell press CTRL tALT F2 while in the bootable media s management console 250 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Acronis command line utilities e Acronis asamba e lash e trueimagecmd e trueimagemnt Linux commands and utilities busybox cat carecord chmod chown chroot Cp dd df dmesg dmraid e2fsck e2label echo egrep fdisk fsck fxload gawk gpm grep growisofs Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 ifconfig init insmod iscsiadm kill kpartx In ls lspci lvm mc mdadm mkdir mke2fs mknod mkswap more mount mtx mv parted pcecardctl readcd reboot rm rmmod route scp scsi id sed sg map26 sh sleep ssh sshd strace swapoff sw
437. perations available depending on the user privileges see the User privileges on a managed machine p 30 section 6 4 2 Archive selection Selecting the archive 1 Enter the full path to the location in the Path field or select the desired folder in the folders tree o Ifthe archive is stored in a centralized vault expand the Centralized group and click the vault o Ifthe archive is stored in a personal vault expand the Personal group and click the vault o If the archive is stored in a local folder on the machine expand the Local folders group and click the required folder If the archive is located on removable media e g DVDs first insert the last DVD and then insert discs in _ order starting from the first one when the program prompts o If the archive is stored on a network share expand the Network folders group then select the required networked machine and then click the shared folder If the network share requires access credentials the program will ask for them _mount point such as mnt share select this mount point instead of the network share itself o Ifthe archive is stored on an FTP or SFTP server type the server name or address in the Path field as follows ftp ftp_server port number or sftp sftp_server port number If the port number is not specified port 21 is used for FTP and port 22 is used for SFTP After entering access credentials the folders on the server become available Click the
438. ply a specific label for a tape for example MyWork label for a tape dedicated to back up files from the folder C work instead of a barcode label use the Labeling procedure as well To launch the procedure select the tape library vault in the Navigation pane of the console and click Manage tapes on the toolbar Then the Tape Management window will show a list of the library slots Every slot in the window has an assigned data field that contains information about the tape associated with the slot or about the slot that is empty If a slot has a tape from the Acronis pool the slot data field indicates the tape label By default an unused tape with a barcode will get a label that is equal to the barcode If a barcode is absent or corrupted the label name will be created automatically The user can accept proposed labels or provide their own label as a plain text To define your own label for a tape select a related data field type in a new label click Eject tape write the same label on the tape cartridge to make association with the label and insert it back into the same slot Once all the required tape labels are specified press Set labels to store labels in the storage node database Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 137 4 1 3 7 Tape options These options are effective when the backup destination is a managed vault located on a tape library Tape options enable you to specify how the backup tasks will distribute backups a
439. ports o Client Encryption options o Server Encryption options For the new communication settings to take effect restart all running Acronis components preferably by restarting Windows If restart is not possible make sure you do the following o If Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console is running close it and start it again o If other Acronis components such as Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows or Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server are running restart their correspondent services from the Services snap in in Windows Remote Agent ports Specifies the port that the component will use for incoming and outgoing communication with other Acronis components Select one of the following Not configured The component will use the default TCP port number 9876 Enabled The component will use the specified port type the port number in the Server TCP Port box Disabled The same as Not configured For details about the network port and instructions on how to specify it in Linux and a bootable environment see Network port configuration p 77 Client Encryption options Specifies whether to encrypt the transferred data when the component acts as a client application and whether to trust self signed SSL certificates Select one of the following Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 75 Not configured The component will use the default settings which is to use encrypti
440. propriate settings as follows Backup Set up the backup schedule when and how often to back up the data To learn more about setting up the schedule see the Scheduling p 161 section Retention rule With the simple scheme only one retention rule p 38 is available Set the retention 328 period for the backups Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 7 2 7 4 Grandfather Father Son scheme At a glance e Daily incremental weekly differential and monthly full backups e Custom day for weekly and monthly backups e Custom retention periods for backups of each type Description Let us suppose that we want to set up a backup plan that will regularly produce a series of daily D weekly W and monthly M backups Here is a natural way to do this the following table shows a sample two month period for such a plan ee Pe oP so Jan 1 Jan 7 meme To fo fe fo moma To fo fe fo mown To fo fe fo e oo ofa ema p pee e ole ole erm ole ol a femme be Daily backups run every workday except Friday which is left for weekly and monthly backups Monthly backups run every fourth Friday and weekly backups run on all other Fridays e Monthly Grandfather backups are full e Weekly Father backups are differential e Daily Son backups are incremental Parameters You can set up the following parameters of a Grandfather Father Son GFS scheme Start backup at Specifies when to start a backup The
441. r processes e High to maximize the backup process speed by taking resources from other processes HDD writing speed This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media This option is available when an internal fixed hard disk of the machine being backed up is selected as the backup destination Backing up to a fixed hard disk for example to Acronis Secure Zone may slow performance of the operating system and applications because of the large amounts of data that needs to be written to the disk You can limit the hard disk usage by the backup process to the desired level The preset is Maximum To set the desired HDD writing speed for backup Do any of the following Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 99 e Click Writing speed stated as a percentage of the maximum speed of the destination hard disk and then drag the slider or select a percentage in the box e Click Writing speed stated in kilobytes per second and then enter the writing speed in kilobytes per second Network connection speed This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media This option is available when a location on the network network share managed vault or an FTP SFTP server is selected as the backup destination The option defines the amount of network connection bandwidth allocated for transferring the backup data By default the speed is set to maximum i e the software uses
442. r backup plan for machines running Microsoft Windows XP replace the text in Event _ source with Windows Update Agent and leave the remaining fields the same How to view events in Event viewer To open a log in Event Viewer 1 Onthe Desktop or in the Start menu right click My Computer and then click Manage 2 Inthe Computer Management console expand System Tools and then expand Event Viewer 3 In Event Viewer click the name of a log that you want to view for example Application To view properties of an event including the event source and event number 1 In Event Viewer click the name of a log that you want to view for example Application a tt 2 In the list of events in the right pane double click the name of an event whose properties you want to view 3 In the Event Properties dialog box view the event s properties such as the event source shown in the Source field and the event number shown in the Event ID field When you are finished click OK to close the Event Properties dialog box 172 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 5 6 Conditions Conditions add more flexibility to the scheduler enabling to execute backup tasks with respect to certain conditions Once a specified event occurs see the Scheduling section for the list of available events the scheduler checks the specified condition and executes the task if the condition is met The scheduler behavior in case the event occurs but the condi
443. r example Keep backups o Daily 1 week o Weekly 1 month o Monthly indefinitely As a result an archive of daily weekly and monthly backups will be created Daily backups will be available for seven days since creation For instance a daily backup of Sunday January 1 will be available through next Sunday January 8 the first weekly backup the one of Saturday January 7 will be stored on the system until February 7 Monthly backups will never be deleted Limited storage If you do not want to arrange a vast amount of space to store a huge archive you may set up a GFS scheme so as to make your backups more short lived at the same time ensuring that your information can be recovered in case of an accidental data loss Suppose that you need to e Perform backups at the end of each working day e Be able to recover an accidentally deleted or inadvertently modified file if this has been discovered relatively quickly e Have access to a weekly backup for 10 days after it was created e Keep monthly backups for half a year Backup scheme parameters can then be set up as follows e Start backup at 6 00 PM e Back up on Workdays e Weekly monthly Friday Keep backups o Daily 1 week o Weekly 10 days o Monthly 6 months With this scheme you will have a week to recover a previous version of a damaged file from a daily backup as well as 10 day access to weekly backups Each monthly full backup will be available for s
444. r in case a centralized plan has failed Last result is View the log to read the warnings gt optionally Perform Succeeded with actions to prevent the future warnings or failure warning Last result is No action is required Succeeded or T i n The state means that the task has never been started or Stopped has been started but has not finished yet and so its result is not available 6 1 2 2 Working with backup plans and tasks Actions on backup plans and tasks The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with backup plans and tasks To Do View details of a plan task Backup plan Click View details In the Plan Details p 189 window review the plan details Task Click View details In the Task Details p 187 window review the task details View plan s task s log Backup plan Click View log You will be taken to the Log p 190 view containing the list of the plan related log entries Task Click View log You will be taken to the Log p 190 view containing the list of the task related log entries Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 183 Run a plan task Stop a plan task 184 Backup plan Click gt Run In the Run Backup Plan p 187 window select the task you need to be run Running the backup plan starts the selected task of that plan immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions Why can t I run the backup plan Do not have
445. r the management server has to collect log events from the registered machines to the centralized log that is stored in a dedicated database and is available in the Log view You can set the option for all the events at once or select the event types to be collected If you completely disable collection of the log events the centralized log will contain only the management server s own log The preset is Collect logs for All events Use the Types of events to log combo box to specify the types of events that will be collected e All events all events information warnings and errors occurred on all the machines registered on the management server will be recorded to the centralized log e Errors and warnings warnings and errors will be recorded to the centralized log e Errors only only errors will be recorded to the centralized log To disable collection of the log events clear the Collect logs check box 3 2 2 Event tracing You can configure the management server to log events in the Application Event Log of Windows besides the management server s own log You can configure the management server to send Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP objects to a specified SNMP manager 84 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 3 2 2 1 Windows event log This option defines whether the management server has to record its own log events in the Application Event Log of Windows to see this log run eventvwr exe or select Control P
446. r too long to enable the next task to start Persistent task overlapping may result from an incorrectly scheduled plan or plans It makes sense to edit the plan in this case 4 Stopping At least one task is No action is required stopping Otherwise see 5 5 ide All the tasks are idle No action is required Backup plan statuses A backup plan can have one of the following statuses Error Warning OK 180 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 A backup plan status is derived from the results of the last run of the plans tasks de How it is determined How to handle At least one task has failed Otherwise see 2 At least one task has succeeded with warnings Otherwise see 3 All the tasks are completed successfully Task states Identify the failed tasks gt Check the tasks log to find out the reason of the failure then do one or more of the following Remove the reason of the failure gt optionally Start the failed task manually e Edit the local plan to prevent its future failure in case a local plan has failed e Edit the backup policy on the management server in case a centralized plan has failed When creating a backup plan or policy the administrator can turn on the option to stop executing the backup plan as soon as the backup plan gets the Error status The backup plan s execution can be resumed using the Restart button View the log to read the warnings gt optionally Per
447. ram displays a warning each time you are trying to edit a plan task last modified by another user On seeing the warning you have two options e Click Cancel and create your own plan or task The original task will remain intact e Continue editing You will have to enter all credentials required for the plan or task execution Archive owner An archive owner is the user who saved the archive to the destination To be more precise this is the user whose account was specified when creating the backup plan in the Where to back up step By default the plan s credentials are used Plan s credentials and task credentials Any task running on a machine runs on behalf of a user When creating a plan or a task you have the option to explicitly specify an account under which the plan or the task will run Your choice depends on whether the plan or task is intended for manual start or for executing on schedule Manual start You can skip the Plan s Task credentials step Every time you start the task the task will run under the credentials with which you are currently logged on Any person that has administrative privileges on the machine can also start the task The task will run under this person s credentials The task will always run under the same credentials regardless of the user who actually starts the task if you specify the task credentials explicitly To do so on the plan task creation page 1 Select the Advanced view check b
448. raphical user interface the Group Policy based parameters take precedence and are effective immediately the parameters shown in the GUI will be changed accordingly The following subtopics describe each way of configuration and the parameters that can be configured through it Folate Parameters set through Group Policy The following are the parameters of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components that can be set via Group Policy 306 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 You can set one or more parameters via Group Policy by using Acronis Administrative Template For information on how to apply the administrative template see How to apply Acronis Administrative Template p 78 The administrative template contains the configuration parameters of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node as described in the correspondent subtopics of this topic Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node The following are the parameters of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node that can be set via Group Policy by using Acronis Administrative Template Client Connection Limit Description Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous connections from Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components to the storage node Possible values Any integer number between 1 and 2147483647 Default value 20 Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agents conne
449. ration Generally you should refer to the boot loader manual pages for the appropriate procedure In case the system disk volume is recovered to identical hardware the following steps would usually help GRUB 1 Boot the machine from the Linux rescue CD or Linux installation CD The installed system and the system on the CD must have the same kernel version The Linux distribution does not have to be the same Opt for boot without RAM disk without the installer linux noinitrd root dev ROOTDEV Where linux is the kernel name the installation CD may contain multiple kernels with different names LILO and GRUB enable you to select the kernel ROOTDEV is the device corresponding to the root partition This is usually hda1 on an IDE device and sda1 on an SCSI device The kernel loads and the operating system starts from the specified root partition Log in as root or log in as a user and switch user sudo su Edit the GRUB configuration file if the number of the partition where the operating system resides has changed Otherwise skip this step a Open the GRUB configuration file usually boot grub grub conf or etc grub conf vim boot grub grub conf b Find the record root hdx Y in the section corresponding to the current kernel In this record X number of the disk Y number of partition on this disk Change X and Y according to the new location of the root c Save the configuration file In V
450. re effective for virtual machines residing on the virtualization servers These options are available only if any Acronis agent for virtual machines is installed on the virtualization server Power off target virtual machines when starting recovery The preset is On Recovery to an existing virtual machine is not possible if the machine is online and so the machine is powered off automatically as soon as the recovery task starts Users will be disconnected from the machine and any unsaved data will be lost Clear the check box for this option if you prefer to power off virtual machines manually before the recovery Power on the target virtual machine when recovery is completed The preset is Off After a machine is recovered from a backup to another machine there is a chance the existing machine s replica will appear on the network To be on the safe side power on the recovered virtual machine manually after you take the necessary precautions Select the check box for this option if automatic powering on of the virtual machine is required Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 121 4 Vaults A vault is a location for storing backup archives For ease of use and administration a vault is associated with the archives metadata Referring to this metadata makes for fast and convenient operations with archives and backups stored in the vault A vault can be organized on a local or networked drive detachable media or a tape devic
451. re that the backup plans you create use the managed vault as destination for the backup archives Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 9 e Creating a backup policy rather than backup plans Set up a centralized backup policy and apply it to the All machines group This way you will deploy backup plans on each machine with a single action Select Actions gt Create backup policy from the top menu and then refer to the context help e Grouping the machines registered on the management server Group the registered machines by appropriate parameters create several policies and apply each policy to the appropriate group of machines For more information please refer to Grouping the registered machines p 56 The comprehensive example of the advanced centralized management is provided in the section Setting up centralized data protection in a heterogeneous network p 52 1 2 1 Using the management console As soon as the console connects to a managed machine p 348 or to a management server p 348 the respective items appear across the console s workspace in the menu in the main area with the Welcome screen the Navigation pane the Actions and tools pane enabling you to perform agent specific or server specific operations E Acronis Becki A ecowery 10 Connected bo Thit Machine loca Corn Ey Fi yp t Acterrc pa iene WA a PENI amp eer i iha casi et H Welcome to Machinei2 The cormole k con
452. rential backup and one two or three tapes for an incremental backup For example if we need to recover data from a backup created on Monday of the 52nd week the task will require the following tapes e Tape 23 with an incremental backup marked with 52 and a differential backup created on Friday of the 51st week e Tape 21 and Tape 22 that contain a full backup created on Friday of the 48th week The example reveals the following shortcomings of the scheme combination with the specified tape options e commonly any data recovery is a long process that requires loading mounting rewinding and reading of one 3 for backups displayed in the Tape usage during the first year figure two 65 or three 32 tapes e 22 tapes are used to store 13 monthly full backups when the monthly backup size is less than the size of a tape so keeping data is more expensive e 25 tapes are required for full year rotation of the data backups 144 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 GFS Example 2 Suppose the backup plan has the following tape options the Use a separate tape set option is selected the Always use a free tape For each full backup option is selected the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is cleared the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is cleared The example has only one difference from the previous one That is selection of the Always use a free tape For
453. res reading of one or more tapes so it might be durational The program finds the tapes and inserts them automatically in the right order The Task Need Interaction window comes up if a required tape is not found Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 135 Keep in mind that a data recovery operation may require access to a number of tapes For example data recovery from an incremental backup commonly might require loading mounting rewinding and reading of the following tapes containing the data backups e tapes storing the incremental backup selected to recover the data e tapes storing the last full backup created before the selected incremental one e tapes storing the last differential backup created after the last full backup but before the selected incremental one if necessary e tapes containing all incremental backups created after the last full or differential backups before the selected incremental one if necessary While a recovery task is running the following tape specific information is accessible from the management console e labels of all the tapes that may be required for the operation e label of the tape that is currently being read e labels of the tapes that have already been read e labels of tapes that are still waiting to be read with information of their current availability loaded or not 4 1 3 6 Managing a tape library To manage a tape library the following tasks procedures are in the product e Invent
454. ributed workstations e Dedicated servers for storage resource optimization Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Advanced Workstation offers new benefits that help organizations meet challenging Recovery Time Objectives while reducing both capital expense and software maintenance costs e Leveraging existing IT infrastructure Data deduplication to reduce storage consumption and network bandwidth utilization Flexible deduplication mechanism allowing deduplication of backup data both at the source and at the storage Improved support for robotic tape libraries Backward compatibility and an easy upgrade from Acronis True Image Echo e Highly automated data protection All round planning of data protection backup retention and validation of backups within a backup policy Built in Tower of Hanoi and Grandfather Father Son backup schemes with customizable parameters A variety of events and conditions can be chosen to trigger a backup e Policy based centralized management Applying backup policies to groups of machines Static and dynamic machine grouping e Easy work with virtual environments Conversion of a backup to a fully configured VMware Microsoft Parallels or Citrix virtual machine e Redesigned GUI Dashboard for quick operational decision making Overview of all configured and running operations with color coding for successful and failed Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 7 operations Enterprise level of security
455. road When the portable computer is connected to the corporate network all changes made to the archive will be transferred to its stationary copy after the first backup operation If you select the password protected Acronis Secure Zone as the primary destination keep in mind that the i 2 archive in the secondary destination will not be protected with a password To use Dual destination 1 Select the check box for Use dual destination 2 Browse to the secondary destination or enter the full path to the destination manually 3 Click OK You might have to provide the access credentials for the secondary destination Enter the credentials on prompt 3 4 1 18 Task start conditions This option is effective in Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under bootable media This option determines the program behavior in case a backup task is about to start the scheduled time comes or the event specified in the schedule occurs but the condition or any of multiple conditions is not met For more information on conditions please see Scheduling p 161 and Conditions p 173 The preset is Wait until the conditions are met Wait until the conditions are met With this setting the scheduler starts monitoring the conditions and launches the task as soon as the conditions are met If the conditions are never met the task will never start To handle the situation when the conditions are not
456. ronis Secure Zone before please note a radical change in the zone functionality The zone does not perform automatic cleanup that is deleting old archives anymore Use backup schemes with automatic cleanup to back up to the zone or delete outdated archives manually using the vault management functionality With the new Acronis Secure Zone behavior you obtain the ability to e list archives located in the zone and backups included in each archive e examine backup content e mount a volume backup to copy files from the backup to a physical disk e safely delete archives and backups from the archives To learn more about operations with vaults see the Vaults p 122 section 6 7 2 1 Increasing Acronis Secure Zone To increase Acronis Secure Zone 1 On the Manage Acronis Secure Zone page click Increase 2 Select volumes from which free space will be used to increase the Acronis Secure Zone 3 Specify the new size of the zone by o dragging the slider and selecting any size between the current and maximum values The maximum size is equal to the disk s unallocated space plus the total free space of all selected partitions o typing an exact value in the Acronis Secure Zone Size field When increasing the size of the zone the program will act as follows o first it will use the unallocated space Volumes will be moved if necessary but not resized Moving of locked volumes requires a reboot o If there is not enough unallocat
457. rs by the site locations etc The main goal of grouping is protection of multiple machines with one policy Once a machine appears in a group the policy applied to the group is applied to the machine and the new tasks are created by the policy on the machine Once a machine is removed from a group the policy applied to the group will be revoked from the machine and the tasks created by the policy will be removed Built in group a group that always exists on a management server The group cannot be deleted or renamed A built in group cannot include nested groups A backup policy can be applied to a built in group The example of a built in group is the E All physical machines group that contains all the machines registered on the management server Custom groups groups created manually by the management server administrator e Static groups Static groups contain machines manually added to the group by the administrator A static member remains in the group until the administrator removes the member from the group or deletes the corresponding managed machine from the management server 8 Dynamic groups Dynamic groups contain machines added automatically according to the criteria specified by the administrator Once the criteria are specified the management server starts to analyze the existing machines properties and will analyze every newly registered machine The machine that meets a certain dynamic criterion will appear in
458. rs with a set of actions that can be performed and tools see the Actions and Tools pane p 12 section E Main area The main place of working where you create edit and manage backup plans policies tasks and perform other operations Displays the different views and action pages p 14 depending on items selected in the menu Navigation tree or on the Actions and Tools pane c Menu bar Appears across the top of the program window and lets you perform all the operations available on both panes Menu items change dynamically 1024x768 or higher display resolution is required for comfortable work with the management console 1 2 1 1 Navigation pane The navigation pane includes the Navigation tree and the Shortcuts bar Navigation tree The Navigation tree enables you to navigate across the program views Views depend on whether the console is connected to a managed machine or to the management server Views for a managed machine When the console is connected to a managed machine the following views are available in the navigation tree e Machine name Root of the tree also called a Welcome view Displays the name of the machine the console is currently connected to Use this view for quick access to the main operations available on the managed machine o Dashboard Use this view to estimate at a glance whether the data is successfully protected on the managed machine o 9B Backup plans and tasks Use this vie
459. rver or not depends on the virtualization product brand and settings VMware ESX may have multiple storages A Microsoft Hyper V server enables creating a new virtual machine in any local folder Memory Initial setting if not contained in the backup the default setting of the virtualization server This is the amount of memory allocated to the new virtual machine The memory adjustment range depends on the host hardware the host operating system and the virtualization product settings For example virtual machines may be allowed to use no more than 30 of memory Disks Initial setting the number and size of the source machine s disks The number of disks is generally equal to that of the source machine but might be different if the program has to add more disks to accommodate the source machine volumes because of limitations set by the virtualization product You can add virtual disks to the machine configuration or in some cases delete the proposed disks Processors Initial setting if not contained in the backup or the backed up setting is not supported by the virtualization server the default server s setting This is the number of processors of the new virtual machine In most cases it is set to one The result of assignment of more than one processor to the machine is not guaranteed The number of virtual processors may be limited by the host CPU configuration the virtualization product and the guest operating system Mult
460. ry user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username o Password The password for the account Select the Save password check box to store the password for future connections 5 Click OK Initiating registration on the machine side The administrator of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server can configure the server s name or IP address in the agent s settings while e installing the agent e using the console agent connection This will launch the standard registration procedure 284 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 To register an agent during agent installation you have to be logged on with the management server administrator s account or provide the server administrator s credentials on prompt To perform registration through a local or remote console agent connection you have to be connected with the management server administrator s credentials or provide the management server administrator s credentials On connecting select from the menu Options Machine options Machine management then opt for Centralized management and then enter the management server s name or IP address and the management server administrator s credentials Importing machines from Active Directory To import machines from Active Directory 1 Inthe Navigation tree select Physical machines or Fa All physical machines 2 Click Me Import machines from Active Directory on the toolbar 3 Inthe Search f
461. s Unfortunately the hardware limitations on size and performance are even more severe with the use of mirrored volumes Mirrored Striped Volume A fault tolerant volume also sometimes called RAID 1 0 combining the advantage of the high I O speed of the striped layout and redundancy of the mirror type The evident disadvantage remains inherent with the mirror architecture a low disk to volume size ratio RAID 5 A fault tolerant volume whose data is striped across an array of three or more disks The disks do not need to be identical but there must be equally sized blocks of unallocated space available on each disk in the volume Parity a calculated value that can be used to reconstruct data in case of failure is also striped across the disk array And it is always stored on a different disk than the data itself If a physical disk fails the portion of the RAID 5 volume that was on that failed disk can be re created from the remaining data and the parity A RAID 5 volume provides reliability and is able to overcome the physical disk size limitations with a higher than mirrored disk to volume size ratio Create volume wizard The Create volume wizard lets you create any type of volume including system and active select a file system label assign a letter and also provides other disk management functions Its pages will enable you to enter operation parameters proceeding step by step further on and return to any previous step if ne
462. s components through Graphical User Interface Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server AMS on one of the Windows servers 2 The management server is your single entry point to the Acronis infrastructure Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent on each of the machines to back up the machine s disks volumes or files o Agent W Agent for Windows o Agent L Agent for Linux The Agent for Linux can be installed on the ESX server since this virtualization product is based on Linux Red Hat If the server uses the ext2 or ext3 file system you will be able to back up the server s disks volumes or files The native ESX file system can be backed up sector by sector only When installing the agents register each of the machines on the management server To do so enter the server s name or IP address and the server s administrator credentials in the appropriate window of the installation wizard Or alternatively add the machines to the management server later using their names or IP addresses Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for ESX Agent ESX on the ESX server 4 to back up the virtual machines from the host The agent is delivered as a virtual appliance Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 53 5 Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node ASN on one of the Windows servers 9 The storage node enables you to organize the infrastructure for storing backup archives and to use
463. s 20 99 00 b6 3d 95 57 28 14 Oc d1 36 22 d8 c6 87 a4 eb 00 85 5 Inthe Start menu click Run and then type the following in the Open box SCommonProgramFiles Acronis Utils acroniscert exe install 20 99 00 b6 3d 95 57 28 14 Oc dl 36 22 d8 c6 87 a4 eb 00 85 80 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Note quotation marks substitute the sample thumbprint shown here with that of your certificate Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 81 3 Options This section covers Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 options that can be configured using Graphical User Interface The content of this section is applicable to both stand alone and advanced editions of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 3 1 Console options The console options define the way information is represented in the Graphical User Interface of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 To access the console options select Options gt Console options from the top menu 3 1 1 Startup page This option defines whether to show the Welcome screen or the Dashboard upon connection of the console to a managed machine or to the management server The preset is the Welcome screen To make a selection select or clear the check box for Show the Dashboard view upon connection of the console to a machine This option can also be set on the Welcome screen If you select the check box for At startup show the Dashboard instead of the current view on the Welcome screen the setting mentio
464. s it is necessary to transfer all the disk data onto a new disk It can be a case of expanding the system volume starting a new system layout or disk evacuation due to a hardware fault In any case the reason for the Clone basic disk operation can be summed up as the necessity to transfer all the source disk data to a target disk exactly as it is Acronis Disk Director Lite allows the operation to be carried out to basic MBR disks only To plan the Clone basic disk operation 1 Select a disk you want to clone 2 Select a disk as target for the cloning operation 3 Selecta cloning method and specify advanced options The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view immediately It is advisable that you deactivate Acronis Startup Recovery Manager p 338 ASRM if it is active before cloning a system disk Otherwise the cloned operating system might not boot You can activate the ASRM again after the cloning is completed If deactivation is not possible choose the As is method to clone the disk Selecting source and target disks The program displays a list of partitioned disks and asks the user to select the source disk from which data will be transferred to another disk The next step is selection of a disk as target for the cloning operation The program enables the user to select a disk if its size will be sufficient to hold all the data from the source disk without any loss If there is
465. s on Windows machines that have either a D or F volume unless an event that will result in an error occurs The policy that has to back up the System and the dev sda1 volumes will get the Warning status on the Windows machines since dev sda is not found and on the Linux machines that have the dev sda1 volume since the System volume is not found The policy will get the Error status on Linux machines that do not have a SCSI device The following table provides details State Status Description Deploying Error The deployment log has errors for example disk space runs out Warning The deployment log has warnings the machine went offline during the deployment cannot connect for N days OK The deployment log does not have errors and warnings Deployed Error The status of the corresponding backup plan is Error Warning The status of the corresponding backup plan is Warning OK The status of the corresponding backup plan is OK Error The updating log has errors cannot delete the locked task the Acronis service is stopped Warning The updating log has warnings OK The updating log does not have errors and warnings Error The revoking log has errors Warning The revoking log has warnings OK The revoking log does not have errors and warnings In addition to the deployment state and status as related to a specific machine the backup policy has the deployment state and status on a group of machines and
466. s that have occurred on the machine and offers you ways of fixing or examining them The most critical issues are displayed on the top If there are no alerts or warnings at the moment the system displays No alerts or warnings Types of alerts The table below illustrates the types of messages you may observe Description Offer Comment x X tasks failed Show tasks Show tasks will open the Backup plans and Tasks view with failed tasks where you can examine the reason of failure fx X task s need s user Show tasks Each time a task needs human interaction the Dashboard interaction shows a message to inform you what action has to be performed for example insert new CD or Stop Retry Ignore on an error x License check failed X days Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Windows remaining until the software periodically checks whether its license is available on stops working Please make Acronis License Server After the Agent is unable to check sure you have a valid license for the license for X more days it will stop working until a on Acronis License Server successful check The Agent checks for the license when it starts and then every 1 5 days as specified by the configuration parameters Q Cannot check the license key For the past X days Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for X days Either Acronis for Windows was unable to check whether its license is License Server was available on Acronis License Server
467. s you obtain in this case will be plan specific or task specific 86 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Fha Windows event log This option is effective only in Windows operating systems This option is not available when operating under the bootable media This option defines whether the agent s operating on the managed machine have to log events in the Application Event Log of Windows to see this log run eventvwr exe or select Control Panel gt Administrative tools gt Event Viewer You can filter the events to be logged You can override the settings set here exclusively for the events that occur during backup or during recovery in the Default backup and recovery options p 89 In this case the settings set here will be effective for operations other than backup and recovery such as archive validation or cleanup You can further override the settings set in the default backup and recovery options when creating a backup plan or a recovery task The settings you obtain in this case will be plan specific or task specific The preset is Disabled To enable this option select the Log events check box Use the Types of events to log check box to filter the events to be logged in the Application Event Log of Windows o All events all events information warnings and errors o Errors and warnings o Errors only To disable this option clear the Log events check box 3 3 2 2 SNMP notifications This option is
468. se a free tape For each full backup option is cleared e the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is cleared e the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is cleared 148 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The figure below shows the tapes usage for the TOH scheme combined with the above mentioned tape options The recurring part of the scheme contains sixteen backup sessions The figure displays the backup archive state at the moment when the 17th session is finished B is Ba 02 EE A a O a O ee es hh Bao ETTE As the Tower of Hanoi backup scheme forces presence of only one backup on each level all the outdated backups are deleted automatically In the next figure the deleted backups are drawn as dark gray rectangles Actually the deleted backup is still stored on the tapes but the information about it is deleted from the storage node database Te a O O O ll re i B EE Oe a B03 E The figure shows the full backup kept on tape 01 at the moment which cannot be deleted as it is a base for actual differential D C B and incremental A backups stored on tape 02 The full backup deletion is postponed until all the above mentioned four backups will be deleted The next figure demonstrates the tapes content at the moment before creation of the new backup on level D Bet O EE EE H i E G E ne E B 0k B E O At the moment the data archive occupies four tapes and the total size o
469. selecting volumes to _ recover Acronis One Click Restore always recovers the entire disk If your disk contains several volumes and you are planning to use Acronis One Click Restore include all the volumes in the backup Any volumes _ missing from the backup will be lost e Bootable agent is a bootable rescue utility based on Linux kernel that includes most of the functionality of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent Put this component on the media if you want more functionality during recovery You will be able to configure the recovery operation in the same way as under regular bootable media use Active Restore or Universal Restore In Windows if Acronis Disk Director Lite is installed on the machine you can select one more component e Acronis Disk Director Lite is a disk management tool that enables such operations as cloning disks creating deleting and converting basic and dynamic volumes and some additional operations such as converting a disk partitioning style from MBR to GPT and vice versa or Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 105 changing disk label Adding this component to the media will enable you to prepare the disk configuration on a machine before recovering the data 3 4 1 16 Error handling These options are effective for Windows and Linux operating systems and bootable media These options enable you to specify how to handle errors that might occur during backup Do not show messages and dia
470. sely on a disk group p 344 Dynamic volumes can span multiple disks Dynamic volumes are usually configured depending on the desired goal e to increase the volume size a spanned volume e to reduce the access time a striped volume e to achieve fault tolerance by introducing redundancy mirrored and RAID 5 volumes E Encrypted archive A backup archive p 339 encrypted according to the Advanced Encryption Standard AES When the encryption option and a password for the archive are set in the backup options p 340 each backup belonging to the archive is encrypted by the agent p 339 before saving the backup to its destination The AES cryptographic algorithm operates in the Cipher block chaining CBC mode and uses a randomly generated key with a user defined size of 128 192 or 256 bits The encryption key is then encrypted with AES 256 using a SHA 256 hash of the password as a key The password itself is not stored anywhere on the disk or in the backup file the password hash is used for verification purposes With this two level security the backup data is protected from any unauthorized access but recovering a lost password is not possible 346 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Encrypted vault A managed vault p 348 to which anything written is encrypted and anything read is decrypted transparently by the storage node p 350 using a vault specific encryption key stored on the node In case the storage medium
471. sersstestssrssrestestserssresissrsstestasissrsstesisciserssieciseisetesisciseissiseiseisetssisciseissiseieciseiseiecieeseeiserecssessececieesserseteeieeisecseieessersereeieesserssiem _ Please be aware that the target machine will be powered off automatically before the recovery If you prefer to power it off manually modify the VM power management option Disk Disk MODEL p 219 Select the destination disk for each of the source disks NT signature p 217 Select the way the recovered disk s signature will be handled The disk signature is used by Windows and the Linux kernel version 2 6 and later Disk destination To specify a destination disk 1 Select a disk where you want the selected disk to recover to The destination disk s space should be at least the same size as the uncompressed image data 2 Click OK All the data stored on 1 the target disk will be replaced by the bi backed up data so gt be careful and watch out for _non backed up data that you might need NT signature When the MBR is selected along with the disk backup you need to retain operating system bootability on the target disk volume The operating system must have the system volume information e g volume letter matched with the disk NT signature which is kept in the MBR disk record But two disks with the same NT signature cannot work properly under one operating system _ If there are two disks having the same NT signature and comprisi
472. server select the type of the new virtual machine to be created or on which virtualization server to create the machine 7 In VM name enter the name for the new virtual machine 8 Optionally Review the Virtual machine settings p 221 and make changes if necessary Here you can change the path to the new virtual machine The same type of machines with the same name cannot be created in the same folder Change either the VM name or the path if you get an error message caused by identical names ee ee ee ee ee ee ee ee ee E E A e E E E E E E E E A SS Se Se ee ee es aes alas a e lel a aerate On a Microsoft Virtual PC be sure to recover the disk or volume where the operating system s loader resides _ to the Hard disk 1 Otherwise the operating system will not boot This cannot be fixed by changing the boot device order in BIOS because a Virtual PC ignores these settings 10 In When to recover specify when to start the recovery task 11 Optionally Review Recovery options and change the settings from the default ones if need be You can specify in Recovery options gt VM power management whether to start the new virtual machine automatically after the recovery is completed This option is available only when the new machine is created on a virtualization server 12 Click OK If the recovery task is scheduled for the future specify the credentials under which the task will run You will be taken to the Backup plans an
473. session is finished is Ba 02 E re ee eee eee eee ey 03 CO eooOoE gt E Eeee In the figure below the backups deleted at the moment are drawn as dark gray rectangles ee SE EE aes az BO MDE The figure indicates that there are two full backups on level E because at the moment the first full backup is a base for differential backups D C and B are a base for incremental backup A So the full backup deletion is postponed until all the D C B and A backups will be deleted The next figure shows the tape usage at the moment before creating a new backup on level D PS ae ll moe GAB S KBB To es MRR UC At the moment the backup archive occupies four tapes It is the maximal number of tapes required in the example After the next backup on level D is created both tapes 01 and 02 are freed and can be reused It is noticed that the ToH scheme combined with the specified options has the following properties for the analyzed case e the data recovery requires access to the backups kept on one 25 or two tapes 75 e five level scheme can require up to four tapes So in this specific case the selection of the Always use a free tape For each full backup option considerably increases the usage efficiency of the tapes in the library TOH Example 3 Imagine the backup plan has the following tape options e the Use a separate tape set option is selected 150 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e the Always
474. set through Windows registry The following two parameters determine paths to Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node s internal databases which contain information about managed vaults They can be modified only by editing the registry When to modify Normally you do not need to modify the default paths which are subfolders of the folder determined by the ALLUSERSPROFILE environment variable such as C Documents and Settings All Users Acronis StorageNode While the database located in the folder determined by DatabasePath is typically small the tape database located at TapeDatabasePath may be large if the tape library contains thousands of archives and you may want to store the tape database on a volume other that the system volume Parameters Important We do not recommend modifying these parameters If you do need to modify either of them you _ should do this before creating any correspondent tape or non tape managed vaults Otherwise the storage node will lose access to those vaults until you re attach them and re attaching a vault especially a 7 deduplicating one may take a considerable amount of time DatabasePath Description Specifies the folder where Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node stores its non tape vaults database This database contains a list of vaults that are managed by the storage node other than tape vaults see the next parameter Its typical size does not exceed a few kiloby
475. seven 7 days per week Such electronic services may include but are not limited to user forums software specific information hints and tips bug fix retrieval via the internet software maintenance and demonstration code retrieval via a WAN accessible FTP server and access to a problem resolution database via Acronis customer support system Support shall consist of supplying telephone or other electronic support to you in order to help you locate and on its own correct problems with the Software and supplying patches updates and other changes that Acronis at its sole discretion makes or adds to the Software and which Acronis makes generally available without additional charge to other licensees of the Software that are enrolled in Support Upon mutual agreement by both parties Acronis shall 22 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 i supply code corrections to you to correct Software malfunctions in order to bring such Software into substantial conformity with the published operating specifications for the most current version of the Software unless your unauthorized modifications prohibit or hamper such corrections or cause the malfunction or ii supply code corrections to correct insubstantial problems at the next general release of the Software More information about contacting Acronis Technical Support is available at the following link http www Acronis com enterprise support Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 2
476. simple daily schedule a backup task will be run every 1 day at 10 AM as well as more complex schedules example of a complex daily schedule a task will be run every 3 days starting from January 15 During the specified days the task will be repeated every 2 hours from 10 AM to 10 PM Thus complex schedules 332 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 specify the sessions on which the scheme should run In the discussion below days can be replaced with scheduled sessions Number of levels Select from 2 to 16 backup levels See the example stated below for details Roll back period The guaranteed number of sessions that one can go back in the archive at any time Calculated automatically depending on the schedule parameters and the numbers of levels you select See the example below for details Example Schedule parameters are set as follows e Recur Every 1 day e Frequency Once at 6 PM Number of levels 4 This is how the first 14 days or 14 sessions of this scheme s schedule look Shaded numbers denote backup levels BROS OoooSooo BRED DORER Backups of different levels have different types e Last level in this case level 4 backups are full e Backups of intermediate levels 2 3 are differential e First level 1 backups are incremental A cleanup mechanism ensures that only the most recent backups of each level are kept Here is how the archive looks on day 8 a day before creating a new full backup
477. sion of Acronis Disk Director will provide more tools and utilities for working with volumes Acronis Disk Director Lite must obtain exclusive access to the target volume This means no other disk management utilities like Windows Disk Management utility can access it at that time If you receive a message stating that the volume cannot be blocked close the disk management applications that use this volume and start again If you cannot determine which applications use the volume close them all 6 9 6 1 Creating a volume You might need a new volume to e Recover a previously saved backup copy in the exactly as was configuration e Store collections of similar files separately for example an MP3 collection or video files on a separate volume e Store backups images of other volumes disks on a special volume e Install a new operating system or swap file on a new volume e Add new hardware to a machine In Acronis Disk Director Lite the tool for creating volumes is the Create volume Wizard Types of dynamic volumes Simple Volume A volume created from free space on a single physical disk It can consist of one region on the disk or several regions virtually united by the Logical Disk Manager LDM It provides no additional reliability no soeed improvement nor extra size Spanned Volume A volume created from free disk space virtually linked together by the LDM from several physical disks Up to 32
478. sk can put itself into the Need interaction state when it needs human interaction such as changing media or ignoring a read error The next state may be Stopping if the user chooses to stop the task or Running on selecting Ignore Retry or another action such as Reboot that can put the task to the Running state Stopping The user can stop a running task or a task that needs interaction The task changes to the Stopping state and then to the Idle state A waiting task can also be stopped In this case since the task is not running stop means removing it from the queue Task state diagram Continue Ignore Retry Need user A interaction The other task is completed 1 Waiting for condition 2 Waiting when another task locks the necessary PeSOuroes Task statuses A task can have one of the following statuses Error Warning OK A task status is derived from the result of the last run of the task Status How it is determined How to handle 1 Last result is Failed Identify the failed task gt Check the task log to find out the reason of the failure then do one or more of the following Remove the reason of the failure gt optionally Start the failed task manually Edit the failed task to prevent its future failure e Edit the local plan to prevent its future failure in case a local plan has failed 182 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Edit the backup policy on the management serve
479. sk management operation will be performed The name of the currently selected operating system is shown on the console toolbar after The current disk layout is for Click the OS name to select another operating system in the Operating System Selection window Under bootable media this window appears after clicking Disk management The disk layout will be displayed according to the operating system you select 6 9 4 Disk management view Acronis Disk Director Lite is controlled through the Disk management view of the console The top part of the view contains a disks and volumes table enabling data sorting and columns customization and toolbar The table presents the numbers of the disks as well as assigned letter label type capacity free space size used space size file system and status for each volume The toolbar comprises of icons to launch the Undo Redo and Commit actions intended for pending operations p 271 The graphic panel at the bottom of the view also graphically depicts all the disks and their volumes as rectangles with basic data on them label letter size status type and file system Both parts of the view also depict all unallocated disk space that can be used in volume creation Starting the operations Any operation can be launched e From the volume or disk context menu both in the table and the graphic panel e From the Disk management menu of the console e From the Operations bar on the Act
480. some data on the disk that was chosen as the target the user will receive a warning The selected target disk is not empty The data on its volumes will be overwritten meaning that all the data currently located on the chosen target disk will be lost irrevocably Cloning method and advanced options The Clone basic disk operation usually means that the information from the source disk is transferred to the target As is So if the destination disk is the same size and even if it is larger it is possible to transfer all the information there exactly as it is stored at the source But with the wide range of available hardware it is normal that the target disk would differ in size from the source If the destination is larger then it would be advisable to resize the source disk volumes to avoid leaving unallocated space on the target disk by selecting the Proportionally resize volumes option The option to Clone basic disk as is remains but the default method of cloning will be carried out with proportional enlargement of all the source disk volumes so that no unallocated Space remains on the target disk 260 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 nD If the destination is smaller then the As is option of cloning will be unavailable and proportional resizing of the source disk volumes will be mandatory The program analyzes the target disk to establish whether its size will be sufficient to hold all the data from the source d
481. sponding column s header type the archive name the owner name or the machine name As a result you will see the list of the archives whose names owner names or machine names fully or just partly coincide with the entered value Configuring the archives table By default the table has seven columns that are displayed others are hidden If required you can hide the displayed columns and show hidden ones To show or hide columns 1 Right click any column header to open the context menu The menu items that are ticked off correspond to column headers presented in the table 2 Click the items you want to be displayed hidden 160 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 5 Scheduling Acronis scheduler helps the administrator adapt backup plans to the company s daily routine and each employee s work style The plans tasks will be launched systematically keeping the critical data safely protected The scheduler uses local time of the machine the backup plan exists on Before creating a schedule be sure the machine s date and time settings are correct Schedule To define when a task has to be executed you need to specify an event or multiple events The task will be launched as soon as any of the events occurs The table below lists the events available under Windows operating systems Event Time Daily Weekly Monthly Time passed since the last successful backup has completed specify the length of time User
482. ssary computing load Last but not least Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node enables using a tape library as a centralized vault for storing backup archives More than one storage node each managing a number of vaults can be set up and controlled centrally from the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server For more detailed information about storage nodes please refer to Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node p 19 2 11 2 Setting up centralized data protection in a heterogeneous network Assume that the network infrastructure includes servers 1 2 9 and workstations 3 5 8 running Windows and Linux You also have a VMware ESX server 4 that hosts two guest systems 52 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 You have to protect each server as a whole the users data on the workstations and the virtual machines You want to be able to track the health of the data protection be sure that the backup archives do not store duplicated information and that the obsolete backups are deleted from the storage in a timely manner These goals can be achieved by regular backup of the desired data items to a centralized vault with deduplication Administrator PO gt Agent W Setting up the Acronis infrastructure 1 Install Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console Console on the machine which you prefer to operate from 3 The console enables you to access and manage other Acroni
483. stemDrive Program Files Common Files Acronis Agent To ensure reliability the certificate is stored in Windows Certificate Store at the following location Certificates Local Computer Acronis Trusted Certificates Cache For self signed certificates the certificate thumbprint also known as fingerprint or hash is used for future host identification if a client has previously connected to a server by using a self signed certificate and tries to establish connection again the server checks whether the certificate s thumbprint is the same as the one used before In case the list of certificates for the local machine is not displayed in the Certificates console you can use the following procedure Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 79 To open the list of a machine s certificates Click Start then click Run and then type mmc In the console on the File menu click Add Remove Snap in In the Add Remove Snap in dialog box click Add In the Add Standalone Snap in dialog box double click Certificates Click Computer account and then click Next StS SY a Click Local computer and then click Finish Tip Alternatively you can manage the list of certificates of a remote machine To do this click Another computer and then type the remote machine s name hocnceeseeuseseninessnccseecnmenssecesceseinesaetseseeinanssastsssesiesesrainsasossessansrasssnssessesesiansslinssbessatsanarsnsntsssaisttslsesssso aaan 7 Click Close to
484. sult the created vault appears in the Personal group of the vaults tree 4 2 2 2 Merging and moving personal vaults What if need to move the existing vault from a one place to another Proceed as follows 1 Make sure that none of the backup plans uses the existing vault while moving files or temporary disable p 187 schedules of the given plans 2 Move the vault folder with all its archives to a new place manually by means of a third party file manager 3 Create anew vault 4 Edit the backup plans and tasks redirect their destination to the new vault 5 Delete the old vault How can merge two vaults Suppose you have two vaults A and B in use Both vaults are used by backup plans You decide to leave only vault B moving all the archives from vault A there To do this proceed as follows 1 Make sure that none of the backup plans uses vault A while merging or temporarily disable p 187 schedules of the given plans Move the archives to vault B manually by means of a third party file manager Edit the backup plans that use vault A redirect their destination to vault B In the vaults tree select vault B to check whether the archives are displayed If not click Refresh oe a oe Delete vault A 4 3 Common operations 4 3 1 Operations with archives stored in a vault To perform any operation with an archive you have to select it first If the archive is protected with a password you will be asked to pro
485. sword For the vault that was encrypted provide the encryption password After you have performed all the required steps click OK to commit to attaching the vault This procedure may last for quite a while since the storage node has to scan the archives write the metadata in the database and deduplicate the archives if the vault was originally deduplicating 4 1 3 Tape libraries This section describes in detail how to use robotic tape devices as vaults for storing backup archives A tape library robotic library is a high capacity storage device that contains the following e one or more tape drives e multiple up to several thousand slots to hold tape cartridges one or more loaders robotic mechanisms intended for relocating the tape cartridges between the slots and the tape drives e barcode readers optional 4 1 3 1 Overview Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides full support of a tape library through Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node The storage node should be installed on the machine a tape library is attached to Storage node can simultaneously use more than one tape library for keeping archives To manage a tape library media the storage node uses the Windows Removable Storage Manager RSM See the RSM Media Pools p 132 section for more information A dedicated database of the storage node keeps information of the backup content written onto the tapes So some operations for example Cleanup p
486. t Acronis Inc 2000 2009 This parameter has two settings Trace State Description Specifies whether to record the agent s events into the event log Possible values True or False Default value False Trace Level Description Specifies the minimum level of severity of events to be recorded into the event log Only events of levels greater than or equal to the value in Trace Level will be recorded Possible values 0 Internal event 1 Debugging information 2 Information 3 Warning 4 Error or 5 Critical error Default value 4 only errors and critical errors will be recorded if Trace State is set to True SNMP Specifies the parameters for sending notifications about Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent s events by means of Simple Network Management Protocol SNMP This parameter has three settings Common Trace Specifies when to send the SNMP notifications This setting has two sub settings Trace State Description Specifies whether to send the SNMP notifications Possible values True or False Default value False Trace Level Description Specifies the minimum level of severity of events for sending SNMP notifications about them Only notifications about events of levels greater than or equal to Trace Level will be sent Possible values 0 Internal event 1 Debugging information 2 Information 3 Warning 4 Error or 5 Critical error Default value 4 only errors and critical errors wi
487. t Time based alerts Once the trial version of the product is installed the program starts the countdown of days remaining until the trial period expires This type of message can appear on a machine that is registered on a management server The Dashboard warns you that the connection might be lost or the server might be unavailable and the machine is not centrally managed as a result Click Show log to open the Log view where you can examine the log entries and find out the reason of the issue The calendar lets you explore the history of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent s activities on the machine Right click on any highlighted date and select View log to see the list of log entries filtered by date On the View section at the right of the calendar you can select the activities to highlight depending on the presence and severity of the errors How it is determined Errors Highlight the date in red if at least one Error entry appeared in the log on this date 178 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Highlight the date in yellow if no Error entries appeared and at least one Warning entry appeared in the log on this date ae Highlight the date in green if only Information log entries appeared on this date normal activity The Select current date link focuses selection to the current date System view Shows summarized statistics of backup plans tasks and brief information on the last ba
488. t 9PM If the location is not available at that moment for instance due to maintenance work skip the backup and wait for the next workday to start the task It is assumed that the backup task should not be started at all rather than failed e Event Weekly Every 1 week s on lt workdays gt Once at 09 00 00 PM e Condition Location is available e Task start conditions Skip the task execution As a result 1 If 9PM comes and the archive location is available the backup task starts right on time 2 If 9PM comes but the archive location is unavailable the backup task will start on the next workday if the location is available 3 If the location will never be available on workdays at 9PM the task never starts 5 6 3 Fits time interval Applies to Windows Linux Restricts a backup task s start time to a specified interval Example A company uses different locations on the same network attached storage for backing up users data and servers The workday starts at 8AM and ends at 5 PM Users data should be backed up as soon as the users log off but not earlier than 4 30 PM and not later than 10 PM Every day at 11 PM the company s servers are backed up So all the users data should be preferably backed up before this time in order to free network bandwidth By specifying the upper limit as 10 PM it is supposed that the backing up of users data does not take more than one hour If a user is still logged on with
489. t the Include child containers check box 294 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Move one group to another To move the selected group to another group or to the root 1 In the groups tree click the group to move the selected group to You can move any type of custom group either static or dynamic to another custom group of any type or to the root folder The root folder of the machines tree contains groups of the first level Groups that include other groups are called parent groups Groups that are in parent groups are called child groups All the backup policies applied to the parent group will be applied to its child groups as well Click OK Editing custom groups Editing a custom group is performed in the same way as creating p 293 one Changing the type of group will result in its conversion Any custom group can be converted to a dynamic group if it was static and vice versa When converting a static group to dynamic provide grouping criteria All the members that exist in the static group that do not match the provided criteria will be removed from the dynamic group When converting a dynamic group to static two options are available either to leave the current content of the group or to empty the group Group details Aggregates in two tabs all information on the selected group Allows performing operations with the policies applied to the group This information is also duplicated in the Informatio
490. t was actually copied to the backup You also specify the destination where to recover the data You can customize the recovery operation using recovery options such as pre post recovery commands error handling or notification options 26 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The following diagram illustrates data recovery under the operating system online No backup can proceed on the machine while the recovery operation is taking place If required you can connect the console to another machine and configure a recovery operation on that machine This ability remote parallel recovery first appeared in Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 the previous Acronis products do not provide it Managed Machine aN r a j A Console Control Backup Plan 1 Archive 1 F Backup 0 m T Task 1 F Backup 1 Full backup J G F Backup 2 Backup Plan 2 Task 1 Full backup Bootable media Task 2 F Backup 0 Differential backup Data Ae Restore task D Backup 3 Select Restore Data2 from backup l Backup 4 ee Recovery using bootable media Recovery over a volume locked by the operating system such as the volume where the operating system resides requires a reboot to the bootable environment which is a part of the agent After the recovery is completed the recovered operating system goes online automatically Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 27 If the machine fails to boot or you need t
491. tailed information Click View details ona machine In the Machine details p 286 window examine information on the machine View tasks existing on a Click A View tasks machine The Tasks p 300 view will display a list of the tasks existing on the machine View log entries of a Click View log machine The Log p 302 view will display a list of the machine s log entries Refresh a list of machines Click i Refresh The management console will update the list of machines from the management server with the most recent information Though the list of machines is refreshed automatically based on events the data may not be retrieved immediately from the management server due to some latency Manual refresh guarantees that the most recent data is displayed Adding a machine to the management server To be able to deploy backup policies from Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server to a managed machine and perform other centralized management operations you need to register the machine on the management server To add a machine 1 Inthe Navigation tree select B Physical machines or All physical machines 2 Click ss Add machine on the toolbar 3 In the IP Name field enter the machine s name or its IP address or click Browse and browse the network for the machine 4 To provide a valid account for the machine click Options gt gt and specify o User name When entering the name of an Active Directo
492. tapes into tape library slots Rescan As stated above the storage node keeps information about tapes and their contents in a dedicated database The Rescan task reads information about the content of user selected tapes and updates the database The task can take a long time so it is only initiated manually You should select each slot with a tape you want to rescan before the task launch Run the Rescan task e for tapes that are unknown for the storage node e if the storage node database is lost or damaged e for tapes whose content is out of date for example a tape content was modified through another storage node or manually Bear in mind a tape might keep some backups that were deleted before the tape rescanning So after the task is completed all such backups will be recovered in the storage node database and become accessible for data recovery At rescanning a tape label should be saved in the storage node database If a slot selected for the procedure contains a tape that still does not have a label the Rescan task for the tape is paused to perform the Labeling p 137 procedure Labeling When a tape required for data recovery is not found the Task Need Interaction window will ask the user to bring the tape and insert it into a tape library slot So all the tape cartridges need a barcode or other readable labels If a tape does not get a label you should define it before the tape will be used If you need to ap
493. tart up such as storage controllers motherboard or chipset 1 3 3 WinPE ISO Builder Acronis WinPE ISO Builder is a dedicated tool for creating bootable media p 341 based on Windows preinstallation environment This tool can be installed only on machines running Windows 1 3 4 Components for centralized management This section lists the components included in the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 editions that provide the centralized management capability Besides these components Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agents have to be installed on all machines that need data protection 18 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 1 3 4 1 Management Server Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server is the central server that drives data protection within the enterprise network The management server provides the administrator with e asingle entry point to the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 infrastructure e an easy way to protect data on numerous machines p 347 using backup policies p 340 and grouping e enterprise wide monitoring functionality e the ability to create centralized vaults p 342 for storing enterprise backup archives p 339 e the ability to manage storage nodes p 350 If there are multiple management servers on the network they operate independently manage different machines and use different centralized vaults for storing archives The management server s databases The management server
494. tasks execution including reasons for failure if any Way of working with log entries e Use filters to display the desired log entries You can also hide the unneeded columns and show the hidden ones See the Filtering and sorting log entries p 191 section for details e In the log table select the log entry or log entries to take action on it See the Actions on log entries p 191 section for details e Use the Information panel to review detailed information on the selected log entry The panel is collapsed by default To expand the panel click the chevron The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Log entry details p 192 window Opening the Log with pre filtered log entries Having selected items in other administration views Dashboard Backup plans and tasks you can open the Log view with pre filtered log entries for the item in question Thus you do not have to configure filters in the log table yourself SS SYSS Dashboard In the calendar right click on any highlighted date and then select View log The Log view appears with the list of log entries already filtered by the date in question Backup plans and tasks select a backup plan or a task and then click L View log The Log view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected plan or task 190 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 1 3 1 Actions on log entries All the operations described below are performed by cl
495. te all the log Click a Clear Log entries All the log entries will be deleted from the log and a new log entry will be created It will contain information about who deleted the entries and when 6 1 3 2 Filtering and sorting log entries The following is a guideline for you to filter and sort log entries Display log entries for a In the From field select the date starting from which to display the log entries given time period In the To field select the date up to which to display the log entries Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 191 Filter log entries by Press or release the following toolbar buttons type 2 to filter error messages A to filter warning messages D to filter information messages Filter log entries by the Under the Backup plan or Managed entity type column header select the backup original backup planor plan or the type of managed entity from the list managed entity type Filter log entries by Type the required value task name machine name owner name etc in the field task managed entity below the respective column header machine code owner l l Eae l As a result you will see that the list of log entries fully or just partly coincide with the entered value Sort log entries by date Click the column s header to sort the log entries in ascending order Click it once again and time to sort the log entries in descending order Configuring the log table By default
496. tensive operation it makes sense to schedule the validation to the managed machine s off peak period On the other hand if the validation is a major part of your data protection strategy and you prefer to be immediately informed whether the backed up data is not corrupted and can be successfully recovered think of starting the validation right after backup creation 2 What to validate select either to validate the entire archive or the latest backup in the archive Validation of a file backup imitates recovery of all files from the backup to a dummy destination Validation of a volume backup calculates a checksum for every data block saved in the backup Validation of the archive will validate all the archive s backups and may take a long time and a lot of system resources 3 Validation schedule appears only if you have selected the on schedule in step 1 set the schedule of validation For more information see the Scheduling p 161 section 210 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 6 3 Recovering data When it comes to data recovery first consider the most functional method connect the console to the managed machine running the operating system and create the recovery task If the managed machine s operating system fails to start or you need to recover data to bare metal boot the machine from the bootable media p 341 or using Acronis Startup Recovery Manager p 47 Then create a recovery task Acronis Universal Restore
497. tes Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value S ALLUSERSPROFILE Application Data Acronis StorageServer Registry key HKEY LOCAL _MACHINE SOFTWARE Acronis ASN Configuration StorageServer DatabasePath TapesDatabasePath Description Specifies the folder where Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node stores its tape vaults database Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 317 This database contains a list of tape vaults that are managed by the storage node Its size depends on the number of archives stored in the tape libraries and approximately equals 10 MB per hundred archives Possible values Any string O to 32765 characters long Default value ALLUSERSPROFILE Application Data Acronis StorageServer TapesLocation Registry key HKLM SOFTWARE Acronis BackupAndRecovery TapeLocation TapesDatabasePath 7 2 Creating a backup policy A backup policy can be applied to both Windows and Linux machines To create a backup policy perform the following steps General Policy name Optional Enter a unique name for the backup policy A conscious name lets you identify the policy among the others Source type Select the type of items to back up Disk volumes or Files Policy credentials p 319 Optional You can change the policy account credentials if necessary To access this option select the Advanced view check box Policy comments Optional Type a description of the backup policy To acc
498. that the bootable agent listens for incoming connection 6 The type of media to create You can o create CD DVD or other bootable media such as removable USB flash drives if the hardware BIOS allows for boot from such media o build an ISO image of a bootable disc to burn it later on a blank disc o upload the selected components to Acronis PXE Server o upload the selected components to a WDS RIS 7 optional Windows system drivers to be used by Acronis Universal Restore p 246 This window appears only if the Acronis Universal Restore add on is installed and a media other than PXE or WDS RIS is selected 8 Path to the media ISO file or the name or IP and credentials for PXE or WDS RIS Network settings While creating Acronis bootable media you have an option to pre configure network connections that will be used by the bootable agent The following parameters can be pre configured e P address e Subnet mask e Gateway e DNS server e WINS server Once the bootable agent starts on a machine the configuration is applied to the machine s network interface card NIC If the settings have not been pre configured the agent uses DHCP auto configuration You also have the ability to configure the network settings manually when the bootable agent is running on the machine Pre configuring multiple network connections You can pre configure TCP IP settings for up to ten network interface cards To ensure that each NIC will
499. the Acronis_agent daemon Configuring the port in a bootable environment While creating Acronis bootable media you have the option to pre configure the network port that will be used by the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Bootable Agent The choice is available between e The default port 9876 e The currently used port e New port enter the port number If a port has not been pre configured the agent uses the default port number 2 11 8 5 How to apply Acronis Administrative Template The Administrative Template provided by Acronis enables the fine tuning of some security related features including encrypted communication settings Through the Microsoft Group Policy mechanism the template policy settings can be applied to a single computer as well as to a domain To load the Acronis Administrative Template Run Windows Group Policy Objects Editor windir system32 gpedit msc Open the Group Policy object GPO you want to edit Expand Computer Configuration Right click Administrative Templates Click Add Remove Templates Click Add ee SS SY Browse to the Acronis Administrative Template Program files Common Files Acronis Agent Acronis_agent adm or Program files Acronis BackupAndRecovery Acronis_agent adm and click Open Once the template is loaded you can open it and edit the desired settings After loading the template or editing its settings you should restart the configured component s or some of their
500. the appropriate privilege Without the Administrator privileges on the machine a user cannot run plans owned by other users Task Click f Run The task will be executed immediately in spite of its schedule and conditions Backup plan Click Stop Stopping the running backup plan stops all its tasks Thus all the task operations will be aborted Task Click J Stop What will happen if stop the task Generally stopping the task aborts its operation backup recovery validation exporting conversion migration The task enters the Stopping state first then becomes Idle The task schedule if created remains valid To complete the operation you will have to run the task over again recovery task from the disk backup The target volume will be deleted and its space unallocated you will get the same result if the recovery is unsuccessful To recover the lost volume you will have to run the task once again e recovery task from the file backup The aborted operation may cause changes in the destination folder Some files may be recovered but some not depending on the moment when you stopped the task To recover all the files you will have to run the task once again Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Edit a plan task Backup plan Click Edit Backup plan editing is performed in the same way as creation p 193 except for the following limitations It is not always possible to use all scheme op
501. the archives stored in the vault or delete the vault along with all the archives The plans and tasks that use this vault will fail If you choose to keep the archives for a managed vault the vault will be detached from the storage node Later on you ll be able to attach this vault to the same or to another storage node 1 Select the unmanaged vault 2 Click Explore The vault will be available for examination with the standard file manager program Click Attach The procedure of attaching a managed vault to a storage node is described in depth in the Attaching a managed vault p 129 section Click Change user Changing user credentials is available for vaults that reside on shared storages only Click Refresh While you are reviewing the vault content archives can be added to the vault deleted or modified Click Refresh to update the vault information with the most recent changes Actions on a tape library on a managed vault Define tape labels and perform inventorying of a tape library ona managed vault Rescan tapes ina managed vaults 126 Click Manage tapes In the Tape Management window define labels for tapes and refresh the inventory For more details see the Managing tape library p 136 section Click Le Rescan tapes Rescan reads information about the content of user selected tapes and updates the storage node database This operation is described in depth in the Rescan p 137 section C
502. the bootable media The drivers are not loaded into the target machine RAM therefore the media must stay inserted or connected throughout the Universal Restore operation Adding drivers to bootable media is available on the condition that 246 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 1 The Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore add on is installed on the machine where the bootable media is created AND 2 You are creating a removable media or its ISO or detachable media such as a flash drive Drivers cannot be uploaded on a PXE server or WDS RIS The drivers can be added to the list only in groups by adding the INF files or folders containing such files Selecting individual drivers from the INF files is not possible but the media builder shows the file content for your information To add drivers 1 Click Add and browse to the INF file or a folder that contains INF files 2 Select the INF file or the folder 3 Click OK The drivers can be removed from the list only in groups by removing INF files To remove drivers 1 Select the INF file 2 Click Remove 6 8 1 2 Adding the Acronis Plug in to WinPE 1 x Acronis Plug in for WinPE can be added to e Windows PE 2004 1 5 Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 2 e Windows PE 2005 1 6 Windows Server 2003 with Service Pack 1 To add Acronis Plug in to WinPE 1 x Install the Acronis Plug in for WinPE from the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 setup
503. the calculated values gives the total number of tapes required for the case 4 1 3 9 What if e What if I have to move tapes with backups from one tape library to another 1 If both tape libraries are attached to the same machine with Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node installed i e the libraries are managed by the same storage node the storage node database has all the required information about the content of the moved tapes So all Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 153 you need to do is to perform the inventory p 136 procedure for the managed vault on the library where the tapes were placed to 2 If you move tapes to a tape library managed by another storage node you should rescan p 137 each relocated tape to provide the storage node with information about backups contained on the tape e What if need to use a tape from the tape library in the local tape device and vice versa Acronis agents create backups on tapes in a format that differs from the format used by the storage node It is the reason why it is impossible to interchange tapes between tape devices attached to a storage node and attached to a managed machine a tape written by a storage node cannot be read by an agent in a locally attached tape device However the storage node can read tapes written by an agent Please refer to the tape compatibility table p 44 to get comprehensive information about the compatibility of tape formats in Acronis Ba
504. the cumulative deployment state and status of the policy 2 11 5 3 Policy deployment state on a group To see this parameter select Machines in the tree then select the group and then select the Backup policies tab on the Information pane This state is defined as a combination of deployment states of the policy on the machines included in the group and its child groups For example you applied the policy to the group consisting of machines A and B While the deployment takes place on both machines the policy s state on the group will be Deploying If the Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 63 deployment completes on one of the machines while it continues on the other the state will be Deploying Deployed When the deployment completes on both machines the state will be Deployed 2 11 5 4 Policy status on a group To see this parameter select Machines in the tree then select the group and then select the Backup policies tab on the Information pane This status is defined as the most severe status of the policy on the machines included in the group and its child groups If the policy is currently not applied to any machine its status is OK 2 11 5 5 Cumulative state and status of a policy In addition to the deployment state and status as related to a specific machine or group the backup policy has a cumulative deployment state and a cumulative status The cumulative state of a backup policy To see this para
505. the deduplication functionality The node can be installed together with the management server if the host is capable enough When installing the storage node register it on the management server in the same way as you register the agents Installation tips e Both AMS and ASN can be installed on a workstation operating system as well e There can be multiple storage nodes on the network Each of the nodes can manage up to 20 local or remote vaults e Multiple Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components can be installed on a machine with a single installation procedure e Inan Active Directory domain you can deploy the components using the Group Policy Setting up the storage node Before using the storage node make sure that all users that will back up to the node s vaults have Windows accounts on the node e If the node is included in an Active Directory domain all the domain users will be able to back up to the node and all the domain administrators will become node administrators e In a workgroup create a local user account for each user that will back up to the node Members of the Administrators group become node administrators You can add more accounts later as required 1 Run the console connect to the management server 2 Create a managed vault as described in Operations with centralized vaults p 125 Enable deduplication when creating a managed vault Setting up groups and policies The detailed explanati
506. the items you want to be displayed hidden 7 1 2 4 Policy details The Policy details window accumulates in five tabs all information on the selected backup policy and lets you perform operations with the machines and groups of machines the policy is applied to This information is also duplicated on the Information pane Backup policy The tab displays information about the selected policy Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 219 Source The tab displays information about the type of source to be backed up and the source selection rules Destination The tab displays information about the backup destination Settings The tab displays information about the backup scheme used by the policy and backup options that were modified against the default settings Applied to The tab displays a list of machines and groups the selected policy is applied to Actions To Do View details of the machine Click View details group In the Machine details p 286 Group details p 295 window examine all information on the selected machine or the selected group View tasks of the machine Click A View tasks group The Tasks p 300 view will display a list of the tasks pre filtered by the selected machine group View log of the machine Click View log group ok The Log p 302 view will display a list of the log entries pre filtered by the selected machine group Revoke policy from the Click
507. the table has seven columns that are displayed others are hidden If required you can hide the shown columns and show the hidden ones To show or hide columns 1 Right click any column header to open the context menu The menu items that are ticked off correspond to column headers presented in the table 2 Click the items you want to be displayed hidden 6 1 3 3 Log entry details Displays detailed information on the log entry you have selected and lets you copy the details to the clipboard To copy the details click the Copy to clipboard button Log entry data fields A local log entry contains the following data fields e Type type of event Error Warning Information e Date date and time of the event occurrence e Backup plan the backup plan the event relates to if any e Task the task the event relates to if any e Code the program code of the event Every type of event in the program has its own code A code is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem e Module number of the program module where the event has occurred It is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem e Owner user name of the backup plan owner only under operating system e Message a text description of the event 192 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The log entry s details that you copy will have the appearance as follows a ielaiataiatatalata
508. the unneeded columns and show the hidden ones See the Filtering and sorting log entries p 305 section for details e Select the log entry or log entries to take action on it them See the Actions on log entries p 304 section for details e Use the Information panel to review the detailed information on the selected log entry The panel is collapsed by default To expand the panel click the chevron The content of the panel is also duplicated in the Log entry details p 305 window Ways to open the Log view with the pre filtered log entries Having selected items in other administration views Dashboard Machines Backup policies Tasks you can open the Log view with already filtered log entries for the item in question Thus you do not have to configure filters in the log table by yourself wea Dashboard In the calendar right click on any highlighted date and then select View log The Log view will appear with the list of the log entries already filtered by the date in question Backup policies Select a backup policy then click View log The Log view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected policy Select a machine or a group of machines then click View log The Log view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected machine or group Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 303 Select a task and then click View log The Log view appears with the log entries belonging to th
509. thly backup is full F and daily backup is incremental I The first backup is always full The Weekly Monthly parameter splits the total schedule into daily weekly and monthly schedules Assume you select Friday for Weekly Monthly backup Here is the real schedule of the backup tasks that will be created St Me Twe We Thu Fri Sat Su Mo Tue We Thu Fsi Set Su mko Tue We Tho Fi Sat Su to Tom wo Thu Ft Sal Total schedule Daily o l l l o l ask Fo D0 L I I i Weekly e a T a T i Monthly task u aMi FIMO Backup tasks created according to the GFS scheme by Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Schedule Workdays at 8 00 PM Weekly Monthly Friday C D D DO W D D D D W D D O D W D D D OD M Keep backups Daily This step defines the retention rule for daily backups The cleanup task will run after each daily Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 33 backup and delete all daily backups that are older than you specify Keep backups Weekly This step defines the retention rule for weekly backups The cleanup task will run after each weekly backup and delete all weekly backups that are older than you specify The weekly backups retention period cannot be less than the daily backups retention period It is usually set several times longer Keep backups Monthly This step defines the retention rule for monthly backups The cleanup task will run after each
510. thout access to this specific storage node If the archive is already encrypted by the agent the storage node side encryption is applied over the encryption performed by the agent 1 3 4 3 PXE Server Acronis PXE Server allows for booting machines into Acronis bootable components through the network 20 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 The network booting e Eliminates the need to have a technician onsite to install the bootable media p 341 into the system that has to be booted e During group operations reduces the time required for booting multiple machines as compared to using physical bootable media 1 3 4 4 License Server The server enables you to manage licenses of Acronis products and install the components that require licenses For more information about Acronis License Server please see Using Acronis License Server 1 3 5 Management Console Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console is an administrative tool for remote or local access to Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agents and in the product editions that include the centralized management capability to the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server The console has two distributions for installation on Windows and installation on Linux While both distributions enable connection to any Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agent and Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server we recommend that you use the console for Windows if you
511. ting the existing archive you are meddling in the area of another backup plan that uses the archive This is not an issue if the other plan is discontinued but in general you should follow the rule one backup plan one archive Doing the opposite will not prevent the program from functioning but is not practical or efficient except for some specific cases Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 199 Why two or more plans should not back up to the same archive 1 Backing up different sources to the same archive makes using the archive difficult from the usability standpoint When it comes to recovery every second counts but you might be lost in the archive content Backup plans that operate with the same archive should back up the same data items say both plans back up volume C 2 Applying multiple retention rules to an archive makes the archive content in some way unpredictable Since each of the rules will be applied to the entire archive the backups belonging to one backup plan can be easily deleted along with the backups belonging to the other You should especially not expect the classic behavior of the GFS and Tower of Hanoi backup schemes Normally each complex backup plan should back up to its own archive 6 2 8 Access credentials for archive location Specify credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive will be stored The user whose name is specified will be considered as the archive owner
512. tion or any of multiple conditions is not met is defined by the Task start conditions p 107 backup option There you can specify how important the conditions are for the backup strategy e conditions are obligatory put the backup task run on hold until all the conditions are met e conditions are preferable but a backup task run has higher priority put the task on hold for the specified time interval If the time interval lapses and the conditions are still not met run the task anyway With this setting the program will automatically handle the situation when the conditions are not met for too long and further delaying the backup is undesirable e backup task start time matters skip the backup task if the conditions are not met at the time when the task should be started Skipping the task run makes sense when you need to back up data strictly at the specified time especially if the events are relatively often Adding multiple conditions Multiple conditions must be met simultaneously to enable task execution Example It is required to run the backup task after free space on the managed machine is changed by at least 1 GB but only if all users are logged off and more than 12 hours have passed since the last backup Set the schedule conditions and the Task start conditions backup option as follows e Schedule When free space changed Value Run task if free space has changed by at least 1 GB e Condition User logged off V
513. tion scheme is Custom with the following settings o full backup every 10 days o differential backup every 2 days o incremental backup every 1 day every 6 hours o retention rules delete backups older than 5 days tape options are the following o the Usea separate tape set option is selected o the Always use a free tape For each full backup option is selected o the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is cleared o the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is cleared e tape size is T_GB The case defines the line of backups that consists of two sections The figure below shows the sections at the moment before the first backup will be deleted In the figure the full differential and incremental backups are designated as orange blue and green rectangles respectively CISTI LPT NTI IS II wC At the moment some backups are deleted by the Cleanup task Deletion of the outdated backups painted in dark colors is postponed as these backups are basic for the actual backups Oi E oL As an exact correlation between the tape size and backup s size is unknown it is impossible to determine number of the tapes that will be free after the deletion So the calculation ignores this probability Tape set 01 should contain round up F_GB 4 D_GB 5 7 I_GB CL T_GB tapes to store the backups Tape set 02 needs round up F GB 1 D_GB 7 I_GB CL T_GB tapes The sum of
514. tions Lei Back up Recover ff Validate Fe Create personal location Create ASZ continue Mount image Create backup policy Ca Manage mounted images Go 4dd centralized location Actions bar on a managed machine and on a management server Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 13 Tools Contains a list of the Acronis tools Always the same across all the program views All the tools can also be accessed in the Tools menu D Create bootable media B Install Acronis components Tools bar Help Contains a list of help topics Different views and action pages of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provided with lists of specific help topics 1 2 1 3 Operations with panes How to expand minimize panes By default the Navigation pane appears expanded and the Actions and Tools minimized You might need to minimize the pane in order to free some additional workspace To do this click the chevron del for the Navigation pane gt for the Actions and tools pane The pane will be minimized and the chevron changes its direction Click the chevron once again to expand the pane How to change the panes borders 1 Point to the pane s border 2 When the pointer becomes a double headed arrow drag the pointer to move the border The management console remembers the way the panes borders are set When you run the management console next time all the panes borders will have the same positio
515. tions So for the backup policy to be created you can use a separate tape set for all machines or for each single machine The A single tape set for all machines option is selected by default Generally this option ensures more efficient usage of tapes than the A separate tape set for each single machine option However the second one can be useful for example when there are special requirements to store the tapes with backups from a specific machine off site When the Use a separate tape set option is enabled there might be a case when the backup has to be written onto a tape that is currently out of the tape library device Define what to do in this case e Ask for user interaction the backup task will enter the Need Interaction state and wait for the tape with the required label to be loaded into the tape library device e Use a free tape the backup will be written onto a free tape so the operation will be paused only if there is no free tape in the library Always use a free tape If you leave the options below unchanged then each backup will be written onto the tape specified by the Use a separate tape set option With some of the options below enabled the program will add new tapes to the tape set every time when a full incremental or differential backup is created 138 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 e For each full backup The preset is Disabled When this option is enabled each full backup will be written onto
516. tions Use the Refresh button to refresh the list of archives You can switch between displaying archives by names and displaying the physical representation of the archives as TIB files using the Show archives and Show TIB files buttons 6 4 5 Access credentials for source Specify the credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive is stored Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 233 To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the task credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the task account specified in the General section o Use the following credentials The program will access the location using the credentials you specify Use this option if the task account does not have access permissions to the location You might need to provide special credentials for a network share or a storage node vault Specify e User name When entering the name of an Active Directory user account be sure to also specify the domain name DOMAIN Username or Username domain e Password The password for the account 2 Click OK As appears from the original FTP specification credentials required for access to FTP servers are transferred _ through a network as plaintext This means that the user name and password can be intercepted by an i eavesdropper using a packet sniffer 6 4 6 When to validate As validation is a resource intensive operation it makes sens
517. tions when editing a backup plan if the created archive is not empty i e contains backups 1 It is not possible to change the scheme to Grandfather Father Son or Tower of Hanoi 2 If the Tower of Hanoi scheme is used it is not possible to change the number of levels In all other cases the scheme can be changed and should continue to operate as if existing archives were created by a new scheme For empty archives all changes are possible Why can t I edit the backup plan The backup plan is currently running Editing of the currently running backup plan is impossible Do not have the appropriate privilege Without the Administrator privileges on the machine a user cannot edit plans owned by other users The backup plan has a centralized origin Direct editing of centralized backup plans is not possible You need to edit the original backup policy Task Click Edit Why can t I edit the task e Task belongs to a backup plan Only tasks that do not belong to a backup plan such as a recovery task can be modified by direct editing When you need to modify a task belonging to a local backup plan edit the backup plan A task belonging to a centralized backup plan can be modified by editing the centralized policy that soawned the plan Only the management server administrator can do so Do not have the appropriate privilege Without the Administrator privileges on the machine a user cannot modify tas
518. tition table If the disk is full and the volume size cannot be automatically decreased the conversion operation of the MBR disk to GPT will fail The operation is irreversible If you have a primary volume belonging to an MBR disk and convert the disk first to GPT and then back to MBR the volume will be logical and will not be able to be used as a system volume If you plan to install an OS that does not support GPT disks the reverse conversion of the disk to MBR is also possible through the same menu items the name of the operation will be listed as Convert to MBR Dynamic disk conversion MBR to GPT Acronis Disk Director Lite does not support direct MBR to GPT conversion for dynamic disks However you can perform the following conversions to reach the goal using the program 1 MBR disk conversion dynamic to basic p 264 using the Convert to basic operation 2 Basic disk conversion MBR to GPT using the Convert to GPT operation 3 GPT disk conversion basic to dynamic p 263 using the Convert to dynamic operation 6 9 5 4 Disk conversion GPT to MBR If you plan to install an OS that does not support GPT disks conversion of the GPT disk to MBR is possible the name of the operation will be listed as Convert to MBR 262 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 If you need to convert a GPT disk to MBR 1 Select a GPT disk to convert to MBR 2 Right click on the selected volume and then click Convert to MBR in the
519. to a basic simple or mirrored volume e A system volume was recovered to a disk that does not have an MBR When you configure recovery of a system volume to a disk that does not have an MBR the program prompts whether you want to recover the MBR along with the system volume Opt for not recovering only if you do not want the system to be bootable Solution Recover the volume once again along with the MBR of the corresponding disk e The system uses Acronis OS Selector Because the Master Boot Record MBR can be changed during the system recovery Acronis OS Selector which uses the MBR might become inoperable If this happens reactivate Acronis OS Selector as follows Solution Boot the machine from the Acronis Disk Director s bootable media and select in the menu Tools gt Activate OS Selector e The system uses GRand Unified Bootloader GRUB and was recovered from a normal not from a raw that is sector by sector backup One part of the GRUB loader resides either in the first several sectors of the disk or in the first several sectors of the volume The rest is on the file system of one of the volumes System bootability can be recovered automatically only when the GRUB resides in the first several sectors of the disk and on the file system to which direct access is possible In other cases the user has to manually reactivate the boot loader Solution Reactivate the boot loader You might also need to fix the configuration fil
520. to enable a POP server and to set up its settings e Incoming mail server POP enter the name of the POP server e Port set the port of the POP server By default the port is set to 110 e User name enter the user name e Password enter the password o Select the Use the specified outgoing mail server check box to enable an SMTP server and to set up its settings e Outgoing mail server SMTP enter the name of the SMTP server e Port set the port of the SMTP server By default the port is set to 25 e User name enter the user name e Password enter the password Click Send test e mail message to check if the settings are correct Messenger service WinPopup This option is effective for Windows and Linux operating systems This option is not available when operating under bootable media The option enables you to receive WinPopup notifications about about the recovery task s successful completion failure or need for interaction The preset is Disabled Before configuring WinPopup notifications make sure the Messenger service is started on both the machine executing the task and the machine that will receive messages The Messenger service is not started by default in the Microsoft Windows Server 2003 family Change the service Startup mode to Automatic and start the service To configure WinPopup notifications 1 2 Select the Send WinPopup notifications check box In the Machine name
521. to the configuration provided by the policy Revoking a policy is the reverse action to the aggregate of applying and deploying Revoking removes the correspondence between the policy and one or more machines and then removes the tasks from the machines If a machine is not available or not reachable at the moment the change will be propagated on the machine when it becomes available This means that deploying a policy to multiple machines is not a momentary action The same is true for revoking These two processes may be durable and so the management server tracks and displays personal statuses for each machine that it works with as well as the policy s cumulative status 2 11 4 1 A policy on a machine or a group In the diagrams below each numbered scheme illustrates the result of the respectively numbered action The container stands for a group the colored circle stands for a machine with applied policy the dark colored circle stands for a machine with two applications of the same policy the white circle stands for a machine to which no policy is applied Policy on a machine 1 A policy can be applied to a machine 2 A policy can be revoked from a machine Policy on a group A policy can be applied to a group A policy can be revoked from a group A policy applied to a group cannot be revoked from a machine 7 oS E To revoke the policy from the machine remove the machine from the group Copyright Acron
522. to the value in Vault Free Space Warning Percentage or less a warning is recorded in the storage node s log indicating the vault in question You can view storage node warnings in the Dashboard 308 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 _ Note The parameters Vault Free Space Warning Limit and Vault Free Space Warning Percentage are _ independent of each other a warning will be recorded every time that either of the thresholds is reached Vault Free Space Error Limit Description Specifies the amount of free space in a managed vault in megabytes below which an error is recorded in the storage node s log and any backup to the vault becomes prohibited Possible values Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value 50 When the amount of free space in a vault is equal to the value in Vault Free Space Error Limit or less an error is recorded in the storage node s log Backups performed to the vault will keep failing until the vault s free space is above the limit Vault Database Free Space Warning Limit Description Specifies the amount of free space in megabytes on the volume containing a managed vault s database below which a warning is recorded in the storage node s log Possible values Any integer number between 0 and 2147483647 Default value 20 If the amount of free space on the volume containing a managed vault s database is less than the value in Vault Database Free Space Warning Limit a warning is recorded
523. trative users A user who has administrative privileges on the machine such as a member of the Administrators or Backup Operators group additionally has the following management rights e Back up and recover the entire machine or any data on the machine with or without using a disk snapshot Members of the Administrators group also can e View and manage backup plans and tasks owned by any user on the machine 2 4 Owners and credentials This section explains the concept of owner and the meaning of a backup plan s or task s credentials Plan task owner A local backup plan owner is the user who created or last modified the plan A centralized backup plan owner is the management server administrator who created or last modified the centralized policy that spawned the plan Tasks belonging to a backup plan either local or centralized are owned by the backup plan owner 30 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Tasks that do not belong to a backup plan such as the recovery task are owned by the user who has created or last modified the task Managing a plan task owned by another user Having Administrator privileges on the machine a user can modify tasks and local backup plans owned by any user registered in the operating system When a user opens a plan or task for editing which is owned by another user all passwords set in the task are cleared This prevents the modify settings leave passwords trick The prog
524. tructions Acronis PXE Server runs as a service immediately after installation Later on it will automatically launch at each system restart You can stop and start Acronis PXE Server in the same way as other Windows services 6 8 6 2 Setting up a machine to boot from PXE For bare metal it is enough that the machine s BIOS supports network booting Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 255 On a machine that has an operating system on the hard disk the BIOS must be configured so that the network interface card is either the first boot device or at least prior to the Hard Drive device The example below shows one of reasonable BIOS configurations If you don t insert bootable media the machine will boot from the network In some BIOS versions you have to save changes to BIOS after enabling the network interface card so that the card appears in the list of boot devices If the hardware has multiple network interface cards make sure that the card supported by the BIOS has the network cable plugged in 6 8 6 3 PXE and DHCP on the same server If Acronis PXE Server and the DHCP server are on the same machine add to the DHCP server option 60 Client Identifier with string value PXE Client This can be done as follows C WINDOWS system32 gt netsh netsh gt dhcp netsh gt dhcp gt server lt server_machine_name gt or lt IP address gt netsh dhcp gt add optiondef 60 PXEClient STRING comment Option added for
525. ts p 339 that create the archives This means that each agent not only backs up data to the archive but also executes service tasks that apply to the archive the retention rules and validation rules specified by the backup plan p 340 To relieve the managed machines of unnecessary CPU load execution of the service tasks can be delegated to the storage node Since the tasks schedule exists on the machine the agent resides on and therefore uses that machine s time and events the agent has to initiate the storage node side cleanup p 350 and the storage node side validation p 350 according to the schedule To do so the agent must be online Further processing is performed by the storage node This functionality cannot be disabled in a managed vault The next two operations are optional Deduplication A managed vault can be configured as a deduplicating vault This means that identical data will be backed up to this vault only once to minimize the network usage during backup and storage space taken by the archives For more information please see Deduplication p 64 Encryption A managed vault can be configured so that anything written to it is encrypted and anything read from it is decrypted transparently by the storage node using a vault specific encryption key stored on the node server In case the storage medium is stolen or accessed by an unauthorized person the malefactor will not be able to decrypt the vault contents wi
526. ts run as services A service runs under an account either a user account such as Administrator or a system account such as Local System A security best practice is to run each service under a dedicated user account which has only a minimal set of user rights needed for that service When installing a component that runs as a service you can specify the account under which the service will run either a default account for the component or an existing account The following table shows the necessary user rights and the default names of the user accounts for each component s service 72 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Component name Service name Necessary user rights Default user account Acronis Backup amp Acronis Managed Log on as a Service Acronis Agent User Recovery 10 Agent Machine Service Backup filesandidireetories Log on locally Restore files and directories Shut down the system Acronis Backup amp Acronis Management Log on asa service Recovery 10 Server Management Server Acronis Backup amp Acronis Storage Log on as a service Recovery 10 Storage Server Node These users are also granted access to the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE SOFTWARE Acronis called Acronis registry key with the following rights Query Value Set Value Create Subkey Enumerate Subkeys Notify Delete and Read Control Important It is only during installation that you can specify a user account for an Acronis service If
527. u can start the machine using the respective virtualization software or prepare the machine files for further usage The Citrix XenServer virtual appliance can be imported to a XenServer using Citrix XenCenter The VMware Workstation machine can be converted to the open virtualization format OVF using the VMware OVF tool With Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi you can recover a disk volume backup to a new virtual machine on the respective virtualization server To convert a disk backup to a virtual machine 1 Connect the console to a machine where Agent for Windows Agent for Hyper V or Agent for ESX ESXi is installed 2 Do any of the following o Click Recover to open the Recover data page Start creating a recovery task as described in Recovering data p 211 Select the archive and then select the disk or volume backup you want to convert o Use the Navigation pane to navigate to the vault where the archive is stored Select the archive and then select the disk or volume backup you want to convert Click Recover as virtual machine The Recover data page opens with the pre selected backup Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 225 3 In Data type select Disks or Volumes depending on what you need to convert 4 In Content select the disks to convert or the volumes with the Master Boot Records MBR of the corresponding disks 5 In Recover to select New virtual machine 6 In VM
528. un Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Console and connect it to a managed machine the Disk management view will be available in the Navigation tree of the console with which you can start Acronis Disk Director Lite Running Acronis Disk Director Lite from a bootable media You can run Acronis Disk Director Lite on a bare metal on a machine that cannot boot or on a non Windows machine To do so boot the machine from a bootable media p 341 created with the Acronis Bootable Media Builder run the management console and then click Disk Management Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 257 6 9 3 Choosing the operating system for disk management On a machine with two or more operating systems representation of disks and volumes depends on which operating system is currently running A volume may have a different letter in different Windows operating systems For example volume E might appear as D or L when you boot another Windows operating system installed on the same machine It is also possible that this volume will have the same letter E under any Windows OS installed on the machine A dynamic disk created in one Windows operating system is considered as a Foreign Disk in another Windows operating system or might be unsupported by this operating system When you need to perform a disk management operation on such machine it is necessary to specify for which operating system the disk layout will be displayed and the di
529. und but the RSM database has no information about the tape it will be moved into the Import pool If the RSM database has the information the tape moves into its own pool of the application Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node provides the RSM to detect the tapes written by Acronis True Image Echo Acronis True Image 9 1 product families and by components of Acronis Backup amp 132 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Recovery 10 The storage node will locate all tapes written in Acronis format into the Acronis pool at the Inventory p 136 operation Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components don t use the Unrecognized pool To utilize a tape from this pool forcibly move the tape to the Free pool using the Removable storage snap in Control panel gt Administrative tools gt Computer management gt Removable storage gt Media pools If a tape has moved into the Free pool it is considered as free and will be accessible to write by any application _ So the tape data will be lost If all the backups are deleted from a tape it will not return to the Free pool It remains in the Acronis pool as a free tape to be reused So if a storage node needs a new tape it finds a free tape first in the Acronis pool then in the Free pool Thereinafter Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node deals only with the tapes belonging to the Acronis pool A1 3 5 Getting started with a tape library If you have a tape libr
530. uneceeseuens 89 Defaut ACK UDO TIONS moreenia E E r a eae EEEE NE E i 89 Defaut retovery Opo Si a a N ences 112 WAUIES E E A A S E E E N E S E E E EE ETS 122 Centaized VAUIES anea e E E TASA E iewae ateuies 123 Working with the Centralized vault ViOW ccccsssscccesssseccesssnsecesssseeecesssseeecssseseeeessseseeeessaeeeeees snes 124 ACTIONS on tenttalized Vaults ast scald a duces oheadvnale el aaa eae cones ce Eero ll antes ose 125 Dc oy a a lt Renee oe eA tre a SCT a EU a 130 PEESOMAl vaults serisini i ea ENEE E S E NEA 154 Working with the Personal vault view ssssssssssseesoseeessseresssseesssererssosensssrreesseeessseressoeesssrrees rees 155 ACTIONS ON PElSONG yat eaa a E N 156 COMMON ODE ATOMS sieour na N N N 157 Operations with archives stored in a vault ssossessoseeesssreessoseesssreessoseessssreessoreesssreessseressssreees eneses 157 Operations With BackUPS ninenin ai a A A A A a aaa ai 158 Deleune archives and DackUpS wiscacinssee cxcobsarsoaunnevsenevtbyssencs tslinececnapadaresties aaa 159 Fitenne and S rtine areni VE Scansione es aucevcusyndevinteenie a eceetaved neon aee 159 SCION Besa ccs eee cease sites tac cpecisas a A 161 DAVES CIC OU Crsonszca tecacuapseecanrecsasnd yennce E O 162 W BONY SCO CUO saran A N 164 NVIOINERIY SCM OO UIC esas ete cishas ios Sali cre Gala tesa saacain cs Mle E Wags seatnnaeuseeanaceeence 167 Advanced scheduling Setn Sna narn ATA N AN eas 169 At Windows Event Loe
531. up There are probably other times when you may need to recover the MBR but the above are the most common When recovering the MBR of one disk to another Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 recovers Track O which does not affect the target disk s partition table and partition layout Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 automatically updates Windows loaders after recovery so there is no need to recover the MBR and Track O for Windows systems unless the MBR is damaged 6 3 4 2 Files selection To select a backup and files to recover 1 Select one of the successive incremental backups by its creation date time Thus you can revert the files folders to a specific moment in time Specify the files and folders to recover by selecting the corresponding check boxes in the archives tree Selecting a folder automatically selects all its nested folders and files Use the table to the right of the archives tree to select the nested items Selecting the check box for the Name column s header automatically selects all items in the table Clearing this check box automatically deselects all the items Click OK Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 215 6 3 5 Access credentials for location Specify the credentials required for access to the location where the backup archive is stored To specify credentials 1 Select one of the following o Use the task credentials The program will access the location using the credentials of the tas
532. up amp Recovery 10 Yes Management Console Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Agent Yes Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Yes Yes Management Server Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Yes Yes Storage Node Acronis PXE Server No Yes Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Yes Yes Bootable Agent 2 11 8 3 Configuring communication settings You can configure communication settings such as whether to encrypt transferred data for Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components installed on one or more machines by using Acronis Administrative Template For information on how to load the Administrative Template see How to load Acronis Administrative Template p 78 74 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 When applied to a single machine the Administrative Template defines the communication settings for all the components on the machine when applied to a domain or an organizational unit it defines the communication settings for all the components on the machines in that domain or organizational unit To configure communication settings 1 2 Click Start then click Run and then type gpedit msc In the Group Policy console expand Computer Configuration then expand Administrative Templates and then click Acronis In the Acronis pane to the right double click a communication option that you want to configure The Administrative Template contains the following options each option is explained later in this topic o Remote Agent
533. up policy p 340 from the management server p 348 and can be modified only by editing the backup policy Centralized vault A networked location allotted by the management server p 348 administrator to serve as storage for the backup archives p 339 A centralized vault can be managed by a storage node p 350 or be unmanaged The total number and size of archives stored in a centralized vault are limited by the storage size only As soon as the management server administrator creates a centralized vault the vault name and path to the vault are distributed to all machines registered p 349 on the server The shortcut to the vault appears on the machines in the Centralized vaults list Any backup plan p 340 existing on the machines including local plans can use the centralized vault 342 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 On a machine that is not registered on the management server a user having the privilege to back up to the centralized vault can do so by specifying the full path to the vault If the vault is managed the user s archives will be managed by the storage node as well as other archives stored in the vault Cleanup Deleting backups p 339 from a backup archive p 339 in order to get rid of outdated backups or prevent the archive from exceeding the desired size Cleanup consists in applying to an archive the retention rules set by the backup plan p 340 that produces the archive This operation checks
534. up policy that you want to apply to the machine group Use filters to display the desired policies 2 Click OK Adding a machine to another group To add the selected machine to another group 1 Select the group the machine will be added to 2 Click OK The machine being added becomes a member of more than one group As a result the backup policies applied to the first group will remain on the machine and the backup policies applied to the second third etc group will be deployed to the machine Moving a machine to another group To move the selected machine to another group 1 Inthe group tree select the group the machine will be moved to 2 Click OK The machine being moved leaves one group and becomes a member of another group As a result the backup policies applied to the first group will be revoked from the machine and the backup policies applied to the second group will be deployed to the machine Adding machines to a group To add machines to the selected group In the groups tree select the group whose machines you need to add In the right part of the window select the machines To add more machines from other groups repeat the steps 1 and 2 for each group a 2 Click OK to add machines Once the machines appear in the group the policy that was applied to the group if any is deployed to the machines If any of the selected machines is not available or reachable at the moment the action will b
535. ups cannot be deleted moved to other groups or manually modified Custom groups cannot be created within built in groups There is no way to remove a physical machine from the built in group except for deleting the machine from the management server Virtual machines are deleted as a result of their host server deletion A backup policy p 340 can be applied to a built in group C Centralized backup plan A backup plan p 340 that appears on the managed machine p 348 as a result of deploying a backup policy p 340 from the management server p 348 Such plan can be modified only by editing the backup policy Centralized management Management of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 infrastructure through a central management unit known as Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server p 348 The centralized management operations include e creating applying and managing backup policies p 340 e creating and managing static p 349 and dynamic groups p 346 of machines p 347 e managing the tasks p 350 existing on the machines e creating and managing centralized vaults p 342 for storing archives e managing storage nodes p 350 e monitoring activities of the Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components viewing the centralized log and more Centralized task A task p 350 belonging to a centralized backup plan p 342 Such task appears on the managed machine p 348 as a result of deploying a back
536. urred if any e Code Blank or the program error code if the event type is error Error code is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem e Module Blank or the number of program module where an error was occurred It is an integer number that may be used by Acronis support service to solve the problem e Owner User name of the policy backup plan owner p 30 e Message The event text description The log entry s details that you copy will have the following appearance sialaiataiatataiataiatatatetatetatatatatatatatatatate Log Entry Details Type Information Date and time DD MM YYYY HH MM SS Backup plan Backup plan name Task Task name Managed entity type Machine Managed entity ENTITY NAME Machine MACHINE NAME Message Description of the operation Code 12 3x45678A Module Module name Owner Owner of the plan 7 1 7 Configuring Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components There are three ways to configure various parameters of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components in Windows e By using Group Policy in Windows e By using the graphical user interface GUI e By modifying the Windows registry In Linux instead of using of Group Policy and modifying the registry parameters are configured by editing the corresponding configuration files If the values of any of these parameters set through Group Policy differ from those set through the g
537. use a free tape For each full backup option is selected e the Always use a free tape For each incremental backup option is selected e the Always use a free tape For each differential backup option is selected The figure shows tape rotation for the TOH scheme with these options W ti W i2 W 03 W 04 W i2 W 05 ey 04 w OF W 05 el ii W 03 w ik W 06 W i W 04 W 03 w i2 W OT W 03 ey 04 W OT W 06 w i 03 w ii W 05 W ti i Maximal number of tapes used in the rotation is seven that is more than in classical five level ToH scheme Two additional tapes used for 1 keeping an old full backup postponed deletion as it is a base for other level backups 2 keeping an old backup on a level until a new backup has been successfully created on the level The example demonstrates that the tapes usage efficiency is reduced Moreover the data recovery requires access to the backups kept on one full backups 6 two differential backups 44 or three incremental backups 50 tapes So on average the operation takes more time than in the previous examples Tape planning Once you have specified the backup scheme and tape options you should determine the minimal number of tapes necessary to achieve full automation of tape rotation To simplify the tape planning lets discard the possibility that the calculated tapes might contain backups of other data It is
538. uses three Microsoft SQL databases e The configuration database that stores the list of registered machines and other configuration information including backup policies created by the administrator e The synchronization database used for synchronization of the management server with registered machines and storage nodes This is a database with rapidly changing operational data e The reporting database that stores the centralized log This database may grow large Its size depends on the logging level you set The configuration and synchronization databases should reside on the same Microsoft SQL Server called an operational server preferably installed on the same machine as the management server The reporting database can be configured on the same or different SQL server When installing a management server you can select for both operational and reporting servers what server to use The following options are available 1 Microsoft SQL Server 2005 Express that comes with the installation package and installs on the same machine In this case an SQL server instance with three databases will be created on the machine 2 Microsoft SQL Server 2008 any edition previously installed on any machine 3 Microsoft SQL Server 2005 any edition previously installed on any machine 1 3 4 2 Storage Node Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Storage Node is a server aimed to optimize usage of various resources such as the corporate storage
539. ut requires extra space for storing backups whose deletion is postponed The archive size and or the backup age can exceed the values you specify Consolidate the backup The program will consolidate the backup that is subject to deletion with the next dependent backup For example the retention rules require to delete a full backup but retain the next incremental one The backups will be combined into a single full backup which will be dated the incremental backup date When an incremental or differential backup from the middle of the chain is deleted the resulting backup type will be incremental Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 This mode ensures that after each cleanup the archive size and the backups age are within the bounds you specify The consolidation however may take a lot of time and system resources And you still need some extra space in the vault for temporary files created during consolidation What you need to know about consolidation Please be aware that consolidation is just a method of deletion but not an alternative to deletion The resulting backup will not contain data that was present in the deleted backup and was absent from the retained incremental or differential backup Backups resulting from consolidation always have maximum compression This means that all backups in an archive may acquire the maximum compression as a result of repeated cleanup with consolidation Best practices Maintain the balance
540. validation p 351 viewing contents mounting and deleting backups should be performed using Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Do not modify your archives using non Acronis tools such as Windows Explorer or third party file managers Backup operation An operation that creates a copy of the data that exists on a machine s p 347 hard disk for the purpose of recovering or reverting the data to a specified date and time Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 339 Backup options Configuration parameters of a backup operation p 339 such as pre post backup commands maximum network bandwidth allotted for the backup stream or data compression level Backup options are a part of a backup plan p 340 Backup plan Plan A set of rules that specify how the given data will be protected on a given machine A backup plan specifies e what data to back up e where to store the backup archive p 339 the backup archive name and location e the backup scheme p 341 that includes the backup schedule and optionally the retention rules optionally the archive validation rules p 352 e the backup options p 340 For example a backup plan can contain the following information e back up volume C this is the data the plan will protect e name the archive MySystemVolume and place it to server backups this is the backup archive name and location e perform full backup monthly on the last day of the month at 10 00AM and
541. vents are accessible through the centralized log only Centralized event log The centralized event log is accessible when the console is connected to the management server With the centralized log you can examine the history of centralized management operations such as creating a managed entities group applying a policy managing a centralized vault as well as the history of operations logged in the local logs of the registered machines and the storage nodes Physically the centralized event log is a table in the dedicated Microsoft SQL database The table contains log entries for events occurred on the management server and the local logs entries extended to the centralized log entry format You can select the types of entries to be collected from the local logs to the centralized database or disable collecting any local entries See the Logging level p 84 section for details The management server events logging cannot be adjusted or disabled Note that there are limitations on the number of log entries in the centralized event log because the SQL Express database has a 4 GB limitation for the database size Way of working with log entries e The maximum number of entries stored in the centralized log is 50000 The maximum number of entries that can be displayed is 10000 In case the number of log entries is greater than 10000 use filtering and sorting capabilities to display the desired log entries in the table You can also hide
542. vide it Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 157 All the operations described below are performed by clicking the corresponding buttons on the toolbar These operations can be also accessed from the Archive name actions bar on the Actions and tools pane and from the Archive name actions item of the main menu respectively The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with archives stored in a vault To Validate an archive Delete a single archive or multiple archives Delete all archives in the vault Do Click wt Validate The Validation p 230 page will be opened with the pre selected archive as a source Validation of an archive will check all the archive s backups 1 Select the archive or one of the archives you want to delete 2 Click pia Delete The program duplicates your selection in the Backups deletion p 159 window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup Review the selection and correct if need be select the check boxes for the desired archives then confirm the deletion Please be aware that if filters have been applied to the vaults list you see only a part of the vault content Be sure that the vault does not contain archives you need to retain before starting the operation Click H Delete all The program duplicates your selection in the new window that has check boxes for each archive and each backup Review the selection and correct if need be then confirm the del
543. volume 1 Select a volume to format 2 Right click on the selected volume and then click Format in the context menu You will be forwarded to the Format Volume window where you will be able to set the new file system options You can choose one of the Windows file systems FAT16 disabled if the Volume Size is more than 2 GB FAT32 disabled if the Volume Size is more than 32 GB or NTFS In the text window you will be able to enter the volume label if necessary by default this window is empty In setting the cluster size you can choose between any number in the preset amount for each file system Note the program suggests the cluster size best suited to the volume with the chosen file system 3 If you click OK to proceed with the Format Volume operation you ll add a pending operation of formatting a volume To finish the added operation you will have to commit p 271 it Exiting the program without committing the pending operations will effectively cancel them The new volume structure will be graphically represented in the Disk management view If you set a 64K cluster size for FAT16 FAT32 or an 8KB 64KB cluster size for NTFS Windows can mount the volume but some programs e g Setup programs might calculate its disk space incorrectly 6 9 7 Pending operations All operations which were prepared by the user in manual mode or with the aid of a wizard are considered pending until the user issues the specific
544. w to manage backup plans and tasks on the managed machine run edit stop and delete plans and tasks view their states and statuses monitor plans o amp vaults Use this view to manage personal vaults and archives stored in there add new vaults rename and delete the existing ones validate vaults explore backup content mount backups as virtual drives etc o lt Log Use this view to examine information on operations performed by the program on the managed machine E o Disk management Use this view to perform operations on the machine s hard disk drives Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 11 Views for a management server When the console is connected to a management server the following views are available in the navigation tree fi Management server name Root of the tree also called a Welcome view Displays the name of the management server the console is currently connected to Use this view for quick access to the main operations available on the management server o Dashboard Use this view to estimate at a glance whether the data is successfully protected on the machines registered on the management server Backup policies Use this view to manage backup policies existing on the management server EE Physical machines Use this view to manage machines registered on the management server gt Vaults Use this view to manage centralized vaults and archives stored in there create new managed and u
545. when e you need the possibility to roll back to any one of multiple saved states e the data changes tend to be small as compared to the total data size It is widely accepted that incremental backups are less reliable than full ones because if one backup in the chain is corrupted the next ones can no longer be used However storing multiple full backups is not an option when you need multiple prior versions of your data because reliability of an oversized archive is even more questionable Example Backing up a database transaction log Differential backup A differential backup stores changes to the data against the latest full backup You need access to the corresponding full backup to recover the data from a differential backup A differential backup is most useful when e you are interested in saving only the most recent data state e the data changes tend to be small as compared to the total data size The typical conclusion is differential backups take longer to do and are faster to restore while incremental ones are quicker to do and take longer to restore In fact there is no physical difference between an incremental backup appended to a full backup and a differential backup appended to the same full backup at the same point of time The above mentioned difference implies creating a differential backup after or instead of creating multiple incremental backups An incremental or differential backup created after disk
546. when the waiting period ends 5 6 4 User logged off Applies to Windows Enables to put a backup task run on hold until all users log off from Windows on the managed machine Example Run the backup task at 8 PM on the first and third Friday of every month preferably when all users are logged off If one of the users is still logged on at 11 PM run the task anyway e Event Monthly Months lt All gt On lt First gt lt Third gt lt Friday gt Once at 08 00 00 PM e Condition User logged off e Task start conditions Wait until the conditions are met Run the task anyway after 3 hour s As a result Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 175 1 If all users are logged off at 8PM the backup task will start at 8PM 2 If the last user logs off between 8PM and 11PM the backup task will start immediately after the user has logged off 3 If any of the users is still logged on at 11PM the backup task starts anyway 5 6 5 Time since last backup _ Applies to Windows Linux Enables to put a backup task run on hold until the specified time interval since the last successful backup completion passes Example Run the backup task after free space on the managed machine has changed by at least 1 GB but only if more than 12 hours have passed since the last successful backup e Event When free space changed Run task if free space has changed by at least 1 GB e Condition Time since last backup Time since
547. which enables you to create or delete volumes change a disk partitioning style create a disk group and perform other disk management operations on the target hardware both under the operating system and on bare metal To find out more about Acronis Disk Director LV see the Disk management p 256 section To create a recovery task perform the following steps General Task name Optional Enter a unique name for the recovery task A conscious name lets you quickly identify the task among the others Task credentials p 213 Optional The task will run on behalf of the user who is creating the task You can change the task account credentials if necessary To access this option select the Advanced view check box What to recover Archive p 213 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 211 Select the archive to recover data from Data type p 214 Applies to disk recovery Choose the type of data you need to recover from the selected disk backup Content p 214 Select the backup and content to be recovered Access credentials p 216 Optional Provide credentials for the archive location if the task account does not have the right to access it To access this option select the Advanced view check box Where to recover This section appears after the required backup is selected and the type of data to recover is defined The parameters you specify here depend on the type of data being recovered Disks p 216 V
548. will be created on Tuesdays and Thursdays with weekly and monthly backups performed on Fridays Note that in order to choose Friday in the Weekly monthly field you need to first select it in the Back up on field Such an archive would allow you to compare your financial documents as of the first and the last day of work and have a five year history of all documents etc Consider a more exotic GFS scheme e Start backup at 12 00 PM e Back up on Friday e Weekly monthly Friday Keep backups o Daily 1 week o Weekly 1 month o Monthly indefinitely Backup is thus performed only on Fridays This makes Friday the only choice for weekly and monthly backups leaving no other date for daily backups The resulting Grandfather Father archive will hence consist only of weekly differential and monthly full backups Even though it is possible to use GFS to create such an archive the Custom scheme is more flexible in this situation 1 2 1 5 Tower of Hanoi scheme At a glance e Upto 16 levels of full differential and incremental backups e Next level backups are twice as rare as previous level backups e One backup of each level is stored at a time e Higher density of more recent backups Parameters You can set up the following parameters of a Tower of Hanoi scheme Schedule Set up a daily p 162 weekly p 164 or monthly p 167 schedule Setting up schedule parameters allows creating simple schedules example of a
549. without committing the pending operations effectively cancels them so if you try to exit Disk management without committing the pending operations you will receive the appropriate warning 212 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 7 Centralized management This section covers operations that can be performed centrally by using the components for centralized management The content of this section is only applicable to advanced editions of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 7 1 Administering Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Management Server This section describes the views that are available through the navigation tree of the console connected to the management server and explains how to work with each view 7 1 1 Dashboard Use the Dashboard to estimate at a glance the health of data protection on the registered machines The Dashboard displays the summary of Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 agents activities lets you check for free space available in managed vaults and rapidly identify and resolve any issues Alerts The alerts section draws your attention to issues that have occurred on the management server and registered machines in centralized vaults and offers you ways of fixing or examining them The most critical issues are displayed at the top If there are no alerts or warnings at the moment the system displays No alerts or warnings Types of alerts The table below illustrates the types of messages you may
550. work connection Bootable Media Builder can also create an ISO image of a bootable disk to burn it later on a blank disk When using the media builder you have to specify 1 The Acronis bootable components to be placed on the media o Universal Restore can be enabled if Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore is installed on the machine where the media is created Otherwise a free or used license for Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 Universal Restore must be present on Acronis License Server or you have to enter the license key for Universal Restore 2 optional The timeout interval for the boot menu plus the component that will automatically Start on timeout o If not configured the Acronis loader waits for someone to select whether to boot the operating system if present or the Acronis component 244 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 o Ifyou set say 10 sec for the bootable agent the agent will launch 10 seconds after the menu is displayed This enables unattended onsite operation when booting from a PXE server or WDS RIS 3 optional Remote logon settings o user name and password to be entered on the console side at connection to the agent If you leave these fields empty the connection will be enabled on typing any symbols in the prompt window 4 optional Network settings p 245 o TCP IP settings to be assigned to the machine network adapters 5 optional Network port p 246 o the TCP port
551. y Media based on PE 2 x that is Windows Vista or Windows Server 2008 kernel allows for dynamic loading of the necessary device drivers 6 8 1 How to create bootable media Linux based bootable media To create Linux based bootable media prepare a blank disk install Acronis PXE Server or set up WDS RIS Then start the Bootable Media Builder by selecting Tools gt Create Bootable Rescue Media The wizard will guide you through the necessary operations Please refer to Bootable Media Builder p 244 for details PE based bootable media Acronis Plug in for WinPE can be added to WinPE distributions based on any of the following kernels e Windows XP Professional with Service Pack 2 PE 1 5 e Windows Server 2003 with Service Pack 1 PE 1 6 e Windows Vista PE 2 0 e Windows Vista SP1 and Windows Server 2008 PE 2 1 If you already have media with PE1 x distribution unpack the media ISO to a local folder and start the Acronis WinPE ISO Builder by selecting it from start menu gt Acronis The wizard will guide you through the necessary operations Please refer to Adding the Acronis Plug in to WinPE 1 x p 247 for details Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 243 To be able to create or modify PE 2 x images install Acronis WinPE ISO Builder on a machine where Windows Automated Installation Kit AIK is installed The further operations are described in the Adding the Acronis Plug in to WinPE 2 x p 247 section If you do
552. y of working with tasks e Use the filtering and sorting p 302 capabilities to display the desired tasks in the table e Select a task to take an action on it Ta Actions on tasks The following is a guideline for you to perform operations with tasks To Do View details of a task Click View details In the Tasks details p 187 window examine all information related to the selected task View a task s log Click View log The Log p 302 view will display a list of the log entries related to the selected task Run a task Click Run The task will be executed immediately in spite of its schedule 300 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 Stop a task Click stop What will happen if stop the task Generally stopping the task aborts its operation backup recovery validation exporting conversion migration The task enters the Stopping state first then becomes Idle The task schedule if created remains valid To complete the operation you will have to run the task over again recovery task from the disk backup The target volume will be deleted and its space unallocated the same result you will get if the recovery is unsuccessful To recover the lost volume you will have to run the task once again recovery task from the file backup The aborted operation may cause changes in the destination folder Some files may be recovered but some not depending on the period when you stopped
553. you must _ change the account after installation do so by reinstalling the correspondent component Do not change the account manually such as via the Services snap in In addition there are two Acronis services which run under a system account e The Acronis Scheduler service provides scheduling for Acronis components tasks It runs under the Local System account and cannot run under a different account e The Acronis Remote Agent service provides connectivity among Acronis components It runs under the Network Service account and cannot run under a different account 2 11 8 Communication between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components This section describes how Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components communicate with each other using secure authentication and encryption This section also provides information on configuring communication settings selecting a network port for communication and managing security certificates 2 11 8 1 Secure communication Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 provides the capability to secure the data transferred between its components within a local area network and through a perimeter network also known as demilitarized zone DMZ There are two mechanisms which ensure secure communication between Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 components e Secure authentication provides secure transfer of certificates needed to establish a connection by using the Secure Sockets Layer SSL
554. your settings in the summary screen and click Proceed 8 Burn the ISO to CD or DVD using a third party tool or copy to a flash drive Once a machine boots into WinPE Acronis Backup amp Recovery 10 starts automatically To create a PE image ISO file from the resulting WIM file replace the default boot wim file in your Windows PE folder with the newly created WIM file For the above example type copy c AcronisMedia wim c winpe_x86 ISO sources boot wim e use the Oscdimg tool For the above example type oscdimg n bc winpe x86 etfsboot com c winpe_ x86 ISO 248 Copyright Acronis Inc 2000 2009 c winpe x86 winpe x86 1iso Adding Acronis Plug in to WinPE 2 x WIM 1 Select Acronis WinPE ISO Builder from the start menu 2 Specify path to the source WINPE WIM file The standard path to this file for x86 hardware is Program Files Windows AIK Tools PETools x86 winpe wim 3 Specify path to the folder with the Acronis plug in files check the registry key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE SOFTWARE Acronis WinPE Settings WinPE for the plug in location 4 Specify the full path to the resulting WIM file including the file name 5 Check your settings in the summary screen and click Proceed For how to create a PE image ISO file from the resulting WIM file please see the previous section For more information on customizing Windows PE see the Windows Preinstallation Environment User s Guide Winpe chm 6 8 1 4 Building B
Download Pdf Manuals
Related Search
Related Contents
放射温度計 - 日本電産シンポ CamLink CL-ROMA300G 1. ¡BIENVENIDO! User Manual - OÜ Toru Arst Betriebsanleitung für Reka Heißklebepistolen LCD TV SERVICE MANUAL Santé & Bien-être 取扱説明書 - エー・アンド・デイ Copyright © All rights reserved.
Failed to retrieve file